10-K 1 y74032e10vk.htm FORM 10-K 10-K
Table of Contents

 
UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
Washington, D.C. 20549
 
 
 
 
FORM 10-K
ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE
SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934
 
 
 
 
     
For the fiscal year ended November 28, 2008
  Commission File Number: 001-14965
 
The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc.
(Exact name of registrant as specified in its charter)
 
     
Delaware   13-4019460
(State or other jurisdiction of
incorporation or organization)
  (I.R.S. Employer
Identification No.)
     
85 Broad Street
New York, N.Y.
  10004
(Zip Code)
(Address of principal executive offices)    
 
(212) 902-1000
(Registrant’s telephone number, including area code)
 
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:
 
     
Title of each class:
  Name of each exchange on which registered:
Common stock, par value $.01 per share, and attached Shareholder Protection Rights
  New York Stock Exchange
Depositary Shares, Each Representing 1/1,000th Interest in a Share of Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series A
  New York Stock Exchange
Depositary Shares, Each Representing 1/1,000th Interest in a Share of 6.20% Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series B
  New York Stock Exchange
Depositary Shares, Each Representing 1/1,000th Interest in a Share of Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series C
  New York Stock Exchange
Depositary Shares, Each Representing 1/1,000th Interest in a Share of Floating Rate Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series D
  New York Stock Exchange
5.793% Fixed-to-Floating Rate Normal Automatic Preferred Enhanced Capital Securities of Goldman Sachs Capital II (and Registrant’s guarantee with respect thereto)
  New York Stock Exchange
Floating Rate Normal Automatic Preferred Enhanced Capital Securities of Goldman Sachs Capital III (and Registrant’s guarantee with respect thereto)
  New York Stock Exchange
Medium-Term Notes, Series B, Index-Linked Notes due February 2013; Index-Linked Notes due April 2013; Index-Linked Notes due May 2013; Index-Linked Notes due 2010; and Index-Linked Notes due 2011
  NYSE Alternext US
Medium-Term Notes, Series B, 7.35% Notes due 2009; 7.80% Notes due 2010; and Floating Rate Notes due 2011
  New York Stock Exchange
Medium-Term Notes, Series A, Index-Linked Notes due 2037 of GS Finance Corp. (and Registrant’s guarantee with respect thereto)
  NYSE Arca
Medium-Term Notes, Series B, Index-Linked Notes due 2037
  NYSE Arca
Securities registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: None
 
 
 
     Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.
Yes  x     No  o
     Indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Act.
Yes  o     No  x
     Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.
Yes  x     No  o
     Indicate by check mark if disclosure of delinquent filers pursuant to Item 405 of Regulation S-K is not contained herein, and will not be contained, to the best of registrant’s knowledge, in definitive proxy or information statements incorporated by reference in Part III of the Annual Report on Form 10-K or any amendment to the Annual Report on Form 10-K.  x
     Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer, or a smaller reporting company. See the definitions of “large accelerated filer,” “accelerated filer” and “smaller reporting company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.
Large accelerated filer  x     Accelerated filer  o     Non-accelerated filer (Do not check if a smaller reporting company)  o     Smaller reporting company  o
     Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act). Yes  o     No  x
     As of May 30, 2008, the aggregate market value of the common stock of the registrant held by non-affiliates of the registrant was approximately $68.2 billion.
     As of January 16, 2009, there were 461,784,433 shares of the registrant’s common stock outstanding.
     Documents incorporated by reference:  Portions of The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc.’s Proxy Statement for its 2009 Annual Meeting of Shareholders to be held on May 8, 2009 are incorporated by reference in the Annual Report on Form 10-K in response to Part III, Items 10, 11, 12, 13 and 14.
 


 

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC.
 
ANNUAL REPORT ON FORM 10-K FOR THE FISCAL YEAR ENDED NOVEMBER 28, 2008
 
INDEX
 
             
    Page
Form 10-K Item Number:
  No.
 
       
    1  
      1  
        1  
        2  
        3  
        4  
        5  
        14  
        15  
        15  
        15  
        17  
      27  
      40  
      40  
      41  
      50  
        51  
             
       
    53  
      53  
      54  
      55  
      127  
      128  
      219  
      219  
      219  
             
       
    220  
      220  
      220  
      220  
      221  
      221  
             
       
    222  
      222  
    II-1  
    II-2  
 EX-3.1: RESTATED CERTIFICATE OF INCORPORATION
 EX-4.5: FORM OF FLOATING RATE SENIOR DEBT SECURITY (TLGP)
 EX-4.6: FORM OF FIXED RATE SENIOR DEBT SECURITY (TLGP)
 EX-4.7: FORM OF FLOATING RATE MEDIUM-TERM NOTE, SERIES D (TLGP)
 EX-4.8: FORM OF FIXED RATE MEDIUM-TERM NOTE, SERIES D (TLGP)
 EX-10.1: AMENDED AND RESTATED STOCK INCENTIVE PLAN
 EX-10.36: FORM OF YEAR-END OPTION AWARD AGREEMENT
 EX-10.37: FORM OF YEAR-END RSU AWARD AGREEMENT
 EX-10.39: FORM OF YEAR-END RSU AWARD AGREEMENT (FRENCH ALTERNATIVE AWARD)
 EX-10.41: FORM OF NON-EMPLOYEE DIRECTOR OPTION AWARD AGREEMENT
 EX-10.42: FORM OF NON-EMPLOYEE DIRECTOR RSU AWARD AGREEMENT
 EX-10.43: DESCRIPTION OF NON-EMPLOYEE DIRECTOR COMPENSATION
 EX-10.49: FORM OF SIGNATURE CARD FOR EQUITY AWARDS
 EX-10.58: FORM OF LETTER AGREEMENT
 EX-10.59: GENERAL GUARANTEE AGREEMENT - GS BANK EUROPE
 EX-10.60: GUARANTEE AGREEMENT - GS BANK USA
 EX-10.61: COLLATERAL AGREEMENT
 EX-10.62: FORM OF PERFORMANCE-BASED ONE-TIME RSU AWARD AGREEMENT
 EX-10.63: FORM OF MAKE-WHOLE ONE-TIME RSU AWARD AGREEMENT
 EX-10.64: FORM OF INCENTIVE ONE-TIME RSU AWARD AGREEMENT
 EX-10.65: FORM OF YEAR-END SUPPLEMENTAL RSU AWARD AGREEMENT (FRANCE)
 EX-10.66: FORM OF SIGNATURE CARD FOR EQUITY AWARDS (ASIA EX CHINA)
 EX-10.67: FORM OF SIGNATURE CARD FOR EQUITY AWARDS (CHINA)
 EX-10.68: AMENDMENTS TO CERTAIN EQUITY AWARD AGREEMENTS
 EX-10.69: AMENDMENTS TO CERTAIN NON-EMPLOYEE DIRECTOR EQUITY AWARD AGREEMENTS
 EX-12.1: STATEMENT RE: COMPUTATION OF RATIOS
 EX-21.1: LIST OF SIGNIFICANT SUBSIDIARIES
 EX-23.1: CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM
 EX-31.1: RULE 13A-14(A) CERTIFICATIONS
 EX-32.1: SECTION 1350 CERTIFICATIONS
 EX-99.1: REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM


Table of Contents

 
PART I
 
Item 1.   Business
 
Introduction
 
Goldman Sachs is a bank holding company and a leading global investment banking, securities and investment management firm that provides a wide range of services worldwide to a substantial and diversified client base that includes corporations, financial institutions, governments and high-net-worth individuals. Goldman Sachs is the successor to a commercial paper business founded in 1869 by Marcus Goldman. On May 7, 1999, we converted from a partnership to a corporation and completed an initial public offering of our common stock. On September 21, 2008, The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. (Group Inc.) became a bank holding company regulated by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (Federal Reserve Board) under the U.S. Bank Holding Company Act of 1956 (BHC Act). Our depository institution subsidiary, Goldman Sachs Bank USA (GS Bank USA), became a New York State-chartered bank on November 28, 2008.
 
Our activities are divided into three segments: (i) Investment Banking, (ii) Trading and Principal Investments and (iii) Asset Management and Securities Services.
 
All references to 2008, 2007 and 2006 refer to our fiscal years ended, or the dates, as the context requires, November 28, 2008, November 30, 2007 and November 24, 2006, respectively. When we use the terms “Goldman Sachs,” “the firm,” “we,” “us” and “our,” we mean The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc., a Delaware corporation, and its consolidated subsidiaries. References herein to our Annual Report on Form 10-K are to our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 28, 2008.
 
On December 15, 2008, our Board of Directors approved a change in our fiscal year-end from the last Friday of November to the last Friday of December. The change is effective for our 2009 fiscal year. Our 2009 fiscal year began December 27, 2008 and will end December 25, 2009, resulting in a one-month transition period that began November 29, 2008 and ended December 26, 2008. Information on this one-month transition period will be included in our Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the three months ended March 27, 2009.
 
Financial information concerning our business segments and geographic regions for each of 2008, 2007 and 2006 is set forth in “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations,” the consolidated financial statements and the notes thereto, and the supplemental financial information, which are in Part II, Items 7, 7A and 8 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K.
 
Our internet address is www.gs.com and the investor relations section of our web site is located at www.gs.com/shareholders. We make available free of charge, on or through the investor relations section of our web site, annual reports on Form 10-K, quarterly reports on Form 10-Q and current reports on Form 8-K and amendments to those reports filed or furnished pursuant to Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the U.S. Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (Exchange Act), as well as proxy statements, as soon as reasonably practicable after we electronically file such material with, or furnish it to, the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission. Also posted on our web site, and available in print upon request of any shareholder to our Investor Relations Department, are our certificate of incorporation and by-laws, charters for our Audit Committee, Compensation Committee, and Corporate Governance and Nominating Committee, our Policy Regarding Director Independence Determinations, our Policy on Reporting of Concerns Regarding Accounting and Other Matters, our Corporate Governance Guidelines and our Code of Business Conduct and Ethics governing our directors, officers and employees. Within the time period required by the SEC and the New York Stock Exchange, we will post on our web site any amendment to the Code of Business Conduct and Ethics and any waiver applicable to any executive officer, director or senior financial officer (as defined in the Code). In addition, our web site includes information concerning purchases and sales of our equity securities by our executive officers and directors, as well as disclosure relating to certain non-GAAP financial measures (as defined in the SEC’s Regulation G) that we may make public orally, telephonically, by webcast, by broadcast or by similar means from time to time.
 
Our Investor Relations Department can be contacted at The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc., 85 Broad Street, 17th Floor, New York, New York 10004, Attn: Investor Relations, telephone: 212-902-0300, e-mail: gs-investor-relations@gs.com.


1


Table of Contents

 
Cautionary Statement Pursuant to the U.S. Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995
 
We have included or incorporated by reference in our Annual Report on Form 10-K, and from time to time our management may make, statements that may constitute “forward-looking statements” within the meaning of the safe harbor provisions of the U.S. Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. Forward-looking statements are not historical facts but instead represent only our beliefs regarding future events, many of which, by their nature, are inherently uncertain and outside our control. These statements include statements other than historical information or statements of current condition and may relate to our future plans and objectives and results, among other things, and may also include our belief regarding the effect of various legal proceedings, as set forth under “Legal Proceedings” in Part I, Item 3 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K, as well as statements about the objectives and effectiveness of our risk management and liquidity policies, statements about trends in or growth opportunities for our businesses, statements about our future status, activities or reporting under U.S. banking regulation, and statements about our investment banking transaction backlog, in Part II, Item 7 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K. By identifying these statements for you in this manner, we are alerting you to the possibility that our actual results and financial condition may differ, possibly materially, from the anticipated results and financial condition indicated in these forward-looking statements. Important factors that could cause our actual results and financial condition to differ from those indicated in the forward-looking statements include, among others, those discussed below and under “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A of our Annual Report on Form 10-K.
 
In the case of statements about our investment banking transaction backlog, such statements are subject to the risk that the terms of these transactions may be modified or that they may not be completed at all; therefore, the net revenues, if any, that we actually earn from these transactions may differ, possibly materially, from those currently expected. Important factors that could result in a modification of the terms of a transaction or a transaction not being completed include, in the case of underwriting transactions, a decline or continued weakness in general economic conditions, outbreak of hostilities, volatility in the securities markets generally or an adverse development with respect to the issuer of the securities and, in the case of financial advisory transactions, a decline in the securities markets, an inability to obtain adequate financing, an adverse development with respect to a party to the transaction or a failure to obtain a required regulatory approval. For a discussion of other important factors that could adversely affect our investment banking transactions, see “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A of our Annual Report on Form 10-K.


2


Table of Contents

 
Segment Operating Results
(in millions)
 
                             
        Year Ended November
        2008   2007   2006
 
Investment
  Net revenues   $ 5,185     $ 7,555     $ 5,629  
Banking
  Operating expenses     3,143       4,985       4,062  
                             
    Pre-tax earnings   $ 2,042     $ 2,570     $ 1,567  
                             
Trading and Principal
  Net revenues   $ 9,063     $ 31,226     $ 25,562  
Investments
  Operating expenses     11,808       17,998       14,962  
                             
    Pre-tax earnings/(loss)   $ (2,745 )   $ 13,228     $ 10,600  
                             
Asset Management and
  Net revenues   $ 7,974     $ 7,206     $ 6,474  
Securities Services
  Operating expenses     4,939       5,363       4,036  
                             
    Pre-tax earnings   $ 3,035     $ 1,843     $ 2,438  
                             
Total
  Net revenues   $ 22,222     $ 45,987     $ 37,665  
    Operating expenses (1)     19,886       28,383       23,105  
                             
    Pre-tax earnings   $ 2,336     $ 17,604     $ 14,560  
                             
 
 
(1) Operating expenses include net provisions for a number of litigation and regulatory proceedings of $(4) million, $37 million and $45 million for the years ended November 2008, November 2007 and November 2006, respectively, that have not been allocated to our segments.


3


Table of Contents

 
Where We Conduct Business
 
As of November 28, 2008, we operated offices in over 30 countries and 43% of our 30,067 employees were based outside the Americas (which includes the countries in North and South America). In 2008, we derived 30% of our net revenues outside of the Americas. See geographic information in Note 18 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K.
 
Our clients are located worldwide, and we are an active participant in financial markets around the world. We have developed and continue to build strong investment banking relationships in new and developing markets. We also continue to expand our presence throughout these markets to invest strategically when opportunities arise and to work more closely with our private wealth and asset management clients in these regions. Our global reach is illustrated by the following:
 
  •  we are a member of and an active participant in most of the world’s major stock, options and futures exchanges and marketplaces;
 
  •  we are a primary dealer in many of the largest government bond markets around the world;
 
  •  we have interbank dealer status in currency markets around the world;
 
  •  we are a member of or have relationships with major commodities exchanges worldwide; and
 
  •  we have commercial banking or deposit-taking institutions organized or operating in the United States, the United Kingdom, Ireland, Brazil, Switzerland, Germany, France, Russia and South Korea.
 
Our businesses are supported by our Global Investment Research division, which, as of November 2008, provided research coverage of over 3,250 companies worldwide and over 45 national economies, and maintained a presence in locations around the world.
 
We continue to expand our geographic reach. For example, in recent years we have opened offices in Mumbai, Moscow, Sao Paulo, Dubai, Qatar, Riyadh and Tel Aviv, become licensed as a broker-dealer in Russia, India and China, opened banks in Brazil, Ireland and Russia and entered into the asset management business in South Korea and India.


4


Table of Contents

 
Business Segments
 
The primary products and activities of our business segments are set forth in the following chart:
 
       
Business Segment/Component     Primary Products and Activities
Investment Banking:
     
Financial Advisory
   
•  Mergers and acquisitions advisory services
     
•  Financial restructuring advisory services
       
Underwriting
   
•  Equity and debt underwriting
       
 
Trading and Principal Investments:
     
Fixed Income, Currency and Commodities
   
•  Commodities and commodity derivatives, including power generation and related activities
     
•  Credit products, including trading and investing in credit derivatives, investment-grade corporate securities, high-yield securities, bank and secured loans, municipal securities, emerging market and distressed debt, public and private equity securities and real estate
     
•  Currencies and currency derivatives
     
•  Interest rate products, including interest rate derivatives, global government securities and money market instruments, including matched book positions
     
•  Mortgage-related securities and loan products and other asset-backed instruments
       
Equities
   
•  Equity securities and derivatives
     
•  Securities, futures and options clearing services
     
•  Market-making and specialist activities in equity securities and options
     
•  Insurance activities
       
Principal Investments
   
•  Principal investments in connection with merchant banking activities
     
•  Investment in the ordinary shares of Industrial and Commercial Bank of China Limited
       
 
Asset Management and Securities Services:
     
Asset Management
   
•  Investment advisory services, financial planning and investment products (primarily through separately managed accounts and commingled vehicles) across all major asset classes, including money markets, fixed income, equities and alternative investments (including hedge funds, private equity, real estate, currencies, commodities and asset allocation strategies), for institutional and individual investors (including high-net-worth clients, as well as retail clients through third-party channels)
     
•  Management of merchant banking funds
       
Securities Services
   
•  Prime brokerage
     
•  Financing services
     
•  Securities lending
       
 


5


Table of Contents

Investment Banking
 
Investment Banking represented 23% of 2008 net revenues. We provide a broad range of investment banking services to a diverse group of corporations, financial institutions, investment funds, governments and individuals and seek to develop and maintain long-term relationships with these clients as their lead investment bank.
 
Our current structure, which is organized by regional, industry and product groups, seeks to combine client-focused investment bankers with execution and industry expertise. We continually assess and adapt our organization to meet the demands of our clients in each geographic region. Through our commitment to teamwork, we believe that we provide services in an integrated fashion for the benefit of our clients.
 
Our goal is to make available to our clients the entire resources of the firm in a seamless fashion, with investment banking serving as “front of the house.” To accomplish this objective, we focus on coordination among our equity and debt underwriting activities and our corporate risk and liability management activities. This coordination is intended to assist our investment banking clients in managing their asset and liability exposures and their capital.
 
Our Investment Banking segment is divided into two components: Financial Advisory and Underwriting.
 
Financial Advisory
 
Financial Advisory includes advisory assignments with respect to mergers and acquisitions, divestitures, corporate defense activities, restructurings and spin-offs. Our mergers and acquisitions capabilities are evidenced by our significant share of assignments in large, complex transactions for which we provide multiple services, including “one-stop” acquisition financing and cross-border structuring expertise, as well as services in other areas of the firm, such as interest rate and currency hedging. In particular, a significant number of the loan commitments and bank and bridge loan facilities that we enter into arise in connection with our advisory assignments.
 
Underwriting
 
Underwriting includes public offerings and private placements of a wide range of securities and other financial instruments, including common and preferred stock, convertible and exchangeable securities, investment-grade debt, high-yield debt, sovereign and emerging market debt, municipal debt, bank loans, asset-backed securities and real estate-related securities, such as mortgage-related securities and the securities of real estate investment trusts.
 
Equity Underwriting.  Equity underwriting has been a long-term core strength of Goldman Sachs. As with mergers and acquisitions, we have been particularly successful in winning mandates for large, complex transactions. We believe our leadership in worldwide initial public offerings and worldwide public common stock offerings reflects our expertise in complex transactions, prior experience and distribution capabilities.
 
Debt Underwriting.  We engage in the underwriting and origination of various types of debt instruments, including investment-grade debt securities, high-yield debt securities, bank and bridge loans and emerging market debt securities, which may be issued by, among others, corporate, sovereign and agency issuers. In addition, we underwrite and originate structured securities, which include mortgage-related securities and other asset-backed securities and collateralized debt obligations.


6


Table of Contents

Trading and Principal Investments
 
Trading and Principal Investments represented 41% of 2008 net revenues. Trading and Principal Investments facilitates client transactions with a diverse group of corporations, financial institutions, investment funds, governments and individuals and takes proprietary positions through market making in, trading of and investing in fixed income and equity products, currencies, commodities and derivatives on these products. In addition, we engage in market-making and specialist activities on equities and options exchanges, and we clear client transactions on major stock, options and futures exchanges worldwide. In connection with our merchant banking and other investing activities, we make principal investments directly and through funds that we raise and manage.
 
To meet the needs of our clients, Trading and Principal Investments is diversified across a wide range of products. We believe our willingness and ability to take risk to facilitate client transactions distinguishes us from many of our competitors and substantially enhances our client relationships.
 
Our Trading and Principal Investments segment is divided into three components: Fixed Income, Currency and Commodities; Equities; and Principal Investments.
 
Fixed Income, Currency and Commodities and Equities
 
Fixed Income, Currency and Commodities (FICC) and Equities are large and diversified operations through which we engage in a variety of client-driven and proprietary trading and investing activities.
 
In our client-driven businesses, FICC and Equities strive to deliver high-quality service by offering broad market-making and market knowledge to our clients on a global basis. In addition, we use our expertise to take positions in markets, by committing capital and taking risk, to facilitate client transactions and to provide liquidity. Our willingness to make markets, commit capital and take risk in a broad range of fixed income, currency, commodity and equity products and their derivatives is crucial to our client relationships and to support our underwriting business by providing secondary market liquidity.
 
We generate trading net revenues from our client-driven businesses in three ways:
 
  •  First, in large, highly liquid markets, we undertake a high volume of transactions for modest spreads and fees.
 
  •  Second, by capitalizing on our strong relationships and capital position, we undertake transactions in less liquid markets where spreads and fees are generally larger.
 
  •  Finally, we structure and execute transactions that address complex client needs.
 
Our FICC and Equities businesses operate in close coordination to provide clients with services and cross-market knowledge and expertise.
 
In our proprietary activities in both FICC and Equities, we assume a variety of risks and devote resources to identify, analyze and benefit from these exposures. We capitalize on our analytical models to analyze information and make informed trading judgments, and we seek to benefit from perceived disparities in the value of assets in the trading markets and from macroeconomic and issuer-specific trends.


7


Table of Contents

FICC
 
We make markets in and trade interest rate and credit products, mortgage-related securities and loan products and other asset-backed instruments, currencies and commodities, structure and enter into a wide variety of derivative transactions, and engage in proprietary trading and investing. FICC has five principal businesses: commodities; credit products; currencies; interest rate products, including money market instruments; and mortgage-related securities and loan products and other asset-backed instruments.
 
Commodities.  We enter into trades with our clients in, make markets in, and trade for our own account a wide variety of commodities, commodity derivatives and interests in commodity-related assets, including oil and oil products, metals, natural gas and electricity, and forest products. As part of our commodities business, we acquire and dispose of interests in, and engage in the development and operation of, electric power generation facilities and related activities.
 
Credit Products.  We offer to and trade for our clients a broad array of credit and credit-linked products all over the world, including credit derivatives, investment-grade corporate securities, high-yield securities, bank and secured loans (origination and trading), municipal securities, and emerging market and distressed debt. For example, we enter, as principal, into complex structured transactions designed to meet client needs.
 
In addition, we provide credit through bridge and other loan facilities to a broad range of clients. Commitments that are extended for contingent acquisition financing are often intended to be short-term in nature, as borrowers often seek to replace them with other funding sources. As part of our ongoing credit origination activities, we may seek to reduce our credit risk on commitments by syndicating all or substantial portions of commitments to other investors or, upon funding, by securitizing the positions through investment vehicles sold to other investors. Underwriting fees from syndications of these commitments are recorded in debt underwriting in our Investment Banking segment. However, to the extent that we recognize losses on these commitments, such losses are recorded within our Trading and Principal Investments segment, net of any related underwriting fees. See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Contractual Obligations and Commitments” in Part II, Item 7 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for additional information on our commitments.
 
Our credit products business includes making significant long-term and short-term investments for our own account (sometimes investing together with our merchant banking funds) in a broad array of asset classes (including distressed debt) globally. We opportunistically invest in debt and equity securities and secured loans, and in private equity, real estate and other assets.
 
Currencies.  We act as a dealer in foreign exchange and trade for our clients and ourselves in most currencies on exchanges and in cash and derivative markets globally.
 
Interest Rate Products.  We trade and make markets in a variety of interest rate products, including interest rate swaps, options and other derivatives, and government bonds, as well as money market instruments, such as commercial paper, treasury bills, repurchase agreements and other highly liquid securities and instruments. This business includes our matched book, which consists of short-term collateralized financing transactions.
 
Mortgage Business.  We make markets in and trade for our clients and ourselves commercial and residential mortgage-related securities and loan products (including agency prime and non-agency prime, Alt-A and subprime mortgages) and other asset-backed and derivative instruments. We acquire positions in these products for proprietary trading purposes as well as for securitization or syndication. We also originate and service commercial and residential mortgages.


8


Table of Contents

Equities
 
We make markets in and trade equities and equity-related products, structure and enter into equity derivative transactions, and engage in proprietary trading. We generate commissions from executing and clearing client transactions on major stock, options and futures exchanges worldwide through our Equities client franchise and clearing activities.
 
Equities includes two principal businesses: our client franchise business and principal strategies. We also engage in specialist and insurance activities.
 
Client Franchise Business.  Our client franchise business includes primarily client-driven activities in the shares, equity derivatives and convertible securities markets. These activities also include clearing client transactions on major stock, options and futures exchanges worldwide, as well as our options specialist and market-making businesses. Our client franchise business increasingly involves providing our clients with access to electronic “low-touch” equity trading platforms, and electronic trades account for the majority of our client trading activity in this business. However, a majority of our net revenues in this business continues to be derived from our traditional “high-touch” handling of more complex trades. We expect both types of trading activities to remain important components of our client franchise business.
 
We trade equity securities and equity-related products, including convertible securities, options, futures and over-the-counter (OTC) derivative instruments, on a global basis as an agent, as a market maker or otherwise as a principal. As a principal, we facilitate client transactions, often by committing capital and taking risk, to provide liquidity to clients with large blocks of stocks or options. For example, we are active in the execution of large block trades. We also execute transactions as agent and offer clients direct electronic access to trading markets.
 
In the options and futures markets, we structure, distribute and execute derivatives on market indices, industry groups, financial measures and individual company stocks to facilitate client transactions and our proprietary activities. We develop strategies and render advice with respect to portfolio hedging and restructuring and asset allocation transactions. We also create specially tailored instruments to enable sophisticated investors to undertake hedging strategies and to establish or liquidate investment positions. We are one of the leading participants in the trading and development of equity derivative instruments. In options, we are a specialist and/or market maker on the International Securities Exchange, the Chicago Board Options Exchange, NYSE Arca, the Boston Options Exchange, the Philadelphia Stock Exchange, NYSE Alternext US and the Chicago Mercantile Exchange.
 
Principal Strategies.  Our principal strategies business is a multi-strategy investment business that invests and trades our capital across global markets. Investment strategies include fundamental equities and relative value trading (which involves trading strategies designed to take advantage of perceived discrepancies in the relative value of financial instruments, including equity, equity-related and debt instruments), event-driven investments (which focus on event-oriented special situations such as corporate restructurings, bankruptcies, recapitalizations, mergers and acquisitions, and legal and regulatory events), convertible bond trading, various types of volatility trading and principal finance.
 
At the start of our first fiscal quarter of 2008, we reassigned approximately one-half of the traders and other personnel and transferred approximately one-half of the firm’s assets comprising our principal strategies business to our asset management business in an effort to strengthen and diversify our asset management offerings. These assets are invested in an alternative investment fund managed by our asset management business.


9


Table of Contents

Specialist Activities.  Our specialist activities business consists of our stock and exchange-traded funds (ETF) specialist and market-making businesses. We engage in specialist and market-making activities on equities exchanges. In the United States, we are one of the leading designated market makers for stocks traded on the NYSE. For ETFs, we are registered market makers on NYSE Arca.
 
Insurance Activities.  Through our insurance subsidiaries, we engage in a range of insurance and reinsurance businesses, including buying, originating and/or reinsuring variable annuity and life insurance contracts, reinsuring property catastrophe and residential homeowner risks and providing power interruption coverage to power generating facilities.
 
Principal Investments
 
Principal Investments primarily represents net revenues from three primary sources: returns on corporate and real estate investments; overrides on corporate and real estate investments made by merchant banking funds that we manage; and our investment in the ordinary shares of Industrial and Commercial Bank of China Limited (ICBC).
 
Returns on Corporate and Real Estate Investments.  As of November 2008, the aggregate carrying value of our principal investments held directly or through our merchant banking funds, excluding our investment in the ordinary shares of ICBC, was $15.13 billion, comprised of corporate principal investments with an aggregate carrying value of $12.16 billion and real estate investments with an aggregate carrying value of $2.97 billion. In addition, as of November 2008, we had outstanding unfunded equity capital commitments of up to $13.47 billion, comprised of corporate principal investment commitments of $10.39 billion and real estate investment commitments of $3.08 billion.
 
Overrides.  Consists of the increased share of the income and gains derived from our merchant banking funds when the return on a fund’s investments over the life of the fund exceeds certain threshold returns (typically referred to as an override). Overrides are recognized in net revenues when all material contingencies have been resolved.
 
ICBC.  Our investment in the ordinary shares of ICBC was acquired on April 28, 2006. The ordinary shares acquired from ICBC are subject to transfer restrictions that, among other things, prohibit any sale, disposition or other transfer until April 28, 2009. From April 28, 2009 to October 20, 2009, we may transfer up to 50% of the aggregate ordinary shares of ICBC that we owned as of October 20, 2006. We may transfer the remaining shares after October 20, 2009. As of November 2008, the fair value of our investment in the ordinary shares of ICBC was $5.50 billion. A portion of our interest is held by investment funds managed by Goldman Sachs. For further information regarding our investment in the ordinary shares of ICBC, see “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Critical Accounting Policies — Fair Value — Cash Instruments” in Part II, Item 7 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K.


10


Table of Contents

Asset Management and Securities Services
 
Asset Management and Securities Services represented 36% of 2008 net revenues. Our asset management business provides investment advisory and financial planning services and offers investment products (primarily through separately managed accounts and commingled vehicles) across all major asset classes to a diverse group of institutions and individuals worldwide and primarily generates revenues in the form of management and incentive fees. Securities Services provides prime brokerage services, financing services and securities lending services to institutional clients, including hedge funds, mutual funds, pension funds and foundations, and to high-net-worth individuals worldwide, and generates revenues primarily in the form of interest rate spreads or fees.
 
Our Asset Management and Securities Services segment is divided into two components: Asset Management and Securities Services.
 
Asset Management
 
We offer a broad array of investment strategies, advice and planning. We provide asset management services and offer investment products (primarily through separately managed accounts and commingled vehicles, such as mutual funds and private investment funds) across all major asset classes: money markets, fixed income, equities and alternative investments (including hedge funds, private equity, real estate, currencies, commodities and asset allocation strategies). Through our subsidiary, The Ayco Company, L.P., we also provide fee-based financial counseling and financial education in the United States.
 
Assets under management (AUM) typically generate fees as a percentage of asset value, which is affected by investment performance and by inflows and redemptions. The fees that we charge vary by asset class, as do our related expenses. In certain circumstances, we are also entitled to receive incentive fees based on a percentage of a fund’s return or when the return on assets under management exceeds specified benchmark returns or other performance targets. Incentive fees are recognized when the performance period ends and they are no longer subject to adjustment. We have numerous incentive fee arrangements, many of which have annual performance periods that end on December 31. For that reason, incentive fees have been seasonally weighted to our first quarter.
 
AUM includes our mutual funds, alternative investment funds and separately managed accounts for institutional and individual investors. Alternative investments include our merchant banking funds, which generate revenues as described below under “— Management of Merchant Banking Funds.” AUM includes assets in clients’ brokerage accounts to the extent that they generate fees based on the assets in the accounts rather than commissions on transactional activity in the accounts.
 
AUM does not include assets in brokerage accounts that generate commissions, mark-ups and spreads based on transactional activity, or our own investments in funds that we manage. Net revenues from these assets are included in our Trading and Principal Investments segment. AUM also does not include non-fee-paying assets, including interest-bearing deposits held through our bank depository institution subsidiaries.


11


Table of Contents

The amount of AUM is set forth in the graph below. In the following graph, as well as in the following tables, substantially all assets under management are valued as of November 30:
 
Assets Under Management
(in billions)
 
(ASSETS UNDER MANAGEMENT CHART)
 
 
The following table sets forth AUM by asset class:
 
Assets Under Management by Asset Class
(in billions)
 
                         
    As of November 30
    2008   2007   2006
Alternative investments (1)
  $ 146     $ 151     $ 145  
Equity
    112       255       215  
Fixed income
    248       256       198  
                         
Total non-money market assets
    506       662       558  
Money markets
    273       206       118  
                         
Total assets under management
  $ 779     $ 868     $ 676  
                         
 
 
(1) Primarily includes hedge funds, private equity, real estate, currencies, commodities and asset allocation strategies.


12


Table of Contents

Clients.  Our clients are institutions and individuals, including both high-net-worth and retail investors. We access institutional and high-net-worth clients through both direct and third-party channels and retail clients primarily through third-party channels. Our institutional clients include pension funds, governmental organizations, corporations, insurance companies, banks, foundations and endowments. In third-party distribution channels, we distribute our mutual funds, alternative investment funds and separately managed accounts through brokerage firms, banks, insurance companies and other financial intermediaries. Our clients are located worldwide.
 
The table below sets forth the amount of AUM by distribution channel and client category:
 
Assets Under Management by Distribution Channel
(in billions)
 
                         
    As of November 30
    2008   2007   2006
• Directly Distributed
                       
— Institutional
  $ 273     $ 354     $ 296  
— High-net-worth individuals
    215       219       177  
                         
Third-Party Distributed
                       
— Institutional, high-net-worth individuals and retail
    291       295       203  
                         
Total
  $ 779     $ 868     $ 676  
                         
 
 
Management of Merchant Banking Funds.  Goldman Sachs sponsors numerous corporate and real estate private investment funds. As of November 2008, the amount of AUM in these funds (including both funded amounts and unfunded commitments on which we earn fees) was $93 billion.
 
Our strategy with respect to these funds generally is to invest opportunistically to build a portfolio of investments that is diversified by industry, product type, geographic region, and transaction structure and type. Our corporate investment funds pursue, on a global basis, long-term investments in equity and debt securities in privately negotiated transactions, leveraged buyouts, acquisitions and investments in funds managed by external parties. Our real estate investment funds invest in real estate operating companies, debt and equity interests in real estate assets, and other real estate-related investments. In addition, our merchant banking funds include funds that invest in infrastructure and infrastructure-related assets and companies on a global basis.
 
Merchant banking activities generate three primary revenue streams. First, we receive a management fee that is generally a percentage of a fund’s committed capital, invested capital, total gross acquisition cost or asset value. These annual management fees are included in our Asset Management net revenues. Second, Goldman Sachs, as a substantial investor in some of these funds, is allocated its proportionate share of the funds’ unrealized appreciation or depreciation arising from changes in fair value as well as gains and losses upon realization. Third, after a fund has achieved a minimum return for fund investors, we receive an increased share of the fund’s income and gains that is a percentage of the income and gains from the fund’s investments. The second and third of these revenue streams are included in Principal Investments within our Trading and Principal Investments segment.


13


Table of Contents

Securities Services
 
Securities Services provides prime brokerage services, financing services and securities lending services to institutional clients, including hedge funds, mutual funds, pension funds and foundations, and to high-net-worth individuals worldwide.
 
Prime brokerage services.  We offer prime brokerage services to our clients, allowing them the flexibility to trade with most brokers while maintaining a single source for financing and consolidated portfolio reports. Our prime brokerage business provides clearing and custody in 53 markets globally and provides consolidated multi-currency accounting and reporting, fund administration and other ancillary services.
 
Financing services.  A central element of our prime brokerage business involves providing financing to our clients for their securities trading activities through margin and securities loans that are collateralized by securities, cash or other acceptable collateral.
 
Securities lending services.  Securities lending services principally involve the borrowing and lending of securities to cover clients’ and Goldman Sachs’ short sales and otherwise to make deliveries into the market. In addition, we are an active participant in the broker-to-broker securities lending business and the third-party agency lending business. Net revenues in securities lending services are, as a general matter, weighted toward our second and third quarters each year due to seasonally higher activity levels in Europe.
 
Global Investment Research
 
Global Investment Research provides fundamental research on companies, industries, economies, currencies and commodities and macro strategy research on a worldwide basis.
 
Global Investment Research employs a team approach that as of November 2008 provided research coverage of over 3,250 companies worldwide and over 45 national economies. This is accomplished by the following departments:
 
  •  The Equity Research Departments provide fundamental analysis, earnings forecasts and investment opinions for equity securities;
 
  •  The Credit Research Department provides fundamental analysis, forecasts and investment opinions as to investment-grade and high-yield corporate bonds and credit derivatives; and
 
  •  The Global ECS Department (formed in December 2008 through a consolidation of the Economic, Commodities and Strategy Research Departments) formulates macroeconomic forecasts for economic activity, foreign exchange and interest rates, provides research on the commodity markets, and provides equity market forecasts, opinions on both asset and industry sector allocation, equity trading strategies, credit trading strategies and options research.
 
Further information regarding research at Goldman Sachs is provided below under “— Regulation — Regulations Applicable in and Outside the United States” and “Legal Proceedings — Research Independence Matters” in Part I, Item 3 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K.


14


Table of Contents

 
Business Continuity and Information Security
 
Business continuity and information security are high priorities for Goldman Sachs. Our Business Continuity Program has been developed to provide reasonable assurance of business continuity in the event of disruptions at the firm’s critical facilities and to comply with the regulatory requirements of the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority (FINRA). Because we are a bank holding company, our Business Continuity Program will be subject to review by the Federal Reserve Board. The key elements of the program are crisis management, people recovery facilities, business recovery, systems and data recovery, and process improvement. In the area of information security, we have developed and implemented a framework of principles, policies and technology to protect the information assets of the firm and our clients. Safeguards are applied to maintain the confidentiality, integrity and availability of information resources.
 
Employees
 
Management believes that a major strength and principal reason for the success of Goldman Sachs is the quality and dedication of our people and the shared sense of being part of a team. We strive to maintain a work environment that fosters professionalism, excellence, diversity, cooperation among our employees worldwide and high standards of business ethics.
 
Instilling the Goldman Sachs culture in all employees is a continuous process, in which training plays an important part. All employees are offered the opportunity to participate in education and periodic seminars that we sponsor at various locations throughout the world. Another important part of instilling the Goldman Sachs culture is our employee review process. Employees are reviewed by supervisors, co-workers and employees they supervise in a 360-degree review process that is integral to our team approach.
 
As of November 2008, we had 30,067 employees, excluding 4,671 employees of certain consolidated entities that are held for investment purposes only. Consolidated entities held for investment purposes are entities that are held strictly for capital appreciation, have a defined exit strategy and are engaged in activities that are not closely related to our principal businesses.
 
Competition
 
The financial services industry — and all of our businesses — are intensely competitive, and we expect them to remain so. Our competitors are other entities that provide investment banking, securities and investment management services, as well as those entities that make investments in securities, commodities, derivatives, real estate, loans and other financial assets. These entities include brokers and dealers, investment banking firms, commercial banks, insurance companies, investment advisers, mutual funds, hedge funds, private equity funds and merchant banks. We compete with some of our competitors globally and with others on a regional, product or niche basis. Our competition is based on a number of factors, including transaction execution, our products and services, innovation, reputation and price.
 
We also face intense competition in attracting and retaining qualified employees. Our ability to continue to compete effectively in our businesses will depend upon our ability to attract new employees and retain and motivate our existing employees.


15


Table of Contents

Over time, there has been substantial consolidation and convergence among companies in the financial services industry. This trend accelerated over the course of the past year as the credit crisis caused numerous mergers and asset acquisitions among industry participants. Many commercial banks and other broad-based financial services firms have had the ability for some time to offer a wide range of products, from loans, deposit-taking and insurance to brokerage, asset management and investment banking services, which may enhance their competitive position. They also have had the ability to support investment banking and securities products with commercial banking, insurance and other financial services revenues in an effort to gain market share, which has resulted in pricing pressure in our investment banking and trading businesses and could result in pricing pressure in other of our businesses.
 
Moreover, we have faced, and expect to continue to face, pressure to retain market share by committing capital to businesses or transactions on terms that offer returns that may not be commensurate with their risks. In particular, corporate clients seek such commitments (such as agreements to participate in their commercial paper backstop or other loan facilities) from financial services firms in connection with investment banking and other assignments.
 
We provide these commitments primarily through GS Bank USA and its subsidiaries, including our William Street entities and Goldman Sachs Credit Partners L.P. With respect to most of the William Street commitments, Sumitomo Mitsui Financial Group, Inc. (SMFG) provides us with credit loss protection that is generally limited to 95% of the first loss we realize on approved loan commitments, up to a maximum of $1.00 billion. In addition, subject to the satisfaction of certain conditions, upon our request, SMFG will provide protection for 70% of additional losses on such commitments, up to a maximum of $1.13 billion, of which $375 million of protection has been provided as of November 2008. We also use other financial instruments to mitigate credit risks related to certain William Street commitments not covered by SMFG. See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Contractual Obligations and Commitments” in Part II, Item 7 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K and Note 8 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for more information regarding the William Street entities and for a description of the credit loss protection provided by SMFG. An increasing number of our commitments in connection with investment banking and other assignments do not meet the criteria established for the William Street entities and do not benefit from the SMFG loss protection. These commitments are issued through GS Bank USA and its subsidiaries or our other subsidiaries.
 
The trend toward consolidation and convergence has significantly increased the capital base and geographic reach of some of our competitors. This trend has also hastened the globalization of the securities and other financial services markets. As a result, we have had to commit capital to support our international operations and to execute large global transactions. To take advantage of some of our most significant challenges and opportunities, we will have to compete successfully with financial institutions that are larger and better capitalized and that may have a stronger local presence and longer operating history outside the United States.
 
We have experienced intense price competition in some of our businesses in recent years. There has been considerable pressure in the pricing of block trades. Also, equity and debt underwriting discounts, as well as trading spreads, have been under pressure for a number of years and the ability to execute trades electronically, through the internet and through alternative trading systems, has increased the pressure on trading commissions. It appears that this trend toward electronic and other “low-touch,” low-commission trading will continue. We believe that we will continue to experience competitive pressures in these and other areas in the future as some of our competitors seek to obtain market share by reducing prices.


16


Table of Contents

 
Regulation
 
Goldman Sachs, as a participant in the banking, securities, commodity futures and options and insurance industries, is subject to extensive regulation in the United States and the other countries in which we operate. See “Risk Factors — Our businesses and those of our clients are subject to extensive and pervasive regulation around the world” in Part I, Item 1A of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for a further discussion of the effect that regulation may have on our businesses. As a matter of public policy, regulatory bodies around the world are charged with safeguarding the integrity of the securities and other financial markets and with protecting the interests of clients participating in those markets, including depositors in U.S. depository institutions such as GS Bank USA. They are not, however, generally charged with protecting the interests of Goldman Sachs’ shareholders or creditors.
 
On September 21, 2008, Group Inc. became a bank holding company under the BHC Act. As of that date, the Federal Reserve Board became the primary U.S. regulator of Group Inc., as a consolidated entity. Prior to September 21, 2008, Group Inc. was subject to regulation by the SEC as a Consolidated Supervised Entity (CSE) and was subject to group-wide supervision and examination by the SEC and to minimum capital standards on a consolidated basis. On September 26, 2008, the SEC announced that it was ending the CSE program. Our principal U.S. broker-dealer, Goldman, Sachs & Co. (GS&Co.) remains subject to regulation by the SEC.
 
Banking Regulation
 
Supervision and Regulation
 
As a bank holding company under the BHC Act, Group Inc. is now subject to supervision and examination by the Federal Reserve Board. Under the system of “functional regulation” established under the BHC Act, the Federal Reserve Board supervises Group Inc., including all of its nonbank subsidiaries, as an “umbrella regulator” of the consolidated organization and generally defers to the primary U.S. regulators of Group Inc.’s U.S. depository institution subsidiary, as applicable, and to the other U.S. regulators of Group Inc.’s U.S. non-depository institution subsidiaries that regulate certain activities of those subsidiaries. Such “functionally regulated” non-depository institution subsidiaries include broker-dealers registered with the SEC, insurance companies regulated by state insurance authorities, investment advisors registered with the SEC with respect to their investment advisory activities and entities regulated by the U.S. Commodity Futures Trading Commission (CFTC) with respect to certain futures-related activities.
 
Activities
 
The BHC Act generally restricts us from engaging in business activities other than the business of banking and certain closely related activities. However, the BHC Act also grants a new bank holding company, such as Group Inc., two years from the date the entity becomes a bank holding company to comply with the restrictions on its activities imposed by the BHC Act with respect to any activities that it was engaged in when it became a bank holding company. We expect that this “grandfather” right will allow us to continue to conduct our business substantially as we have in the past until at least September 22, 2010. In addition, under the BHC Act, we can apply to the Federal Reserve Board for up to three one-year extensions.
 
Under the U.S. Gramm-Leach-Bliley Act of 1999 (GLB Act), an eligible bank holding company may elect to become a “financial holding company.” Financial holding companies may engage in a broader range of financial and related activities than are permissible for bank holding companies as long as they continue to meet the eligibility requirements for financial holding companies. These activities include underwriting, dealing and making markets in securities, insurance underwriting and making merchant banking investments in nonfinancial companies. In addition, the GLB Act also allows a company that was not a bank holding company and becomes a financial holding company after November 12, 1999 to continue to engage in certain commodities activities that are otherwise


17


Table of Contents

impermissible for bank holding companies if the company was engaged in any of these activities in the United States as of September 30, 1997 and if the assets held pursuant to these activities do not equal 5% or more of the consolidated assets of the bank holding company.
 
We intend to apply to elect to become a financial holding company under the GLB Act as soon as practicable. Our ability to achieve and maintain financial holding company status is dependent on a number of factors, including our U.S. depository institution subsidiaries continuing to qualify as “well capitalized” as described under “— Prompt Corrective Action” below. We do not believe that any activities that are material to our current or currently proposed business would be impermissible activities for us as a financial holding company.
 
As a bank holding company, Group Inc. is required to obtain prior Federal Reserve Board approval before directly or indirectly acquiring more than 5% of any class of voting shares of any unaffiliated depository institution. In addition, as a bank holding company, we may generally engage in banking and other financial activities abroad, including investing in and owning non-U.S. banks, if those activities and investments do not exceed certain limits and, in some cases, if we have obtained the prior approval of the Federal Reserve Board.
 
Capital Requirements
 
We are subject to regulatory capital requirements administered by the U.S. federal banking agencies. Our bank depository institution subsidiaries, including GS Bank USA, are subject to similar capital guidelines. Under the Federal Reserve Board’s capital adequacy guidelines and the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action (PCA) that is applicable to GS Bank USA, Goldman Sachs and its bank depository institution subsidiaries must meet specific capital guidelines that involve quantitative measures of assets, liabilities and certain off-balance-sheet items as calculated under regulatory reporting practices. Goldman Sachs and its bank depository institution subsidiaries’ capital amounts, as well as GS Bank USA’s PCA classification, are also subject to qualitative judgments by the regulators about components, risk weightings and other factors. We anticipate reporting capital ratios as follows:
 
  •  Before we became a bank holding company, we were subject to capital guidelines by the SEC as a CSE that were generally consistent with those set out in the Revised Framework for the International Convergence of Capital Measurement and Capital Standards issued by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (Basel II). We currently compute and report our firmwide capital ratios in accordance with the Basel II requirements as applicable to us when we were regulated as a CSE for the purpose of assessing the adequacy of our capital. We expect to continue to report to investors for a period of time our Basel II capital ratios as applicable to us when we were regulated as a CSE.
 
  •  The regulatory capital guidelines currently applicable to bank holding companies are based on the Capital Accord of the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (Basel I), with Basel II to be phased in over time. We are currently working with the Federal Reserve Board to put in place the appropriate reporting and compliance mechanisms and methodologies to allow reporting of the Basel I capital ratios as of the end of March 2009.
 
  •  In addition, we are currently working to implement the Basel II framework as applicable to us as a bank holding company (as opposed to as a CSE). U.S. banking regulators have incorporated the Basel II framework into the existing risk-based capital requirements by requiring that internationally active banking organizations, such as Group Inc., transition to Basel II over the next several years.
 
Under the Basel II framework as it applied to us when we were regulated as a CSE, we evaluate our Tier 1 Capital and Total Allowable Capital as a percentage of Risk-Weighted Assets (RWAs). RWAs are calculated based on the level of market risk, credit risk and operational risk associated with our business activities, using methodologies generally consistent with those set out in Basel II. Our


18


Table of Contents

Tier 1 Capital consists of common shareholders’ equity, qualifying preferred stock (including the cumulative preferred stock issued by Group Inc. to the U.S. Department of the Treasury’s (U.S. Treasury) TARP Capital Purchase Program and our junior subordinated debt issued to trusts, less deductions for goodwill, disallowed intangible assets and other items. Our Total Allowable Capital consists of our Tier 1 Capital and our qualifying subordinated debt, less certain deductions. Additional information on the calculation of our Tier 1 Capital, Total Allowable Capital and RWAs under the Basel II framework as it applied to us as a CSE is set forth in “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Equity Capital — Consolidated Capital Requirements,” and in Note 17 to the consolidated financial statements, which are in Part II, Items 7 and 8 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K. As of November 2008, our Total Capital Ratio (Total Allowable Capital as a percentage of RWAs) was 18.9% and our Tier 1 Ratio (Tier 1 Capital as a percentage of RWAs) was 15.6%, in each case calculated under the Basel II framework as it applied to us when we were regulated as a CSE.
 
As noted above, we are currently working to implement the Basel II framework as applicable to us as a bank holding company (as opposed to as a CSE). During a parallel period, we anticipate that Group Inc.’s capital calculations computed under both the Basel I rules and the Basel II rules will be reported to the Federal Reserve Board for examination and compliance for at least four consecutive quarterly periods. Once the parallel period and subsequent three-year transition period are successfully completed, Group Inc. will utilize the Basel II framework as its means of capital adequacy assessment, measurement and reporting and will discontinue use of Basel I. Internationally, the Basel II framework was implemented in several countries during the second half of 2007 and in 2008, while others will begin implementation in 2009. The Basel II rules therefore also apply to certain of our operations in non-U.S. jurisdictions.
 
The Federal Reserve Board also has established minimum leverage ratio guidelines. We were not subject to these guidelines before becoming a bank holding company and, accordingly, we are currently working with the Federal Reserve Board to finalize our methodology for calculating this ratio. The Tier 1 leverage ratio is defined as Tier 1 capital (as applicable to us as a bank holding company) divided by adjusted average total assets (which includes adjustments for disallowed goodwill and certain intangible assets). The minimum Tier 1 leverage ratio is 3% for bank holding companies that have received the highest supervisory rating under Federal Reserve Board guidelines or that have implemented the Federal Reserve Board’s risk-based capital measure for market risk. Other bank holding companies must have a minimum Tier 1 leverage ratio of 4%. Bank holding companies may be expected to maintain ratios well above the minimum levels, depending upon their particular condition, risk profile and growth plans. As of November 2008, our estimated Tier 1 leverage ratio was 6.1%. This ratio represents a preliminary estimate and may be revised in subsequent filings as we continue to work with the Federal Reserve Board to finalize the methodology for the calculation.
 
GS&Co. will continue to calculate its regulatory capital requirements in accordance with the market and credit risk standards of Appendix E of Rule 15c3-1 under the Exchange Act, which are consistent with Basel II.
 
Payment of Dividends
 
Federal and state law imposes limitations on the payment of dividends by our bank depository institution subsidiaries. The amount of dividends that may be paid by a state-chartered bank that is a member of the Federal Reserve System, such as GS Bank USA or our national bank trust company subsidiary, is limited to the lesser of the amounts calculated under a “recent earnings” test and an “undivided profits” test. Under the recent earnings test, a dividend may not be paid if the total of all dividends declared by a bank in any calendar year is in excess of the current year’s net income combined with the retained net income of the two preceding years, unless the bank obtains the approval of its chartering authority. Under the undivided profits test, a dividend may not be paid in excess of a bank’s “undivided profits.” New York law imposes similar limitations on New York State-


19


Table of Contents

chartered banks. As a result of these restrictions, GS Bank USA was not able to declare dividends to Group Inc. without regulatory approval as of November 2008.
 
In addition to the dividend restrictions described above, the banking regulators have authority to prohibit or to limit the payment of dividends by the banking organizations they supervise if, in the banking regulator’s opinion, payment of a dividend would constitute an unsafe or unsound practice in light of the financial condition of the banking organization.
 
It is also the policy of the Federal Reserve Board that a bank holding company generally only pay dividends on common stock out of net income available to common shareholders over the past year and only if the prospective rate of earnings retention appears consistent with the bank holding company’s capital needs, asset quality, and overall financial condition. In the current financial and economic environment, the Federal Reserve Board has indicated that bank holding companies should carefully review their dividend policy and has discouraged dividend pay-out ratios that are at the 100% level unless both asset quality and capital are very strong. A bank holding company also should not maintain a dividend level that places undue pressure on the capital of bank depository institution subsidiaries, or that may undermine the bank holding company’s ability to serve as a source of strength for such bank depository institution subsidiaries. See “— U.S. Treasury’s TARP Capital Purchase Program” below for a discussion of additional restrictions on Group Inc.’s ability to pay dividends. In addition, certain of Group Inc.’s nonbank subsidiaries are subject to separate regulatory limitations on dividends and distributions, including our broker-dealer and our insurance subsidiaries as described below.
 
Source of Strength
 
Under Federal Reserve Board policy, Group Inc. is expected to act as a source of strength to GS Bank USA and to commit capital and financial resources to support this subsidiary. The required support may be needed at times when, absent that Federal Reserve Board policy, we may not find ourselves able to provide it. Capital loans by a bank holding company to any of its subsidiary banks are subordinate in right of payment to deposits and to certain other indebtedness of such subsidiary banks. In the event of a bank holding company’s bankruptcy, any commitment by the bank holding company to a federal bank regulator to maintain the capital of a subsidiary bank will be assumed by the bankruptcy trustee and entitled to a priority of payment.
 
However, because the BHC Act provides for functional regulation of bank holding company activities by various regulators, the BHC Act prohibits the Federal Reserve Board from requiring payment by a holding company or subsidiary to a depository institution if the functional regulator of the payor objects to such payment. In such a case, the Federal Reserve Board could instead require the divestiture of the depository institution and impose operating restrictions pending the divestiture.
 
Cross-guarantee Provisions
 
Each insured depository institution “controlled” (as defined in the BHC Act) by the same bank holding company can be held liable to the U.S. Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (FDIC) for any loss incurred, or reasonably expected to be incurred, by the FDIC due to the default of any other insured depository institution controlled by that holding company and for any assistance provided by the FDIC to any of those banks that is in danger of default. Such a “cross-guarantee” claim against a depository institution is generally superior in right of payment to claims of the holding company and its affiliates against that depository institution. At this time, we control only one insured depository institution for this purpose, namely GS Bank USA. However, if, in the future, we were to control other insured depository institutions, such cross-guarantee would apply to all such insured depository institutions.


20


Table of Contents

U.S. Treasury’s TARP Capital Purchase Program
 
On October 28, 2008, Group Inc. issued preferred stock and a warrant to purchase its common stock to the U.S. Treasury as a participant in the TARP Capital Purchase Program. Prior to October 28, 2011, unless we have redeemed all of this preferred stock or the U.S. Treasury has transferred all of this preferred stock to a third party, the consent of the U.S. Treasury will be required for us to, among other things, increase our common stock dividend above the current quarterly cash dividend of $0.35 per share or repurchase our common stock or outstanding preferred stock except in limited circumstances. In addition, until the U.S. Treasury ceases to own any Group Inc. securities sold under the TARP Capital Purchase Program, the compensation arrangements for our senior executive officers must comply in all respects with the U.S. Emergency Economic Stabilization Act of 2008 and the rules and regulations thereunder. See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Equity Capital — Equity Capital Management” in Part II, Item 7 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for a further discussion of our participation in the U.S. Treasury’s TARP Capital Purchase Program.
 
FDIC Temporary Liquidity Guarantee Program
 
Group Inc. and GS Bank USA have chosen to participate in the FDIC’s Temporary Liquidity Guarantee Program (TLGP), which applies to, among others, all U.S. depository institutions insured by the FDIC and all U.S. bank holding companies, unless they have opted out of the TLGP or the FDIC has terminated their participation. Under the TLGP, the FDIC guarantees certain senior unsecured debt of Group Inc. and GS Bank USA, as well as noninterest-bearing transaction account deposits at GS Bank USA, and in return for these guarantees the FDIC is paid a fee based on the amount of the deposit or the amount and maturity of the debt. Under the debt guarantee component of the TLGP, the FDIC will pay the unpaid principal and interest on an FDIC-guaranteed debt instrument upon the uncured failure of the participating entity to make a timely payment of principal or interest in accordance with the terms of the instrument. Under the transaction account guarantee component of the TLGP, all noninterest-bearing transaction accounts maintained at GS Bank USA are insured in full by the FDIC until December 31, 2009, regardless of the standard maximum deposit insurance amount. See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Liquidity and Funding Risk — Conservative Liability Structure” in Part II, Item 7 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for a further discussion of our participation in the TLGP.
 
GS Bank USA
 
Our U.S. depository institution subsidiary, GS Bank USA, a New York State-chartered bank and a member of the Federal Reserve System and the FDIC, is regulated by the Federal Reserve Board and the New York State Banking Department and is subject to minimum capital requirements that (subject to certain exceptions) are similar to those applicable to bank holding companies. GS Bank USA was formed in November 2008 through the merger of our existing Utah industrial bank (named GS Bank USA) into our New York limited purpose trust company, with the surviving company taking the name GS Bank USA. Concurrently with this merger, we contributed subsidiaries with an aggregate of $117.16 billion of assets into GS Bank USA (which brought total assets in GS Bank USA to $145.06 billion as of November 2008). As a result, a number of our businesses are now conducted partially or entirely through GS Bank USA, including: bank loan trading and origination; interest rate, credit, currency and other derivatives; leveraged finance; commercial and residential mortgage origination, trading and servicing; structured finance; and agency lending, custody and hedge fund administration services. The businesses conducted through GS Bank USA are now subject to regulation by the Federal Reserve Board, the New York State Banking Department and the FDIC.


21


Table of Contents

Deposit Insurance
 
GS Bank USA accepts deposits, and those deposits have the benefit of FDIC insurance up to the applicable limits. The FDIC’s Deposit Insurance Fund is funded by assessments on insured depository institutions, which depend on the risk category of an institution and the amount of insured deposits that it holds. The FDIC may increase or decrease the assessment rate schedule on a semi-annual basis. We are also participants in the TLGP as discussed above under “— FDIC Temporary Liquidity Guarantee Program.”
 
Prompt Corrective Action
 
The U.S. Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation Improvement Act of 1991 (FDICIA), among other things, requires the federal banking agencies to take “prompt corrective action” in respect of depository institutions that do not meet specified capital requirements. FDICIA establishes five capital categories for FDIC-insured banks: well capitalized, adequately capitalized, undercapitalized, significantly undercapitalized and critically undercapitalized. A depository institution is deemed to be “well capitalized,” the highest category, if it has a total capital ratio of 10% or greater, a Tier 1 capital ratio of 6% or greater and a Tier 1 leverage ratio of 5% or greater and is not subject to any order or written directive by any such regulatory authority to meet and maintain a specific capital level for any capital measure. In connection with the November 2008 asset transfer described below, GS Bank USA agreed with the Federal Reserve Board to minimum capital ratios in excess of these “well capitalized” levels. Accordingly, for a period of time, GS Bank USA is expected to maintain a Tier 1 capital ratio of at least 8%, a total capital ratio of at least 11% and a Tier 1 leverage ratio of at least 6%. We contributed subsidiaries with an aggregate of $117.16 billion in assets into GS Bank USA in November 2008 (which brought total assets in GS Bank USA to $145.06 billion as of November 2008). As a result, we are currently working with the Federal Reserve Board to finalize our methodology for the Basel I calculations. As of November 2008, under Basel I, GS Bank USA’s estimated Tier 1 capital ratio was 8.9% and estimated total capital ratio was 11.6%. In addition, GS Bank USA’s estimated Tier 1 leverage ratio was 9.1%. An institution may be downgraded to, or deemed to be in, a capital category that is lower than is indicated by its capital ratios if it is determined to be in an unsafe or unsound condition or if it receives an unsatisfactory examination rating with respect to certain matters.
 
FDICIA imposes progressively more restrictive constraints on operations, management and capital distributions, as the capital category of an institution declines. Failure to meet the capital guidelines could also subject a depository institution to capital raising requirements. Ultimately, critically undercapitalized institutions are subject to the appointment of a receiver or conservator.
 
The prompt corrective action regulations apply only to depository institutions and not to bank holding companies such as Group Inc. However, the Federal Reserve Board is authorized to take appropriate action at the holding company level, based upon the undercapitalized status of the holding company’s depository institution subsidiaries. In certain instances relating to an undercapitalized depository institution subsidiary, the bank holding company would be required to guarantee the performance of the undercapitalized subsidiary’s capital restoration plan and might be liable for civil money damages for failure to fulfill its commitments on that guarantee. Furthermore, in the event of the bankruptcy of the parent holding company, the guarantee would take priority over the parent’s general unsecured creditors.
 
Insolvency of an Insured Depository Institution
 
If the FDIC is appointed the conservator or receiver of an insured depository institution such as GS Bank USA, upon its insolvency or in certain other events, the FDIC has the power:
 
  •  to transfer any of the depository institution’s assets and liabilities to a new obligor without the approval of the depository institution’s creditors;


22


Table of Contents

 
  •  to enforce the terms of the depository institution’s contracts pursuant to their terms; or
 
  •  to repudiate or disaffirm any contract or lease to which the depository institution is a party, the performance of which is determined by the FDIC to be burdensome and the disaffirmance or repudiation of which is determined by the FDIC to promote the orderly administration of the depository institution.
 
In addition, under federal law, the claims of holders of deposit liabilities and certain claims for administrative expenses against an insured depository institution would be afforded a priority over other general unsecured claims against such an institution, including claims of debt holders of the institution, in the “liquidation or other resolution” of such an institution by any receiver. As a result, whether or not the FDIC ever sought to repudiate any debt obligations of GS Bank USA, the debt holders would be treated differently from, and could receive, if anything, substantially less than, the depositors of the depository institution.
 
Transactions with Affiliates
 
Transactions between GS Bank USA and Group Inc. and its subsidiaries and affiliates are regulated by the Federal Reserve Board. These regulations limit the types and amounts of transactions (including loans to and credit extensions from GS Bank USA) that may take place and generally require those transactions to be on an arms-length basis. These regulations generally do not apply to transactions between GS Bank USA and its subsidiaries. In November 2008, Group Inc. transferred assets and operations to GS Bank USA as described above under “— GS Bank USA.” In connection with this transfer, Group Inc. entered into a guarantee agreement with GS Bank USA whereby Group Inc. agreed to (i) purchase from GS Bank USA certain transferred assets (other than derivatives and mortgage servicing rights) or reimburse GS Bank USA for certain losses relating to those assets; (ii) reimburse GS Bank USA for credit-related losses from assets transferred to GS Bank USA; and (iii) protect GS Bank USA or reimburse it for certain losses arising from derivatives and mortgage servicing rights transferred to GS Bank USA. Group Inc. also agreed to pledge to GS Bank USA collateral with an aggregate value at any time not less than 5% of the face amount of committed but unfunded credit lines plus the original transfer value of the assets transferred to GS Bank USA, which amounted to a required collateral value of approximately $7.1 billion as of November 2008.
 
Trust Companies
 
Group Inc.’s two limited purpose trust company subsidiaries operate under state or federal law. They are not permitted to and do not accept deposits (other than as incidental to their trust activities) or make loans and, as a result, are not insured by the FDIC. The Goldman Sachs Trust Company, N.A., a national banking association that is limited to fiduciary activities, is regulated by the Office of the Comptroller of the Currency and is a member bank of the Federal Reserve System. The Goldman Sachs Trust Company of Delaware, a Delaware limited purpose trust company, is regulated by the Office of the Delaware State Bank Commissioner.
 
U.S. Securities and Commodities Regulation
 
Goldman Sachs’ broker-dealer subsidiaries are subject to regulations that cover all aspects of the securities business, including sales methods, trade practices, use and safekeeping of clients’ funds and securities, capital structure, recordkeeping, the financing of clients’ purchases, and the conduct of directors, officers and employees.
 
In the United States, the SEC is the federal agency responsible for the administration of the federal securities laws. GS&Co. is registered as a broker-dealer and as an investment adviser with the SEC and as a broker-dealer in all 50 states and the District of Columbia. Self-regulatory organizations, such as FINRA and the NYSE, adopt rules that apply to, and examine, broker-dealers such as GS&Co. In addition, state securities and other regulators also have regulatory or oversight


23


Table of Contents

authority over GS&Co. Similarly, our businesses are also subject to regulation by various non-U.S. governmental and regulatory bodies and self-regulatory authorities in virtually all countries where we have offices. Goldman Sachs Execution & Clearing, L.P. (GSEC) and two of its subsidiaries are registered U.S. broker-dealers and are regulated by the SEC, the NYSE and FINRA. Goldman Sachs Financial Markets, L.P. is registered with the SEC as an OTC derivatives dealer and conducts certain OTC derivatives businesses.
 
The commodity futures and commodity options industry in the United States is subject to regulation under the U.S. Commodity Exchange Act (CEA). The CFTC is the federal agency charged with the administration of the CEA. Several of Goldman Sachs’ subsidiaries, including GS&Co. and GSEC, are registered with the CFTC and act as futures commission merchants, commodity pool operators or commodity trading advisors and are subject to the CEA. The rules and regulations of various self-regulatory organizations, such as the Chicago Board of Trade and the Chicago Mercantile Exchange, other futures exchanges and the National Futures Association, also govern the commodity futures and commodity options businesses of these entities.
 
GS&Co. and GSEC are subject to Rule 15c3-1 of the SEC and Rule 1.17 of the CFTC, which specify uniform minimum net capital requirements and also effectively require that a significant part of the registrants’ assets be kept in relatively liquid form. GS&Co. and GSEC have elected to compute their minimum capital requirements in accordance with the “Alternative Net Capital Requirement” as permitted by Rule 15c3-1. As of November 2008, GS&Co. had regulatory net capital, as defined by Rule 15c3-1, of $10.92 billion, which exceeded the amounts required by $8.87 billion. As of November 2008, GSEC had regulatory net capital, as defined by Rule 15c3-1, of $1.38 billion, which exceeded the amounts required by $1.29 billion. In addition to its alternative minimum net capital requirements, GS&Co. is also required to hold tentative net capital in excess of $1 billion and net capital in excess of $500 million in accordance with the market and credit risk standards of Appendix E of Rule 15c3-1. GS&Co. is also required to notify the SEC in the event that its tentative net capital is less than $5 billion. As of November 2008, GS&Co. had tentative net capital and net capital in excess of both the minimum and the notification requirements. These net capital requirements may have the effect of prohibiting these entities from distributing or withdrawing capital and may require prior notice to the SEC for certain withdrawals of capital. See Note 17 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K.
 
Our specialist businesses are subject to extensive regulation by a number of securities exchanges. As a Designated Market Maker on the NYSE and as a specialist on other exchanges, we are required to maintain orderly markets in the securities to which we are assigned. Under the NYSE’s new Designated Market Maker rules, this may require us to supply liquidity to these markets in certain circumstances.
 
J. Aron & Company is authorized by the U.S. Federal Energy Regulatory Commission (FERC) to sell wholesale physical power at market-based rates. As a FERC-authorized power marketer, J. Aron & Company is subject to regulation under the U.S. Federal Power Act and FERC regulations and to the oversight of FERC. As a result of our investing activities, GS&Co. is also an “exempt holding company” under the U.S. Public Utility Holding Company Act of 2005 and applicable FERC rules.
 
In addition, as a result of our power-related activities, we are subject to extensive and evolving energy, environmental and other governmental laws and regulations, as discussed under “Risk Factors — Our power generation interests and related activities subject us to extensive regulation, as well as environmental and other risks associated with power generation activities” in Part I, Item 1A of our Annual Report on Form 10-K.
 
Other Regulation in the United States
 
Our U.S. insurance subsidiaries are subject to state insurance regulation and oversight in the states in which they are domiciled and in the other states in which they are licensed, and we are subject to oversight as an insurance holding company in states where our insurance subsidiaries are


24


Table of Contents

domiciled. State insurance regulations limit the ability of our insurance subsidiaries to pay dividends to Group Inc. in certain circumstances, and could require regulatory approval for any change in “control” of Group Inc., which may include control of 10% or more of our voting stock. In addition, a number of our other businesses, including our lending and mortgage businesses, require us to obtain licenses, adhere to applicable regulations and be subject to the oversight of various regulators in the states in which we conduct these businesses.
 
The U.S. Bank Secrecy Act (BSA), as amended by the USA PATRIOT Act of 2001 (PATRIOT Act), contains anti-money laundering and financial transparency laws and mandated the implementation of various regulations applicable to all financial institutions, including standards for verifying client identification at account opening, and obligations to monitor client transactions and report suspicious activities. Through these and other provisions, the BSA and the PATRIOT Act seek to promote the identification of parties that may be involved in terrorism, money laundering or other suspicious activities. Anti-money laundering laws outside the United States contain some similar provisions. The obligation of financial institutions, including Goldman Sachs, to identify their clients, to monitor for and report suspicious transactions, to respond to requests for information by regulatory authorities and law enforcement agencies, and to share information with other financial institutions, has required the implementation and maintenance of internal practices, procedures and controls that have increased, and may continue to increase, our costs, and any failure with respect to our programs in this area could subject us to substantial liability and regulatory fines.
 
Regulation Outside the United States
 
Goldman Sachs provides investment services in and from the United Kingdom under the regulation of the Financial Services Authority (FSA). Goldman Sachs International (GSI), our regulated U.K. broker-dealer, is subject to the capital requirements imposed by the FSA. As of November 2008, GSI was in compliance with the FSA capital requirements. Other subsidiaries, including Goldman Sachs International Bank, are also regulated by the FSA.
 
Goldman Sachs Bank (Europe) PLC (GS Bank Europe), our regulated Irish bank, is subject to minimum capital requirements imposed by the Irish Financial Services Regulatory Authority. As of November 2008, this bank was in compliance with all regulatory capital requirements. Group Inc. has issued a general guarantee of the obligations of this bank.
 
Various other Goldman Sachs entities are regulated by the banking, insurance and securities regulatory authorities of the European countries in which they operate, including, among others, the Federal Financial Supervisory Authority (BaFin) and the Bundesbank in Germany, Banque de France and the Autorité des Marchés Financiers in France, Banca d’Italia and the Commissione Nazionale per le Società e la Borsa (CONSOB) in Italy, the Federal Financial Markets Service in Russia and the Swiss Federal Banking Commission. Certain Goldman Sachs entities are also regulated by the European securities, derivatives and commodities exchanges of which they are members.
 
The investment services that are subject to oversight by the FSA and other regulators within the European Union (EU) are regulated in accordance with national laws, many of which implement EU directives requiring, among other things, compliance with certain capital adequacy standards, customer protection requirements and market conduct and trade reporting rules. These standards, requirements and rules are similarly implemented, under the same directives, throughout the EU.
 
Goldman Sachs Japan Co., Ltd. (GSJCL), our regulated Japanese broker-dealer, is subject to the capital requirements imposed by Japan’s Financial Services Agency. As of November 2008, GSJCL was in compliance with its capital adequacy requirements. GSJCL is also regulated by the Tokyo Stock Exchange, the Osaka Securities Exchange, the Tokyo Financial Exchange, the Japan Securities Dealers Association, the Tokyo Commodity Exchange and the Ministry of Economy, Trade and Industry in Japan.


25


Table of Contents

Also in Asia, the Securities and Futures Commission in Hong Kong, the Monetary Authority of Singapore, the China Securities Regulatory Commission, the Korean Financial Supervisory Service, the Reserve Bank of India and the Securities and Exchange Board of India, among others, regulate various of our subsidiaries and also have capital standards and other requirements comparable to the rules of the SEC.
 
Various Goldman Sachs entities are regulated by the banking and regulatory authorities in other non-U.S. countries in which Goldman Sachs operates, including, among others, Brazil and Dubai. In addition, certain of our insurance subsidiaries are regulated by Lloyd’s (which is, in turn, regulated by the FSA) and by the Bermuda Monetary Authority.
 
Regulations Applicable in and Outside the United States
 
The U.S. and non-U.S. government agencies, regulatory bodies and self-regulatory organizations, as well as state securities commissions and other state regulators in the United States, are empowered to conduct administrative proceedings that can result in censure, fine, the issuance of cease and desist orders, or the suspension or expulsion of a broker-dealer or its directors, officers or employees. From time to time, our subsidiaries have been subject to investigations and proceedings, and sanctions have been imposed for infractions of various regulations relating to our activities, none of which has had a material adverse effect on us or our businesses.
 
The research areas of investment banks have been and remain the subject of regulatory scrutiny. The SEC and FINRA have rules governing research analysts, including rules imposing restrictions on the interaction between equity research analysts and investment banking personnel at member securities firms. Various non-U.S. jurisdictions have imposed both substantive and disclosure-based requirements with respect to research and may impose additional regulations. In 2003, GS&Co. agreed to a global settlement with certain federal and state securities regulators and self-regulatory organizations to resolve investigations into equity research analysts’ alleged conflicts of interest. The global settlement includes certain restrictions and undertakings that have imposed additional costs and limitations on the conduct of our businesses, including restrictions on the interaction between research and investment banking areas.
 
In connection with the research settlement, we have also subscribed to a voluntary initiative imposing restrictions on the allocation of shares in initial public offerings to executives and directors of public companies. The FSA in the United Kingdom has imposed requirements on the conduct of the allocation process in equity and fixed income securities offerings (including initial public offerings and secondary distributions). The SEC, the FSA, FINRA and other U.S. or non-U.S. regulators may in the future adopt additional and more stringent rules with respect to offering procedures and the management of conflicts of interest, and we cannot fully predict the effect that any new requirements will have on our business.
 
Our investment management businesses are subject to significant regulation in numerous jurisdictions around the world relating to, among other things, the safeguarding of client assets and our management of client funds.
 
As discussed above, many of our subsidiaries are subject to regulatory capital requirements in jurisdictions throughout the world. Subsidiaries not subject to separate regulation may hold capital to satisfy local tax guidelines, rating agency requirements or internal policies, including policies concerning the minimum amount of capital a subsidiary should hold based upon its underlying risk.
 
Certain of our businesses are subject to compliance with regulations enacted by U.S. federal and state governments, the European Union or other jurisdictions and/or enacted by various regulatory organizations or exchanges relating to the privacy of the information of clients, employees or others, and any failure to comply with these regulations could expose us to liability and/or reputational damage.


26


Table of Contents

 
Item 1A.  Risk Factors
 
We face a variety of risks that are substantial and inherent in our businesses, including market, liquidity, credit, operational, legal and regulatory risks. The following are some of the more important factors that could affect our businesses.
 
Our businesses have been and may continue to be adversely affected by conditions in the global financial markets and economic conditions generally.
 
Our businesses, by their nature, do not produce predictable earnings, and all of our businesses are materially affected by conditions in the global financial markets and economic conditions generally. In the past twelve months, these conditions have changed suddenly and negatively.
 
Since mid-2007, and particularly during the second half of 2008, the financial services industry and the securities markets generally were materially and adversely affected by significant declines in the values of nearly all asset classes and by a serious lack of liquidity. This was initially triggered by declines in the values of subprime mortgages, but spread to all mortgage and real estate asset classes, to leveraged bank loans and to nearly all asset classes, including equities. The global markets have been characterized by substantially increased volatility and short-selling and an overall loss of investor confidence, initially in financial institutions, but more recently in companies in a number of other industries and in the broader markets. The decline in asset values has caused increases in margin calls for investors, requirements that derivatives counterparties post additional collateral and redemptions by mutual and hedge fund investors, all of which have increased the downward pressure on asset values and outflows of client funds across the financial services industry. In addition, the increased redemptions and unavailability of credit have required hedge funds and others to rapidly reduce leverage, which has increased volatility and further contributed to the decline in asset values.
 
Market conditions have also led to the failure or merger of a number of prominent financial institutions. Financial institution failures or near-failures have resulted in further losses as a consequence of defaults on securities issued by them and defaults under bilateral derivatives and other contracts entered into with such entities as counterparties. Furthermore, declining asset values, defaults on mortgages and consumer loans, and the lack of market and investor confidence, as well as other factors, have all combined to increase credit default swap spreads, to cause rating agencies to lower credit ratings, and to otherwise increase the cost and decrease the availability of liquidity, despite very significant declines in central bank borrowing rates and other government actions. Banks and other lenders have suffered significant losses and have become reluctant to lend, even on a secured basis, due to the increased risk of default and the impact of declining asset values on the value of collateral. The markets for securitized debt offerings backed by mortgages, loans, credit card receivables and other assets have for the most part been closed.
 
In 2008, governments, regulators and central banks in the United States and worldwide have taken numerous steps to increase liquidity and to restore investor confidence, but asset values have continued to decline and access to liquidity continues to be very limited.
 
We have “long” proprietary positions in a number of our businesses. These positions are accounted for at fair value, and the declines in the values of assets have had a direct and large negative impact on our earnings in fiscal 2008. Revenues from our asset management and merchant banking businesses were also negatively impacted by declines in the values of assets managed for our clients.
 
The ongoing liquidity crisis and the loss of confidence in financial institutions has increased our cost of funding and limited our access to some of our traditional sources of liquidity, including both secured and unsecured borrowings. While the numerous steps taken by governments, regulators and central banks have helped reduce these funding costs somewhat and increase our access to traditional and new sources of liquidity, increases in funding costs and limitations on our access to liquidity have


27


Table of Contents

negatively impacted our earnings and our ability to engage in certain activities. In particular, in the latter half of 2008, we were unable to raise significant amounts of long-term unsecured debt in the public markets, other than as a result of the issuance of securities guaranteed by the FDIC under the TLGP. We are able to have outstanding approximately $35 billion of debt under the TLGP that is issued prior to June 30, 2009. It is unclear when we will regain access to the public long-term unsecured debt markets on customary terms or whether any similar program will be available after the TLGP’s scheduled June 2009 expiration. However, we continue to have access to short-term funding and to a number of sources of secured funding, both in the private markets and through various government and central bank sponsored initiatives. In December 2008, Moody’s Investors Service downgraded our long-term debt credit rating and Standard & Poor’s downgraded both our long-term and short-term debt credit ratings, in each case with an outlook of “negative.”
 
We have been able to fund our operations during fiscal 2008. Our global core excess (our cash and cash equivalent positions maintained to ensure short-term liquidity) and our capital ratios are at levels significantly higher than in the past. Nevertheless, our credit spreads have widened and the average maturity of our new funding has decreased. Recently, we have relied to a significant extent for our long-term unsecured funding on emergency funding programs implemented by governments and central banks. It is unclear whether or for how long these facilities will be extended and what impact termination of these facilities could have on our ability to access funding. See “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Liquidity and Funding Risk” in Part II, Item 7 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K.
 
Furthermore, the increased riskiness of assets due to increases in the volatility of asset prices, coupled with market concerns about the levels of financial institution leverage ratios, as well as fewer attractive business opportunities, have caused us to significantly decrease the size of our balance sheet and to increase the size of our global core excess. Both of these steps may have a negative effect on our profitability, until reversed.
 
Concerns about financial institution profitability and solvency as a result of general market conditions, particularly in the credit markets, together with the forced merger or failure of a number of major commercial and investment banks, have at times caused a number of our clients to reduce the level of business that they do with us, either because of concerns about the safety of their assets held by us or simply arising from a desire to diversify their risk or for other reasons. Some clients have withdrawn some of the funds held at our firm or transferred them from deposits with GS Bank USA to other types of assets (in many cases leaving those assets in their brokerage accounts held with us). Some counterparties have at times refused to enter into certain derivatives and other long-term transactions with us or have requested additional collateral. These instances were more prevalent during periods when the lack of confidence in financial institutions was most widespread and have become significantly less frequent in recent months in the wake of government and central bank actions, greater understanding of client account protections and higher limits of FDIC insurance. In addition, we have acquired some new clients as a result of the difficulties experienced by other financial institutions.
 
During the fourth quarter of 2008, we raised $20.75 billion in equity, comprised of a $5.75 billion public common stock offering, a $5 billion preferred stock and warrant issuance to Berkshire Hathaway Inc. and certain affiliates and a $10 billion preferred stock and warrant issuance under the U.S. Treasury’s TARP Capital Purchase Program. While this additional capital provides further funding to our business and we believe has improved investor perceptions with regard to our financial position, it has increased our equity and the number of actual and diluted outstanding shares of our common stock as well as our preferred dividend requirements, which will reduce our earnings per share and the return on our equity unless our earnings increase sufficiently.
 
In addition, as of the end of 2008, the United States, Europe and Japan are all in a recession. Business activity across a wide range of industries and regions is greatly reduced and local governments and many companies are in serious difficulty due to the lack of consumer spending and


28


Table of Contents

the lack of liquidity in the credit markets. Unemployment has increased significantly. While lower interest rates, increased volatility and substantial increases in trading volumes have positively impacted earnings in a number of our trading businesses, declines in asset values, the lack of liquidity, general uncertainty about economic and market activities and a lack of consumer, investor and CEO confidence have negatively impacted many of our other businesses, particularly our investment banking, merchant banking, asset management, credit products, mortgage, leveraged lending and equity principal strategies businesses. In particular, our investment banking business has been affected during the last twelve months by the decrease in equity and debt underwritings and the decline in both announced and completed mergers and acquisitions.
 
Our financial performance is highly dependent on the environment in which our businesses operate. A favorable business environment is generally characterized by, among other factors, high global gross domestic product growth, transparent, liquid and efficient capital markets, low inflation, high business and investor confidence, stable geopolitical conditions, and strong business earnings. Unfavorable or uncertain economic and market conditions can be caused by: declines in economic growth, business activity or investor or business confidence; limitations on the availability or increases in the cost of credit and capital; increases in inflation, interest rates, exchange rate volatility, default rates or the price of basic commodities; outbreaks of hostilities or other geopolitical instability; corporate, political or other scandals that reduce investor confidence in capital markets; natural disasters or pandemics; or a combination of these or other factors.
 
Overall, during fiscal 2008, the business environment has been extremely adverse for many of our businesses and there can be no assurance that these conditions will improve in the near term. Until they do, we expect our results of operations to be adversely affected.
 
Our businesses have been and may continue to be adversely affected by declining asset values.
 
Many of our businesses, such as our merchant banking businesses, our mortgages, leveraged loan and credit products businesses in our FICC segment, and our equity principal strategies business, have net “long” positions in debt securities, loans, derivatives, mortgages, equities (including private equity) and most other asset classes. In addition, many of our market-making and other businesses in which we act as a principal to facilitate our clients’ activities, including our specialist businesses, commit large amounts of capital to maintain trading positions in interest rate and credit products, as well as currencies, commodities and equities. Because nearly all of these investing and trading positions are marked-to-market on a daily basis, declines in asset values directly and immediately impact our earnings, unless we have effectively “hedged” our exposures to such declines. In certain circumstances (particularly in the case of leveraged loans and private equities or other securities that are not freely tradable or lack established and liquid trading markets), it may not be possible or economic to hedge such exposures and to the extent that we do so the hedge may be ineffective or may greatly reduce our ability to profit from increases in the values of the assets. Sudden declines and significant volatility in the prices of assets may substantially curtail or eliminate the trading markets for certain assets, which may make it very difficult to sell, hedge or value such assets. The inability to sell or effectively hedge assets reduces our ability to limit losses in such positions and the difficulty in valuing assets may increase our risk-weighted assets which requires us to maintain additional capital and increases our funding costs.
 
In our specialist businesses, we are obligated by stock exchange rules to maintain an orderly market, including by purchasing shares in a declining market. In markets where asset values are declining and in volatile markets, this results in trading losses and an increased need for liquidity.
 
We receive asset-based management fees based on the value of our clients’ portfolios or investment in funds managed by us and, in some cases, we also receive incentive fees based on increases in the value of such investments. Declines in asset values reduce the value of our clients’ portfolios or fund assets, which in turn reduce the fees we earn for managing such assets.


29


Table of Contents

We post collateral to support our obligations and receive collateral to support the obligations of our clients and counterparties in connection with our trading businesses. When the value of the assets posted as collateral declines, the party posting the collateral may need to provide additional collateral or, if possible, reduce its trading position. A classic example of such a situation is a “margin call” in connection with a brokerage account. Therefore, declines in the value of asset classes used as collateral mean that either the cost of funding trading positions is increased or the size of trading positions is decreased. If we are the party providing collateral this can increase our costs and reduce our profitability and if we are the party receiving collateral this can also reduce our profitability by reducing the level of business done with our clients and counterparties. In addition, volatile or less liquid markets increase the difficulty of valuing assets which can lead to costly and time-consuming disputes over asset values and the level of required collateral, as well as increased credit risk to the recipient of the collateral due to delays in receiving adequate collateral.
 
Our businesses have been and may continue to be adversely affected by disruptions in the credit markets, including reduced access to credit and higher costs of obtaining credit.
 
Widening credit spreads, as well as significant declines in the availability of credit, have adversely affected our ability to borrow on a secured and unsecured basis and may continue to do so. We fund ourselves on an unsecured basis by issuing commercial paper, promissory notes and long-term debt, or by obtaining bank loans or lines of credit. We seek to finance many of our assets, including our less liquid assets, on a secured basis, including by entering into repurchase agreements. Disruptions in the credit markets make it harder and more expensive to obtain funding for our businesses. If our available funding is limited or we are forced to fund our operations at a higher cost, these conditions may require us to curtail our business activities and increase our cost of funding, both of which could reduce our profitability, particularly in our businesses that involve investing, lending and taking principal positions, including market making.
 
Our clients engaging in mergers and acquisitions often rely on access to the secured and unsecured credit markets to finance their transactions. The lack of available credit and the increased cost of credit can adversely affect the size, volume and timing of our clients’ merger and acquisition transactions — particularly large transactions — and adversely affect our financial advisory and underwriting businesses.
 
In addition, we may incur significant unrealized gains or losses due solely to changes in our credit spreads or those of third parties, as these changes may affect the fair value of our derivative instruments and the debt securities that we hold or issue.
 
Our businesses have been and may continue to be affected by changes in the levels of market volatility.
 
Certain of our trading businesses depend on market volatility to provide trading and arbitrage opportunities, and decreases in volatility may reduce these opportunities and adversely affect the results of these businesses. On the other hand, increased volatility, while it can increase trading volumes and spreads, also increases risk as measured by VaR and may expose us to increased risks in connection with our market-making and proprietary businesses or cause us to reduce the size of these businesses in order to avoid increasing our VaR. Limiting the size of our market-making positions and investing businesses can adversely affect our profitability, even though spreads are widening and we may earn more on each trade. In periods when volatility is increasing, but asset values are declining significantly (as has been the case recently), it may not be possible to sell assets at all or it may only be possible to do so at steep discounts. In such circumstances we may be forced to either take on additional risk or to incur losses in order to decrease our VaR. In addition, increases in volatility increase the level of our risk weighted assets and increase our capital requirements which increases our funding costs.


30


Table of Contents

Our businesses have been adversely affected and may continue to be adversely affected by market uncertainty or lack of confidence among investors and CEOs due to general declines in economic activity and other unfavorable economic, geopolitical or market conditions.
 
Our investment banking business has been and may continue to be adversely affected by market conditions. Poor economic conditions and other adverse geopolitical conditions can adversely affect and have adversely affected investor and CEO confidence, resulting in significant industry-wide declines in the size and number of underwritings and of financial advisory transactions, which could continue to have an adverse effect on our revenues and our profit margins. In particular, because a significant portion of our investment banking revenues are derived from our participation in large transactions, a decline in the number of large transactions would adversely affect our investment banking business.
 
In certain circumstances, market uncertainty or general declines in market or economic activity may affect our trading businesses by decreasing levels of overall activity or by decreasing volatility, but at other times market uncertainty and even declining economic activity may result in higher trading volumes or higher spreads or both.
 
Market uncertainty, volatility and adverse economic conditions, as well as declines in asset values, may cause our clients to transfer their assets out of our funds or other products or their brokerage accounts and result in reduced net revenues, principally in our asset management business. To the extent that clients do not withdraw their funds, they may invest them in products that generate less fee income.
 
Our investing businesses may be affected by the poor investment performance of our investment products.
 
Poor investment returns in our asset management business, due to either general market conditions or underperformance (against the performance of benchmarks or of our competitors) by funds or accounts that we manage or investment products that we design or sell, affects our ability to retain existing assets and to attract new clients or additional assets from existing clients. This could affect the asset management and incentive fees that we earn on assets under management or the commissions that we earn for selling other investment products, such as structured notes or derivatives.
 
We have in the past provided financial support to certain of our investment products in difficult market circumstances and, at our discretion, we may decide to do so in the future for reputational or business reasons, including through equity investments or cash infusions.
 
We may incur losses as a result of ineffective risk management processes and strategies.
 
We seek to monitor and control our risk exposure through a risk and control framework encompassing a variety of separate but complementary financial, credit, operational, compliance and legal reporting systems, internal controls, management review processes and other mechanisms. Our trading risk management process seeks to balance our ability to profit from trading positions with our exposure to potential losses. While we employ a broad and diversified set of risk monitoring and risk mitigation techniques, those techniques and the judgments that accompany their application cannot anticipate every economic and financial outcome or the specifics and timing of such outcomes. Thus, we may, in the course of our activities, incur losses. Recent market conditions have involved unprecedented dislocations and highlight the limitations inherent in using historical data to manage risk.
 
The models that we use to assess and control our risk exposures reflect assumptions about the degrees of correlation or lack thereof among prices of various asset classes or other market indicators. In times of market stress or other unforeseen circumstances, such as occurred during 2008, previously uncorrelated indicators may become correlated, or conversely previously correlated indicators may move in different directions. These types of market movements have at times limited the effectiveness of our hedging strategies and have caused us to incur significant losses, and they


31


Table of Contents

may do so in the future. These changes in correlation can be exacerbated where other market participants are using risk or trading models with assumptions or algorithms that are similar to ours. In these and other cases, it may be difficult to reduce our risk positions due to the activity of other market participants or widespread market dislocations, including circumstances where asset values are declining significantly or no market exists for certain assets. To the extent that we make investments directly through various of our businesses in securities, including private equity, that do not have an established liquid trading market or are otherwise subject to restrictions on sale or hedging, we may not be able to reduce our positions and therefore reduce our risk associated with such positions. In addition, we invest our own capital in our merchant banking, alternative investment and infrastructure funds, and limitations on our ability to withdraw some or all of our investments in these funds, whether for legal, reputational or other reasons, may make it more difficult for us to control the risk exposures relating to these investments.
 
For a further discussion of our risk management policies and procedures, see “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Risk Management” in Part II, Item 7 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K.
 
Our liquidity, profitability and businesses may be adversely affected by an inability to access the debt capital markets or to sell assets or by a reduction in our credit ratings or by an increase in our credit spreads.
 
Liquidity is essential to our businesses. Our liquidity may be impaired by an inability to access secured and/or unsecured debt markets, an inability to access funds from our subsidiaries, an inability to sell assets or redeem our investments, or unforeseen outflows of cash or collateral. This situation may arise due to circumstances that we may be unable to control, such as a general market disruption or an operational problem that affects third parties or us, or even by the perception among market participants that we, or other market participants, are experiencing greater liquidity risk.
 
The financial instruments that we hold and the contracts to which we are a party are increasingly complex, as we employ structured products to benefit our clients and ourselves, and these complex structured products often do not have readily available markets to access in times of liquidity stress. Our investing activities may lead to situations where the holdings from these activities represent a significant portion of specific markets, which could restrict liquidity for our positions. Further, our ability to sell assets may be impaired if other market participants are seeking to sell similar assets at the same time, as is likely to occur in a liquidity or other market crisis. In addition, financial institutions with which we interact may exercise set-off rights or the right to require additional collateral, including in difficult market conditions, which could further impair our access to liquidity.
 
Our credit ratings are important to our liquidity. A reduction in our credit ratings could adversely affect our liquidity and competitive position, increase our borrowing costs, limit our access to the capital markets or trigger our obligations under certain bilateral provisions in some of our trading and collateralized financing contracts. Under these provisions, counterparties could be permitted to terminate contracts with Goldman Sachs or require us to post additional collateral. Termination of our trading and collateralized financing contracts could cause us to sustain losses and impair our liquidity by requiring us to find other sources of financing or to make significant cash payments or securities movements.
 
Our cost of obtaining long-term unsecured funding is directly related to our credit spreads (the amount in excess of the interest rate of U.S. Treasury securities (or other benchmark securities) of the same maturity that we need to pay to our debt investors). Increases in our credit spreads can significantly increase our cost of this funding. Changes in credit spreads are continuous, market-driven, and subject at times to unpredictable and highly volatile movements. Credit spreads are influenced by market perceptions of our creditworthiness. In addition, our credit spreads may be influenced by movements in the costs to purchasers of credit default swaps referenced to our


32


Table of Contents

long-term debt. The market for credit default swaps is relatively new, although very large, and it has proven to be extremely volatile and currently lacks a high degree of structure or transparency.
 
Group Inc. is a holding company and is dependent for liquidity on payments from its subsidiaries, which are subject to restrictions.
 
Group Inc. is a holding company and, therefore, depends on dividends, distributions and other payments from its subsidiaries to fund dividend payments and to fund all payments on its obligations, including debt obligations. Many of our subsidiaries, including our broker-dealer, bank and insurance subsidiaries, are subject to laws that restrict dividend payments or authorize regulatory bodies to block or reduce the flow of funds from those subsidiaries to Group Inc. Restrictions or regulatory action of that kind could impede access to funds that Group Inc. needs to make payments on its obligations, including debt obligations, or dividend payments. In addition, Group Inc.’s right to participate in a distribution of assets upon a subsidiary’s liquidation or reorganization is subject to the prior claims of the subsidiary’s creditors.
 
Furthermore, Group Inc. has guaranteed the payment obligations of GS&Co., GS Bank USA and GS Bank Europe, subject to certain exceptions, and has pledged significant assets to GS Bank USA to support obligations to GS Bank USA. These guarantees may require Group Inc. to provide substantial funds or assets to its subsidiaries or their creditors and counterparties at a time when Group Inc. is in need of liquidity to fund its own obligations. See “Business — Regulation” in Part I, Item 1 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K.
 
Our businesses, profitability and liquidity may be adversely affected by deterioration in the credit quality of, or defaults by, third parties who owe us money, securities or other assets or whose securities or obligations we hold.
 
The amount and duration of our credit exposures have been increasing over the past several years, as have the breadth and size of the entities to which we have credit exposures. We are exposed to the risk that third parties that owe us money, securities or other assets will not perform their obligations. These parties may default on their obligations to us due to bankruptcy, lack of liquidity, operational failure or other reasons. A failure of a significant market participant, or even concerns about a default by such an institution, could lead to significant liquidity problems, losses or defaults by other institutions, which in turn could adversely affect us.
 
We are also subject to the risk that our rights against third parties may not be enforceable in all circumstances. In addition, deterioration in the credit quality of third parties whose securities or obligations we hold could result in losses and/or adversely affect our ability to rehypothecate or otherwise use those securities or obligations for liquidity purposes. A significant downgrade in the credit ratings of our counterparties could also have a negative impact on our results. While in many cases we are permitted to require additional collateral from counterparties that experience financial difficulty, disputes may arise as to the amount of collateral we are entitled to receive and the value of pledged assets. The termination of contracts and the foreclosure on collateral may subject us to claims for the improper exercise of our rights. Default rates, downgrades and disputes with counterparties as to the valuation of collateral increase significantly in times of market stress and illiquidity.
 
As part of our clearing business, we finance our client positions, and we could be held responsible for the defaults or misconduct of our clients. Although we regularly review credit exposures to specific clients and counterparties and to specific industries, countries and regions that we believe may present credit concerns, default risk may arise from events or circumstances that are difficult to detect or foresee.


33


Table of Contents

Concentration of risk increases the potential for significant losses.
 
Concentration of risk increases the potential for significant losses in our market-making, proprietary trading, investing, block trading, merchant banking, underwriting and lending businesses. This risk may increase to the extent we expand our proprietary trading and investing businesses or commit capital to facilitate client-driven business. The number and size of such transactions may affect our results of operations in a given period. Moreover, because of concentration of risk, we may suffer losses even when economic and market conditions are generally favorable for our competitors. Disruptions in the credit markets can make it difficult to hedge these credit exposures effectively or economically. In addition, we extend large commitments as part of our credit origination activities. Our inability to reduce our credit risk by selling, syndicating or securitizing these positions, including during periods of market stress, could negatively affect our results of operations due to a decrease in the fair value of the positions, including due to the insolvency or bankruptcy of the borrower, as well as the loss of revenues associated with selling such securities or loans.
 
In the ordinary course of business, we may be subject to a concentration of credit risk to a particular counterparty, borrower or issuer, and a failure or downgrade of, or default by, such entity could negatively impact our businesses, perhaps materially, and the systems by which we set limits and monitor the level of our credit exposure to individual entities, industries and countries may not function as we have anticipated. While our activities expose us to many different industries and counterparties, we routinely execute a high volume of transactions with counterparties in the financial services industry, including brokers and dealers, commercial banks, and investment funds. This has resulted in significant credit concentration with respect to this industry.
 
The financial services industry is highly competitive.
 
The financial services industry — and all of our businesses — are intensely competitive, and we expect them to remain so. We compete on the basis of a number of factors, including transaction execution, our products and services, innovation, reputation, creditworthiness and price. Over time, there has been substantial consolidation and convergence among companies in the financial services industry. This trend accelerated over the course of the past year as a result of numerous mergers and asset acquisitions among industry participants. This trend has also hastened the globalization of the securities and other financial services markets. As a result, we have had to commit capital to support our international operations and to execute large global transactions. To the extent we expand into new business areas and new geographic regions, we will face competitors with more experience and more established relationships with clients, regulators and industry participants in the relevant market, which could adversely affect our ability to expand.
 
Pricing and other competitive pressures in our investment banking business, as well as our other businesses, have continued to increase, particularly in situations where some of our competitors may seek to increase market share by reducing prices. For example, in connection with investment banking and other assignments, we have experienced pressure to extend and price credit at levels that may not always fully compensate us for the risks we take.
 
We face enhanced risks as new business initiatives lead us to transact with a broader array of clients and counterparties and expose us to new asset classes and new markets.
 
A number of our recent and planned business initiatives and expansions of existing businesses may bring us into contact, directly or indirectly, with individuals and entities that are not within our traditional client and counterparty base and expose us to new asset classes and new markets. These business activities expose us to new and enhanced risks, including risks associated with dealing with governmental entities, reputational concerns arising from dealing with less sophisticated counterparties and investors, greater regulatory scrutiny of these activities, increased credit-related, sovereign and operational risks, risks arising from accidents or acts of terrorism, and reputational concerns with the manner in which these assets are being operated or held.


34


Table of Contents

Derivative transactions may expose us to unexpected risk and potential losses.
 
We are party to a large number of derivative transactions, including credit derivatives. Many of these derivative instruments are individually negotiated and non-standardized, which can make exiting, transferring or settling the position difficult. Many credit derivatives require that we deliver to the counterparty the underlying security, loan or other obligation in order to receive payment. In a number of cases, we do not hold the underlying security, loan or other obligation and may not be able to obtain, the underlying security, loan or other obligation. This could cause us to forfeit the payments due to us under these contracts or result in settlement delays with the attendant credit and operational risk as well as increased costs to the firm.
 
Derivative contracts and other transactions entered into with third parties are not always confirmed by the counterparties on a timely basis. While the transaction remains unconfirmed, we are subject to heightened credit and operational risk and in the event of a default may find it more difficult to enforce the contract. In addition, as new and more complex derivative products are created, covering a wider array of underlying credit and other instruments, disputes about the terms of the underlying contracts could arise, which could impair our ability to effectively manage our risk exposures from these products and subject us to increased costs. Any regulatory effort to create an exchange or trading platform for credit derivatives and other OTC derivative contracts, or a market shift toward standardized derivatives, could reduce the risk associated with such transactions, but under certain circumstances could also limit our ability to develop derivatives that best suit the needs of our clients and ourselves and adversely affect our profitability.
 
A failure in our operational systems or infrastructure, or those of third parties, could impair our liquidity, disrupt our businesses, result in the disclosure of confidential information, damage our reputation and cause losses.
 
Our businesses are highly dependent on our ability to process and monitor, on a daily basis, a very large number of transactions, many of which are highly complex, across numerous and diverse markets in many currencies. These transactions, as well as the information technology services we provide to clients, often must adhere to client-specific guidelines, as well as legal and regulatory standards. As our client base and our geographical reach expands, developing and maintaining our operational systems and infrastructure becomes increasingly challenging. Our financial, accounting, data processing or other operating systems and facilities may fail to operate properly or become disabled as a result of events that are wholly or partially beyond our control, such as a spike in transaction volume, adversely affecting our ability to process these transactions or provide these services. In addition, we also face the risk of operational failure, termination or capacity constraints of any of the clearing agents, exchanges, clearing houses or other financial intermediaries we use to facilitate our securities transactions, and as our interconnectivity with our clients grows, we increasingly face the risk of operational failure with respect to our clients’ systems. In recent years, there has been significant consolidation among clearing agents, exchanges and clearing houses, which has increased our exposure to operational failure, termination or capacity constraints of the particular financial intermediaries that we use and could affect our ability to find adequate and cost-effective alternatives in the event of any such failure, termination or constraint. Industry consolidation, whether among market participants or financial intermediaries, increases the risk of operational failure as disparate complex systems need to be integrated, often on an accelerated basis. Furthermore, the interconnectivity of multiple financial institutions with central agents, exchanges and clearing houses increases the risk that an operational failure at one institution may cause an industry-wide operational failure that could materially impact our ability to conduct business. Any such failure, termination or constraint could adversely affect our ability to effect transactions, service our clients, manage our exposure to risk or expand our businesses or result in financial loss or liability to our clients, impairment of our liquidity, disruption of our businesses, regulatory intervention or reputational damage.


35


Table of Contents

Despite the resiliency plans and facilities we have in place, our ability to conduct business may be adversely impacted by a disruption in the infrastructure that supports our businesses and the communities in which we are located. This may include a disruption involving electrical, communications, internet, transportation or other services used by us or third parties with which we conduct business. These disruptions may occur as a result of events that affect only our buildings or the buildings of such third parties, or as a result of events with a broader impact globally, regionally or in the cities where those buildings are located. Nearly all of our employees in our primary locations, including the New York metropolitan area, London, Frankfurt, Hong Kong, Tokyo and Bangalore, work in close proximity to one another, in one or more buildings. Notwithstanding our efforts to maintain business continuity, given that our headquarters and the largest concentration of our employees are in the New York metropolitan area, depending on the intensity and longevity of the event, a catastrophic event impacting our New York metropolitan area offices could very negatively affect our business. If a disruption occurs in one location and our employees in that location are unable to occupy our offices or communicate with or travel to other locations, our ability to service and interact with our clients may suffer, and we may not be able to successfully implement contingency plans that depend on communication or travel.
 
Our operations rely on the secure processing, storage and transmission of confidential and other information in our computer systems and networks. Although we take protective measures and endeavor to modify them as circumstances warrant, our computer systems, software and networks may be vulnerable to unauthorized access, computer viruses or other malicious code and other events that could have a security impact. If one or more of such events occur, this potentially could jeopardize our or our clients’ or counterparties’ confidential and other information processed and stored in, and transmitted through, our computer systems and networks, or otherwise cause interruptions or malfunctions in our, our clients’, our counterparties’ or third parties’ operations, which could result in significant losses or reputational damage. We may be required to expend significant additional resources to modify our protective measures or to investigate and remediate vulnerabilities or other exposures, and we may be subject to litigation and financial losses that are either not insured against or not fully covered through any insurance maintained by us.
 
We routinely transmit and receive personal, confidential and proprietary information by email and other electronic means. We have discussed and worked with clients, vendors, service providers, counterparties and other third parties to develop secure transmission capabilities, but we do not have, and may be unable to put in place, secure capabilities with all of our clients, vendors, service providers, counterparties and other third parties and we may not be able to ensure that these third parties have appropriate controls in place to protect the confidentiality of the information. An interception, misuse or mishandling of personal, confidential or proprietary information being sent to or received from a client, vendor, service provider, counterparty or other third party could result in legal liability, regulatory action and reputational harm.
 
Conflicts of interest are increasing and a failure to appropriately identify and deal with conflicts of interest could adversely affect our businesses.
 
As we have expanded the scope of our businesses and our client base, we increasingly must address potential conflicts of interest, including situations where our services to a particular client or our own investments or other interests conflict, or are perceived to conflict, with the interests of another client, as well as situations where one or more of our businesses have access to material non-public information that may not be shared with other businesses within the firm and situations where we may be a creditor of an entity with which we also have an advisory or other relationship.
 
Our regulators have the ability to scrutinize our activities for potential conflicts of interest, including through detailed examinations of specific transactions. Our status as a bank holding company subjects us to heightened regulation and increased regulatory scrutiny by the Federal Reserve Board with respect to transactions between GS Bank USA and entities that are or could be seen as affiliates of ours.


36


Table of Contents

We have extensive procedures and controls that are designed to identify and address conflicts of interest, including those designed to prevent the improper sharing of information among our businesses. However, appropriately identifying and dealing with conflicts of interest is complex and difficult, and our reputation, which is one of our most important assets, could be damaged and the willingness of clients to enter into transactions in which such a conflict might arise may be affected if we fail, or appear to fail, to identify and deal appropriately with conflicts of interest. In addition, potential or perceived conflicts could give rise to litigation or enforcement actions.
 
Our businesses and those of our clients are subject to extensive and pervasive regulation around the world.
 
As a participant in the financial services industry, we are subject to extensive regulation in jurisdictions around the world. We face the risk of significant intervention by regulatory authorities in all jurisdictions in which we conduct our businesses. Among other things, we could be fined, prohibited from engaging in some of our business activities or subject to limitations or conditions on our business activities.
 
In recent years, firms in the financial services industry have been operating in a difficult regulatory environment. The industry has experienced increased scrutiny from a variety of regulators, both within and outside the United States. Penalties and fines sought by regulatory authorities have increased substantially over the last several years, and certain regulators have been more likely in recent years to commence enforcement actions.
 
In addition, new laws or regulations or changes in enforcement of existing laws or regulations applicable to our businesses or those of our clients may adversely affect our businesses. Recent market disruptions have led to numerous proposals for changes in the regulation of the financial services industry, including significant additional regulation. Regulatory changes could lead to business disruptions, could impact the value of assets that we hold or the scope or profitability of our business activities, could require us to change certain of our business practices and could expose us to additional costs (including compliance costs) and liabilities as well as reputational harm, and, to the extent the regulations strictly control the activities of financial services firms, make it more difficult for us to distinguish ourselves from competitors. For a discussion of the extensive regulation to which our businesses are subject, see “Business — Regulation” in Part I, Item 1 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K.
 
Our status as a bank holding company and the operation of our lending and other businesses through GS Bank USA subject us to additional regulation and limitations on our activities, as described in “Business — Regulation — Banking Regulation” in Part I, Item 1 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K, as well as some regulatory uncertainty as we apply banking regulations and practices to many of our businesses. The application of these regulations and practices may present us and our regulators with new or novel issues.
 
Our firm is subject to regulatory capital requirements at a number of levels, as described above under “Business — Regulation” in Part I, Item 1 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K. As a bank holding company, we will be subject to capital requirements based on Basel I as opposed to the requirements based on Basel II that applied to us as a CSE. Complying with these requirements may require us to liquidate assets or raise capital in a manner that adversely increases our funding costs or otherwise adversely affects our shareholders and creditors. In addition, failure to meet minimum capital requirements can initiate certain mandatory and possibly additional discretionary actions by regulators that, if undertaken, could have a direct material adverse effect on our financial condition.
 
Our agreements with the U.S. Treasury and Berkshire Hathaway Inc. impose restrictions and obligations on us that limit our ability to increase dividends, repurchase our common stock or preferred stock and access the equity capital markets.
 
In October 2008, we issued preferred stock and a warrant to purchase our common stock to the U.S. Treasury as part of its TARP Capital Purchase Program. Prior to October 28, 2011, unless we have redeemed all of the preferred stock or the U.S. Treasury has transferred all of the preferred stock to a third party, the consent of the U.S. Treasury will be required for us to, among other things,


37


Table of Contents

increase our common stock dividend or repurchase our common stock or other preferred stock (with certain exceptions, including the repurchase of our common stock to offset share dilution from equity-based employee compensation awards). We have also granted registration rights and offering facilitation rights to the U.S. Treasury and to Berkshire Hathaway Inc. pursuant to which we have agreed to lock-up periods during which we would be unable to issue equity securities.
 
Substantial legal liability or significant regulatory action against us could have material adverse financial effects or cause us significant reputational harm, which in turn could seriously harm our business prospects.
 
We face significant legal risks in our businesses, and the volume of claims and amount of damages and penalties claimed in litigation and regulatory proceedings against financial institutions remain high. See “Legal Proceedings” in Part I, Item 3 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for a discussion of certain legal proceedings in which we are involved. Our experience has been that legal claims by customers and clients increase in a market downturn. In addition, employment-related claims typically increase in periods when we have reduced the total number of employees.
 
There have been a number of highly publicized cases involving fraud or other misconduct by employees in the financial services industry in recent years, and we run the risk that employee misconduct could occur. It is not always possible to deter or prevent employee misconduct and the precautions we take to prevent and detect this activity may not be effective in all cases.
 
The growth of electronic trading and the introduction of new technology may adversely affect our business and may increase competition.
 
Technology is fundamental to our business and our industry. The growth of electronic trading and the introduction of new technologies is changing our businesses and presenting us with new challenges. Securities, futures and options transactions are increasingly occurring electronically, both on our own systems and through other alternative trading systems, and it appears that the trend toward alternative trading systems will continue and probably accelerate. Some of these alternative trading systems compete with our trading businesses, including our specialist businesses, and we may experience continued competitive pressures in these and other areas. In addition, the increased use by our clients of low-cost electronic trading systems and direct electronic access to trading markets could cause a reduction in commissions and spreads. As our clients increasingly use our systems to trade directly in the markets, we may incur liabilities as a result of their use of our order routing and execution infrastructure. The NYSE’s adoption and continued refinement of its hybrid market for trading securities may increase pressure on our Equities business as clients execute more of their NYSE-related trades electronically. We have invested significant resources into the development of electronic trading systems and expect to continue to do so, but there is no assurance that the revenues generated by these systems will yield an adequate return on our investment, particularly given the relatively lower commissions arising from electronic trades.
 
Our businesses may be adversely affected if we are unable to hire and retain qualified employees.
 
Our performance is largely dependent on the talents and efforts of highly skilled individuals; therefore, our continued ability to compete effectively in our businesses, to manage our businesses effectively and to expand into new businesses and geographic areas depends on our ability to attract new employees and to retain and motivate our existing employees. Competition from within the financial services industry and from businesses outside the financial services industry for qualified employees has often been intense. This is particularly the case in emerging markets, where we are often competing for qualified employees with entities that have a significantly greater presence or more extensive experience in the region.


38


Table of Contents

In fiscal 2008, we significantly reduced compensation levels. In addition, the market price of our shares of our common stock declined very significantly during the year. A substantial portion of our annual bonus compensation paid to our senior employees has in recent years been paid in the form of equity-based awards. In addition, we reduced the number of employees across nearly all of our businesses during the latter portion of the year. The combination of these events could adversely affect our ability to hire and retain qualified employees.
 
Our power generation interests and related activities subject us to extensive regulation, as well as environmental and other risks associated with power generation activities.
 
The power generation facilities that we own and those that we operate, as well as our other power-related activities, are subject to extensive and evolving federal, state and local energy, environmental and other governmental laws and regulations, including environmental laws and regulations relating to, among others, air quality, water quality, waste management, natural resources, site remediation and health and safety.
 
We may incur substantial costs (including being required to cease or curtail operations of one or more of our power generation facilities) in complying with current or future laws and regulations relating to electric power generation and wholesale sales and trading of electricity and natural gas, including having to commit significant capital toward environmental monitoring, installation of pollution control equipment, payment of emission fees and carbon or other taxes, and application for, and holding of, permits and licenses at our power generation facilities. Our power generation facilities are also subject to the risk of unforeseen or catastrophic events, many of which are outside of our control, including breakdown or failure of power generation equipment, transmission lines or other equipment or processes or other mechanical malfunctions, performance below expected levels of output or efficiency, terrorist attacks, natural disasters or other hostile or catastrophic events. In addition, these facilities could be adversely affected by the failure of any of our third party suppliers or service providers to perform their contractual obligations, including the failure to obtain raw materials necessary for operation at reasonable prices. Market conditions or other factors could cause a failure to satisfy or obtain waivers under agreements with third parties, including lenders and utilities, which impose significant obligations on our subsidiaries that own such facilities. In addition, we may not have insurance against the risks that such facilities face or the insurance that we have may be inadequate to cover our losses.
 
The occurrence of any of such events may prevent the affected facilities from performing under applicable power sales agreements, may impair their operations or financial results and may result in litigation or other reputational harm.
 
In conducting our businesses around the world, we are subject to political, economic, legal, operational and other risks that are inherent in operating in many countries.
 
In conducting our businesses and maintaining and supporting our global operations, we are subject to risks of possible nationalization, expropriation, price controls, capital controls, exchange controls and other restrictive governmental actions, as well the outbreak of hostilities or acts of terrorism. In many countries, the laws and regulations applicable to the securities and financial services industries and many of the transactions in which we are involved are uncertain and evolving, and it may be difficult for us to determine the exact requirements of local laws in every market. Any determination by local regulators that we have not acted in compliance with the application of local laws in a particular market or our failure to develop effective working relationships with local regulators could have a significant and negative effect not only on our businesses in that market but also on our reputation generally. We are also subject to the enhanced risk that transactions we structure might not be legally enforceable in all cases.
 
Our businesses and operations are increasingly expanding into new regions throughout the world, including emerging markets, and we expect this trend to continue. Various emerging market


39


Table of Contents

countries have experienced severe economic and financial disruptions, including significant devaluations of their currencies, defaults or threatened defaults on sovereign debt, capital and currency exchange controls, and low or negative growth rates in their economies, as well as military activity or acts of terrorism. The possible effects of any of these conditions include an adverse impact on our businesses and increased volatility in financial markets generally.
 
We may incur losses as a result of unforeseen or catastrophic events, including the emergence of a pandemic, terrorist attacks or natural disasters.
 
The occurrence of unforeseen or catastrophic events, including the emergence of a pandemic or other widespread health emergency (or concerns over the possibility of such an emergency), terrorist attacks or natural disasters, could create economic and financial disruptions, could lead to operational difficulties (including travel limitations) that could impair our ability to manage our businesses, and could expose our insurance subsidiaries to significant losses.
 
Item 1B.   Unresolved Staff Comments
 
There are no material unresolved written comments that were received from the SEC staff 180 days or more before the end of our fiscal year relating to our periodic or current reports under the Exchange Act.
 
Item 2.   Properties
 
Our principal executive offices are located at 85 Broad Street, New York, New York, and comprise approximately one million rentable square feet of leased space, pursuant to a lease agreement expiring in June 2011. We also occupy over 680,000 rentable square feet at One New York Plaza under lease agreements expiring primarily in 2010 (with options to renew for up to five additional years), and we lease space at various other locations in the New York metropolitan area. In total, we lease approximately 3.7 million rentable square feet in the New York metropolitan area.
 
In August 2005, we leased from Battery Park City Authority a parcel of land in lower Manhattan, pursuant to a ground lease. We are currently constructing a 2.1 million gross square foot office building on the site that will serve as our headquarters. Under the lease, Battery Park City Authority holds title to all improvements, including the office building, subject to Goldman Sachs’ right of exclusive possession and use until June 2069, the expiration date of the lease.
 
Under the terms of the ground lease, we made a lump-sum ground rent payment in June 2007 of $161 million, which was paid into escrow, to be released to the Battery Park City Authority pending performance of specified state and city obligations. We are required to make additional periodic payments during the term of the lease. We are obligated under the ground lease to construct the office building by 2011 (subject to extensions in the case of force majeure) in accordance with certain pre-approved design standards. Construction began on the building in November 2005, and we expect construction completion and initial occupancy of the building during 2009. The building is projected to cost between $2.1 billion and $2.3 billion, including acquisition, development, fitout and furnishings, financing and other related costs.
 
We are receiving significant benefits from the City and State of New York based on our agreement to construct our headquarters in lower Manhattan. These benefits are subject to recoupment or recapture if we do not satisfy our obligations under these agreements with the City and State of New York.
 
We have offices at 30 Hudson Street in Jersey City, New Jersey, which we own and which include approximately 1.6 million gross square feet of office space, and we own over 575,000 square feet of additional office space spread among four locations in New York and New Jersey. We have additional offices in the U.S. and elsewhere in the Americas, which together comprise approximately 2.9 million rentable square feet of leased space.


40


Table of Contents

In Europe, the Middle East and Africa, we have offices that total approximately 2.2 million rentable square feet. Our European headquarters is located in London at Peterborough Court, pursuant to a lease expiring in 2026. In total, we lease approximately 1.6 million rentable square feet in London through various leases, relating to various properties.
 
In Asia, we have offices that total approximately 1.5 million rentable square feet. Our headquarters in this region are in Tokyo, at the Roppongi Hills Mori Tower, and in Hong Kong, at the Cheung Kong Center. In Tokyo, we currently lease approximately 415,000 rentable square feet, the majority of which will expire in 2018. In Hong Kong, we currently lease approximately 295,000 rentable square feet under lease agreements, the majority of which will expire in 2011.
 
Our occupancy expenses include costs associated with office space held in excess of our current requirements. This excess space, the cost of which is charged to earnings as incurred, is being held for potential growth or to replace currently occupied space that we may exit in the future. We regularly evaluate our current and future space capacity in relation to current and projected staffing levels. In 2008, we incurred exit costs of $80 million related to our office space. We may incur exit costs in the future to the extent we (i) reduce our space capacity or (ii) commit to, or occupy, new properties in the locations in which we operate and, consequently, dispose of existing space that had been held for potential growth. These exit costs may be material to our results of operations in a given period.
 
Item 3.   Legal Proceedings
 
We are involved in a number of judicial, regulatory and arbitration proceedings (including those described below) concerning matters arising in connection with the conduct of our businesses. We believe, based on currently available information, that the results of such proceedings, in the aggregate, will not have a material adverse effect on our financial condition, but might be material to our operating results for any particular period, depending, in part, upon the operating results for such period. Given the range of litigation and investigations presently under way, our litigation expenses can be expected to remain high.
 
IPO Process Matters
 
Group Inc. and GS&Co. are among the numerous financial services companies that have been named as defendants in a variety of lawsuits alleging improprieties in the process by which those companies participated in the underwriting of public offerings in recent years.
 
GS&Co. has, together with other underwriters in certain offerings as well as the issuers and certain of their officers and directors, been named as a defendant in a number of related lawsuits filed in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York alleging, among other things, that the prospectuses for the offerings violated the federal securities laws by failing to disclose the existence of alleged arrangements tying allocations in certain offerings to higher customer brokerage commission rates as well as purchase orders in the aftermarket, and that the alleged arrangements resulted in market manipulation. The federal district court denied a motion to dismiss in all material respects relating to the underwriter defendants and generally granted plaintiffs’ motion for class certification in six “focus cases.” The U.S. Court of Appeals for the Second Circuit reversed the district court’s order granting class certification, denied plaintiffs’ applications for rehearing and rehearing en banc, and remanded. On August 14, 2007, plaintiffs amended their complaints in the six “focus cases” as well as their master allegations for all such cases to reflect new class related allegations. On September 27, 2007, plaintiffs filed a new motion for class certification in the district court, and on November 14, 2007, GS&Co. and the other defendants moved to dismiss the amended complaints. Following a mediation, a settlement in principle has been reached, subject to negotiation of definitive documentation and court approval.
 
GS&Co. is among numerous underwriting firms named as defendants in a number of complaints filed commencing October 3, 2007, in the U.S. District Court for the Western District of Washington alleging violations of the federal securities laws in connection with offerings of securities for 16 issuers


41


Table of Contents

during 1999 and 2000. The complaints generally assert that the underwriters, together with each issuer’s directors, officers and principal shareholders, entered into purported agreements to tie allocations in the offerings to increased brokerage commissions and aftermarket purchase orders. The complaints further allege that, based upon these and other purported agreements, the underwriters violated the reporting provisions of, and are subject to short-swing profit recovery under, Section 16 of the Exchange Act. On October 29, 2007, the cases were reassigned to a single district judge. On July 25, 2008, defendants moved to dismiss the various complaints.
 
GS&Co. has been named as a defendant in an action commenced on May 15, 2002 in New York Supreme Court, New York County, by an official committee of unsecured creditors on behalf of eToys, Inc., alleging that the firm intentionally underpriced eToys, Inc.’s initial public offering. The action seeks, among other things, unspecified compensatory damages resulting from the alleged lower amount of offering proceeds. The court granted GS&Co.’s motion to dismiss as to five of the claims; plaintiff appealed from the dismissal of the five claims, and GS&Co. appealed from the denial of its motion as to the remaining claim. The New York Appellate Division, First Department affirmed in part and reversed in part the lower court’s ruling on the firm’s motion to dismiss, permitting all claims to proceed except the claim for fraud, as to which the appellate court granted leave to replead, and the New York Court of Appeals affirmed in part and reversed in part, dismissing claims for breach of contract, professional malpractice and unjust enrichment, but permitting claims for breach of fiduciary duty and fraud to continue. On remand to the lower court, GS&Co. moved to dismiss the surviving claims or, in the alternative, for summary judgment, but the motion was denied by a decision dated March 21, 2006. Plaintiff has moved for leave to amend the complaint again, and GS&Co. has cross-moved to dismiss.
 
Group Inc. and certain of its affiliates have, together with various underwriters in certain offerings, received subpoenas and requests for documents and information from various governmental agencies and self-regulatory organizations in connection with investigations relating to the public offering process. Goldman Sachs has cooperated with these investigations.
 
Iridium Securities Litigation
 
GS&Co. has been named as a defendant in two purported class action lawsuits commenced, beginning on May 26, 1999, in the U.S. District Court for the District of Columbia brought on behalf of purchasers of Class A common stock of Iridium World Communications, Ltd. in a January 1999 underwritten secondary offering of 7,500,000 shares of Class A common stock. All parties entered into settlement agreements, with the underwriter defendants contributing $8.25 million to a settlement fund. The settlement was approved by the Court by order dated October 23, 2008 and has become final.
 
World Online Litigation
 
Several lawsuits have been commenced in the Netherlands courts based on alleged misstatements and omissions relating to the initial public offering of World Online in March 2000. Goldman Sachs and ABN AMRO Rothschild served as joint global coordinators of the approximately €2.9 billion offering. GSI underwrote 20,268,846 shares and GS&Co. underwrote 6,756,282 shares for a total offering price of approximately €1.16 billion.
 
On September 11, 2000, several Dutch World Online shareholders as well as a Dutch entity purporting to represent the interests of certain World Online shareholders commenced a proceeding in Amsterdam District Court against “ABN AMRO Bank N.V., also acting under the name of ABN AMRO Rothschild,” alleging misrepresentations and omissions relating to the initial public offering of World Online. The lawsuit seeks, among other things, the return of the purchase price of the shares purchased by the plaintiffs or unspecified damages. The court held that the claims failed and dismissed the complaint and the Amsterdam Court of Appeal affirmed dismissal of the complaint.
 
In March 2001, a Dutch shareholders association initiated legal proceedings for an unspecified amount of damages against GSI in Amsterdam District Court in connection with the World Online


42


Table of Contents

offering. The court rejected the claims against GSI, but found World Online liable in an amount to be determined. The Dutch shareholders association appealed from the dismissal of their claims against GSI. By a decision dated May 3, 2007, the Netherlands Court of Appeals affirmed in part and reversed in part the decision of the district court dismissing the complaint, holding that certain of the alleged disclosure deficiencies were actionable. On July 24, 2007, the shareholder association appealed from the Netherlands Court of Appeals decision to the extent that it affirmed the decision of the district court dismissing the complaint. On November 2, 2007, GSI joined the other defendants in appealing from the Court of Appeals decision to the extent that it reversed the district court’s dismissal.
 
Research Independence Matters
 
GS&Co. is one of several investment firms that have been named as defendants in substantively identical purported class actions filed in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York alleging violations of the federal securities laws in connection with research coverage of certain issuers and seeking compensatory damages. In one such action, relating to coverage of RSL Communications, Inc. commenced on July 15, 2003, GS&Co.’s motion to dismiss the complaint was denied. The district court granted the plaintiffs’ motion for class certification and the U.S. Court of Appeals for the Second Circuit, by an order dated January 26, 2007, vacated the district court’s class certification and remanded for reconsideration.
 
GS&Co. is also a defendant in several actions relating to research coverage of Exodus Communications, Inc. that commenced beginning in May 2003. The actions were consolidated, Goldman, Sachs & Co.’s motion to dismiss was granted with leave to replead, and plaintiff filed a second amended complaint. The defendants’ motion to dismiss the second amended complaint was granted by order dated December 4, 2007, and plaintiff’s motion for reconsideration was denied by order dated June 3, 2008. Plaintiff appealed the dismissal, and while the appeal was pending, the parties entered into a settlement agreement on a non-class basis, disposing of the case.
 
A purported shareholder derivative action was filed in New York Supreme Court, New York County on June 13, 2003 against Group Inc. and its board of directors, which, as amended on March 3, 2004 and June 14, 2005, alleges that the directors breached their fiduciary duties in connection with the firm’s research as well as the firm’s IPO allocations practices.
 
Group Inc., GS&Co. and Henry M. Paulson, Jr., the former Chairman and Chief Executive Officer of Group Inc., have been named as defendants in a purported class action filed originally on July 18, 2003 in the U.S. District Court for the District of Nevada on behalf of purchasers of Group Inc. stock from July 1, 1999 through May 7, 2002. The complaint alleges that defendants breached their fiduciary duties and violated the federal securities laws in connection with the firm’s research activities. The complaint seeks, among other things, unspecified compensatory damages and/or rescission. The action was transferred on consent to the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York, and the district court granted the defendants’ motion to dismiss with leave to amend. Plaintiffs filed a second amended complaint, and defendants filed a motion to dismiss. In a decision dated September 29, 2006, the federal district court granted Mr. Paulson’s motion to dismiss with leave to replead but otherwise denied the motion. Plaintiffs’ motion for class certification was granted by a decision dated September 15, 2008, and on September 26, 2008, the Goldman Sachs defendants filed a petition in the U.S. Court of Appeals for the Second Circuit seeking review of the certification ruling.
 
Group Inc. and its affiliates, together with other financial services firms, have received requests for information from various governmental agencies and self-regulatory organizations in connection with their review of research independence issues. Goldman Sachs has cooperated with these requests. See “Business — Regulation — Regulations Applicable in and Outside the United States” in Part I, Item 1 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for a discussion of our global research settlement.


43


Table of Contents

Enron Litigation Matters
 
Goldman Sachs affiliates are defendants in certain actions relating to Enron Corp., which filed for protection under the U.S. bankruptcy laws on December 2, 2001.
 
GS&Co. and co-managing underwriters have been named as defendants in certain purported securities class and individual actions commenced beginning on December 14, 2001 in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of Texas and California Superior Court brought by purchasers of $255,875,000, (including over-allotments) of Exchangeable Notes of Enron Corp. in August 1999. The notes were mandatorily exchangeable in 2002 into shares of Enron Oil & Gas Company held by Enron Corp. or their cash equivalent. The complaints also name as defendants Group Inc. as well as certain past and present officers and directors of Enron Corp. and the company’s outside accounting firm. The complaints generally allege violations of the disclosure requirements of the federal securities laws and/or state law, and seek compensatory damages. GS&Co. underwrote $127,937,500 (including over-allotments) principal amount of the notes. Group Inc. and GS&Co. moved to dismiss the class action complaint in the Texas federal court and the motion was granted as to Group Inc. but denied as to GS&Co. One of the plaintiffs has moved for class certification. GS&Co. has moved for judgment on the pleadings against all plaintiffs. On October 18, 2007, the parties reached a settlement agreement in principle pursuant to which GS&Co. has contributed $11.5 million to a settlement fund, subject to definitive documentation and court approval. Plaintiffs in various consolidated actions relating to Enron entered into a settlement with Banc of America Securities LLC on July 2, 2004 and with Citigroup, Inc. on June 10, 2005, including with respect to claims relating to the Exchangeable Notes offering, as to which affiliates of those settling defendants were two of the three underwriters (together with GS&Co.).
 
Several funds which allegedly sustained investment losses of approximately $125 million in connection with secondary market purchases of the Exchangeable Notes as well as Zero Coupon Convertible Notes of Enron Corp. commenced an action in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York on January 16, 2002. As amended, the lawsuit names as defendants the underwriters of the August 1999 offering and the company’s outside accounting firm, and alleges violations of the disclosure requirements of the federal securities laws, fraud and misrepresentation. The Judicial Panel on Multidistrict Litigation has transferred that action to the Texas federal district court for purposes of coordinated or consolidated pretrial proceedings with other matters relating to Enron Corp. GS&Co. moved to dismiss the complaint and the motion was granted in part and denied in part. The district court granted the funds’ motion for leave to file a second amended complaint on January 22, 2007.
 
GS&Co. is among numerous defendants in two substantively identical actions filed by Enron Corp.’s bankruptcy trustee in the U.S. Bankruptcy Court for the Southern District of New York beginning in November 2003 seeking to recover as fraudulent transfers and/or preferences payments made by Enron Corp. in repurchasing its commercial paper shortly before its bankruptcy filing. GS&Co., which had acted as a commercial paper dealer for Enron Corp., resold to Enron Corp. approximately $30 million of commercial paper as principal, and as an agent facilitated Enron Corp.’s repurchase of approximately $340 million additional commercial paper from various customers who have also been named as defendants. The bankruptcy court denied GS&Co.’s motion to dismiss as well as similar motions by other defendants. On August 1, 2005, various defendants including GS&Co. petitioned to have the denial of their motion to dismiss reviewed by the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York. On March 10, 2008, the district court denied GS&Co.’s motion to remove the standing reference at the present time. On April 29, 2008, GS&Co. moved for summary judgment. On January 6, 2009, GS&Co. entered into a settlement with the trustee pursuant to which it will pay $6.95 million in exchange for a release and a bar order against any third party claims. The settlement was approved by the bankruptcy court on January 21, 2009.


44


Table of Contents

Exodus Securities Litigation
 
By an amended complaint dated July 11, 2002, GS&Co. and the other lead underwriters for the February 2001 offering of 13,000,000 shares of common stock and $575,000,000 of 51/4% convertible subordinated notes of Exodus Communications, Inc. were added as defendants in a purported class action pending in the U.S. District Court for the Northern District of California. The complaint, which also names as defendants certain officers and directors of Exodus Communications, Inc., alleged violations of the disclosure requirements of the federal securities laws and seeks compensatory damages. The parties entered into a settlement agreement, with the underwriter defendants contributing $1 million toward a settlement fund. The settlement was approved by the district court on October 31, 2008 and has become final.
 
Montana Power Litigation
 
GS&Co. and Group Inc. have been named as defendants in a purported class action commenced originally on October 1, 2001 in Montana District Court, Second Judicial District on behalf of former shareholders of Montana Power Company. The complaint generally alleges that Montana Power Company violated Montana law by failing to procure shareholder approval of certain corporate strategies and transactions, that the company’s board breached its fiduciary duties in pursuing those strategies and transactions, and that GS&Co. aided and abetted the board’s breaches and rendered negligent advice in its role as financial advisor to the company. The complaint seeks, among other things, compensatory damages. In addition to GS&Co. and Group Inc., the defendants include Montana Power Company, certain of its officers and directors, an outside law firm for the Montana Power Company, and certain companies that purchased assets from Montana Power Company and its affiliates. The Montana state court denied the Goldman Sachs defendants’ motions to dismiss. Following the bankruptcies of certain defendants in the action, defendants removed the action to federal court, the U.S. District Court for the District of Montana, Butte Division.
 
On October 26, 2004, a creditors committee of Touch America Holdings, Inc. brought an action against GS&Co., Group Inc., and a former outside law firm for Montana Power Company in Montana District Court, Second Judicial District. The complaint asserts that Touch America Holdings, Inc. is the successor to Montana Power Corporation and alleges substantially the same claims as in the purported class action. Defendants removed the action to federal court. Defendants moved to dismiss the complaint, but the motion was denied by a decision dated June 10, 2005.
 
Adelphia Communications Fraudulent Conveyance Litigation
 
GS&Co. is among numerous entities named as defendants in two adversary proceedings commenced in the U.S. Bankruptcy Court for the Southern District of New York, one on July 6, 2003 by a creditors committee, and the second on or about July 31, 2003 by an equity committee of Adelphia Communications, Inc. Those proceedings have now been consolidated in a single amended complaint filed by the Adelphia Recovery Trust on October 31, 2007. The complaint seeks, among other things, to recover, as fraudulent conveyances, payments made allegedly by Adelphia Communications, Inc. and its affiliates to certain brokerage firms, including approximately $62.9 million allegedly paid to GS&Co., in respect of margin calls made in the ordinary course of business on accounts owned by members of the family that formerly controlled Adelphia Communications, Inc. GS&Co. moved to dismiss the claim related to such margin payments on December 21, 2007.
 
Specialist Matters
 
Spear, Leeds & Kellogg Specialists LLC (SLKS) and certain affiliates have received requests for information from various governmental agencies and self-regulatory organizations as part of an industry-wide investigation relating to activities of floor specialists in recent years. Goldman Sachs has cooperated with the requests.


45


Table of Contents

On March 30, 2004, certain specialist firms on the NYSE, including SLKS, without admitting or denying the allegations, entered into a final global settlement with the SEC and the NYSE covering certain activities during the years 1999 through 2003. The SLKS settlement involves, among other things, (i) findings by the SEC and the NYSE that SLKS violated certain federal securities laws and NYSE rules, and in some cases failed to supervise certain individual specialists, in connection with trades that allegedly disadvantaged customer orders, (ii) a cease and desist order against SLKS, (iii) a censure of SLKS, (iv) SLKS’ agreement to pay an aggregate of $45.3 million in disgorgement and a penalty to be used to compensate customers, (v) certain undertakings with respect to SLKS’ systems and procedures, and (v) SLKS’ retention of an independent consultant to review and evaluate certain of SLKS’ compliance systems, policies and procedures. Comparable findings were made and sanctions imposed in the settlements with other specialist firms. The settlement did not resolve the related private civil actions against SLKS and other firms or regulatory investigations involving individuals or conduct on other exchanges.
 
SLKS, Spear, Leeds & Kellogg, L.P. and Group Inc. are among numerous defendants named in purported class actions brought beginning in October 2003 on behalf of investors in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York alleging violations of the federal securities laws and state common law in connection with NYSE floor specialist activities. The actions seek unspecified compensatory damages, restitution and disgorgement on behalf of purchasers and sellers of unspecified securities between October 17, 1998 and October 15, 2003. Plaintiffs filed a consolidated amended complaint on September 16, 2004. The defendants’ motion to dismiss the amended complaint was granted in part and denied in part by a decision dated December 13, 2005. On June 28, 2007, plaintiffs filed a motion seeking to certify a class.
 
Treasury Matters
 
On September 4, 2003, the SEC announced that GS&Co. had settled an administrative proceeding arising from certain trading in U.S. Treasury bonds over an approximately eight-minute period after GS&Co. received an October 31, 2001 telephone call from a Washington, D.C.-based political consultant concerning a forthcoming Treasury refunding announcement. Without admitting or denying the allegations, GS&Co. consented to the entry of an order that, among other things, (i) censured GS&Co.; (ii) directed GS&Co. to cease and desist from committing or causing any violations of Sections 15(c)(1)(A) and (C) and 15(f) of, and Rule 15c1-2 under, the Exchange Act; (iii) ordered GS&Co. to pay disgorgement and prejudgment interest in the amount of $1,742,642, and a civil monetary penalty of $5 million; and (iv) directed GS&Co. to conduct a review of its policies and procedures and adopt, implement and maintain policies and procedures consistent with the order and that review. GS&Co. also undertook to pay $2,562,740 in disgorgement and interest relating to certain trading in U.S. Treasury bond futures during the same eight-minute period.
 
GS&Co. has been named as a defendant in a purported class action filed on March 10, 2004 in the U.S. District Court for the Northern District of Illinois on behalf of holders of short positions in 30-year U.S. Treasury futures and options on the morning of October 31, 2001. The complaint alleges that the firm purchased 30-year bonds and futures prior to the Treasury’s refunding announcement that morning based on non-public information about that announcement, and that such purchases increased the costs of covering such short positions. The complaint also names as defendants the Washington, D.C.-based political consultant who allegedly was the source of the information, a former GS&Co. economist who allegedly received the information, and another company and one of its employees who also allegedly received and traded on the information prior to its public announcement. The complaint alleges violations of the federal commodities and antitrust laws, as well as Illinois statutory and common law, and seeks, among other things, unspecified damages including treble damages under the antitrust laws. The district court dismissed the antitrust and Illinois state law claims but permitted the federal commodities law claims to proceed. Plaintiff’s motion for class certification was denied by a decision dated August 22, 2008. GS&Co. moved for summary judgment, and by a decision dated July 30, 2008, the district court granted the motion insofar as the remaining


46


Table of Contents

claim relates to the trading of treasury bonds, but denied the motion without prejudice to the extent the claim relates to trading of treasury futures.
 
Mutual Fund Matters
 
GS&Co. and certain mutual fund affiliates have received subpoenas and requests for information from various governmental agencies and self-regulatory organizations including the SEC as part of the industry-wide investigation relating to the practices of mutual funds and their customers. GS&Co. and its affiliates have cooperated with such requests.
 
Refco Securities Litigation
 
GS&Co. and the other lead underwriters for the August 2005 initial public offering of 26,500,000 shares of common stock of Refco Inc. are among the defendants in various putative class actions filed in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York beginning in October 2005 by investors in Refco Inc. in response to certain publicly reported events that culminated in the October 17, 2005 filing by Refco Inc. and certain affiliates for protection under U.S. bankruptcy laws. The actions, which have been consolidated, allege violations of the disclosure requirements of the federal securities laws and seek compensatory damages. In addition to the underwriters, the consolidated complaint names as defendants Refco Inc. and certain of its affiliates, certain officers and directors of Refco Inc., Thomas H. Lee Partners, L.P. (which held a majority of Refco Inc.’s equity through certain funds it manages), Grant Thornton (Refco Inc.’s outside auditor), and BAWAG P.S.K. Bank fur Arbeit und Wirtschaft und Osterreichische Postsparkasse Aktiengesellschaft (BAWAG). Lead plaintiffs entered into a settlement with BAWAG, which was approved following certain amendments on June 29, 2007. GS&Co. underwrote 5,639,200 shares of common stock at a price of $22 per share for a total offering price of approximately $124 million.
 
A purported shareholder derivative action was filed in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York on November 2, 2005 on behalf of Group Inc. against certain of its officers and directors. The complaint alleges that the individual defendants breached their fiduciary duties by failing to ensure that adequate due diligence was conducted in connection with the Refco Inc. initial public offering. The parties subsequently stipulated to the action’s dismissal, and the action was dismissed by the district court by order dated January 7, 2009.
 
GS&Co. has, together with other underwriters of the Refco Inc. initial public offering, received requests for information from various governmental agencies and self-regulatory organizations. GS&Co. is cooperating with those requests.
 
Short-Selling Litigation
 
Group Inc., GS&Co. and Goldman Sachs Execution & Clearing, L.P. are among the numerous financial services firms that have been named as defendants in a purported class action filed on April 12, 2006 in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York by customers who engaged in short-selling transactions in equity securities since April 12, 2000. The amended complaint generally alleges that the customers were charged fees in connection with the short sales but that the applicable securities were not necessarily borrowed to effect delivery, resulting in failed deliveries, and that the defendants conspired to set a minimum threshold borrowing rate for securities designated as hard to borrow. The complaint asserts a claim under the federal antitrust laws, as well as claims under the New York Business Law and common law, and seeks treble damages as well as injunctive relief. Defendants’ motion to dismiss the complaint was granted by a decision dated December 20, 2007. On January 18, 2008, plaintiffs appealed from this decision.
 
Fannie Mae Litigation
 
GS&Co. was added as a defendant in an amended complaint filed on August 14, 2006 in a purported class action pending in the U.S. District Court for the District of Columbia. The complaint


47


Table of Contents

asserts violations of the federal securities laws generally arising from allegations concerning Fannie Mae’s accounting practices in connection with certain Fannie Mae-sponsored REMIC transactions that were allegedly arranged by GS&Co. The other defendants include Fannie Mae, certain of its past and present officers and directors, and accountants. By a decision dated May 8, 2007, the district court granted GS&Co.’s motion to dismiss the claim against it. The time for an appeal will not begin to run until disposition of the claims against other defendants.
 
Beginning in September 2006, Group Inc. and/or GS&Co. were added named as defendants in four Fannie Mae shareholder derivative actions in the U.S. District Court for the District of Columbia. The complaints generally allege that the Goldman Sachs defendants aided and abetted a breach of fiduciary duty by Fannie Mae’s directors and officers in connection with certain Fannie Mae-sponsored REMIC transactions and one of the complaints also asserts a breach of contract claim. The complaints also name as defendants certain former officers and directors of Fannie Mae as well as an outside accounting firm. The complaints seek, inter alia, unspecified damages. The Goldman Sachs defendants were dismissed without prejudice from the first filed of these actions, and the remaining claims in that action were dismissed for failure to make a demand on Fannie Mae’s board of directors. That dismissal has been affirmed on appeal. The remaining three actions have been stayed by the district court.
 
General American Litigation
 
On February 13, 2007, the liquidators of General American Mutual Holding Corporation filed a complaint in Missouri Circuit Court against one of the company’s former officers to assert claims against Group Inc. and GS&Co. The amended complaint asserted that the Goldman Sachs defendants breached certain duties and violated Missouri law in the course of acting as the company’s financial advisor during 1998-1999 in connection with the exploration of a potential demutualization and initial public offering, and the ensuing sale of certain company assets. The complaint sought compensatory and punitive damages. The parties settled the action, with the Goldman Sachs defendants paying $99.975 million. The settlement was approved by order dated November 6, 2008.
 
Executive Compensation Litigation
 
On March 16, 2007, Group Inc., its board of directors, executive officers and members of its management committee were named as defendants in a purported shareholder derivative action in the U.S. District Court for the Eastern District of New York challenging the sufficiency of the firm’s February 21, 2007 Proxy Statement and the compensation of certain employees. The complaint generally alleges that the Proxy Statement undervalues stock option awards disclosed therein, that the recipients received excessive awards because the proper methodology was not followed, and that the firm’s senior management received excessive compensation, constituting corporate waste. The complaint seeks, among other things, an injunction against the 2007 Annual Meeting of Shareholders, the voiding of any election of directors in the absence of an injunction and an equitable accounting for the allegedly excessive compensation. On July 20, 2007, defendants moved to dismiss the complaint, the motion was granted by an order dated December 18, 2008 and plaintiff appealed on January 13, 2009.
 
On January 17, 2008, Group Inc., its board of directors, executive officers and members of its management committee were named as defendants in a related purported shareholder derivative action brought by the same plaintiff in the same court predicting that the firm’s 2008 Proxy Statement will violate the federal securities laws by undervaluing certain stock option awards and alleging that senior management received excessive compensation for 2007. The complaint seeks, among other things, an injunction against the distribution of the 2008 Proxy Statement, the voiding of any election


48


Table of Contents

of directors in the absence of an injunction and an equitable accounting for the allegedly excessive compensation. On January 25, 2008, the plaintiff moved for a preliminary injunction to prevent the 2008 Proxy Statement from using options valuations that the plaintiff alleges are incorrect and to require the amendment of SEC Form 4s filed by certain of the executive officers named in the complaint to reflect the stock option valuations alleged by the plaintiff. Plaintiff’s motion for a preliminary injunction was denied by order dated February 14, 2008, plaintiff appealed and twice moved to expedite the appeal, with the motions being denied by orders dated February 29, 2008 and April 3, 2008.
 
Mortgage-Related Matters
 
GS&Co. and certain of its affiliates, together with other financial services firms, have received requests for information from various governmental agencies and self-regulatory organizations relating to subprime mortgages, and securitizations, collateralized debt obligations and synthetic products related to subprime mortgages. GS&Co. and its affiliates are cooperating with the requests.
 
GS&Co., along with numerous other financial institutions, is a defendant in an action brought by the City of Cleveland alleging that the defendants’ activities in connection with securitizations of subprime mortgages created a “public nuisance” in Cleveland. The action is pending in the U.S. District Court for the Northern District of Ohio, and the complaint seeks, among other things, unspecified compensatory damages. Defendants moved to dismiss on November 24, 2008.
 
GS&Co., Goldman Sachs Mortgage Company and GS Mortgage Securities Corp. are among the defendants in a purported class action commenced on December 11, 2008 in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York brought on behalf of purchasers of various mortgage pass-through certificates and asset-backed certificates issued by various securitization trusts in 2007 and underwritten by GS&Co. The other defendants include the various issuer trusts that issued the securities as well as certain officers and directors of certain of the entity defendants. The complaint generally alleges that the registration statement and prospectus supplements for the certificates violated the federal securities laws. The complaint asserts claims against the issuer trusts and GS&Co. under Section 11 of the U.S. Securities Act of 1933 (Securities Act), and a related “controlling person” claim against the other defendants under Section 15 of the Securities Act, and seeks unspecified compensatory damages and rescission or recessionary damages.
 
Auction Products Matters
 
On August 21, 2008, GS&Co. entered into a settlement in principle with the Office of Attorney General of the State of New York and the Illinois Securities Department (on behalf of the North American Securities Administrators Association) regarding auction rate securities. Under the agreement, Goldman Sachs agreed, among other things, (i) to offer to repurchase at par the outstanding auction rate securities that its private wealth management clients purchased through the firm prior to February 11, 2008, with the exception of those auction rate securities where auctions are clearing, (ii) to continue to work with issuers and other interested parties, including regulatory and governmental entities, to expeditiously provide liquidity solutions for institutional investors, and (iii) to pay a $22.5 million fine. The settlement, which is subject to definitive documentation and approval by the various states, does not resolve any potential regulatory action by the SEC.
 
On August 28, 2008, a putative shareholder derivative action was filed in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York naming as defendants Group Inc., its board of directors, and certain senior officers. The complaint alleges generally that the board breached its fiduciary duties and committed mismanagement in connection with its oversight of auction rate securities marketing and trading operations, that certain individual defendants engaged in insider selling by selling shares of Group Inc., and that the firm’s public filings were false and misleading in violation of the federal securities laws by failing to accurately disclose the alleged practices involving auction rate securities. The complaint seeks damages, injunctive and declaratory relief, restitution, and an order requiring the firm to adopt corporate reforms. Defendants moved to dismiss on January 23, 2009.


49


Table of Contents

On September 4, 2008, Group Inc. was named as a defendant, together with numerous other financial services firms, in two complaints filed in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York alleging that the defendants engaged in a conspiracy to manipulate the auction securities market in violation of federal antitrust laws. The actions were filed, respectively, on behalf of putative classes of issuers of and investors in auction rate securities and seek, among other things, treble damages. Defendants moved to dismiss on January 15, 2009.
 
Private Equity-Sponsored Acquisitions Litigation
 
Group Inc. and “GS Capital Partners” are among numerous private equity firms and investment banks named as defendants in a federal antitrust action filed in the U.S. District Court for the District of Massachusetts in December 2007. As amended, the complaint generally alleges that the defendants have colluded to limit competition in bidding for private equity-sponsored acquisitions of public companies, thereby resulting in lower prevailing bids and, by extension, less consideration for shareholders of those companies in violation of Section 1 of the U.S. Sherman Antitrust Act and common law. Defendants moved to dismiss on August 27, 2008. By an order dated November 19, 2008, the district court dismissed claims relating to certain transactions that were the subject of releases as part of the settlement of shareholder actions challenging such transactions, and by an order dated December 15, 2008 otherwise denied the motion to dismiss.
 
Washington Mutual Securities Litigation
 
GS&Co. is among numerous underwriters named as defendants in a putative securities class action amended complaint filed on August 5, 2008 in the U.S. District Court for the Western District of Washington. As to the underwriters, plaintiffs allege that the offering documents in connection with various securities offerings by Washington Mutual, Inc. failed to describe accurately the company’s exposure to mortgage-related activities in violation of the disclosure requirements of the federal securities laws. The defendants include past and present directors and officers of Washington Mutual, the company’s former outside auditors, and numerous underwriters. The underwriter defendants moved to dismiss on December 8, 2008. GS&Co. underwrote $788,500,000 principal amount of securities in the offerings at issue.
 
On September 25, 2008, the FDIC took over the primary banking operations of Washington Mutual, Inc. and then sold them. On September 27, 2008, Washington Mutual, Inc. filed for Chapter 11 bankruptcy in the U.S. bankruptcy court in Delaware.
 
Britannia Bulk Securities Litigation
 
GS&Co. is among the underwriters named as defendants in numerous putative securities class actions filed beginning on November 6, 2008 in the U.S. District Court for the Southern District of New York arising from the June 17, 2008 $125 million initial public offering of common stock of Britannia Bulk Holdings, Inc. The complaints name as defendants the company, certain of its directors and officers, and the underwriters for the offering. Plaintiffs allege that the offering materials violated the disclosure requirements of the federal securities laws and seek compensatory damages. Defendants have yet to respond.
 
GS&Co. underwrote 3.75 million shares of common stock for a total offering price of $56.25 million. The principal operating subsidiary of Britannia Bulk Holdings, Inc. is subject to an insolvency proceeding in the U.K. courts.
 
Item 4.   Submission of Matters to a Vote of Security Holders
 
There were no matters submitted to a vote of security holders during the fourth quarter of our fiscal year ended November 28, 2008.


50


Table of Contents

 
EXECUTIVE OFFICERS OF THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC.
 
Set forth below are the name, age, present title, principal occupation and certain biographical information as of January 26, 2009 for our executive officers. All of our executive officers have been appointed by and serve at the pleasure of our board of directors.
 
Lloyd C. Blankfein, 54
 
Mr. Blankfein has been our Chairman and Chief Executive Officer since June 2006, and a director since April 2003. Previously, he had been our President and Chief Operating Officer since January 2004. Prior to that, from April 2002 until January 2004, he was a Vice Chairman of Goldman Sachs, with management responsibility for Goldman Sachs’ Fixed Income, Currency and Commodities Division (FICC) and Equities Division (Equities). Prior to becoming a Vice Chairman, he had served as co-head of FICC since its formation in 1997. From 1994 to 1997, he headed or co-headed the Currency and Commodities Division. Mr. Blankfein is not on the board of any public company other than Goldman Sachs. He is affiliated with certain non-profit organizations, including as a member of the Harvard University Committee on University Resources, the Advisory Board of the Tsinghua University School of Economics and Management and the Governing Board of the Indian School of Business, an overseer of the Weill Medical College of Cornell University, and a director of the Partnership for New York City and Catalyst.
 
Alan M. Cohen, 58
 
Mr. Cohen has been an Executive Vice President of Goldman Sachs and our Global Head of Compliance since February 2004. From 1991 until January 2004, he was a partner in the law firm of O’Melveny & Myers LLP. He is affiliated with certain non-profit organizations, including as a board member of the New York Stem Cell Foundation.
 
Gary D. Cohn, 48
 
Mr. Cohn has been our President and Co-Chief Operating Officer and a director since June 2006. Previously, he had been the co-head of Goldman Sachs’ global securities businesses since January 2004. He also had been the co-head of Equities since 2003 and the co-head of FICC since September 2002. From March 2002 to September 2002, he served as co-chief operating officer of FICC. Prior to that, beginning in 1999, Mr. Cohn managed the FICC macro businesses. From 1996 to 1999, he was the global head of Goldman Sachs’ commodities business. Mr. Cohn is not on the board of any public company other than Goldman Sachs. He is affiliated with certain non-profit organizations, including as a trustee of the Gilmour Academy, the NYU Child Study Center, the NYU Hospital, the NYU Medical School, the Harlem Children’s Zone and American University.
 
J. Michael Evans, 51
 
Mr. Evans has been a Vice Chairman of Goldman Sachs since February 2008 and chairman of Goldman Sachs Asia since 2004. Prior to becoming a Vice Chairman, he had served as global co-head of Goldman Sachs’ securities business since 2003. Previously, he had been co-head of the Equities Division since 2001. Mr. Evans is a board member of CASPER (Center for Advancement of Standards-based Physical Education Reform). He also serves as a trustee of the Bendheim Center for Finance at Princeton University.
 
Gregory K. Palm, 60
 
Mr. Palm has been an Executive Vice President of Goldman Sachs since May 1999, and our General Counsel and head or co-head of the Legal Department since May 1992.


51


Table of Contents

Michael S. Sherwood, 43
 
Mr. Sherwood has been a Vice Chairman of Goldman Sachs since February 2008 and co-chief executive officer of Goldman Sachs International since 2005. Prior to becoming a Vice Chairman, he had served as global co-head of Goldman Sachs’ securities business since 2003. Prior to that, he had been head of the Fixed Income, Currency and Commodities Division in Europe since 2001.
 
Esta E. Stecher, 51
 
Ms. Stecher has been an Executive Vice President of Goldman Sachs and our General Counsel and co-head of the Legal Department since December 2000. From 1994 to 2000, she was head of the firm’s Tax Department, over which she continues to have senior oversight responsibility. She is also a trustee of Columbia University.
 
David A. Viniar, 53
 
Mr. Viniar has been an Executive Vice President of Goldman Sachs and our Chief Financial Officer since May 1999. He has been the head of Operations, Technology, Finance and Services Division since December 2002. He was head of the Finance Division and co-head of Credit Risk Management and Advisory and Firmwide Risk from December 2001 to December 2002. Mr. Viniar was co-head of Operations, Finance and Resources from March 1999 to December 2001. He was Chief Financial Officer of The Goldman Sachs Group, L.P. from March 1999 to May 1999. From July 1998 until March 1999, he was Deputy Chief Financial Officer and from 1994 until July 1998, he was head of Finance, with responsibility for Controllers and Treasury. From 1992 to 1994, he was head of Treasury and prior to that was in the Structured Finance Department of Investment Banking. He also serves on the Board of Trustees of Union College.
 
John S. Weinberg, 51
 
Mr. Weinberg has been a Vice Chairman of Goldman Sachs since June 2006. He has been co-head of Goldman Sachs’ Investment Banking Division since December 2002. From January 2002 to December 2002, he was co-head of the Investment Banking Division in the Americas. Prior to that, he served as co-head of the Investment Banking Services Department since 1997. He is affiliated with certain non-profit organizations, including as a board member at NewYork-Presbyterian Hospital, The Steppingstone Foundation, the Greenwich Country Day School and Community Anti-Drug Coalitions of America. Mr. Weinberg also serves on the Visiting Committee for Harvard Business School.
 
Jon Winkelried, 49
 
Mr. Winkelried has been our President and Co-Chief Operating Officer and a director since June 2006. Previously, he had been the co-head of Goldman Sachs’ Investment Banking Division since January 2005. From 2000 to 2005, he was co-head of FICC. From 1999 to 2000, he was head of FICC in Europe. From 1995 to 1999, he was responsible for Goldman Sachs’ leveraged finance business. Mr. Winkelried is not on the board of any public company other than Goldman Sachs. He is also a trustee of the University of Chicago.


52


Table of Contents

 
PART II
 
Item 5.   Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities
 
The principal market on which our common stock is traded is the NYSE. Information relating to the high and low sales prices per share of our common stock, as reported by the Consolidated Tape Association, for each full quarterly period during fiscal 2007 and 2008 is set forth under the heading “Supplemental Financial Information — Common Stock Price Range” in Part II, Item 8 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K. As of January 16, 2009, there were 9,909 holders of record of our common stock.
 
During fiscal 2008 and 2007, dividends of $0.35 per share of common stock were declared on December 11, 2007, March 12, 2008, June 13, 2007, September 19, 2007, December 17, 2007, March 17, 2008, June 16, 2008 and September 15, 2008. The holders of our common stock share proportionately on a per share basis in all dividends and other distributions on common stock declared by our board of directors.
 
The declaration of dividends by Goldman Sachs is subject to the discretion of our board of directors. Our board of directors will take into account such matters as general business conditions, our financial results, capital requirements, contractual, legal and regulatory restrictions on the payment of dividends by us to our shareholders or by our subsidiaries to us, the effect on our debt ratings and such other factors as our board of directors may deem relevant. See “Business — Regulation” in Part I, Item 1 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for a discussion of potential regulatory limitations on our receipt of funds from our regulated subsidiaries and our payment of dividends to shareholders of Group Inc.
 
Prior to October 28, 2011, unless we have redeemed all the preferred stock issued to the U.S. Treasury on October 28, 2008 or unless the U.S. Treasury has transferred all the preferred stock to a third party, the consent of the U.S. Treasury will be required for us to declare or pay any dividend or make any distribution on common stock other than (i) regular quarterly cash dividends of not more than $0.35 per share, as adjusted for any stock split, stock dividend, reverse stock split, reclassification or similar transaction, (ii) dividends payable solely in shares of common stock and (iii) dividends or distributions of rights or junior stock in connection with a stockholders’ rights plan.


53


Table of Contents

The table below sets forth the information with respect to purchases made by or on behalf of Group Inc. or any “affiliated purchaser” (as defined in Rule 10b-18(a)(3) under the Exchange Act), of our common stock during the fourth quarter of our fiscal year ended November 28, 2008.
 
                                 
            Total Number of
  Maximum Number
        Average
  Shares Purchased
  of Shares That May
    Total Number
  Price
  as Part of Publicly
  Yet Be Purchased
    of Shares
  Paid per
  Announced Plans
  Under the Plans or
Period
 
Purchased
 
Share
 
or Programs (2)
 
Programs (2)
Month #1
(August 30, 2008 to September 26, 2008)
                      60,859,203  
Month #2
(September 27, 2008 to
October 31, 2008)
    2,025     $ 121.35       2,025       60,857,178  
Month #3
(November 1, 2008 to
November 28, 2008)
    4,700     $ 53.31       4,700       60,852,478  
                                 
Total (1)
    6,725     $ 73.80       6,725          
                                 
 
 
(1) Goldman Sachs generally does not repurchase shares of its common stock as part of the repurchase program during self-imposed “black-out” periods, which run from the last two weeks of a fiscal quarter through and including the date of the earnings release for such quarter.
 
(2) On March 21, 2000, we announced that our board of directors had approved a repurchase program, pursuant to which up to 15 million shares of our common stock may be repurchased. This repurchase program was increased by an aggregate of 280 million shares by resolutions of our board of directors adopted on June 18, 2001, March 18, 2002, November 20, 2002, January 30, 2004, January 25, 2005, September 16, 2005, September 11, 2006 and December 17, 2007. We use our share repurchase program to help maintain the appropriate level of common equity and to substantially offset increases in share count over time resulting from employee share-based compensation. Prior to October 28, 2011, unless we have redeemed all the preferred stock issued to the U.S. Treasury on October 28, 2008 or unless the U.S. Treasury has transferred all the preferred stock to a third party, the consent of the U.S. Treasury will be required for us to repurchase our common stock in an aggregate amount greater than the increase in the number of diluted shares outstanding (as reported in our Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the three months ended August 29, 2008) resulting from the grant, vesting or exercise of equity-based compensation to employees and equitably adjusted for any stock split, stock dividend, reverse stock split, reclassification or similar transaction.
 
The repurchase program is effected primarily through regular open-market purchases, the amounts and timing of which are determined primarily by our current and projected capital positions (i.e., comparisons of our desired level of capital to our actual level of capital) but which may also be influenced by general market conditions and the prevailing price and trading volumes of our common stock, in each case subject to the limit imposed under the U.S. Treasury’s TARP Capital Purchase Program. The total remaining authorization under the repurchase program was 60,852,478 shares as of January 16, 2009; the repurchase program has no set expiration or termination date.
 
 
Information relating to compensation plans under which our equity securities are authorized for issuance is set forth in Part III, Item 12 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K.
 
Item 6.   Selected Financial Data
 
The Selected Financial Data table is set forth under Part II, Item 8 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K.


54


 

 
Item 7.   Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations
 
INDEX
 
         
    Page
    No.
 
    56  
       
    57  
       
    59  
       
    61  
       
    66  
       
    66  
       
    74  
       
    77  
       
    78  
       
    78  
       
    84  
       
    91  
       
    91  
       
    93  
       
    102  
       
    105  
       
    106  
       
    112  
       
    113  
       
    117  
       
    125  
       
    126  


55


Table of Contents

 
Introduction
 
The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. (Group Inc.) is a bank holding company and a leading global investment banking, securities and investment management firm that provides a wide range of services worldwide to a substantial and diversified client base that includes corporations, financial institutions, governments and high-net-worth individuals.
 
Our activities are divided into three segments:
 
  •  Investment Banking.  We provide a broad range of investment banking services to a diverse group of corporations, financial institutions, investment funds, governments and individuals.
 
  •  Trading and Principal Investments.  We facilitate client transactions with a diverse group of corporations, financial institutions, investment funds, governments and individuals and take proprietary positions through market making in, trading of and investing in fixed income and equity products, currencies, commodities and derivatives on these products. In addition, we engage in market-making and specialist activities on equities and options exchanges, and we clear client transactions on major stock, options and futures exchanges worldwide. In connection with our merchant banking and other investing activities, we make principal investments directly and through funds that we raise and manage.
 
  •  Asset Management and Securities Services.  We provide investment advisory and financial planning services and offer investment products (primarily through separately managed accounts and commingled vehicles, such as mutual funds and private investment funds) across all major asset classes to a diverse group of institutions and individuals worldwide and provide prime brokerage services, financing services and securities lending services to institutional clients, including hedge funds, mutual funds, pension funds and foundations, and to high-net-worth individuals worldwide.
 
Unless specifically stated otherwise, all references to 2008, 2007 and 2006 refer to our fiscal years ended, or the dates, as the context requires, November 28, 2008, November 30, 2007 and November 24, 2006, respectively, and any reference to a future year refers to a fiscal year ending on the last Friday in November of that year.
 
On December 15, 2008, the Board of Directors of Group Inc. (Board) approved a change in our fiscal year-end from the last Friday of November to the last Friday of December. The change is effective for our 2009 fiscal year. The firm’s 2009 fiscal year began December 27, 2008 and will end December 25, 2009, resulting in a one-month transition period that began November 29, 2008 and ended December 26, 2008.
 
When we use the terms “Goldman Sachs,” “the firm,” “we,” “us” and “our,” we mean Group Inc., a Delaware corporation, and its consolidated subsidiaries. References herein to our Annual Report on Form 10-K are to our Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 28, 2008.
 
In this discussion, we have included statements that may constitute “forward-looking statements” within the meaning of the safe harbor provisions of the U.S. Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995. Forward-looking statements are not historical facts but instead represent only our beliefs regarding future events, many of which, by their nature, are inherently uncertain and outside our control. These statements include statements other than historical information or statements of current condition and may relate to our future plans and objectives and results, among other things, and may also include statements about the objectives and effectiveness of our risk management and liquidity policies, statements about trends in or growth opportunities for our businesses, statements about our future status, activities or reporting under U.S. banking regulation, and statements about our investment banking transaction backlog. By identifying these statements for you in this manner, we are alerting you to the possibility that our actual results and financial condition may differ, possibly materially, from the anticipated results and financial condition indicated in these forward-looking statements. Important factors that could cause our actual results and financial condition to differ from those indicated in these forward-looking statements include, among others, those discussed below under “— Certain Risk Factors That May Affect Our Businesses” as well as “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A of our Annual Report on Form 10-K and “Cautionary Statement Pursuant to the U.S. Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995” in Part I, Item 1 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K.


56


Table of Contents

 
Executive Overview
 
Our diluted earnings per common share were $4.47 for 2008, compared with $24.73 for 2007. Return on average tangible common shareholders’ equity (1) was 5.5% and return on average common shareholders’ equity was 4.9% for 2008. As of November 2008, book value per common share was $98.68, an increase of 9.1% compared with the end of 2007, and our Tier 1 Ratio (2) was 15.6%. During the fourth quarter of 2008, we raised $20.75 billion in equity, comprised of a $5.75 billion public common stock sale, a $5 billion preferred stock and warrant issuance to Berkshire Hathaway Inc. and certain affiliates and a $10 billion preferred stock and warrant issuance under the U.S. Department of the Treasury’s (U.S. Treasury) TARP Capital Purchase Program. Total assets were $885 billion at the end of the year, a decrease of 21% compared with the end of 2007. During the fourth quarter of 2008, the firm became a bank holding company regulated by the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (Federal Reserve Board).
 
Our results for 2008 reflected a particularly difficult operating environment, including significant asset price declines, high levels of volatility and reduced levels of liquidity, particularly in the fourth quarter. In addition, credit markets experienced significant dislocation between prices for cash instruments and the related derivative contracts and between credit indices and underlying single names. Net revenues in Trading and Principal Investments were significantly lower compared with 2007, reflecting significant declines in Fixed Income, Currency and Commodities (FICC), Principal Investments and Equities. The decrease in FICC primarily reflected losses in credit products, which included a loss of approximately $3.1 billion (net of hedges) related to non-investment-grade credit origination activities and losses from investments, including corporate debt and private and public equities. Results in mortgages included net losses of approximately $1.7 billion on residential mortgage loans and securities and approximately $1.4 billion on commercial mortgage loans and securities. Interest rate products, currencies and commodities each produced particularly strong results and net revenues were higher compared with 2007. During 2008, although client-driven activity was generally solid, FICC operated in a challenging environment characterized by broad-based declines in asset values, wider mortgage and corporate credit spreads, reduced levels of liquidity and broad-based investor deleveraging, particularly in the second half of the year. The decline in Principal Investments primarily reflected net losses of $2.53 billion from corporate principal investments and $949 million from real estate principal investments, as well as a $446 million loss from our investment in the ordinary shares of Industrial and Commercial Bank of China Limited (ICBC). In Equities, the decrease compared with particularly strong net revenues in 2007 reflected losses in principal strategies, partially offset by higher net revenues in our client franchise businesses. Commissions were particularly strong and were higher than 2007. During 2008, Equities operated in an environment characterized by a significant decline in global equity prices, broad-based investor deleveraging and very high levels of volatility, particularly in the second half of the year.
 
 
(1)   Return on average tangible common shareholders’ equity (ROTE) is computed by dividing net earnings applicable to common shareholders by average monthly tangible common shareholders’ equity. See “— Results of Operations — Financial Overview” below for further information regarding our calculation of ROTE.
 
(2)   Before we became a bank holding company, we were subject to capital guidelines as a Consolidated Supervised Entity (CSE) that were generally consistent with those set out in the Revised Framework for the International Convergence of Capital Measurement and Capital Standards issued by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (Basel II). We currently compute and report our consolidated capital ratios in accordance with the Basel II requirements, as applicable to us when we were regulated as a CSE, for the purpose of assessing the adequacy of our capital. Under the Basel II framework as it applied to us when we were regulated as a CSE, our Tier 1 Ratio equals Tier 1 Capital divided by Total Risk-Weighted Assets (RWAs). We are currently working with the Federal Reserve Board to put in place the appropriate reporting and compliance mechanisms and methodologies to allow reporting of the Basel I capital ratios as of the end of March 2009. See “— Equity Capital” below for a further discussion of our Tier 1 Ratio.


57


Table of Contents

Net revenues in Investment Banking also declined significantly compared with 2007, reflecting significantly lower net revenues in both Financial Advisory and Underwriting. In Financial Advisory, the decrease compared with particularly strong net revenues in 2007 reflected a decline in industry-wide completed mergers and acquisitions. The decrease in Underwriting primarily reflected significantly lower net revenues in debt underwriting, primarily due to a decline in leveraged finance and mortgage-related activity, reflecting difficult market conditions. Net revenues in equity underwriting were slightly lower compared with 2007, reflecting a decrease in industry-wide equity and equity-related offerings. Our investment banking transaction backlog at the end of 2008 was significantly lower than it was at the end of 2007. (3)
 
Net revenues in Asset Management and Securities Services increased compared with 2007. Securities Services net revenues were higher, reflecting the impact of changes in the composition of securities lending customer balances, as well as higher total average customer balances. Asset Management net revenues increased slightly compared with 2007. During the year, assets under management decreased $89 billion to $779 billion, due to $123 billion of market depreciation, primarily in equity assets, partially offset by $34 billion of net inflows.
 
Given the difficult market conditions, and in particular, the challenging liquidity and funding environment during 2008, we focused on reducing concentrated risk positions, including our exposure to leveraged loans and real estate-related loans. We believe that the strength of our capital position will enable us to take advantage of market opportunities as they arise in 2009.
 
Our business, by its nature, does not produce predictable earnings. Our results in any given period can be materially affected by conditions in global financial markets and economic conditions generally. For a further discussion of the factors that may affect our future operating results, see “— Certain Risk Factors That May Affect Our Businesses” below as well as “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A of our Annual Report on Form 10-K.
 
 
(3) Our investment banking transaction backlog represents an estimate of our future net revenues from investment banking transactions where we believe that future revenue realization is more likely than not.


58


Table of Contents

 
Business Environment
 
Our financial performance is highly dependent on the environment in which our businesses operate. During the first half of 2008, global economic growth slowed as the U.S. entered a recession. Despite the weakness in the U.S. and other major economies, growth in most emerging markets remained solid, which contributed to a dramatic increase in commodity prices as well as increased inflation. However, during the second half of 2008, the downturn in global economic growth became broad-based, which coincided with significant weakness and sharply reduced liquidity across global financial markets. For a further discussion of how market conditions affect our businesses, see “— Certain Risk Factors That May Affect Our Businesses” below as well as “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A of our Annual Report on Form 10-K. A further discussion of the business environment in 2008 is set forth below.
 
Global.  Growth in the global economy weakened substantially over the course of 2008, particularly in the major economies. Economic growth in emerging markets also generally declined in 2008, but remained high relative to the major economies. Fixed income and equity markets experienced high levels of volatility, broad-based declines in asset prices and reduced levels of liquidity, particularly during the fourth quarter of our fiscal year. In addition, mortgage and corporate credit spreads widened and credit markets experienced significant dislocation between prices for cash instruments and the related derivative contracts and between credit indices and underlying single names. The U.S. Federal Reserve lowered its federal funds target rate over the course of our fiscal year, while central banks in the Eurozone, United Kingdom, Japan and China also lowered interest rates towards the end of the year. Oil prices exhibited significant volatility during our fiscal year, rising to over $140 per barrel in July before declining to under $60 per barrel by the end of our fiscal year. In currency markets, the U.S. dollar initially weakened against most major currencies, particularly against the Euro, but subsequently recovered as the pace of decline in global economic growth began to accelerate in the second half of the year. Investment banking activity was generally subdued during our fiscal year, reflecting a significant decline in industry-wide announced and completed mergers and acquisitions and equity and equity-related offerings compared with 2007.
 
United States.  Real gross domestic product growth in the U.S. economy slowed to an estimated 1.2% in calendar year 2008, down from 2.0% in 2007. The economy entered a recession near the beginning of our fiscal year, with the downturn intensifying in our fourth quarter. Much of the slowdown was attributable to weakness in credit markets brought on by the contraction in the housing market and the associated increase in mortgage delinquencies and defaults. Growth in industrial production slowed from 2007 levels, reflecting reduced growth in domestic demand and exports. Both business and consumer confidence declined over the course of the year. Growth in consumer expenditure was supported in the first half of the year by the federal government’s stimulus package but declined thereafter, as the housing market continued to weaken and the rate of unemployment rose significantly. The rate of inflation increased during the first half of our fiscal year, as energy and food prices increased significantly, but declined sharply towards the end of the year. Measures of core inflation, which remained elevated in the first half of the year, also declined towards the end of the year as the labor market continued to weaken and capacity utilization decreased. The U.S. Federal Reserve reduced its federal funds target rate by a total of 350 basis points to 1.00% during our fiscal year, its lowest level since 2003. U.S. regulatory agencies have also taken additional measures to address reduced levels of liquidity in credit markets and the U.S. Treasury took measures to strengthen the capital adequacy of financial institutions. The yield on the 10-year U.S. Treasury note declined by 104 basis points to 2.93% during our fiscal year. The Dow Jones Industrial Average, the S&P 500 Index and the NASDAQ Composite Index ended our fiscal year lower by 34%, 39% and 42%, respectively.
 
Europe.  Real gross domestic product growth in the Eurozone economies slowed to an estimated 0.8% in calendar year 2008, down from 2.6% in 2007. Growth in industrial production, fixed investment and consumer expenditure weakened throughout the year. In addition, surveys of business and consumer confidence declined. Although the labor market remained solid in the first half of the


59


Table of Contents

year, the unemployment rate began to increase in the second half of the year. The rate of inflation increased during the first three quarters of the year. In response to inflationary pressures, the European Central Bank (ECB) raised interest rates in July, increasing its main refinancing operations rate by 25 basis points to 4.25%. However, during the fourth quarter of our fiscal year, the ECB lowered its main refinancing operations rate by a total of 100 basis points to 3.25%, as financial markets and the outlook for growth weakened considerably and inflationary pressures appeared to decline. In the United Kingdom, real gross domestic product growth fell to an estimated 0.9% for calendar year 2008, down from 3.0% in 2007. The decline in growth accelerated in the second half of the year as credit market conditions deteriorated and the slowdown in the U.K. housing market intensified. The rate of inflation increased during the year, although inflationary pressures appeared to moderate in our fourth quarter. The Bank of England lowered its official bank rate over the course of our fiscal year by a total of 275 basis points to 3.00%. Long-term government bond yields in both the Eurozone and the U.K. ended our fiscal year lower. The Euro and British pound depreciated by 13% and 25%, respectively, against the U.S. dollar during our fiscal year. Major European equity markets ended our fiscal year significantly lower.
 
Asia.  In Japan, real gross domestic product decreased by an estimated 0.2% in calendar year 2008 compared with an increase of 2.4% in 2007. Measures of investment activity in the housing sector and growth in consumption declined during the year. Export growth remained solid in the first half of the year but deteriorated notably towards year-end as the environment outside of Japan worsened. The rate of inflation increased from the near-zero levels seen in recent years, but remained moderate. The Bank of Japan lowered its target overnight call rate by 20 basis points in October, bringing it to 0.30%, while the yield on 10-year Japanese government bonds declined by 23 basis points during our fiscal year. The yen appreciated by 14% against the U.S. dollar. The Nikkei 225 ended our fiscal year down 46%.
 
In China, real gross domestic product growth declined to an estimated 9.0% in calendar year 2008 from 13.0% in 2007. Export growth and industrial production decelerated rapidly toward the end of the year, while consumer spending softened but remained solid. Rising food prices contributed to a higher rate of inflation in the first half of the year but inflation fell sharply in the second half of the year. The People’s Bank of China raised its one-year benchmark lending rate by 18 basis points to 7.47% at the beginning of our fiscal year, but reduced the lending rate by 189 basis points during our fourth quarter and took additional measures to increase liquidity in the financial system. The Chinese government continued to allow the steady appreciation of its currency against the U.S. dollar in the first half of the year, after which the exchange rate remained broadly unchanged. Real gross domestic product growth in India slowed to an estimated 6.7% in calendar year 2008 from 9.0% in 2007. While export growth remained solid for most of the year, growth in consumer expenditure and fixed investment declined. The rate of wholesale inflation increased sharply in the first half of the year and then subsequently declined. The Indian rupee, along with other currencies in the region, generally depreciated against the U.S. dollar. Equity markets experienced substantial declines across the region, with the Shanghai Composite Index down 62%, and markets in Hong Kong, India and South Korea also ending the year significantly lower.
 
Other Markets.  Real gross domestic product growth in Brazil declined to an estimated 5.4% in calendar year 2008 from 5.7% in 2007. For most of the year, growth was supported by strong capital inflows, high demand for commodity exports, and strong domestic demand. Towards the end of the year, however, the economic outlook deteriorated, as the Brazilian currency depreciated against the U.S. dollar and commodity prices fell. In Russia, real gross domestic product growth declined to an estimated 6.2% in calendar year 2008 from 8.1% in 2007. Growth was supported by strong household consumption and increased capital investment, particularly in the first half of the year. However, in the fourth quarter, the pace of growth declined sharply, as capital outflows intensified and the Russian currency depreciated against the U.S. dollar. Brazilian and Russian equity prices ended our fiscal year significantly lower.


60


Table of Contents

 
Certain Risk Factors That May Affect Our Businesses
 
We face a variety of risks that are substantial and inherent in our businesses, including market, liquidity, credit, operational, legal and regulatory risks. For a discussion of how management seeks to manage some of these risks, see “— Risk Management” below. A summary of the more important factors that could affect our businesses follows below. For a further discussion of these and other important factors that could affect our businesses, see “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A of our Annual Report on Form 10-K.
 
Market Conditions and Market Risk.  Our financial performance is highly dependent on the environment in which our businesses operate. Overall, during fiscal 2008, the business environment has been extremely adverse for many of our businesses and there can be no assurance that these conditions will improve in the near term.
 
A favorable business environment is generally characterized by, among other factors, high global gross domestic product growth, transparent, liquid and efficient capital markets, low inflation, high business and investor confidence, stable geopolitical conditions and strong business earnings. Unfavorable or uncertain economic and market conditions can be caused by: declines in economic growth, business activity or investor or business confidence; limitations on the availability or increases in the cost of credit and capital; increases in inflation, interest rates, exchange rate volatility, default rates or the price of basic commodities; outbreaks of hostilities or other geopolitical instability; corporate, political or other scandals that reduce investor confidence in capital markets; natural disasters or pandemics; or a combination of these or other factors. Our businesses and profitability have been and may continue to become adversely affected by market conditions in many ways, including the following:
 
  •  Many of our businesses, such as our merchant banking businesses, our mortgages, leveraged loan and credit products businesses in our FICC segment, and our equity principal strategies business, have net “long” positions in debt securities, loans, derivatives, mortgages, equities (including private equity) and most other asset classes. In addition, many of our market-making and other businesses in which we act as a principal to facilitate our clients’ activities, including our specialist businesses, commit large amounts of capital to maintain trading positions in interest rate and credit products, as well as currencies, commodities and equities. Because nearly all of these investing and trading positions are marked-to-market on a daily basis, declines in asset values directly and immediately impact our earnings, unless we have effectively “hedged” our exposures to such declines. In certain circumstances (particularly in the case of leveraged loans and private equities or other securities that are not freely tradable or lack established and liquid trading markets), it may not be possible or economic to hedge such exposures and to the extent that we do so the hedge may be ineffective or may greatly reduce our ability to profit from increases in the values of the assets. Sudden declines and significant volatility in the prices of assets may substantially curtail or eliminate the trading markets for certain assets, which may make it very difficult to sell, hedge or value such assets. The inability to sell or effectively hedge assets reduces our ability to limit losses in such positions and the difficulty in valuing assets may increase our risk-weighted assets which requires us to maintain additional capital and increases our funding costs.
 
  •  Our cost of obtaining long-term unsecured funding is directly related to our credit spreads. Credit spreads are influenced by market perceptions of our creditworthiness. Widening credit spreads, as well as significant declines in the availability of credit, have adversely affected our ability to borrow on a secured and unsecured basis and may continue to do so. We fund ourselves on an unsecured basis by issuing commercial paper, promissory notes and long-term debt, or by obtaining bank loans or lines of credit. We seek to finance many of our assets, including our less liquid assets, on a secured basis, including by entering into repurchase agreements. Disruptions in the credit markets make it harder and more expensive to obtain funding for our businesses. If our available funding is limited or we are forced to fund


61


Table of Contents

  our operations at a higher cost, these conditions may require us to curtail our business activities and increase our cost of funding, both of which could reduce our profitability, particularly in our businesses that involve investing, lending and taking principal positions, including market making.
 
  •  Our investment banking business has been and may continue to be adversely affected by market conditions. Poor economic conditions and other adverse geopolitical conditions can adversely affect and have adversely affected investor and CEO confidence, resulting in significant industry-wide declines in the size and number of underwritings and of financial advisory transactions, which could continue to have an adverse effect on our revenues and our profit margins. In addition, our clients engaging in mergers and acquisitions often rely on access to the secured and unsecured credit markets to finance their transactions. The lack of available credit and the increased cost of credit can adversely affect the size, volume and timing of our clients’ merger and acquisition transactions — particularly large transactions. Because a significant portion of our investment banking revenues are derived from our participation in large transactions, a decline in the number of large transactions would adversely affect our investment banking business.
 
  •  Certain of our trading businesses depend on market volatility to provide trading and arbitrage opportunities, and decreases in volatility may reduce these opportunities and adversely affect the results of these businesses. On the other hand, increased volatility, while it can increase trading volumes and spreads, also increases risk as measured by VaR and may expose us to increased risks in connection with our market-making and proprietary businesses or cause us to reduce the size of these businesses in order to avoid increasing our VaR. Limiting the size of our market-making positions and investing businesses can adversely affect our profitability.
 
  •  We receive asset-based management fees based on the value of our clients’ portfolios or investment in funds managed by us and, in some cases, we also receive incentive fees based on increases in the value of such investments. Declines in asset values reduce the value of our clients’ portfolios or fund assets, which in turn reduce the fees we earn for managing such assets. Market uncertainty, volatility and adverse economic conditions, as well as declines in asset values, may cause our clients to transfer their assets out of our funds or other products or their brokerage accounts or affect our ability to attract new clients or additional assets from existing clients and result in reduced net revenues, principally in our asset management business. To the extent that clients do not withdraw their funds, they may invest them in products that generate less fee income.
 
  •  Concentration of risk increases the potential for significant losses in our market-making, proprietary trading, investing, block trading, merchant banking, underwriting and lending businesses. This risk may increase to the extent we expand our proprietary trading and investing businesses or commit capital to facilitate customer-driven business.
 
  •  Concerns about financial institution profitability and solvency as a result of general market conditions, particularly in the credit markets, together with the forced merger or failure of a number of major commercial and investment banks have at times caused a number of our clients to reduce the level of business that they do with us, either because of concerns about the safety of their assets held by us or simply arising from a desire to diversify their risk or for other reasons. Some clients have withdrawn some of the funds held at our firm or transferred them from deposits with GS Bank USA to other types of assets (in many cases leaving those assets in their brokerage accounts held with us). Some counterparties have at times refused to enter into certain derivatives and other long-term transactions with us or have requested additional collateral. These instances were more prevalent during periods when the lack of confidence in financial institutions was most widespread and have become significantly less frequent in recent months.


62


Table of Contents

 
Liquidity Risk.  Liquidity is essential to our businesses. Our liquidity may be impaired by an inability to access secured and/or unsecured debt markets, an inability to access funds from our subsidiaries, an inability to sell assets or redeem our investments, or unforeseen outflows of cash or collateral. This situation may arise due to circumstances that we may be unable to control, such as a general market disruption or an operational problem that affects third parties or us, or even by the perception among market participants that we, or other market participants, are experiencing greater liquidity risk. The ongoing liquidity crisis and the loss of confidence in financial institutions has increased our cost of funding and limited our access to some of our traditional sources of liquidity, including both secured and unsecured borrowings. In particular, in the latter half of 2008, we were unable to raise significant amounts of long-term unsecured debt in the public markets, other than as a result of the issuance of securities guaranteed by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (FDIC) under the FDIC’s Temporary Liquidity Guarantee Program (TLGP). It is unclear when we will regain access to the public long-term unsecured debt markets on customary terms or whether any similar program will be available after the TLGP’s scheduled June 2009 expiration.
 
The financial instruments that we hold and the contracts to which we are a party are increasingly complex, as we employ structured products to benefit our clients and ourselves, and these complex structured products often do not have readily available markets to access in times of liquidity stress. Our investing activities may lead to situations where the holdings from these activities represent a significant portion of specific markets, which could restrict liquidity for our positions. Further, our ability to sell assets may be impaired if other market participants are seeking to sell similar assets at the same time, as is likely to occur in a liquidity or other market crisis. In addition, financial institutions with which we interact may exercise set-off rights or the right to require additional collateral, including in difficult market conditions, which could further impair our access to liquidity.
 
Our credit ratings are important to our liquidity. A reduction in our credit ratings could adversely affect our liquidity and competitive position, increase our borrowing costs, limit our access to the capital markets or trigger our obligations under certain bilateral provisions in some of our trading and collateralized financing contracts. Under these provisions, counterparties could be permitted to terminate contracts with Goldman Sachs or require us to post additional collateral. Termination of our trading and collateralized financing contracts could cause us to sustain losses and impair our liquidity by requiring us to find other sources of financing or to make significant cash payments or securities movements. For a discussion of downgrades to our ratings that occurred in December 2008 and of the potential impact on Goldman Sachs of a further reduction in our credit ratings, see “— Liquidity and Funding Risk — Credit Ratings” below.
 
Group Inc. has guaranteed the payment obligations of Goldman, Sachs & Co. (GS&Co.), Goldman Sachs Bank USA (GS Bank USA) and Goldman Sachs Bank (Europe) PLC (GS Bank Europe), subject to certain exceptions, and has pledged significant assets to GS Bank USA to support its obligations to GS Bank USA. These guarantees may require Group Inc. to provide substantial funds or assets to its subsidiaries or their creditors or counterparties at a time when Group Inc. is in need of liquidity to fund its own obligations.


63


Table of Contents

Credit Risk.  The amount and duration of our credit exposures have been increasing over the past several years, as have the breadth and size of the entities to which we have credit exposures. We are exposed to the risk that third parties that owe us money, securities or other assets will not perform their obligations. These parties may default on their obligations to us due to bankruptcy, lack of liquidity, operational failure or other reasons. A failure of a significant market participant, or even concerns about a default by such an institution, could lead to significant liquidity problems, losses or defaults by other institutions, which in turn could adversely affect us. We are also subject to the risk that our rights against third parties may not be enforceable in all circumstances. In addition, deterioration in the credit quality of third parties whose securities or obligations we hold could result in losses and/or adversely affect our ability to rehypothecate or otherwise use those securities or obligations for liquidity purposes. A significant downgrade in the credit ratings of our counterparties could also have a negative impact on our results. While in many cases we are permitted to require additional collateral for counterparties that experience financial difficulty, disputes may arise as to the amount of collateral we are entitled to receive and the value of pledged assets. Default rates, downgrades and disputes with counterparties as to the valuation of collateral increase significantly in times of market stress and illiquidity.
 
As part of our clearing business, we finance our client positions, and we could be held responsible for the defaults or misconduct of our clients. Although we regularly review credit exposures to specific clients and counterparties and to specific industries, countries and regions that we believe may present credit concerns, default risk may arise from events or circumstances that are difficult to detect or foresee, particularly as new business initiatives lead us to transact with a broader array of clients and counterparties and expose us to new asset classes and new markets.
 
We have experienced, due to competitive factors, pressure to extend and price credit at levels that may not always fully compensate us for the risks we take. In particular, corporate clients sometimes seek to require credit commitments from us in connection with investment banking and other assignments.
 
Operational Risk.  Our businesses are highly dependent on our ability to process and monitor, on a daily basis, a very large number of transactions, many of which are highly complex, across numerous and diverse markets in many currencies. These transactions, as well as the information technology services we provide to clients, often must adhere to client-specific guidelines, as well as legal and regulatory standards. Despite the resiliency plans and facilities we have in place, our ability to conduct business may be adversely impacted by a disruption in the infrastructure that supports our businesses and the communities in which we are located. This may include a disruption involving electrical, communications, internet, transportation or other services used by us or third parties with which we conduct business.
 
Industry consolidation, whether among market participants or financial intermediaries, increases the risk of operational failure as disparate complex systems need to be integrated, often on an accelerated basis. Furthermore, the interconnectivity of multiple financial institutions with central agents, exchanges and clearing houses increases the risk that an operational failure at one institution may cause an industry-wide operational failure that could materially impact our ability to conduct business.


64


Table of Contents

Legal and Regulatory Risk.  We are subject to extensive and evolving regulation in jurisdictions around the world. Several of our subsidiaries are subject to regulatory capital requirements and, as a bank holding company, we are subject to minimum capital standards and a minimum Tier 1 leverage ratio on a consolidated basis. Firms in the financial services industry have been operating in a difficult regulatory environment. Recent market disruptions have led to numerous proposals for significant additional regulation of the financial services industry. These regulations could limit our business activities, increase compliance costs and, to the extent the regulations strictly control the activities of financial services firms, make it more difficult for us to distinguish ourselves from competitors. Substantial legal liability or a significant regulatory action against us could have material adverse financial effects or cause significant reputational harm to us, which in turn could seriously harm our business prospects. As a bank holding company, we will be subject to capital requirements based on Basel I as opposed to the requirements based on Basel II that applied to us as a CSE. Complying with these requirements may require us to liquidate assets or raise capital in a manner that adversely increases our funding costs or otherwise adversely affects our shareholders and creditors. In addition, failure to meet minimum capital requirements can initiate certain mandatory and possibly additional discretionary actions by regulators that, if undertaken, could have a direct material adverse effect on our financial condition. Our status as a bank holding company and the operation of our lending and other businesses through GS Bank USA subject us to additional regulation and limitations on our activities, as described in “Regulation — Banking Regulation” in Part I, Item 1 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K, as well as some regulatory uncertainty as we apply banking regulations and practices to many of our businesses. The application of these regulations and practices may present us and our regulators with new or novel issues. We face significant legal risks in our businesses, and the volume of claims and amount of damages and penalties claimed in litigation and regulatory proceedings against financial institutions remain high. Our experience has been that legal claims by customers and clients increase in a market downturn. In addition, employment-related claims typically increase in periods when we have reduced the total number of employees. For a discussion of how we account for our legal and regulatory exposures, see “— Use of Estimates” below.


65


Table of Contents

 
Critical Accounting Policies
 
Fair Value
 
The use of fair value to measure financial instruments, with related unrealized gains or losses generally recognized in “Trading and principal investments” in our consolidated statements of earnings, is fundamental to our financial statements and our risk management processes and is our most critical accounting policy. The fair value of a financial instrument is the amount that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date (the exit price). Financial assets are marked to bid prices and financial liabilities are marked to offer prices.
 
During the fourth quarter of 2008, both the Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB) and the staff of the SEC re-emphasized the importance of sound fair value measurement in financial reporting. In October 2008, the FASB issued FASB Staff Position No. FAS 157-3, “Determining the Fair Value of a Financial Asset When the Market for That Asset is Not Active.” This statement clarifies that determining fair value in an inactive or dislocated market depends on facts and circumstances and requires significant management judgment. This statement specifies that it is acceptable to use inputs based on management estimates or assumptions, or for management to make adjustments to observable inputs to determine fair value when markets are not active and relevant observable inputs are not available. Our fair value measurement policies are consistent with the guidance in FSP No. FAS 157-3.
 
Substantially all trading assets and trading liabilities are reflected in our consolidated statements of financial condition at fair value, pursuant principally to:
 
  •  Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (SFAS) No. 115, “Accounting for Certain Investments in Debt and Equity Securities;”
 
  •  specialized industry accounting for broker-dealers and investment companies;
 
  •  SFAS No. 133, “Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities;” or
 
  •  the fair value option under either SFAS No. 155, “Accounting for Certain Hybrid Financial Instruments — an amendment of FASB Statements No. 133 and 140,” or SFAS No. 159, “The Fair Value Option for Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities” (i.e., the fair value option).
 
Upon becoming a bank holding company in September 2008, we could no longer apply specialized broker-dealer industry accounting to those subsidiaries not regulated as broker-dealers. Therefore, within our non-broker-dealer subsidiaries, we designated as held for trading those instruments within the scope of SFAS No. 115 (i.e., debt securities and marketable equity securities), and elected the fair value option for other cash instruments (specifically loans, loan commitments and certain private equity and restricted public equity securities) which we historically had carried at fair value. These fair value elections were in addition to previous elections made for certain corporate loans, loan commitments and certificates of deposit issued by GS Bank USA. There was no impact on earnings from these initial elections because all of these instruments were already recorded at fair value in “Trading assets, at fair value” or “Trading liabilities, at fair value” in the consolidated statements of financial condition prior to Group Inc. becoming a bank holding company.


66


Table of Contents

In determining fair value, we separate our “Trading assets, at fair value” and “Trading liabilities, at fair value” into two categories: cash instruments and derivative contracts, as set forth in the following table:
 
Trading Instruments by Category
(in millions)
 
                                 
    As of November
    2008   2007
    Trading
  Trading
  Trading
  Trading
    Assets, at
  Liabilities, at
  Assets, at
  Liabilities, at
   
Fair Value
 
Fair Value
 
Fair Value
 
Fair Value
Cash trading instruments
  $ 186,231     $ 57,143     $ 324,181     $ 112,018  
ICBC
    5,496  (1)           6,807  (1)      
SMFG
    1,135       1,134  (4)     4,060       3,627  (4)
Other principal investments
    15,126  (2)           11,933  (2)      
                                 
Principal investments
    21,757       1,134       22,800       3,627  
                                 
Cash instruments
    207,988       58,277       346,981       115,645  
Exchange-traded
    6,164       8,347       13,541       12,280  
Over-the-counter
    124,173       109,348       92,073       87,098  
                                 
Derivative contracts
    130,337  (3)     117,695  (5)     105,614  (3)     99,378  (5)
                                 
Total
  $ 338,325     $ 175,972     $ 452,595     $ 215,023  
                                 
 
 
(1) Includes interests of $3.48 billion and $4.30 billion as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively, held by investment funds managed by Goldman Sachs. The fair value of our investment in the ordinary shares of ICBC, which trade on The Stock Exchange of Hong Kong, includes the effect of foreign exchange revaluation for which we maintain an economic currency hedge.
 
(2) The following table sets forth the principal investments (in addition to our investments in ICBC and Sumitomo Mitsui Financial Group, Inc. (SMFG)) included within the Principal Investments component of our Trading and Principal Investments segment:
 
                                                 
    As of November
    2008   2007
   
Corporate
 
Real Estate
 
Total
 
Corporate
 
Real Estate
 
Total
    (in millions)
 
Private
  $ 10,726     $ 2,935     $ 13,661     $ 7,297     $ 2,361     $ 9,658  
Public
    1,436       29       1,465       2,208       67       2,275  
                                                 
Total
  $ 12,162     $ 2,964     $ 15,126     $ 9,505     $ 2,428     $ 11,933  
                                                 
 
(3) Net of cash received pursuant to credit support agreements of $137.16 billion and $59.05 billion as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively.
 
(4) Represents an economic hedge on the shares of common stock underlying our investment in the convertible preferred stock of SMFG.
 
(5) Net of cash paid pursuant to credit support agreements of $34.01 billion and $27.76 billion as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively.


67


Table of Contents

Cash Instruments.  Cash instruments include cash trading instruments, public principal investments and private principal investments.
 
  •  Cash Trading Instruments.  Our cash trading instruments are generally valued using quoted market prices, broker or dealer quotations, or alternative pricing sources with reasonable levels of price transparency. The types of instruments valued based on quoted market prices in active markets include most U.S. government and sovereign obligations, active listed equities and certain money market securities.
 
The types of instruments that trade in markets that are not considered to be active, but are valued based on quoted market prices, broker or dealer quotations, or alternative pricing sources with reasonable levels of price transparency include most government agency securities, investment-grade corporate bonds, certain mortgage products, certain bank loans and bridge loans, less liquid listed equities, state, municipal and provincial obligations and certain money market securities and loan commitments.
 
Certain cash trading instruments trade infrequently and therefore have little or no price transparency. Such instruments include private equity and real estate fund investments, certain bank loans and bridge loans (including certain mezzanine financing, leveraged loans arising from capital market transactions and other corporate bank debt), less liquid corporate debt securities and other debt obligations (including less liquid high-yield corporate bonds, distressed debt instruments and collateralized debt obligations (CDOs) backed by corporate obligations), less liquid mortgage whole loans and securities (backed by either commercial or residential real estate), and acquired portfolios of distressed loans. The transaction price is initially used as the best estimate of fair value. Accordingly, when a pricing model is used to value such an instrument, the model is adjusted so that the model value at inception equals the transaction price. This valuation is adjusted only when changes to inputs and assumptions are corroborated by evidence such as transactions in similar instruments, completed or pending third-party transactions in the underlying investment or comparable entities, subsequent rounds of financing, recapitalizations and other transactions across the capital structure, offerings in the equity or debt capital markets, and changes in financial ratios or cash flows.
 
For positions that are not traded in active markets or are subject to transfer restrictions, valuations are adjusted to reflect illiquidity and/or non-transferability. Such adjustments are generally based on available market evidence. In the absence of such evidence, management’s best estimate is used.
 
  •  Public Principal Investments.  Our public principal investments held within the Principal Investments component of our Trading and Principal Investments segment tend to be large, concentrated holdings resulting from initial public offerings or other corporate transactions, and are valued based on quoted market prices. For positions that are not traded in active markets or are subject to transfer restrictions, valuations are adjusted to reflect illiquidity and/or non-transferability. Such adjustments are generally based on available market evidence. In the absence of such evidence, management’s best estimate is used.
 
Our most significant public principal investment is our investment in the ordinary shares of ICBC. Our investment in ICBC is valued using the quoted market price adjusted for transfer restrictions. The ordinary shares acquired from ICBC are subject to transfer restrictions that, among other things, prohibit any sale, disposition or other transfer until April 28, 2009. From April 28, 2009 to October 20, 2009, we may transfer up to 50% of the aggregate ordinary shares of ICBC that we owned as of October 20, 2006. We may transfer the remaining shares after October 20, 2009. A portion of our interest is held by investment funds managed by Goldman Sachs.


68


Table of Contents

We also have an investment in the convertible preferred stock of SMFG. This investment is valued using a model that is principally based on SMFG’s common stock price. During our second quarter of 2008, we converted one-third of our SMFG preferred stock investment into SMFG common stock, and delivered the common stock to close out one-third of our hedge position. As of November 2008, we remained hedged on the common stock underlying our remaining investment in SMFG.
 
  •  Private Principal Investments.  Our private principal investments held within the Principal Investments component of our Trading and Principal Investments segment include investments in private equity, debt and real estate, primarily held through investment funds. By their nature, these investments have little or no price transparency. We value such instruments initially at transaction price and adjust valuations when evidence is available to support such adjustments. Such evidence includes transactions in similar instruments, completed or pending third-party transactions in the underlying investment or comparable entities, subsequent rounds of financing, recapitalizations and other transactions across the capital structure, offerings in the equity or debt capital markets, and changes in financial ratios or cash flows.
 
Derivative Contracts.  Derivative contracts can be exchange-traded or over-the-counter (OTC). We generally value exchange-traded derivatives using models which calibrate to market-clearing levels and eliminate timing differences between the closing price of the exchange-traded derivatives and their underlying instruments.
 
OTC derivatives are valued using market transactions and other market evidence whenever possible, including market-based inputs to models, model calibration to market-clearing transactions, broker or dealer quotations, or alternative pricing sources with reasonable levels of price transparency. Where models are used, the selection of a particular model to value an OTC derivative depends upon the contractual terms of, and specific risks inherent in, the instrument as well as the availability of pricing information in the market. We generally use similar models to value similar instruments. Valuation models require a variety of inputs, including contractual terms, market prices, yield curves, credit curves, measures of volatility, prepayment rates and correlations of such inputs. For OTC derivatives that trade in liquid markets, such as generic forwards, swaps and options, model inputs can generally be verified and model selection does not involve significant management judgment.
 
Certain OTC derivatives trade in less liquid markets with limited pricing information, and the determination of fair value for these derivatives is inherently more difficult. Where we do not have corroborating market evidence to support significant model inputs and cannot verify the model to market transactions, the transaction price is initially used as the best estimate of fair value. Accordingly, when a pricing model is used to value such an instrument, the model is adjusted so that the model value at inception equals the transaction price. Subsequent to initial recognition, we only update valuation inputs when corroborated by evidence such as similar market transactions, third-party pricing services and/or broker or dealer quotations, or other empirical market data. In circumstances where we cannot verify the model value to market transactions, it is possible that a different valuation model could produce a materially different estimate of fair value. See “— Derivatives” below for further information on our OTC derivatives.
 
When appropriate, valuations are adjusted for various factors such as liquidity, bid/offer spreads and credit considerations. Such adjustments are generally based on available market evidence. In the absence of such evidence, management’s best estimate is used.
 
Controls Over Valuation of Financial Instruments.  A control infrastructure, independent of the trading and investing functions, is fundamental to ensuring that our financial instruments are appropriately valued at market-clearing levels (exit price) and that fair value measurements are reliable and consistently determined.


69


Table of Contents

We employ an oversight structure that includes appropriate segregation of duties. Senior management, independent of the trading and investing functions, is responsible for the oversight of control and valuation policies and for reporting the results of these policies to our Audit Committee. We seek to maintain the necessary resources to ensure that control functions are performed appropriately. We employ procedures for the approval of new transaction types and markets, price verification, review of daily profit and loss, and review of valuation models by personnel with appropriate technical knowledge of relevant products and markets. These procedures are performed by personnel independent of the trading and investing functions. For financial instruments where prices or valuations that require inputs are less observable, we employ, where possible, procedures that include comparisons with similar observable positions, analysis of actual to projected cash flows, comparisons with subsequent sales, reviews of valuations used for collateral management purposes and discussions with senior business leaders. See “— Market Risk” and “— Credit Risk” below for a further discussion of how we manage the risks inherent in our trading and principal investing businesses.
 
Fair Value Hierarchy — Level 3.  SFAS No. 157 establishes a fair value hierarchy that prioritizes the inputs to valuation techniques used to measure fair value. The objective of a fair value measurement is to determine the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date (the exit price). The hierarchy gives the highest priority to unadjusted quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities (level 1 measurements) and the lowest priority to unobservable inputs (level 3 measurements). Assets and liabilities are classified in their entirety based on the lowest level of input that is significant to the fair value measurement.
 
Instruments that trade infrequently and therefore have little or no price transparency are classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy. We determine which instruments are classified within level 3 based on the results of our price verification process. This process is performed by personnel independent of our trading and investing functions who corroborate valuations to external market data (e.g., quoted market prices, broker or dealer quotations, third-party pricing vendors, recent trading activity and comparative analyses to similar instruments). When broker or dealer quotations or third-party pricing vendors are used for valuation or price verification, greater priority is given to executable quotes. As part of our price verification process, valuations based on quotes are corroborated by comparison both to other quotes and to recent trading activity in the same or similar instruments. The number of quotes obtained varies by instrument and depends on the liquidity of the particular instrument. See Notes 2 and 3 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for further information regarding SFAS No. 157.
 
Recent market conditions, particularly in the fourth quarter of 2008 (characterized by dislocations between asset classes, elevated levels of volatility, and reduced price transparency), have increased the level of management judgment required to value cash trading instruments classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy. In particular, management’s judgment is required to determine the appropriate risk-adjusted discount rate for cash trading instruments with little or no price transparency as a result of decreased volumes and lower levels of trading activity. In such situations, our valuation is adjusted to approximate rates which market participants would likely consider appropriate for relevant credit and liquidity risks.
 
Valuation Methodologies for Level 3 Assets.  Instruments classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy are initially valued at transaction price, which is considered to be the best initial estimate of fair value. As time passes, transaction price becomes less reliable as an estimate of fair value and accordingly, we use other methodologies to determine fair value, which vary based on the type of instrument, as described below. Regardless of the methodology, valuation inputs and assumptions are only changed when corroborated by substantive evidence. Senior management in control functions, independent of the trading and investing functions, reviews all significant unrealized gains/losses, including the primary drivers of the change in value. Valuations are further corroborated by values realized upon


70


Table of Contents

sales of our level 3 assets. An overview of methodologies used to value our level 3 assets subsequent to the transaction date is as follows:
 
  •  Private equity and real estate fund investments.  Investments are generally held at cost for the first year. Recent third-party investments or pending transactions are considered to be the best evidence for any change in fair value. In the absence of such evidence, valuations are based on third-party independent appraisals, transactions in similar instruments, discounted cash flow techniques, valuation multiples and public comparables. Such evidence includes pending reorganizations (e.g., merger proposals, tender offers or debt restructurings); and significant changes in financial metrics (e.g., operating results as compared to previous projections, industry multiples, credit ratings and balance sheet ratios).
 
  •  Bank loans and bridge loans and Corporate debt securities and other debt obligations. Valuations are generally based on discounted cash flow techniques, for which the key inputs are the amount and timing of expected future cash flows, market yields for such instruments and recovery assumptions. Inputs are generally determined based on relative value analyses, which incorporate comparisons both to credit default swaps that reference the same underlying credit risk and to other debt instruments for the same issuer for which observable prices or broker quotes are available.
 
  •  Loans and securities backed by commercial real estate. Loans and securities backed by commercial real estate are collateralized by specific assets and are generally tranched into varying levels of subordination. Due to the nature of these instruments, valuation techniques vary by instrument. Methodologies include relative value analyses across different tranches, comparisons to transactions in both the underlying collateral and instruments with the same or substantially the same underlying collateral, market indices (such as the CMBX (1)), and credit default swaps, as well as discounted cash flow techniques.
 
  •  Loans and securities backed by residential real estate. Valuations are based on both proprietary and industry recognized models (including Intex and Bloomberg), discounted cash flow techniques and hypothetical securitization analyses. In the recent market environment, the most significant inputs to the valuation of these instruments are rates of delinquency, default and loss expectations, which are driven in part by housing prices. Inputs are determined based on relative value analyses, which incorporate comparisons to instruments with similar collateral and risk profiles, including relevant indices such as the ABX (1).
 
  •  Loan portfolios.  Valuations are based on discounted cash flow techniques, for which the key inputs are the amount and timing of expected future cash flows and market yields for such instruments. Inputs are determined based on relative value analyses which incorporate comparisons to recent auction data for other similar loan portfolios.
 
  •  Derivative contracts.  Valuation models are calibrated to initial transaction price. Subsequent changes in valuations are based on observable inputs to the valuation models (e.g., interest rates, credit spreads, volatilities, etc.). Inputs are changed only when corroborated by market data. Valuations of less liquid OTC derivatives are typically based on level 1 or level 2 inputs that can be observed in the market, as well as unobservable inputs, such as correlations and volatilities.
 
Total level 3 assets were $66.19 billion and $69.15 billion as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively. The decrease in level 3 assets for the year ended November 2008 primarily reflected (i) unrealized losses on loans and securities backed by commercial real estate, bank loans and bridge loans, and private equity and real estate fund investments, and (ii) sales and paydowns on bank loans and bridge loans and loan portfolios. These decreases were partially offset by transfers to level 3 of certain loans and securities backed by commercial real estate due to reduced price transparency.
 
 
 
 
(1) The CMBX and ABX are indices that track the performance of commercial mortgage bonds and subprime residential mortgage bonds, respectively.


71


Table of Contents

The following table sets forth the fair values of financial assets classified as level 3 within the fair value hierarchy:
 
Level 3 Financial Assets at Fair Value
(in millions)
 
                 
    As of November
Description
  2008   2007
Private equity and real estate fund investments (1)
  $ 16,006     $ 18,006  
Bank loans and bridge loans (2)
    11,957       13,334  
Corporate debt securities and other debt obligations (3)
    7,596       6,111  
Mortgage and other asset-backed loans and securities
               
Loans and securities backed by commercial real estate
    9,340       7,410  
Loans and securities backed by residential real estate
    2,049       2,484  
Loan portfolios (4)
    4,118       6,106  
                 
Cash instruments
    51,066       53,451  
Derivative contracts
    15,124       15,700  
                 
Total level 3 assets at fair value
    66,190       69,151  
Level 3 assets for which we do not bear economic exposure (5)
    (6,616 )     (14,437 )
                 
Level 3 assets for which we bear economic exposure
  $ 59,574     $ 54,714  
                 
 
 
  (1)  Includes $1.18 billion and $7.06 billion as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively, of assets for which we do not bear economic exposure. Also includes $2.62 billion and $2.02 billion as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively, of real estate fund investments.
 
  (2)  Includes mezzanine financing, leveraged loans arising from capital market transactions and other corporate bank debt.
 
  (3)  Includes $804 million and $2.49 billion as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively, of CDOs backed by corporate obligations.
 
  (4)  Consists of acquired portfolios of distressed loans, primarily backed by commercial and residential real estate collateral.
 
  (5)  We do not bear economic exposure to these level 3 assets as they are financed by nonrecourse debt, attributable to minority investors or attributable to employee interests in certain consolidated funds.

72


Table of Contents

Loans and securities backed by residential real estate.  We securitize, underwrite and make markets in various types of residential mortgages, including prime, Alt-A and subprime. At any point in time, we may use cash instruments as well as derivatives to manage our long or short risk position in residential real estate. The following table sets forth the fair value of our long positions in prime, Alt-A and subprime mortgage cash instruments:
 
Long Positions in Loans and Securities Backed by Residential Real Estate
(in millions)
 
                 
    As of November
    2008   2007
Prime (1)
  $ 1,494     $ 7,135  
Alt-A
    1,845       6,358  
Subprime (2)
    1,906       2,109  
                 
Total (3)
  $ 5,245     $ 15,602  
                 
 
 
  (1)  Excludes U.S. government agency-issued collateralized mortgage obligations of $4.27 billion and $7.24 billion as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively. Also excludes U.S. government agency-issued mortgage-pass through certificates.
 
  (2)  Includes $228 million and $316 million of CDOs backed by subprime mortgages as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively.
 
  (3)  Includes $2.05 billion and $2.48 billion of financial instruments (primarily loans and investment-grade securities, the majority of which were issued during 2006 and 2007) classified as level 3 under the fair value hierarchy as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively.
 
 
Loans and securities backed by commercial real estate.  We originate, securitize and syndicate fixed and floating rate commercial mortgages globally. At any point in time, we may use cash instruments as well as derivatives to manage our risk position in the commercial mortgage market. The following table sets forth the fair value of our long positions in loans and securities backed by commercial real estate by geographic region. The decrease in loans and securities backed by commercial real estate from November 2007 to November 2008 was primarily due to dispositions.
 
Long Positions in Loans and Securities Backed by
Commercial Real Estate by Geographic Region
(in millions)
 
                 
    As of November
    2008   2007
Americas (1)
  $ 7,433     $ 12,361  
EMEA (2)
    3,304       6,607  
Asia
    157       52  
                 
Total (3)
  $ 10,894  (4)   $ 19,020  (5)
                 
 
 
  (1)  Substantially all relates to the U.S.
 
  (2)  EMEA (Europe, Middle East and Africa).
 
  (3)  Includes $9.34 billion and $7.41 billion of financial instruments classified as level 3 under the fair value hierarchy as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively.
 
  (4)  Comprised of loans of $9.23 billion and commercial mortgage-backed securities of $1.66 billion as of November 2008, of which $9.78 billion was floating rate and $1.11 billion was fixed rate.
 
  (5)  Comprised of loans of $16.27 billion and commercial mortgage-backed securities of $2.75 billion as of November 2007, of which $16.52 billion was floating rate and $2.50 billion was fixed rate.


73


Table of Contents

 
Other Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities at Fair Value.  In addition to “Trading assets, at fair value” and “Trading liabilities, at fair value,” we have elected to account for certain of our other financial assets and financial liabilities at fair value under the fair value option. The primary reasons for electing the fair value option are to reflect economic events in earnings on a timely basis, to mitigate volatility in earnings from using different measurement attributes and to address simplification and cost-benefit considerations.
 
Such financial assets and financial liabilities accounted for at fair value include:
 
  •  certain unsecured short-term borrowings, consisting of all promissory notes and commercial paper and certain hybrid financial instruments;
 
  •  certain other secured financings, primarily transfers accounted for as financings rather than sales under SFAS No. 140, debt raised through our William Street program and certain other nonrecourse financings;
 
  •  certain unsecured long-term borrowings, including prepaid physical commodity transactions;
 
  •  resale and repurchase agreements;
 
  •  securities borrowed and loaned within Trading and Principal Investments, consisting of our matched book and certain firm financing activities;
 
  •  certain corporate loans, loan commitments and certificates of deposit issued by GS Bank USA as well as securities held by GS Bank USA;
 
  •  receivables from customers and counterparties arising from transfers accounted for as secured loans rather than purchases under SFAS No. 140;
 
  •  certain insurance and reinsurance contracts; and
 
  •  in general, investments acquired after the adoption of SFAS No. 159 where we have significant influence over the investee and would otherwise apply the equity method of accounting. In certain cases, we may apply the equity method of accounting to new investments that are strategic in nature or closely related to our principal business activities, where we have a significant degree of involvement in the cash flows or operations of the investee, or where cost-benefit considerations are less significant.
 
Goodwill and Identifiable Intangible Assets
 
As a result of our acquisitions, principally SLK LLC (SLK) in 2000, The Ayco Company, L.P. (Ayco) in 2003 and our variable annuity and life insurance business in 2006, we have acquired goodwill and identifiable intangible assets. Goodwill is the cost of acquired companies in excess of the fair value of net assets, including identifiable intangible assets, at the acquisition date.
 
Goodwill.  We test the goodwill in each of our operating segments, which are components one level below our three business segments, for impairment at least annually in accordance with SFAS No. 142, “Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets,” by comparing the estimated fair value of each operating segment with its estimated net book value. We derive the fair value of each of our operating segments based on valuation techniques we believe market participants would use for each segment (observable average price-to-earnings multiples of our competitors in these businesses and price-to-book multiples). We derive the net book value of our operating segments by estimating the amount of shareholders’ equity required to support the activities of each operating segment. Our last annual impairment test was performed during our 2008 fourth quarter and no impairment was identified. Substantially all of our goodwill is in our Equities component of our Trading and Principal Investments segment and in our Asset Management and Securities Services segment. Our Asset Management and Securities Services segment generated record net revenues in 2008 and our Equities component of our Trading and Principal Investments segment had its second best year following its record net revenues in 2007.


74


Table of Contents

During 2008, particularly during the fourth quarter, the financial services industry and the securities markets generally were materially and adversely affected by significant declines in the values of nearly all asset classes and by a serious lack of liquidity. Our stock price, consistent with stock prices in the broader financial services sector, declined significantly during this period of time. During the fourth quarter of 2008, our market capitalization fell below recorded book value, principally during the last five weeks of the quarter. With respect to the testing of our goodwill for impairment, we believe that it is reasonable to consider market capitalization as an indicator of fair value over a reasonable period of time. If the current economic market conditions persist and if there is a prolonged period of weakness in the business environment and financial markets, our businesses may be adversely affected, which could result in an impairment of goodwill in the future.
 
The following table sets forth the carrying value of our goodwill by operating segment:
 
Goodwill by Operating Segment
(in millions)
 
                 
    As of November
    2008   2007
Investment Banking
               
Underwriting
  $ 125     $ 125  
Trading and Principal Investments
               
FICC
    247       123  
Equities (1)
    2,389       2,381  
Principal Investments
    80       11  
Asset Management and Securities Services
               
Asset Management (2)
    565       564  
Securities Services
    117       117  
                 
Total
  $ 3,523     $ 3,321  
                 
 
 
(1) Primarily related to SLK.
 
(2) Primarily related to Ayco.
 
 
Identifiable Intangible Assets.  We amortize our identifiable intangible assets over their estimated lives in accordance with SFAS No. 142 or, in the case of insurance contracts, in accordance with SFAS No. 60, “Accounting and Reporting by Insurance Enterprises,” and SFAS No. 97, “Accounting and Reporting by Insurance Enterprises for Certain Long-Duration Contracts and for Realized Gains and Losses from the Sale of Investments.” Identifiable intangible assets are tested for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances suggest that an asset’s or asset group’s carrying value may not be fully recoverable in accordance with SFAS No. 144, “Accounting for the Impairment or Disposal of Long-Lived Assets,” or SFAS No. 60 and SFAS No. 97. An impairment loss, generally calculated as the difference between the estimated fair value and the carrying value of an asset or asset group, is recognized if the sum of the estimated undiscounted cash flows relating to the asset or asset group is less than the corresponding carrying value.


75


Table of Contents

The following table sets forth the carrying value and range of remaining lives of our identifiable intangible assets by major asset class:
 
Identifiable Intangible Assets by Asset Class
($ in millions)
 
                         
    As of November
    2008   2007
        Range of Estimated
   
    Carrying
  Remaining Lives
  Carrying
   
Value
 
(in years)
 
Value
Customer lists (1)
  $ 724       2 - 17     $ 732  
New York Stock Exchange (NYSE) Designated Market Maker (DMM) rights
    462       13       502  
Insurance-related assets (2)
    303       7       372  
Exchange-traded fund (ETF) lead market maker rights
    95       19       100  
Other (3)
    93       1 - 17       65  
                         
Total
  $ 1,677             $ 1,771  
                         
 
 
(1) Primarily includes our clearance and execution and NASDAQ customer lists related to SLK and financial counseling customer lists related to Ayco.
 
(2) Consists of the value of business acquired (VOBA) and deferred acquisition costs (DAC). VOBA represents the present value of estimated future gross profits of acquired variable annuity and life insurance businesses. DAC results from commissions paid by Goldman Sachs to the primary insurer (ceding company) on life and annuity reinsurance agreements as compensation to place the business with us and to cover the ceding company’s acquisition expenses. VOBA and DAC are amortized over the estimated life of the underlying contracts based on estimated gross profits, and amortization is adjusted based on actual experience. The seven-year estimated life represents the weighted average remaining amortization period of the underlying contracts (certain of which extend for approximately 30 years).
 
(3) Primarily includes marketing-related assets and power contracts.
 
 
A prolonged period of weakness in global equity markets and the trading of securities in multiple markets and on multiple exchanges could adversely impact our businesses and impair the value of our identifiable intangible assets. In addition, certain events could indicate a potential impairment of our identifiable intangible assets, including (i) changes in market structure that could adversely affect our specialist businesses (see discussion below), (ii) an adverse action or assessment by a regulator, or (iii) adverse actual experience on the contracts in our variable annuity and life insurance business.
 
In October 2008, the SEC approved the NYSE’s proposal to create a new market model and redefine the role of NYSE DMMs. This new rule set further aligns the NYSE’s model with investor requirements for speed and efficiency of execution and establishes specialists as DMMs. While DMMs still have an obligation to commit capital, they are now able to trade on parity with other market participants. In addition, in November 2008 the NYSE introduced a reserve order type that allows for anonymous trade execution, which is expected to allow the NYSE to recapture liquidity and market share from other venues in which anonymous reserve orders have been available for some time. The new rule set and the launch of the reserve order type, in combination with technology improvements to increase execution speed, are expected to bolster the NYSE’s competitive position.


76


Table of Contents

In 2007, we tested our NYSE DMM rights for impairment in accordance with SFAS No. 144, “Accounting for the Impairment or Disposal of Long-Lived Assets.” Under SFAS No. 144, an impairment loss is recognized if the carrying amount of our NYSE DMM rights exceeds the projected undiscounted cash flows of the business over the estimated remaining life of our NYSE DMM rights. Projected undiscounted cash flows exceeded the carrying amount of our NYSE DMM rights, and accordingly we did not record an impairment loss. In projecting the undiscounted cash flows of the business, we made several important assumptions about the potential beneficial effects of the rule and market structure changes described above. Specifically, we assumed that:
 
  •  total equity trading volumes in NYSE-listed companies will continue to grow at a rate consistent with recent historical trends;
 
  •  the NYSE will be able to recapture approximately one-half of the market share that it lost in 2007; and
 
  •  we will increase our market share of the NYSE DMM business and, as a DMM, the profitability of each share traded.
 
We also assumed that the rule changes would be implemented in our fiscal fourth quarter of 2008 (as noted above, such rule changes were approved in October 2008) and that projected cash flow increases related to the implementation of the rule set would begin in 2009, consistent with the assumptions above. Subsequently, there have been no events or changes in circumstances indicating that NYSE DMM rights intangible asset may not be recoverable. However, there can be no assurance that the assumptions, rule or structure changes described above will result in sufficient cash flows to avoid impairment of our NYSE DMM rights in the future. We will continue to evaluate the performance of the specialist business under the new market model. As of November 2008, the carrying value of our NYSE DMM rights was $462 million. To the extent that there were to be an impairment in the future, it could result in a significant writedown in the carrying value of these DMM rights.
 
Use of Estimates
 
The use of generally accepted accounting principles requires management to make certain estimates and assumptions. In addition to the estimates we make in connection with fair value measurements and the accounting for goodwill and identifiable intangible assets, the use of estimates and assumptions is also important in determining provisions for potential losses that may arise from litigation and regulatory proceedings and tax audits.
 
We estimate and provide for potential losses that may arise out of litigation and regulatory proceedings to the extent that such losses are probable and can be estimated, in accordance with SFAS No. 5, “Accounting for Contingencies.” We estimate and provide for potential liabilities that may arise out of tax audits to the extent that uncertain tax positions fail to meet the recognition standard of FIN 48, “Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes — an Interpretation of FASB Statement No. 109.” See Note 16 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for further information on FIN 48.
 
Significant judgment is required in making these estimates and our final liabilities may ultimately be materially different. Our total estimated liability in respect of litigation and regulatory proceedings is determined on a case-by-case basis and represents an estimate of probable losses after considering, among other factors, the progress of each case or proceeding, our experience and the experience of others in similar cases or proceedings, and the opinions and views of legal counsel. Given the inherent difficulty of predicting the outcome of our litigation and regulatory matters, particularly in cases or proceedings in which substantial or indeterminate damages or fines are sought, we cannot estimate losses or ranges of losses for cases or proceedings where there is only a reasonable possibility that a loss may be incurred. See “— Legal Proceedings” in Part I, Item 3 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for information on our judicial, regulatory and arbitration proceedings.


77


Table of Contents

 
Results of Operations
 
The composition of our net revenues has varied over time as financial markets and the scope of our operations have changed. The composition of net revenues can also vary over the shorter term due to fluctuations in U.S. and global economic and market conditions. See “— Certain Risk Factors That May Affect Our Businesses” above and “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for a further discussion of the impact of economic and market conditions on our results of operations.
 
Financial Overview
 
The following table sets forth an overview of our financial results:
 
Financial Overview
($ in millions, except per share amounts)
 
                         
    Year Ended November
    2008   2007   2006
Net revenues
  $ 22,222     $ 45,987     $ 37,665  
Pre-tax earnings
    2,336       17,604       14,560  
Net earnings
    2,322       11,599       9,537  
Net earnings applicable to common shareholders
    2,041       11,407       9,398  
Diluted earnings per common share
    4.47       24.73       19.69  
Return on average common shareholders’ equity (1)
    4.9 %     32.7 %     32.8 %
Return on average tangible common shareholders’ equity (2)
    5.5 %     38.2 %     39.8 %
 
 
(1) Return on average common shareholders’ equity (ROE) is computed by dividing net earnings applicable to common shareholders by average monthly common shareholders’ equity.
 
(2) Tangible common shareholders’ equity equals total shareholders’ equity less preferred stock, goodwill and identifiable intangible assets, excluding power contracts. Identifiable intangible assets associated with power contracts are not deducted from total shareholders’ equity because, unlike other intangible assets, less than 50% of these assets are supported by common shareholders’ equity.
 
We believe that return on average tangible common shareholders’ equity (ROTE) is meaningful because it measures the performance of businesses consistently, whether they were acquired or developed internally. ROTE is computed by dividing net earnings applicable to common shareholders by average monthly tangible common shareholders’ equity.
 
The following table sets forth the reconciliation of average total shareholders’ equity to average tangible common shareholders’ equity:
 
                         
    Average for the
    Year Ended November
    2008   2007   2006
    (in millions)
 
Total shareholders’ equity
  $ 47,167     $ 37,959     $ 31,048  
Preferred stock
    (5,157 )     (3,100 )     (2,400 )
                         
Common shareholders’ equity
    42,010       34,859       28,648  
Goodwill and identifiable intangible assets, excluding power contracts
    (5,220 )     (4,971 )     (5,013 )
                         
Tangible common shareholders’ equity
  $ 36,790     $ 29,888     $ 23,635  
                         


78


Table of Contents

Net Revenues
 
2008 versus 2007.  Our net revenues were $22.22 billion in 2008, a decrease of 52% compared with 2007, reflecting a particularly difficult operating environment, including significant asset price declines, high levels of volatility and reduced levels of liquidity, particularly in the fourth quarter. In addition, credit markets experienced significant dislocation between prices for cash instruments and the related derivative contracts and between credit indices and underlying single names. Net revenues in Trading and Principal Investments were significantly lower compared with 2007, reflecting significant declines in FICC, Principal Investments and Equities. The decrease in FICC primarily reflected losses in credit products, which included a loss of approximately $3.1 billion (net of hedges) related to non-investment-grade credit origination activities and losses from investments, including corporate debt and private and public equities. Results in mortgages included net losses of approximately $1.7 billion on residential mortgage loans and securities and approximately $1.4 billion on commercial mortgage loans and securities. Interest rate products, currencies and commodities each produced particularly strong results and net revenues were higher compared with 2007. During 2008, although client-driven activity was generally solid, FICC operated in a challenging environment characterized by broad-based declines in asset values, wider mortgage and corporate credit spreads, reduced levels of liquidity and broad-based investor deleveraging, particularly in the second half of the year. The decline in Principal Investments primarily reflected net losses of $2.53 billion from corporate principal investments and $949 million from real estate principal investments, as well as a $446 million loss from our investment in the ordinary shares of ICBC. In Equities, the decrease compared with particularly strong net revenues in 2007 reflected losses in principal strategies, partially offset by higher net revenues in our client franchise businesses. Commissions were particularly strong and were higher than 2007. During 2008, Equities operated in an environment characterized by a significant decline in global equity prices, broad-based investor deleveraging and very high levels of volatility, particularly in the second half of the year.
 
Net revenues in Investment Banking also declined significantly compared with 2007, reflecting significantly lower net revenues in both Financial Advisory and Underwriting. In Financial Advisory, the decrease compared with particularly strong net revenues in 2007 reflected a decline in industry-wide completed mergers and acquisitions. The decrease in Underwriting primarily reflected significantly lower net revenues in debt underwriting, primarily due to a decline in leveraged finance and mortgage-related activity, reflecting difficult market conditions. Net revenues in equity underwriting were slightly lower compared with 2007, reflecting a decrease in industry-wide equity and equity-related offerings.
 
Net revenues in Asset Management and Securities Services increased compared with 2007. Securities Services net revenues were higher, reflecting the impact of changes in the composition of securities lending customer balances, as well as higher total average customer balances. Asset Management net revenues increased slightly compared with 2007. During the year, assets under management decreased $89 billion to $779 billion, due to $123 billion of market depreciation, primarily in equity assets, partially offset by $34 billion of net inflows.


79


Table of Contents

2007 versus 2006.  Our net revenues were $45.99 billion in 2007, an increase of 22% compared with 2006, reflecting significantly higher net revenues in Trading and Principal Investments and Investment Banking, and higher net revenues in Asset Management and Securities Services. The increase in Trading and Principal Investments reflected higher net revenues in Equities, FICC and Principal Investments. Net revenues in Equities increased 33% compared with 2006, reflecting significantly higher net revenues in both our client franchise businesses and principal strategies. During 2007, Equities operated in an environment characterized by strong client-driven activity, generally higher equity prices and higher levels of volatility, particularly during the second half of the year. The increase in FICC reflected significantly higher net revenues in currencies and interest rate products. In addition, net revenues in mortgages were higher despite a significant deterioration in the mortgage market throughout the year, while net revenues in credit products were strong, but slightly lower compared with 2006. Credit products included substantial gains from equity investments, including a gain of approximately $900 million related to the disposition of Horizon Wind Energy L.L.C., as well as a loss of approximately $1 billion (net of hedges) related to non-investment-grade credit origination activities. During 2007, FICC operated in an environment generally characterized by strong client-driven activity and favorable market opportunities. However, during the year, the mortgage market experienced significant deterioration and, in the second half of the year, the broader credit markets were characterized by wider spreads and reduced levels of liquidity. The increase in Principal Investments reflected strong results in both corporate and real estate investing.
 
The increase in Investment Banking reflected a 64% increase in Financial Advisory net revenues and a strong performance in our Underwriting business. The increase in Financial Advisory primarily reflected growth in industry-wide completed mergers and acquisitions. The increase in Underwriting reflected higher net revenues in debt underwriting, as leveraged finance activity was strong during the first half of our fiscal year, while net revenues in equity underwriting were strong but essentially unchanged from 2006.
 
Net revenues in Asset Management and Securities Services also increased. The increase in Securities Services primarily reflected significant growth in global customer balances. The increase in Asset Management reflected significantly higher asset management fees, partially offset by significantly lower incentive fees. During the year, assets under management increased $192 billion, or 28%, to $868 billion, including net inflows of $161 billion.


80


Table of Contents

Operating Expenses
 
Our operating expenses are primarily influenced by compensation, headcount and levels of business activity. A substantial portion of our compensation expense represents discretionary bonuses which are significantly impacted by, among other factors, the level of net revenues, prevailing labor markets, business mix and the structure of our share-based compensation programs. For 2008, our ratio of compensation and benefits (excluding severance costs of approximately $275 million in the fourth quarter of 2008) to net revenues was 48.0%. Our ratio of compensation and benefits to net revenues was 43.9% for 2007.
 
The following table sets forth our operating expenses and number of employees:
 
Operating Expenses and Employees
($ in millions)
 
                         
    Year Ended November
    2008   2007   2006
Compensation and benefits (1)
  $ 10,934     $ 20,190     $ 16,457  
                         
Brokerage, clearing, exchange and distribution fees
    2,998       2,758       1,985  
Market development
    485       601       492  
Communications and technology
    759       665       544  
Depreciation and amortization
    1,022       624       521  
Amortization of identifiable intangible assets
    240       195       173  
Occupancy
    960       975       850  
Professional fees
    779       714       545  
Other expenses (2)
    1,709       1,661       1,538  
                         
Total non-compensation expenses
    8,952       8,193       6,648  
                         
Total operating expenses
  $ 19,886     $ 28,383     $ 23,105  
                         
Employees at year-end (3)
    30,067       30,522       26,467  
 
 
(1) Compensation and benefits includes $262 million, $168 million and $259 million for the years ended November 2008, November 2007 and November 2006, respectively, attributable to consolidated entities held for investment purposes. Consolidated entities held for investment purposes are entities that are held strictly for capital appreciation, have a defined exit strategy and are engaged in activities that are not closely related to our principal businesses.
 
(2) Beginning in the first quarter of 2008, “Cost of power generation” was reclassified into “Other expenses” in the consolidated statements of earnings. Prior periods have been reclassified to conform to the current presentation.
 
(3) Excludes 4,671, 4,572 and 3,868 employees as of November 2008, November 2007 and November 2006, respectively, of consolidated entities held for investment purposes (see footnote 1 above).


81


Table of Contents

The following table sets forth non-compensation expenses of consolidated entities held for investment purposes and our remaining non-compensation expenses by line item:
 
Non-Compensation Expenses
(in millions)
 
                         
    Year Ended November
    2008   2007   2006
Non-compensation expenses of consolidated investments (1)
  $ 779     $ 446     $ 501  
                         
Non-compensation expenses excluding consolidated investments
                       
Brokerage, clearing, exchange and distribution fees
    2,998       2,758       1,985  
Market development
    475       593       461  
Communications and technology
    754       661       537  
Depreciation and amortization
    631       509       444  
Amortization of identifiable intangible assets
    233       189       169  
Occupancy
    861       892       738  
Professional fees
    770       711       534  
Other expenses (2)
    1,451       1,434       1,279  
                         
Subtotal
    8,173       7,747       6,147  
                         
Total non-compensation expenses, as reported
  $ 8,952     $ 8,193     $ 6,648  
                         
 
 
(1) Consolidated entities held for investment purposes are entities that are held strictly for capital appreciation, have a defined exit strategy and are engaged in activities that are not closely related to our principal businesses. For example, these investments include consolidated entities that hold real estate assets, such as hotels, but exclude investments in entities that primarily hold financial assets. We believe that it is meaningful to review non-compensation expenses excluding expenses related to these consolidated entities in order to evaluate trends in non-compensation expenses related to our principal business activities. Revenues related to such entities are included in “Trading and principal investments” in the consolidated statements of earnings.
 
(2) Beginning in the first quarter of 2008, “Cost of power generation” was reclassified into “Other expenses” in the consolidated statements of earnings. Prior periods have been reclassified to conform to the current presentation.
 
 
2008 versus 2007.  Operating expenses were $19.89 billion for 2008, 30% lower than 2007. Compensation and benefits expenses (including salaries, bonuses, amortization of prior year equity awards and other items such as payroll taxes and benefits) of $10.93 billion decreased 46% compared with 2007, reflecting lower levels of discretionary compensation due to lower net revenues. For 2008, our ratio of compensation and benefits (excluding severance costs of approximately $275 million in the fourth quarter of 2008) to net revenues was 48.0%. Our ratio of compensation and benefits to net revenues was 43.9% for 2007. Employment levels decreased 1% compared with November 2007, reflecting an 8% decrease during the fourth quarter.
 
Non-compensation expenses of $8.95 billion for 2008 increased 9% compared with 2007. Excluding consolidated entities held for investment purposes, non-compensation expenses increased 5% compared with 2007. The majority of this increase was attributable to higher brokerage, clearing, exchange and distribution fees, principally reflecting higher activity levels in Equities and FICC. The increase in non-compensation expenses related to consolidated entities held for investment purposes primarily reflected the impact of impairment on certain real estate assets during 2008.
 
2007 versus 2006.  Operating expenses were $28.38 billion for 2007, 23% higher than 2006. Compensation and benefits expenses of $20.19 billion increased 23% compared with 2006, reflecting increased discretionary compensation and growth in employment levels. The ratio of compensation and benefits to net revenues for 2007 was 43.9% compared with 43.7% for 2006. Employment levels increased 15% compared with November 2006.


82


Table of Contents

Non-compensation expenses of $8.19 billion for 2007 increased 23% compared with 2006, primarily attributable to higher levels of business activity and continued geographic expansion. One-half of this increase was attributable to brokerage, clearing, exchange and distribution fees, principally reflecting higher transaction volumes in Equities. Professional fees, other expenses and communications and technology expenses also increased, primarily due to higher levels of business activity. Occupancy and depreciation and amortization expenses in 2007 included exit costs of $128 million related to our office space.
 
Provision for Taxes
 
The effective income tax rate was approximately 1% for 2008, down from 34.1% for 2007. The decrease in the effective income tax rate was primarily due to an increase in permanent benefits as a percentage of lower earnings and changes in geographic earnings mix. The effective income tax rate was 34.1% for 2007, down from 34.5% for 2006, primarily due to changes in the geographic mix of earnings.
 
Our effective income tax rate can vary from period to period depending on, among other factors, the geographic and business mix of our earnings, the level of our pre-tax earnings, the level of our tax credits and the effect of tax audits. Certain of these and other factors, including our history of pre-tax earnings, are taken into account in assessing our ability to realize our net deferred tax assets. See Note 16 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for further information regarding our provision for taxes.


83


Table of Contents

 
Segment Operating Results
 
The following table sets forth the net revenues, operating expenses and pre-tax earnings of our segments:
 
Segment Operating Results
(in millions)
 
                             
        Year Ended November
        2008   2007   2006
 
Investment
  Net revenues   $ 5,185     $ 7,555     $ 5,629  
Banking
  Operating expenses     3,143       4,985       4,062  
                             
    Pre-tax earnings   $ 2,042     $ 2,570     $ 1,567  
                             
Trading and Principal
  Net revenues   $ 9,063     $ 31,226     $ 25,562  
Investments
  Operating expenses     11,808       17,998       14,962  
                             
    Pre-tax earnings/(loss)   $ (2,745 )   $ 13,228     $ 10,600  
                             
Asset Management and
  Net revenues   $ 7,974     $ 7,206     $ 6,474  
Securities Services
  Operating expenses     4,939       5,363       4,036  
                             
    Pre-tax earnings   $ 3,035     $ 1,843     $ 2,438  
                             
Total
  Net revenues   $ 22,222     $ 45,987     $ 37,665  
    Operating expenses (1)     19,886       28,383       23,105  
                             
    Pre-tax earnings   $ 2,336     $ 17,604     $ 14,560  
                             
 
 
(1) Operating expenses include net provisions for a number of litigation and regulatory proceedings of $(4) million, $37 million and $45 million for the years ended November 2008, November 2007 and November 2006, respectively, that have not been allocated to our segments.
 
 
Net revenues in our segments include allocations of interest income and interest expense to specific securities, commodities and other positions in relation to the cash generated by, or funding requirements of, such underlying positions. See Note 18 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for further information regarding our business segments.
 
The cost drivers of Goldman Sachs taken as a whole — compensation, headcount and levels of business activity — are broadly similar in each of our business segments. Compensation and benefits expenses within our segments reflect, among other factors, the overall performance of Goldman Sachs as well as the performance of individual business units. Consequently, pre-tax margins in one segment of our business may be significantly affected by the performance of our other business segments. A discussion of segment operating results follows.


84


Table of Contents

Investment Banking
 
Our Investment Banking segment is divided into two components:
 
  •  Financial Advisory.  Financial Advisory includes advisory assignments with respect to mergers and acquisitions, divestitures, corporate defense activities, restructurings and spin-offs.
 
  •  Underwriting.  Underwriting includes public offerings and private placements of a wide range of securities and other financial instruments.
 
The following table sets forth the operating results of our Investment Banking segment:
 
Investment Banking Operating Results
(in millions)
 
                         
    Year Ended November
    2008   2007   2006
Financial Advisory
  $ 2,656     $ 4,222     $ 2,580  
                         
Equity underwriting
    1,353       1,382       1,365  
Debt underwriting
    1,176       1,951       1,684  
                         
Total Underwriting
    2,529       3,333       3,049  
                         
Total net revenues
    5,185       7,555       5,629  
Operating expenses
    3,143       4,985       4,062  
                         
Pre-tax earnings
  $ 2,042     $ 2,570     $ 1,567  
                         
 
 
The following table sets forth our financial advisory and underwriting transaction volumes:
 
Goldman Sachs Global Investment Banking Volumes (1)
(in billions)
 
                         
    Year Ended November
    2008   2007   2006
Announced mergers and acquisitions
  $ 927     $ 1,249     $ 1,101  
Completed mergers and acquisitions
    823       1,443       863  
Equity and equity-related offerings (2)
    61       66       74  
Debt offerings (3)
    185       345       320  
 
 
(1) Source: Thomson Reuters. Announced and completed mergers and acquisitions volumes are based on full credit to each of the advisors in a transaction. Equity and equity-related offerings and debt offerings are based on full credit for single book managers and equal credit for joint book managers. Transaction volumes may not be indicative of net revenues in a given period. In addition, transaction volumes for prior periods may vary from amounts previously reported due to the subsequent withdrawal or a change in the value of a previously announced transaction.
 
(2) Includes Rule 144A and public common stock offerings, convertible offerings and rights offerings.
 
(3) Includes non-convertible preferred stock, mortgage-backed securities, asset-backed securities and taxable municipal debt. Includes publicly registered and Rule 144A issues.


85


Table of Contents

2008 versus 2007. Net revenues in Investment Banking of $5.19 billion for 2008 decreased 31% compared with 2007.
 
Net revenues in Financial Advisory of $2.66 billion decreased 37% compared with particularly strong net revenues in 2007, primarily reflecting a decline in industry-wide completed mergers and acquisitions. Net revenues in our Underwriting business of $2.53 billion decreased 24% compared with 2007, principally due to significantly lower net revenues in debt underwriting. The decrease in debt underwriting was primarily due to a decline in leveraged finance and mortgage-related activity, reflecting difficult market conditions. Net revenues in equity underwriting were slightly lower compared with 2007, reflecting a decrease in industry-wide equity and equity-related offerings. Our investment banking transaction backlog ended the year significantly lower than at the end of 2007. (1)
 
Operating expenses of $3.14 billion for 2008 decreased 37% compared with 2007, due to decreased compensation and benefits expenses, resulting from lower levels of discretionary compensation. Pre-tax earnings of $2.04 billion in 2008 decreased 21% compared with 2007.
 
2007 versus 2006.  Net revenues in Investment Banking of $7.56 billion for 2007 increased 34% compared with 2006.
 
Net revenues in Financial Advisory of $4.22 billion increased 64% compared with 2006, primarily reflecting growth in industry-wide completed mergers and acquisitions. Net revenues in our Underwriting business of $3.33 billion increased 9% compared with 2006, due to higher net revenues in debt underwriting, primarily reflecting strength in leveraged finance during the first half of 2007. Net revenues in equity underwriting were also strong, but essentially unchanged from 2006. Our investment banking transaction backlog at the end of 2007 was higher than at the end of 2006. (1)
 
Operating expenses of $4.99 billion for 2007 increased 23% compared with 2006, primarily due to increased compensation and benefits expenses, resulting from higher discretionary compensation and growth in employment levels. Pre-tax earnings of $2.57 billion in 2007 increased 64% compared with 2006.
 
Trading and Principal Investments
 
Our Trading and Principal Investments segment is divided into three components:
 
  •  FICC.  We make markets in and trade interest rate and credit products, mortgage-related securities and loan products and other asset-backed instruments, currencies and commodities, structure and enter into a wide variety of derivative transactions, and engage in proprietary trading and investing.
 
  •  Equities.  We make markets in and trade equities and equity-related products, structure and enter into equity derivative transactions and engage in proprietary trading. We generate commissions from executing and clearing client transactions on major stock, options and futures exchanges worldwide through our Equities client franchise and clearing activities. We also engage in specialist and insurance activities.
 
  •  Principal Investments.  We make real estate and corporate principal investments, including our investment in the ordinary shares of ICBC. We generate net revenues from returns on these investments and from the increased share of the income and gains derived from our merchant banking funds when the return on a fund’s investments over the life of the fund exceeds certain threshold returns (typically referred to as an override).
 
 
(1) Our investment banking transaction backlog represents an estimate of our future net revenues from investment banking transactions where we believe that future revenue realization is more likely than not.
     


86


Table of Contents

Substantially all of our inventory is marked-to-market daily and, therefore, its value and our net revenues are subject to fluctuations based on market movements. In addition, net revenues derived from our principal investments, including those in privately held concerns and in real estate, may fluctuate significantly depending on the revaluation of these investments in any given period. We also regularly enter into large transactions as part of our trading businesses. The number and size of such transactions may affect our results of operations in a given period.
 
Net revenues from Principal Investments do not include management fees generated from our merchant banking funds. These management fees are included in the net revenues of the Asset Management and Securities Services segment.
 
The following table sets forth the operating results of our Trading and Principal Investments segment:
 
Trading and Principal Investments Operating Results
(in millions)
 
                         
    Year Ended November
    2008   2007   2006
FICC
  $ 3,713     $ 16,165     $ 14,262  
                         
Equities trading
    4,208       6,725       4,965  
Equities commissions
    4,998       4,579       3,518  
                         
Total Equities
    9,206       11,304       8,483  
                         
ICBC
    (446 )     495       937  
                         
                         
Gross gains
    1,335       3,728       2,061  
Gross losses
    (4,815 )     (943 )     (585 )
                         
Net other corporate and real estate investments
    (3,480 )     2,785       1,476  
Overrides
    70       477       404  
                         
                         
Total Principal Investments
    (3,856 )     3,757       2,817  
                         
Total net revenues
    9,063       31,226       25,562  
Operating expenses
    11,808       17,998       14,962  
                         
Pre-tax earnings/(loss)
  $ (2,745 )   $ 13,228     $ 10,600  
                         
 
 
2008 versus 2007.  Net revenues in Trading and Principal Investments of $9.06 billion for 2008 decreased 71% compared with 2007.
 
Net revenues in FICC of $3.71 billion for 2008 decreased 77% compared with 2007, primarily reflecting losses in credit products, which included a loss of approximately $3.1 billion (net of hedges) related to non-investment-grade credit origination activities and losses from investments, including corporate debt and private and public equities. Results in mortgages included net losses of approximately $1.7 billion on residential mortgage loans and securities and approximately $1.4 billion on commercial mortgage loans and securities. Interest rate products, currencies and commodities each produced particularly strong results and net revenues were higher compared with 2007. During 2008, although client-driven activity was generally solid, FICC operated in a challenging environment characterized by broad-based declines in asset values, wider mortgage and corporate credit spreads, reduced levels of liquidity and broad-based investor deleveraging, particularly in the second half of the year.


87


Table of Contents

Net revenues in Equities of $9.21 billion for 2008 decreased 19% compared with a particularly strong 2007, reflecting losses in principal strategies, partially offset by higher net revenues in the client franchise businesses. Commissions were particularly strong and were higher than 2007. During 2008, Equities operated in an environment characterized by a significant decline in global equity prices, broad-based investor deleveraging and very high levels of volatility, particularly in the second half of the year.
 
Principal Investments recorded a net loss of $3.86 billion for 2008. These results included net losses of $2.53 billion from corporate principal investments and $949 million from real estate principal investments, as well as a $446 million loss related to our investment in the ordinary shares of ICBC.
 
Operating expenses of $11.81 billion for 2008 decreased 34% compared with 2007, due to decreased compensation and benefits expenses, resulting from lower levels of discretionary compensation. This decrease was partially offset by higher non-compensation expenses. Excluding consolidated entities held for investment purposes, the majority of this increase was attributable to higher brokerage, clearing, exchange and distribution fees, principally reflecting higher activity levels in Equities and FICC. The increase in non-compensation expenses related to consolidated entities held for investment purposes primarily reflected the impact of impairment on certain real estate assets during 2008. Pre-tax loss was $2.75 billion in 2008 compared with pre-tax earnings of $13.23 billion in 2007.
 
2007 versus 2006.  Net revenues in Trading and Principal Investments of $31.23 billion for 2007 increased 22% compared with 2006.
 
Net revenues in FICC of $16.17 billion for 2007 increased 13% compared with 2006, reflecting significantly higher net revenues in currencies and interest rate products. In addition, net revenues in mortgages were higher despite a significant deterioration in the mortgage market throughout 2007, while net revenues in credit products were strong, but slightly lower compared with 2006. Credit products included substantial gains from equity investments, including a gain of approximately $900 million related to the disposition of Horizon Wind Energy L.L.C., as well as a loss of approximately $1 billion (net of hedges) related to non-investment-grade credit origination activities. Net revenues in commodities were also strong but lower compared with 2006. During 2007, FICC operated in an environment generally characterized by strong client-driven activity and favorable market opportunities. However, during 2007, the mortgage market experienced significant deterioration and, in the second half of the year, the broader credit markets were characterized by wider spreads and reduced levels of liquidity.
 
Net revenues in Equities of $11.30 billion for 2007 increased 33% compared with 2006, reflecting significantly higher net revenues in both our client franchise businesses and principal strategies. The client franchise businesses benefited from significantly higher commission volumes. During 2007, Equities operated in an environment characterized by strong client-driven activity, generally higher equity prices and higher levels of volatility, particularly during the second half of the year.
 
Principal Investments recorded net revenues of $3.76 billion for 2007, reflecting gains and overrides from corporate and real estate principal investments. Results in Principal Investments included a $495 million gain related to our investment in the ordinary shares of ICBC and a $129 million loss related to our investment in the convertible preferred stock of SMFG.
 
Operating expenses of $18.00 billion for 2007 increased 20% compared with 2006, primarily due to increased compensation and benefits expenses, resulting from higher discretionary compensation and growth in employment levels. Non-compensation expenses increased due to the impact of higher levels of business activity and continued geographic expansion. The majority of this increase was in brokerage, clearing, exchange and distribution fees, which primarily reflected higher transaction volumes in Equities. Professional fees also increased, reflecting increased business activity. Pre-tax earnings of $13.23 billion in 2007 increased 25% compared with 2006.


88


Table of Contents

Asset Management and Securities Services
 
Our Asset Management and Securities Services segment is divided into two components:
 
  •  Asset Management.  Asset Management provides investment advisory and financial planning services and offers investment products (primarily through separately managed accounts and commingled vehicles, such as mutual funds and private investment funds) across all major asset classes to a diverse group of institutions and individuals worldwide and primarily generates revenues in the form of management and incentive fees.
 
  •  Securities Services.  Securities Services provides prime brokerage services, financing services and securities lending services to institutional clients, including hedge funds, mutual funds, pension funds and foundations, and to high-net-worth individuals worldwide, and generates revenues primarily in the form of interest rate spreads or fees.
 
Assets under management typically generate fees as a percentage of asset value, which is affected by investment performance and by inflows and redemptions. The fees that we charge vary by asset class, as do our related expenses. In certain circumstances, we are also entitled to receive incentive fees based on a percentage of a fund’s return or when the return on assets under management exceeds specified benchmark returns or other performance targets. Incentive fees are recognized when the performance period ends and they are no longer subject to adjustment. We have numerous incentive fee arrangements, many of which have annual performance periods that end on December 31. For that reason, incentive fees have been seasonally weighted to our first quarter.
 
The following table sets forth the operating results of our Asset Management and Securities Services segment:
 
Asset Management and Securities Services Operating Results
(in millions)
 
                         
    Year Ended November
    2008   2007   2006
Management and other fees
  $ 4,321     $ 4,303     $ 3,332  
Incentive fees
    231       187       962  
                         
Total Asset Management
    4,552       4,490       4,294  
Securities Services
    3,422       2,716       2,180  
                         
Total net revenues
    7,974       7,206       6,474  
Operating expenses
    4,939       5,363       4,036  
                         
Pre-tax earnings
  $ 3,035     $ 1,843     $ 2,438  
                         
 
 
Assets under management include our mutual funds, alternative investment funds and separately managed accounts for institutional and individual investors. Substantially all assets under management are valued as of calendar month-end. Assets under management do not include:
 
  •  assets in brokerage accounts that generate commissions, mark-ups and spreads based on transactional activity,
 
  •  our own investments in funds that we manage;
 
  •  or non-fee-paying assets, including interest-bearing deposits held through our depository institution subsidiaries.


89


Table of Contents

 
The following table sets forth our assets under management by asset class:
 
Assets Under Management by Asset Class
(in billions)
 
                         
    As of November 30
    2008   2007   2006
Alternative investments (1)
  $  146      $ 151     $ 145  
Equity
    112       255       215  
Fixed income
    248       256       198  
                         
Total non-money market assets
    506       662       558  
Money markets
    273       206       118  
                         
Total assets under management
  $ 779     $ 868     $ 676  
                         
 
 
(1) Primarily includes hedge funds, private equity, real estate, currencies, commodities and asset allocation strategies.
 
 
The following table sets forth a summary of the changes in our assets under management:
 
Changes in Assets Under Management
(in billions)
 
                         
    Year Ended November 30
    2008   2007   2006
Balance, beginning of year
  $ 868     $ 676     $ 532  
                         
Net inflows/(outflows)
                       
Alternative investments
    8       9       32  
Equity
    (55 )     26       16  
Fixed income
    14       38       29  
                         
Total non-money market net inflows/(outflows)
    (33 )     73  (1)     77  
Money markets
    67       88       17  (2)
                         
Total net inflows/(outflows)
    34       161       94  (3)
                         
Net market appreciation/(depreciation)
    (123 )     31       50  
                         
Balance, end of year
  $ 779     $ 868     $ 676  
                         
 
 
(1) Includes $7 billion in net asset inflows in connection with our acquisition of Macquarie — IMM Investment Management.
 
(2) Net of the transfer of $8 billion of money market assets under management to interest-bearing deposits at GS Bank USA.
 
(3) Includes $3 billion of net asset inflows in connection with the acquisition of our variable annuity and life insurance business.
 
 
2008 versus 2007.  Net revenues in Asset Management and Securities Services of $7.97 billion for 2008 increased 11% compared with 2007.
 
Asset Management net revenues of $4.55 billion for 2008 increased 1% compared with 2007. During 2008, assets under management decreased $89 billion to $779 billion, due to $123 billion of market depreciation, primarily in equity assets, partially offset by $34 billion of net inflows. Net inflows reflected inflows in money market, fixed income and alternative investment assets, partially offset by outflows in equity assets.


90


Table of Contents

Securities Services net revenues of $3.42 billion for 2008 increased 26% compared with 2007, reflecting the impact of changes in the composition of securities lending customer balances, as well as higher total average customer balances.
 
Operating expenses of $4.94 billion for 2008 decreased 8% compared with 2007, due to decreased compensation and benefits expenses, resulting from lower levels of discretionary compensation. Pre-tax earnings of $3.04 billion in 2008 increased 65% compared with 2007.
 
2007 versus 2006.  Net revenues in Asset Management and Securities Services of $7.21 billion for 2007 increased 11% compared with 2006.
 
Asset Management net revenues of $4.49 billion for 2007 increased 5% compared with 2006, reflecting a 29% increase in management and other fees, partially offset by significantly lower incentive fees. Incentive fees were $187 million for 2007 compared with $962 million for 2006. During 2007, assets under management increased $192 billion, or 28%, to $868 billion, reflecting non-money market net inflows of $73 billion (1), primarily in fixed income and equity assets, money market net inflows of $88 billion, and net market appreciation of $31 billion, reflecting appreciation in fixed income and equity assets, partially offset by depreciation in alternative investment assets.
 
Securities Services net revenues of $2.72 billion for 2007 increased 25% compared with 2006, as our prime brokerage business continued to generate strong results, primarily reflecting significantly higher customer balances in securities lending and margin lending.
 
Operating expenses of $5.36 billion for 2007 increased 33% compared with 2006, primarily due to increased compensation and benefits expenses, resulting from higher discretionary compensation and growth in employment levels, and higher distribution fees (included in brokerage, clearing, exchange and distribution fees). Pre-tax earnings of $1.84 billion in 2007 decreased 24% compared with 2006.
 
Geographic Data
 
See Note 18 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for a summary of our total net revenues, pre-tax earnings and net earnings by geographic region.
 
Off-Balance-Sheet Arrangements
 
We have various types of off-balance-sheet arrangements that we enter into in the ordinary course of business. Our involvement in these arrangements can take many different forms, including purchasing or retaining residual and other interests in mortgage-backed and other asset-backed securitization vehicles; holding senior and subordinated debt, interests in limited and general partnerships, and preferred and common stock in other nonconsolidated vehicles; entering into interest rate, foreign currency, equity, commodity and credit derivatives, including total return swaps; entering into operating leases; and providing guarantees, indemnifications, loan commitments, letters of credit and representations and warranties.
 
We enter into these arrangements for a variety of business purposes, including the securitization of commercial and residential mortgages, home equity and auto loans, government and corporate bonds, and other types of financial assets. Other reasons for entering into these arrangements include underwriting client securitization transactions; providing secondary market liquidity; making investments in performing and nonperforming debt, equity, real estate and other assets; providing investors with credit-linked and asset-repackaged notes; and receiving or providing letters of credit to satisfy margin requirements and to facilitate the clearance and settlement process.
 
 
(1) Includes $7 billion in net asset inflows in connection with our acquisition of Macquarie — IMM Investment Management.


91


Table of Contents

We engage in transactions with variable interest entities (VIEs) and qualifying special-purpose entities (QSPEs). Such vehicles are critical to the functioning of several significant investor markets, including the mortgage-backed and other asset-backed securities markets, since they offer investors access to specific cash flows and risks created through the securitization process. Our financial interests in, and derivative transactions with, such nonconsolidated entities are accounted for at fair value, in the same manner as our other financial instruments, except in cases where we apply the equity method of accounting.
 
We did not have off-balance-sheet commitments to purchase or finance any CDOs held by structured investment vehicles as of November 2008 or November 2007.
 
In December 2007, the American Securitization Forum (ASF) issued the “Streamlined Foreclosure and Loss Avoidance Framework for Securitized Subprime Adjustable Rate Mortgage Loans” (ASF Framework). The ASF Framework provides guidance for servicers to streamline borrower evaluation procedures and to facilitate the use of foreclosure and loss prevention measures for securitized subprime residential mortgages that meet certain criteria. For certain eligible loans as defined in the ASF Framework, servicers may presume default is reasonably foreseeable and apply a fast-track loan modification plan, under which the loan interest rate will be kept at the introductory rate for a period of five years following the upcoming reset date. Mortgage loan modifications of these eligible loans will not affect our accounting treatment for QSPEs that hold the subprime loans.
 
The following table sets forth where a discussion of off-balance-sheet arrangements may be found in Part II, Items 7 and 8 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K:
 
     
Type of Off-Balance-Sheet Arrangement   Disclosure in our Annual Report on Form 10-K
 
 
     
Retained interests or contingent interests in assets transferred by us to nonconsolidated entities   See Note 4 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K.
     
Leases, letters of credit, and loans and other commitments   See “— Contractual Obligations and Commitments” below and Note 8 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K.
     
Guarantees   See Note 8 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K.
     
Other obligations, including contingent obligations, arising out of variable interests we have in nonconsolidated entities   See Note 4 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K.
     
Derivative contracts   See “— Critical Accounting Policies” above, and “— Risk Management” and “— Derivatives” below and Notes 3 and 7 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K.
     
     
 
 
 
In addition, see Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for a discussion of our consolidation policies.


92


Table of Contents

 
Equity Capital
 
The level and composition of our equity capital are principally determined by our consolidated regulatory capital requirements but may also be influenced by rating agency guidelines, subsidiary capital requirements, the business environment, conditions in the financial markets and assessments of potential future losses due to extreme and adverse changes in our business and market environments. As of November 2008, our total shareholders’ equity was $64.37 billion (consisting of common shareholders’ equity of $47.90 billion and preferred stock of $16.47 billion) compared with total shareholders’ equity of $42.80 billion as of November 2007 (consisting of common shareholders’ equity of $39.70 billion and preferred stock of $3.10 billion). In addition to total shareholders’ equity, we consider the $5.00 billion of junior subordinated debt issued to trusts (see discussion below) to be part of our equity capital, as it qualifies as capital for regulatory and certain rating agency purposes.
 
Consolidated Capital Requirements
 
We are subject to regulatory capital requirements administered by the U.S. federal banking agencies. Our bank depository institution subsidiaries, including GS Bank USA, are subject to similar capital guidelines. Under the Federal Reserve Board’s capital adequacy guidelines and the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action (PCA) that is applicable to GS Bank USA, Goldman Sachs and its bank depository institution subsidiaries must meet specific capital guidelines that involve quantitative measures of assets, liabilities and certain off-balance-sheet items as calculated under regulatory reporting practices. Goldman Sachs and its bank depository institution subsidiaries’ capital amounts, as well as GS Bank USA’s PCA classification, are also subject to qualitative judgments by the regulators about components, risk weightings and other factors. We anticipate reporting capital ratios as follows:
 
  •  Before we became a bank holding company, we were subject to capital guidelines by the SEC as a Consolidated Supervised Entity (CSE) that were generally consistent with those set out in the Revised Framework for the International Convergence of Capital Measurement and Capital Standards issued by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (Basel II). We currently compute and report our firmwide capital ratios in accordance with the Basel II requirements as applicable to us when we were regulated as a CSE for the purpose of assessing the adequacy of our capital. Under the Basel II framework as it applied to us when we were regulated as a CSE, we evaluate our Tier 1 Capital and Total Allowable Capital as a percentage of RWAs. As of November 2008, our Total Capital Ratio (Total Allowable Capital as a percentage of RWAs) was 18.9% and our Tier 1 Ratio (Tier 1 Capital as a percentage of RWAs) was 15.6%, in each case calculated under the Basel II framework as it applied to us when we were regulated as a CSE. See “— Consolidated Capital Ratios” below for further information. We expect to continue to report to investors for a period of time our Basel II capital ratios as applicable to us when we were regulated as a CSE.
 
  •  The regulatory capital guidelines currently applicable to bank holding companies are based on the Capital Accord of the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (Basel I), with Basel II to be phased in over time. We are currently working with the Federal Reserve Board to put in place the appropriate reporting and compliance mechanisms and methodologies to allow reporting of the Basel I capital ratios as of the end of March 2009.
 
  •  In addition, we are currently working to implement the Basel II framework as applicable to us as a bank holding company (as opposed to as a CSE). U.S. banking regulators have incorporated the Basel II framework into the existing risk-based capital requirements by requiring that internationally active banking organizations, such as Group Inc., transition to Basel II over the next several years.
 
The Federal Reserve Board also has established minimum leverage ratio guidelines. We were not subject to these guidelines before becoming a bank holding company and, accordingly, we are currently working with the Federal Reserve Board to finalize our methodology for calculating this ratio.


93


Table of Contents

The Tier 1 leverage ratio is defined as Tier 1 capital (as applicable to us as a bank holding company) divided by adjusted average total assets (which includes adjustments for disallowed goodwill and certain intangible assets). The minimum Tier 1 leverage ratio is 3% for bank holding companies that have received the highest supervisory rating under Federal Reserve Board guidelines or that have implemented the Federal Reserve Board’s risk-based capital measure for market risk. Other bank holding companies must have a minimum leverage ratio of 4%. Bank holding companies may be expected to maintain ratios well above the minimum levels, depending upon their particular condition, risk profile and growth plans. As of November 2008, our estimated Tier 1 leverage ratio was 6.1%. This ratio represents a preliminary estimate and may be revised in subsequent filings as we continue to work with the Federal Reserve Board to finalize the methodology for the calculation.
 
Consolidated Capital Ratios
 
The following table sets forth additional information on our capital ratios as of November 2008 calculated in the same manner (generally consistent with Basel II) as when the firm was regulated by the SEC as a CSE:
 
         
    As of
    November
    2008
    ($ in millions)
I. Tier 1 and Total Allowable Capital
       
Common shareholders’ equity
  $ 47,898  
Preferred stock
    16,471  
Junior subordinated debt issued to trusts
    5,000  
Less: Goodwill
    (3,523 )
Less: Disallowable intangible assets
    (1,386 )
Less: Other deductions (1)
    (1,823 )
         
Tier 1 Capital
    62,637  
Other components of Total Allowable Capital
       
Qualifying subordinated debt (2)
    13,703  
Less: Other deductions (1)
    (690 )
         
Total Allowable Capital
  $ 75,650  
         
II. Risk-Weighted Assets
       
Market risk
  $ 176,646  
Credit risk
    184,055  
Operational risk
    39,675  
         
Total Risk-Weighted Assets
  $ 400,376  
         
III. Tier 1 Ratio
    15.6 %
IV. Total Capital Ratio
    18.9 %
 
 
(1) Principally included investments in regulated insurance entities and certain financial service entities (50% was deducted from both Tier 1 Capital and Total Allowable Capital).
 
(2) Substantially all of our existing subordinated debt qualified as Total Allowable Capital for CSE purposes.
 
 
Our RWAs are driven by the amount of market risk, credit risk and operational risk associated with our business activities in a manner generally consistent with methodologies set out in Basel II. The methodologies used to compute RWAs for each of market risk, credit risk and operational risk are closely aligned with our risk management practices. See “— Market Risk” and “— Credit Risk” below for a discussion of how we manage risks in our trading and principal investing businesses. Further details on the methodologies used to calculate RWAs are set forth below.


94


Table of Contents

Risk-Weighted Assets for Market Risk
 
For positions captured in VaR, RWAs are calculated using VaR and other model-based measures, including requirements for incremental default risk and other event risks. VaR is the potential loss in value of trading positions due to adverse market movements over a defined time horizon with a specified confidence level. Market risk RWAs are calculated consistent with the specific conditions set out in the Basel II framework (based on VaR calibrated to a 99% confidence level, over a 10-day holding period, multiplied by a factor). Additional RWAs are calculated with respect to incremental default risk and other event risks, in a manner generally consistent with our internal risk management methodologies.
 
For positions not included in VaR because VaR is not the most appropriate measure of risk, we calculate RWAs based on alternative methodologies, including sensitivity analyses.
 
Risk-Weighted Assets for Credit Risk
 
RWAs for credit risk are calculated for on- and off-balance-sheet exposures that are not captured in our market risk RWAs, with the exception of OTC derivatives for which both market risk and credit risk RWAs are calculated. The calculations are consistent with the Advanced Internal Ratings Based (AIRB) approach and the Internal Models Method (IMM) of Basel II, and were based on Exposure at Default (EAD), which is an estimate of the amount that would be owed to us at the time of a default, multiplied by each counterparty’s risk weight.
 
Under the Basel II AIRB approach, a counterparty’s risk weight is generally derived from a combination of the Probability of Default (PD), the Loss Given Default (LGD) and the maturity of the trade or portfolio of trades, where:
 
  •  PD is an estimate of the probability that an obligor will default over a one-year horizon. PD is derived from the use of internally determined equivalents of public rating agency ratings.
 
  •  LGD is an estimate of the economic loss rate if a default occurs during economic downturn conditions. LGD is determined based on industry data.
 
For OTC derivatives and funding trades (such as repurchase and reverse repurchase transactions), we use the Basel II IMM approach, which allows EAD to be calculated using model-based measures to determine potential exposure, consistent with models and methodologies that we use for internal risk management purposes. For commitments, EAD is calculated as a percentage of the outstanding notional balance. For other credit exposures, EAD is generally the carrying value of the exposure.
 
Risk-Weighted Assets for Operational Risk
 
RWAs for operational risk are calculated using a risk-based methodology consistent with the qualitative and quantitative criteria for the Advanced Measurement Approach (AMA), as defined in Basel II. The methodology incorporates internal loss events, relevant external loss events, results of scenario analyses and management’s assessment of our business environment and internal controls. We estimate capital requirements for both expected and unexpected losses, seeking to capture the major drivers of operational risk over a one-year time horizon, at a 99.9% confidence level. Operational risk capital is allocated among our businesses and is regularly reported to senior management and key risk and oversight committees.
 
Rating Agency Guidelines
 
The credit rating agencies assign credit ratings to the obligations of Group Inc., which directly issues or guarantees substantially all of the firm’s senior unsecured obligations. The level and composition of our equity capital are among the many factors considered in determining our credit ratings. Each agency has its own definition of eligible capital and methodology for evaluating capital


95


Table of Contents

adequacy, and assessments are generally based on a combination of factors rather than a single calculation. See “— Liquidity and Funding Risk — Credit Ratings” below for further information regarding our credit ratings.
 
Subsidiary Capital Requirements
 
Many of our subsidiaries are subject to separate regulation and capital requirements in the U.S. and/or elsewhere. GS&Co. and Goldman Sachs Execution & Clearing, L.P. are registered U.S. broker-dealers and futures commissions merchants, and are subject to regulatory capital requirements, including those imposed by the SEC, the Commodity Futures Trading Commission, the Chicago Board of Trade, the Financial Industry Regulatory Authority, Inc. (FINRA) and the National Futures Association.
 
Our depository institution subsidiary, GS Bank USA, a New York State-chartered bank and a member of the Federal Reserve System and the FDIC, is regulated by the Federal Reserve Board and the New York State Banking Department and is subject to minimum capital requirements that (subject to certain exceptions) are similar to those applicable to bank holding companies. GS Bank USA was formed in November 2008 through the merger of our existing Utah industrial bank (named GS Bank USA) into our New York limited purpose trust company, with the surviving company taking the name GS Bank USA. As of November 2007, GS Bank USA’s predecessor was a wholly owned industrial bank regulated by the Utah Department of Financial Institutions, was a member of the FDIC and was subject to minimum capital requirements. We compute the capital ratios for GS Bank USA in accordance with the Basel I framework for purposes of assessing the adequacy of its capital. In order to be considered a “well capitalized” depository institution under the Federal Reserve Board guidelines, GS Bank USA must maintain a Tier 1 capital ratio of at least 6%, a total capital ratio of at least 10%, and a Tier 1 leverage ratio of at least 5%. In connection with the November 2008 asset transfer described below, GS Bank USA agreed with the Federal Reserve Board to minimum capital ratios in excess of these “well capitalized” levels. Accordingly, for a period of time, GS Bank USA is expected to maintain a Tier 1 capital ratio of at least 8%, a total capital ratio of at least 11% and a Tier 1 leverage ratio of at least 6%. In November 2008, we contributed subsidiaries with an aggregate of $117.16 billion of assets into GS Bank USA (which brought total assets in GS Bank USA to $145.06 billion as of November 2008). As a result, we are currently working with the Federal Reserve Board to finalize our methodology for the Basel I calculations. As of November 2008, under Basel I, GS Bank USA’s estimated Tier 1 capital ratio was 8.9% and estimated total capital ratio was 11.6%. In addition, GS Bank USA’s estimated Tier 1 leverage ratio was 9.1%.
 
Group Inc. has guaranteed the payment obligations of GS&Co., GS Bank USA and GS Bank Europe, subject to certain exceptions. In November 2008, as noted above, we contributed subsidiaries, with an aggregate of $117.16 billion of assets, into GS Bank USA and Group Inc. agreed to guarantee certain losses, including credit-related losses, relating to assets held by the contributed entities. In connection with this guarantee, Group Inc. also agreed to pledge to GS Bank USA certain collateral, including interests in subsidiaries and other illiquid assets.
 
GS Bank Europe, our regulated Irish bank, is subject to minimum capital requirements imposed by the Irish Financial Services Regulatory Authority. Several other subsidiaries of Goldman Sachs are regulated by securities, investment advisory, banking, insurance, and other regulators and authorities around the world. Goldman Sachs International (GSI), our regulated U.K. broker-dealer, is subject to minimum capital requirements imposed by the Financial Services Authority (FSA). Goldman Sachs Japan Co., Ltd., our regulated Japanese broker-dealer, is subject to minimum capital requirements imposed by Japan’s Financial Services Agency. As of November 2008 and November 2007, these subsidiaries were in compliance with their local capital requirements.
 
As discussed above, many of our subsidiaries are subject to regulatory capital requirements in jurisdictions throughout the world. Subsidiaries not subject to separate regulation may hold capital to satisfy local tax guidelines, rating agency requirements (for entities with assigned credit ratings) or


96


Table of Contents

internal policies, including policies concerning the minimum amount of capital a subsidiary should hold based on its underlying level of risk. See “— Liquidity and Funding Risk — Conservative Liability Structure” below for a discussion of our potential inability to access funds from our subsidiaries.
 
Equity investments in subsidiaries are generally funded with parent company equity capital. As of November 2008, Group Inc.’s equity investment in subsidiaries was $51.70 billion compared with its total shareholders’ equity of $64.37 billion.
 
Our capital invested in non-U.S. subsidiaries is generally exposed to foreign exchange risk, substantially all of which is managed through a combination of derivative contracts and non-U.S. denominated debt. In addition, we generally manage the non-trading exposure to foreign exchange risk that arises from transactions denominated in currencies other than the transacting entity’s functional currency.
 
See Note 17 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for further information regarding our regulated subsidiaries.
 
Equity Capital Management
 
Our objective is to maintain a sufficient level and optimal composition of equity capital. We manage our capital through repurchases of our common stock, as permitted, and issuances of common and preferred stock, junior subordinated debt issued to trusts and other subordinated debt. We manage our capital requirements principally by setting limits on balance sheet assets and/or limits on risk, in each case at both the consolidated and business unit levels. We attribute capital usage to each of our business units based upon our regulatory capital framework and manage the levels of usage based upon the balance sheet and risk limits established.
 
Share Repurchase Program.  Subject to the limitations of the U.S. Treasury’s TARP Capital Purchase Program described below under “— Equity Capital — Equity Capital Management — Preferred Stock,” we seek to use our share repurchase program to substantially offset increases in share count over time resulting from employee share-based compensation. The repurchase program is effected primarily through regular open-market purchases, the amounts and timing of which are determined primarily by our current and projected capital positions (i.e., comparisons of our desired level of capital to our actual level of capital) but which may also be influenced by general market conditions and the prevailing price and trading volumes of our common stock, in each case subject to the limit imposed under the U.S. Treasury’s TARP Capital Purchase Program. See “— Equity Capital — Equity Capital Management — Preferred Stock” below for information regarding restrictions on our ability to repurchase common stock.
 
The following table sets forth the level of share repurchases for the years ended November 2008 and November 2007:
 
                 
    As of November
    2008   2007
    (in millions, except
    per share amounts)
Number of shares repurchased
    10.54       41.22  
Total cost
  $ 2,037     $ 8,956  
Average cost per share
  $ 193.18     $ 217.29  
 
 
As of November 2008, we were authorized to repurchase up to 60.9 million additional shares of common stock pursuant to our repurchase program. See “Market for Registrant’s Common Equity, Related Stockholder Matters and Issuer Purchases of Equity Securities” in Part II, Item 5 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for additional information on our repurchase program.
 
Stock Offerings.  In September 2008, we completed a public offering of 46.7 million shares of common stock at $123.00 per share for proceeds of $5.75 billion.


97


Table of Contents

In October 2008, we issued to Berkshire Hathaway Inc. and certain affiliates 50,000 shares of 10% Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series G (Series G Preferred Stock), and a five-year warrant to purchase up to 43.5 million shares of common stock at an exercise price of $115.00 per share, for aggregate proceeds of $5.00 billion. The allocated carrying values of the warrant and the Series G Preferred Stock on the date of issuance (based on their relative fair values) were $1.14 billion and $3.86 billion, respectively. The warrant is exercisable at any time until October 1, 2013 and the number of shares of common stock underlying the warrant and the exercise price are subject to adjustment for certain dilutive events.
 
In October 2008, under the U.S. Treasury’s TARP Capital Purchase Program, we issued to the U.S. Treasury 10.0 million shares of Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series H (Series H Preferred Stock), and a 10-year warrant to purchase up to 12.2 million shares of common stock at an exercise price of $122.90 per share, for aggregate proceeds of $10.00 billion. The allocated carrying values of the warrant and the Series H Preferred Stock on the date of issuance (based on their relative fair values) were $490 million and $9.51 billion, respectively. Cumulative dividends on the Series H Preferred Stock are payable at 5% per annum through November 14, 2013 and at a rate of 9% per annum thereafter. The Series H Preferred Stock will be accreted to the redemption price of $10.00 billion over five years. The warrant is exercisable at any time until October 28, 2018 and the number of shares of common stock underlying the warrant and the exercise price are subject to adjustment for certain dilutive events. If, on or prior to December 31, 2009, we receive aggregate gross cash proceeds of at least $10 billion from sales of Tier 1 qualifying perpetual preferred stock or common stock, the number of shares of common stock issuable upon exercise of the warrant will be reduced by one-half of the original number of shares of common stock.
 
Preferred Stock.  As of November 2008, Goldman Sachs had 10.2 million shares of perpetual preferred stock issued and outstanding as set forth in the following table:
 
Preferred Stock by Series
 
                                     
    Dividend
  Shares
  Shares
      Earliest
  Redemption Value
Series
 
Preference
 
Issued
 
Authorized
 
Dividend Rate
 
Redemption Date
 
(in millions)
A
  Non-cumulative     30,000       50,000     3 month LIBOR + 0.75%,
with floor of 3.75% per annum
  April 25, 2010   $ 750  
                                     
B
  Non-cumulative     32,000       50,000     6.20% per annum   October 31, 2010     800  
                                     
C
  Non-cumulative     8,000       25,000     3 month LIBOR + 0.75%,
with floor of 4.00% per annum
  October 31, 2010     200  
                                     
D
  Non-cumulative     54,000       60,000     3 month LIBOR + 0.67%,
with floor of 4.00% per annum
  May 24, 2011     1,350  
                                     
G
  Cumulative     50,000       50,000     10.00% per annum   Date of issuance     5,500  
                                     
H
  Cumulative     10,000,000       10,000,000     5.00% per annum through
November 14, 2013 and
9.00% per annum thereafter
  Date of issuance     10,000  
                                     
          10,174,000       10,235,000             $ 18,600  
                                     
 
 
Each share of non-cumulative preferred stock issued and outstanding has a par value of $0.01, has a liquidation preference of $25,000, is represented by 1,000 depositary shares and is redeemable at our option, subject to the approval of the Federal Reserve Board, at a redemption price equal to $25,000 plus declared and unpaid dividends.
 
Each share of Series G Preferred Stock issued and outstanding has a par value of $0.01, has a liquidation preference of $100,000 and is redeemable at our option, subject to the approval of the Federal Reserve Board, at a redemption price equal to $110,000 plus accrued and unpaid dividends.
 
Each share of Series H Preferred Stock issued and outstanding has a par value of $0.01, has a liquidation preference of $1,000 and is redeemable at our option, subject to the approval of the


98


Table of Contents

Federal Reserve Board, at a redemption price equal to $1,000 plus accrued and unpaid dividends, provided that through November 14, 2011 the Series H Preferred Stock is redeemable only in an amount up to the aggregate net cash proceeds received from sales of Tier 1 qualifying perpetual preferred stock or common stock, and only once such sales have resulted in aggregate gross proceeds of at least $2.5 billion.
 
All series of preferred stock are pari passu and have a preference over our common stock upon liquidation. Dividends on each series of preferred stock, if declared, are payable quarterly in arrears. Our ability to declare or pay dividends on, or purchase, redeem or otherwise acquire, our common stock is subject to certain restrictions in the event that we fail to pay or set aside full dividends on our preferred stock for the latest completed dividend period. In addition, pursuant to the U.S. Treasury’s TARP Capital Purchase Program, until the earliest of October 28, 2011, the redemption of all of the Series H Preferred Stock or transfer by the U.S. Treasury of all of the Series H Preferred Stock to third parties, we must obtain the consent of the U.S. Treasury to raise our common stock dividend or to repurchase any shares of common stock or other preferred stock, with certain exceptions (including repurchases of our common stock under our share repurchase program to offset dilution from equity-based compensation). For as long as the Series H Preferred Stock remains outstanding, due to the limitations pursuant to the U.S. Treasury’s TARP Capital Purchase Program, we will repurchase our common stock through our share repurchase program only for the purpose of offsetting dilution from equity-based compensation, to the extent permitted.
 
Junior Subordinated Debt Issued to Trusts in Connection with Normal Automatic Preferred Enhanced Capital Securities.  In 2007, we issued $1.75 billion of fixed rate junior subordinated debt to Goldman Sachs Capital II and $500 million of floating rate junior subordinated debt to Goldman Sachs Capital III, Delaware statutory trusts that, in turn, issued $2.25 billion of guaranteed perpetual Automatic Preferred Enhanced Capital Securities (APEX) to third parties and a de minimis amount of common securities to Goldman Sachs. The junior subordinated debt is included in “Unsecured long-term borrowings” in the consolidated statements of financial condition. In connection with the APEX issuance, we entered into stock purchase contracts with Goldman Sachs Capital II and III under which we will be obligated to sell and these entities will be obligated to purchase $2.25 billion of perpetual non-cumulative preferred stock that we will issue in the future. Goldman Sachs Capital II and III are required to remarket the junior subordinated debt in order to fund their purchase of the preferred stock, but in the event that a remarketing is unsuccessful, they will relinquish the subordinated debt to us in exchange for the preferred stock. Because of certain characteristics of the junior subordinated debt (and the associated APEX), including its long-term nature, the future issuance of perpetual non-cumulative preferred stock under the stock purchase contracts, our ability to defer payments due on the debt and the subordinated nature of the debt in our capital structure, it qualifies as Tier 1 and Total Allowable Capital and is included as part of our equity capital.
 
Junior Subordinated Debt Issued to a Trust in Connection with Trust Preferred Securities.  We issued $2.84 billion of junior subordinated debentures in 2004 to Goldman Sachs Capital I, a Delaware statutory trust that, in turn, issued $2.75 billion of guaranteed preferred beneficial interests to third parties and $85 million of common beneficial interests to Goldman Sachs. The junior subordinated debentures are included in “Unsecured long-term borrowings” in the consolidated statements of financial condition. Because of certain characteristics of the junior subordinated debt (and the associated trust preferred securities), including its long-term nature, our ability to defer coupon interest for up to ten consecutive semi-annual periods and the subordinated nature of the debt in our capital structure, it qualifies as Tier 1 and Total Allowable Capital and is included as part of our equity capital.
 
Subordinated Debt.  In addition to junior subordinated debt issued to trusts, we had other subordinated debt outstanding of $14.17 billion as of November 2008. Although not part of our shareholders’ equity, substantially all of our subordinated debt qualifies as Total Allowable Capital.


99


Table of Contents

Other Capital Ratios and Metrics
 
The following table sets forth information on our assets, shareholders’ equity, leverage ratios and book value per common share:
 
                 
    As of November
    2008   2007
    ($ in millions, except
    per share amounts)
Total assets
  $ 884,547     $ 1,119,796  
Adjusted assets (1)
    528,161       745,700  
Total shareholders’ equity
    64,369       42,800  
Tangible equity capital (2)
    64,186       42,728  
Leverage ratio (3)
    13.7 x     26.2 x
Adjusted leverage ratio (4)
    8.2 x     17.5 x
Debt to equity ratio (5)
    2.6 x     3.8 x
Common shareholders’ equity
  $ 47,898     $ 39,700  
Tangible common shareholders’ equity (6)
    42,715       34,628  
Book value per common share (7)
  $ 98.68     $ 90.43  
Tangible book value per common share (8)
    88.00       78.88  
 
 
(1) Adjusted assets excludes (i) low-risk collateralized assets generally associated with our matched book and securities lending businesses and federal funds sold, (ii) cash and securities we segregate for regulatory and other purposes and (iii) goodwill and identifiable intangible assets, excluding power contracts. We do not deduct identifiable intangible assets associated with power contracts from total assets in order to be consistent with the calculation of tangible equity capital and the adjusted leverage ratio (see footnote 2 below).
 
The following table sets forth the reconciliation of total assets to adjusted assets:
 
                     
        As of November
        2008   2007
        (in millions)
Total assets
  $ 884,547     $ 1,119,796  
Deduct:
  Securities borrowed     (180,795 )     (277,413 )
    Securities purchased under agreements to resell, at fair value and federal funds sold     (122,021 )     (87,317 )
Add:
  Trading liabilities, at fair value     175,972       215,023  
    Less derivative liabilities     (117,695 )     (99,378 )
                     
    Subtotal     58,277       115,645  
Deduct:
  Cash and securities segregated for regulatory and other purposes     (106,664 )     (119,939 )
    Goodwill and identifiable intangible assets, excluding power contracts     (5,183 )     (5,072 )
                     
Adjusted assets
  $ 528,161     $ 745,700  
                 
 
(2) Tangible equity capital equals total shareholders’ equity and junior subordinated debt issued to trusts less goodwill and identifiable intangible assets, excluding power contracts. We do not deduct identifiable intangible assets associated with power contracts from total shareholders’ equity because, unlike other intangible assets, less than 50% of these assets are supported by common shareholders’ equity. We consider junior subordinated debt issued to trusts to be a component of our tangible equity capital base due to certain characteristics of the debt, including its long-term nature, our ability to defer payments due on the debt and the subordinated nature of the debt in our capital structure.
 
The following table sets forth the reconciliation of total shareholders’ equity to tangible equity capital:
 
                     
        As of November
        2008   2007
        (in millions)
Total shareholders’ equity
  $ 64,369     $ 42,800  
Add:
  Junior subordinated debt issued to trusts     5,000       5,000  
Deduct:
  Goodwill and identifiable intangible assets, excluding power contracts     (5,183 )     (5,072 )
                     
Tangible equity capital
  $ 64,186     $ 42,728  
                 


100


Table of Contents

(3) The leverage ratio equals total assets divided by total shareholders’ equity. This ratio is different from the Tier 1 leverage ratios included in “— Equity Capital — Consolidated Capital Requirements” and “— Equity Capital — Subsidiary Capital Requirements” above.
 
(4) The adjusted leverage ratio equals adjusted assets divided by tangible equity capital. We believe that the adjusted leverage ratio is a more meaningful measure of our capital adequacy than the leverage ratio because it excludes certain low-risk collateralized assets that are generally supported with little or no capital and reflects the tangible equity capital deployed in our businesses.
 
(5) The debt to equity ratio equals unsecured long-term borrowings divided by total shareholders’ equity.
 
(6) Tangible common shareholders’ equity equals total shareholders’ equity less preferred stock, goodwill and identifiable intangible assets, excluding power contracts. We do not deduct identifiable intangible assets associated with power contracts from total shareholders’ equity because, unlike other intangible assets, less than 50% of these assets are supported by common shareholders’ equity.
 
The following table sets forth the reconciliation of total shareholders’ equity to tangible common shareholders’ equity:
 
                     
        As of November
        2008   2007
        (in millions)
Total shareholders’ equity
  $ 64,369     $ 42,800  
Deduct:
  Preferred stock     (16,471 )     (3,100 )
                     
Common shareholders’ equity
    47,898       39,700  
Deduct:
  Goodwill and identifiable intangible assets, excluding power contracts     (5,183 )     (5,072 )
                     
Tangible common shareholders’ equity
  $ 42,715     $ 34,628  
                 
 
(7) Book value per common share is based on common shares outstanding, including restricted stock units granted to employees with no future service requirements, of 485.4 million and 439.0 million as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively.
 
(8) Tangible book value per common share is computed by dividing tangible common shareholders’ equity by the number of common shares outstanding, including restricted stock units granted to employees with no future service requirements.


101


Table of Contents

 
Contractual Obligations and Commitments
 
Goldman Sachs has contractual obligations to make future payments related to our unsecured long-term borrowings, secured long-term financings, long-term noncancelable lease agreements and purchase obligations and has commitments under a variety of commercial arrangements.
 
The following table sets forth our contractual obligations by fiscal maturity date as of November 2008:
 
Contractual Obligations
(in millions)
 
                                         
        2010-
  2012-
  2014-
   
    2009   2011   2013   Thereafter   Total
Unsecured long-term borrowings (1)(2)(3)
  $     $ 25,122     $ 38,750     $ 104,348     $ 168,220  
Secured long-term financings (1)(2)(4)
          6,735       4,417       6,306       17,458  
Contractual interest payments (5)
    8,145       14,681       11,947       34,399       69,172  
Insurance liabilities (6)
    642       951       791       4,879       7,263  
Minimum rental payments
    494       800       535       1,664       3,493  
Purchase obligations
    569       132       21       21       743  
 
 
(1) Obligations maturing within one year of our financial statement date or redeemable within one year of our financial statement date at the option of the holder are excluded from this table and are treated as short-term obligations. See Note 3 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for further information regarding our secured financings.
 
(2) Obligations that are repayable prior to maturity at the option of Goldman Sachs are reflected at their contractual maturity dates. Obligations that are redeemable prior to maturity at the option of the holder are reflected at the dates such options become exercisable.
 
(3) Includes $17.45 billion accounted for at fair value under SFAS No. 155 or SFAS No. 159, primarily consisting of hybrid financial instruments and prepaid physical commodity transactions.
 
(4) These obligations are reported within “Other secured financings” in the consolidated statements of financial condition and include $7.85 billion accounted for at fair value under SFAS No. 159.
 
(5) Represents estimated future interest payments related to unsecured long-term borrowings and secured long-term financings based on applicable interest rates as of November 2008. Includes stated coupons, if any, on structured notes.
 
(6) Represents estimated undiscounted payments related to future benefits and unpaid claims arising from policies associated with our insurance activities, excluding separate accounts and estimated recoveries under reinsurance contracts.
 
 
As of November 2008, our unsecured long-term borrowings were $168.22 billion, with maturities extending to 2043, and consisted principally of senior borrowings. See Note 7 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for further information regarding our unsecured long-term borrowings.
 
As of November 2008, our future minimum rental payments, net of minimum sublease rentals, under noncancelable leases were $3.49 billion. These lease commitments, principally for office space, expire on various dates through 2069. Certain agreements are subject to periodic escalation provisions for increases in real estate taxes and other charges. See Note 8 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for further information regarding our leases.
 
Our occupancy expenses include costs associated with office space held in excess of our current requirements. This excess space, the cost of which is charged to earnings as incurred, is being held for potential growth or to replace currently occupied space that we may exit in the future. We regularly evaluate our current and future space capacity in relation to current and projected staffing levels. In 2008, we incurred exit costs of $80 million related to our office space (included in


102


Table of Contents

“Occupancy” and “Depreciation and Amortization” in the consolidated statement of earnings). We may incur exit costs in the future to the extent we (i) reduce our space capacity or (ii) commit to, or occupy, new properties in the locations in which we operate and, consequently, dispose of existing space that had been held for potential growth. These exit costs may be material to our results of operations in a given period.
 
As of November 2008, included in purchase obligations was $483 million of construction-related obligations. Our construction-related obligations include commitments of $388 million related to our new headquarters in New York City, which is expected to cost between $2.1 billion and $2.3 billion. We have partially financed this construction project with $1.65 billion of tax-exempt Liberty Bonds.
 
Due to the uncertainty of the timing and amounts that will ultimately be paid, our liability for unrecognized tax benefits has been excluded from the above contractual obligations table. See Note 16 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for further information on FIN 48.
 
The following table sets forth our commitments as of November 2008:
 
Commitments
(in millions)
 
                                         
    Commitment Amount by Fiscal Period of Expiration
        2010-
  2012-
  2014-
   
    2009   2011   2013   Thereafter   Total
Commitments to extend credit
                                       
Commercial lending:
                                       
Investment-grade
  $ 3,587     $ 2,705     $ 1,538     $ 177     $ 8,007  
Non-investment-grade
    1,188       1,767       5,708       655       9,318  
William Street program
    3,300       6,715       12,178       417       22,610  
Warehouse financing
    604       497                   1,101  
                                         
Total commitments to extend credit (1)
    8,679       11,684       19,424       1,249       41,036  
Forward starting resale and securities borrowing agreements
    61,455                         61,455  
Forward starting repurchase and securities lending agreements
    6,948                         6,948  
Commitments under letters of credit issued by banks to counterparties
    6,953       101       197             7,251  
Investment commitments
    6,398       7,144       101       623       14,266  
Underwriting commitments
    241                         241  
                                         
Total
  $ 90,674     $ 18,929     $ 19,722     $ 1,872     $ 131,197  
                                         
 
 
(1) Commitments to extend credit are net of amounts syndicated to third parties.
 
 
Our commitments to extend credit are agreements to lend to counterparties that have fixed termination dates and are contingent on the satisfaction of all conditions to borrowing set forth in the contract. In connection with our lending activities, we had outstanding commitments to extend credit of $41.04 billion as of November 2008. Since these commitments may expire unused or be reduced or cancelled at the counterparty’s request, the total commitment amount does not necessarily reflect the actual future cash flow requirements. Our commercial lending commitments are generally extended in connection with contingent acquisition financing and other types of corporate lending as well as commercial real estate financing. We may seek to reduce our credit risk on these commitments by syndicating all or substantial portions of commitments to other investors in the future. In addition,


103


Table of Contents

commitments that are extended for contingent acquisition financing are often intended to be short-term in nature, as borrowers often seek to replace them with other funding sources.
 
Included within non-investment-grade commitments as of November 2008 was $2.07 billion of exposure to leveraged lending capital market transactions, $164 million related to commercial real estate transactions and $7.09 billion arising from other unfunded credit facilities. Including funded loans, our total exposure to leveraged lending capital market transactions was $7.97 billion as of November 2008.
 
The following table sets forth our exposure to leveraged lending capital market transactions by geographic region:
 
Leveraged Lending Capital Market Exposure by Geographic Region
(in millions)
 
                         
    As of November 2008
   
Funded
 
Unfunded
 
Total
Americas (1)
  $ 3,036     $ 1,735     $ 4,771  
EMEA (2)
    2,294       259       2,553  
Asia
    568       73       641  
                         
Total
  $ 5,898     $ 2,067     $ 7,965  
                         
 
 
(1) Substantially all relates to the U.S.
 
(2) EMEA (Europe, Middle East and Africa).
 
 
Substantially all of the commitments provided under the William Street credit extension program are to investment-grade corporate borrowers. Commitments under the program are principally extended by William Street Commitment Corporation (Commitment Corp.), a consolidated wholly owned subsidiary of GS Bank USA, and also by William Street Credit Corporation, GS Bank USA or Goldman Sachs Credit Partners L.P. The commitments extended by Commitment Corp. are supported, in part, by funding raised by William Street Funding Corporation (Funding Corp.), another consolidated wholly owned subsidiary of GS Bank USA. The assets and liabilities of Commitment Corp. and Funding Corp. are legally separated from other assets and liabilities of the firm. With respect to most of the William Street commitments, SMFG provides us with credit loss protection that is generally limited to 95% of the first loss we realize on approved loan commitments, up to a maximum of $1.00 billion. In addition, subject to the satisfaction of certain conditions, upon our request, SMFG will provide protection for 70% of additional losses on such commitments, up to a maximum of $1.13 billion, of which $375 million of protection has been provided as of November 2008. We also use other financial instruments to mitigate credit risks related to certain William Street commitments not covered by SMFG.
 
Our commitments to extend credit also include financing for the warehousing of financial assets. These arrangements are secured by the warehoused assets, primarily consisting of commercial mortgages as of November 2008.
 
See Note 8 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for further information regarding our commitments, contingencies and guarantees.


104


Table of Contents

 
Risk Management
 
Management believes that effective risk management is of primary importance to the success of Goldman Sachs. Accordingly, we have a comprehensive risk management process to monitor, evaluate and manage the principal risks we assume in conducting our activities. These risks include market, credit, liquidity, operational, legal and reputational exposures.
 
Risk Management Structure
 
We seek to monitor and control our risk exposure through a variety of separate but complementary financial, credit, operational, compliance and legal reporting systems. In addition, a number of committees are responsible for monitoring risk exposures and for general oversight of our risk management process, as described further below. These committees (including their subcommittees), meet regularly and consist of senior members of both our revenue-producing units and departments that are independent of our revenue-producing units.
 
Segregation of duties and management oversight are fundamental elements of our risk management process. In addition to the committees described below, functions that are independent of the revenue-producing units, such as Compliance, Finance, Legal, Management Controls (Internal Audit) and Operations, perform risk management functions, which include monitoring, analyzing and evaluating risk.
 
Management Committee.  All risk control functions ultimately report to our Management Committee. Through both direct and delegated authority, the Management Committee approves all of our operating activities and trading risk parameters.
 
Risk Committees.  The Firmwide Risk Committee reviews the activities of existing trading businesses, approves new businesses and products, approves firmwide market risk limits, reviews business unit market risk limits, approves market risk limits for selected sovereign markets and business units, approves sovereign credit risk limits and credit risk limits by ratings group, and reviews scenario analyses based on abnormal or “catastrophic” market movements.
 
The Securities Divisional Risk Committee sets market risk limits for our trading activities subject to overall firmwide risk limits, based on a number of measures, including VaR, stress tests and scenario analyses.
 
Business unit risk limits are established by the appropriate risk committee and may be further allocated by the business unit managers to individual trading desks. Trading desk managers have the first line of responsibility for managing risk within prescribed limits. These managers have in-depth knowledge of the primary sources of risk in their respective markets and the instruments available to hedge their exposures.
 
Market risk limits are monitored by the Finance Division and are reviewed regularly by the appropriate risk committee. Limit violations are reported to the appropriate risk committee and business unit managers and addressed, as necessary. Credit risk limits are also monitored by the Finance Division and reviewed by the appropriate risk committee.
 
The Asset Management Divisional Risk Committee oversees various risk, valuation and credit issues related to our asset management business.
 
Business Practices Committee.  The Business Practices Committee assists senior management in its oversight of compliance and operational risks and related reputational concerns, seeks to ensure the consistency of our policies, practices and procedures with our Business Principles, and makes recommendations on ways to mitigate potential risks.


105


Table of Contents

Firmwide Capital Committee.  The Firmwide Capital Committee reviews and approves transactions involving commitments of our capital. Such capital commitments include, but are not limited to, extensions of credit, alternative liquidity commitments, certain bond underwritings and certain distressed debt and principal finance activities. The Firmwide Capital Committee is also responsible for establishing business and reputational standards for capital commitments and seeking to ensure that they are maintained on a global basis.
 
Commitments Committee.  The Commitments Committee reviews and approves underwriting and distribution activities, primarily with respect to offerings of equity and equity-related securities, and sets and maintains policies and procedures designed to ensure that legal, reputational, regulatory and business standards are maintained in conjunction with these activities. In addition to reviewing specific transactions, the Commitments Committee periodically conducts strategic reviews of industry sectors and products and establishes policies in connection with transaction practices.
 
Credit Policy Committee.  The Credit Policy Committee establishes and reviews broad credit policies and parameters that are implemented by the Credit Department.
 
Finance Committee.  The Finance Committee establishes and oversees our liquidity policies, sets certain inventory position limits and has oversight responsibility for liquidity risk, the size and composition of our balance sheet and capital base, and our credit ratings. The Finance Committee regularly reviews our funding position and capitalization and makes adjustments in light of current events, risks and exposures.
 
New Products Committee.  The New Products Committee, under the oversight of the Firmwide Risk Committee, is responsible for reviewing and approving new products and businesses globally.
 
Operational Risk Committee.  The Operational Risk Committee provides oversight of the ongoing development and implementation of our operational risk policies, framework and methodologies, and monitors the effectiveness of operational risk management.
 
Structured Products Committee.  The Structured Products Committee reviews and approves structured product transactions entered into with our clients that raise legal, regulatory, tax or accounting issues or present reputational risk to Goldman Sachs.
 
Market Risk
 
The potential for changes in the market value of our trading and investing positions is referred to as market risk. Such positions result from market-making, proprietary trading, underwriting, specialist and investing activities. Substantially all of our inventory positions are marked-to-market on a daily basis and changes are recorded in net revenues.
 
Categories of market risk include exposures to interest rates, equity prices, currency rates and commodity prices. A description of each market risk category is set forth below:
 
  •  Interest rate risks primarily result from exposures to changes in the level, slope and curvature of the yield curve, the volatility of interest rates, mortgage prepayment speeds and credit spreads.
 
  •  Equity price risks result from exposures to changes in prices and volatilities of individual equities, equity baskets and equity indices.
 
  •  Currency rate risks result from exposures to changes in spot prices, forward prices and volatilities of currency rates.
 
  •  Commodity price risks result from exposures to changes in spot prices, forward prices and volatilities of commodities, such as electricity, natural gas, crude oil, petroleum products, and precious and base metals.


106


Table of Contents

 
We seek to manage these risks by diversifying exposures, controlling position sizes and establishing economic hedges in related securities or derivatives. For example, we may seek to hedge a portfolio of common stocks by taking an offsetting position in a related equity-index futures contract. The ability to manage an exposure may, however, be limited by adverse changes in the liquidity of the security or the related hedge instrument and in the correlation of price movements between the security and related hedge instrument.
 
In addition to applying business judgment, senior management uses a number of quantitative tools to manage our exposure to market risk for “Trading assets, at fair value” and “Trading liabilities, at fair value” in the consolidated statements of financial condition. These tools include:
 
  •  risk limits based on a summary measure of market risk exposure referred to as VaR;
 
  •  scenario analyses, stress tests and other analytical tools that measure the potential effects on our trading net revenues of various market events, including, but not limited to, a large widening of credit spreads, a substantial decline in equity markets and significant moves in selected emerging markets; and
 
  •  inventory position limits for selected business units.
 
VaR
 
VaR is the potential loss in value of trading positions due to adverse market movements over a defined time horizon with a specified confidence level.
 
For the VaR numbers reported below, a one-day time horizon and a 95% confidence level were used. This means that there is a 1 in 20 chance that daily trading net revenues will fall below the expected daily trading net revenues by an amount at least as large as the reported VaR. Thus, shortfalls from expected trading net revenues on a single trading day greater than the reported VaR would be anticipated to occur, on average, about once a month. Shortfalls on a single day can exceed reported VaR by significant amounts. Shortfalls can also occur more frequently or accumulate over a longer time horizon such as a number of consecutive trading days.
 
The modeling of the risk characteristics of our trading positions involves a number of assumptions and approximations. While we believe that these assumptions and approximations are reasonable, there is no standard methodology for estimating VaR, and different assumptions and/or approximations could produce materially different VaR estimates.
 
We use historical data to estimate our VaR and, to better reflect current asset volatilities, we generally weight historical data to give greater importance to more recent observations. Given its reliance on historical data, VaR is most effective in estimating risk exposures in markets in which there are no sudden fundamental changes or shifts in market conditions. An inherent limitation of VaR is that the distribution of past changes in market risk factors may not produce accurate predictions of future market risk. Different VaR methodologies and distributional assumptions could produce a materially different VaR. Moreover, VaR calculated for a one-day time horizon does not fully capture the market risk of positions that cannot be liquidated or offset with hedges within one day.


107


Table of Contents

The following tables set forth the daily VaR:
 
Average Daily VaR (1)
(in millions)
 
                         
    Year Ended November
Risk Categories
  2008   2007   2006
Interest rates
  $ 142     $ 85     $ 49  
Equity prices
    72       100       72  
Currency rates
    30       23       21  
Commodity prices
    44       26       30  
Diversification effect (2)
    (108 )     (96 )     (71 )
                         
Total
  $ 180     $ 138     $ 101  
                         
 
 
(1) Certain portfolios and individual positions are not included in VaR, where VaR is not the most appropriate measure of risk (e.g., due to transfer restrictions and/or illiquidity). See “— Other Market Risk Measures” below.
 
(2) Equals the difference between total VaR and the sum of the VaRs for the four risk categories. This effect arises because the four market risk categories are not perfectly correlated.
 
 
Our average daily VaR increased to $180 million in 2008 from $138 million in 2007, principally due to increases in the interest rate, commodity price and currency rate categories, partially offset by a decrease in the equity price category. The increase in interest rates was primarily due to higher levels of volatility and wider spreads, partially offset by position reductions, and the increases in commodity prices and currency rates were primarily due to higher levels of volatility. The decrease in equity prices was principally due to position reductions, partially offset by higher levels of volatility.
 
Our average daily VaR increased to $138 million in 2007 from $101 million in 2006. The increase was primarily due to higher levels of exposure and volatility in interest rates and equity prices.
 
VaR excludes the impact of changes in counterparty and our own credit spreads on derivatives as well as changes in our own credit spreads on unsecured borrowings for which the fair value option was elected. The estimated sensitivity of our net revenues to a one basis point increase in credit spreads (counterparty and our own) on derivatives was $1 million as of November 2008. In addition, the estimated sensitivity of our net revenues to a one basis point increase in our own credit spreads on unsecured borrowings for which the fair value option was elected was $1 million (including hedges) as of November 2008.
 
Daily VaR (1)
(in millions)
 
                                 
        Year Ended
    As of November   November 2008
Risk Categories
  2008   2007   High   Low
Interest rates
  $ 228     $ 105     $ 228     $ 93  
Equity prices
    38       82       234       36  
Currency rates
    36       35       55       17  
Commodity prices
    33       33       68       25  
Diversification effect (2)
    (91 )     (121 )                
                                 
Total
  $ 244     $ 134     $ 246     $ 129  
                                 
 
 
(1) Certain portfolios and individual positions are not included in VaR, where VaR is not the most appropriate measure of risk (e.g., due to transfer restrictions and/or illiquidity). See “— Other Market Risk Measures” below.
 
(2) Equals the difference between total VaR and the sum of the VaRs for the four risk categories. This effect arises because the four market risk categories are not perfectly correlated.


108


Table of Contents

Our daily VaR increased to $244 million as of November 2008 from $134 million as of November 2007, primarily due to an increase in the interest rate category and a reduction in the diversification benefit across risk categories, partially offset by a decrease in the equity price category. The increase in interest rates was principally due to higher levels of volatility and wider spreads, partially offset by position reductions. The decrease in equity prices was primarily due to position reductions, partially offset by higher levels of volatility.
 
The following chart presents our daily VaR during 2008:
 
Daily VaR
($ in millions)
 


109


Table of Contents

Trading Net Revenues Distribution
 
The following chart sets forth the frequency distribution of our daily trading net revenues for substantially all inventory positions included in VaR for the year ended November 2008:
 
Daily Trading Net Revenues
($ in millions)
 
 
 
As part of our overall risk control process, daily trading net revenues are compared with VaR calculated as of the end of the prior business day. Trading losses incurred on a single day exceeded our 95% one-day VaR on 13 and 10 occasions during 2008 and 2007, respectively.
 
Other Market Risk Measures
 
Certain portfolios and individual positions are not included in VaR, where VaR is not the most appropriate measure of risk (e.g., due to transfer restrictions and/or illiquidity). The market risk related to our investment in the ordinary shares of ICBC, excluding interests held by investment funds managed by Goldman Sachs, is measured by estimating the potential reduction in net revenues associated with a 10% decline in the ICBC ordinary share price. The market risk related to the remaining positions is measured by estimating the potential reduction in net revenues associated with a 10% decline in asset values.
 
The sensitivity analyses for equity and debt positions in our trading portfolio and equity, debt (primarily mezzanine instruments) and real estate positions in our non-trading portfolio are measured by the impact of a decline in the asset values (including the impact of leverage in the underlying investments for real estate positions in our non-trading portfolio) of such positions. The fair value of the underlying positions may be impacted by factors such as transactions in similar instruments, completed or pending third-party transactions in the underlying investment or comparable entities, subsequent rounds of financing, recapitalizations and other transactions across the capital structure, offerings in the equity or debt capital markets, and changes in financial ratios or cash flows.


110


Table of Contents

The following table sets forth market risk for positions not included in VaR. These measures do not reflect diversification benefits across asset categories and, given the differing likelihood of the potential declines in asset categories, these measures have not been aggregated:
 
                     
        10% Sensitivity
        Amount as of November
Asset Categories
 
10% Sensitivity Measure
  2008   2007
        (in millions)
 
Trading Risk (1)
                   
Equity (2)
  Underlying asset value   $ 790     $ 1,325  
Debt (3)
  Underlying asset value     808       1,020  
                     
Non-trading Risk
                   
ICBC
  ICBC ordinary share price     202       250  
Other Equity (4)
  Underlying asset value     1,155       1,054  
Debt (5)
  Underlying asset value     694       500  
Real Estate (6)
  Underlying asset value     1,330       1,108  
 
 
(1) In addition to the positions in these portfolios, which are accounted for at fair value, we make investments accounted for under the equity method and we also make direct investments in real estate, both of which are included in “Other assets” in the consolidated statements of financial condition. Direct investments in real estate are accounted for at cost less accumulated depreciation. See Note 12 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for information on “Other assets.”
 
(2) Relates to private and restricted public equity securities held within the FICC and Equities components of our Trading and Principal Investments segment.
 
(3) Relates to acquired portfolios of distressed loans (primarily backed by commercial and residential real estate collateral), bank loans and bridge loans, and loans backed by commercial real estate and held within the FICC component of our Trading and Principal Investments segment.
 
(4) Primarily relates to interests in our merchant banking funds that invest in corporate equities.
 
(5) Primarily relates to interests in our merchant banking funds that invest in corporate mezzanine debt instruments.
 
(6) Primarily relates to interests in our merchant banking funds that invest in real estate. Such funds typically employ leverage as part of the investment strategy. This sensitivity measure is based on our percentage ownership of the underlying asset values in the funds and unfunded commitments to the funds.
 
 
The decrease in our 10% sensitivity measures as of November 2008 from November 2007 for equity and debt positions in our trading portfolio was due to dispositions and a decrease in the fair value of the portfolio, partially offset by new investments. The increase in our 10% sensitivity measures as of November 2008 from November 2007 for our non-trading portfolio (excluding ICBC) was due to new investments, partially offset by a decrease in the fair value of the portfolio.
 
In addition to the positions included in VaR and the other risk measures described above, as of November 2008, we held approximately $10.39 billion of financial instruments in our bank and insurance subsidiaries, primarily consisting of $3.08 billion of U.S. government, federal agency and sovereign obligations, $2.87 billion of corporate debt securities and other debt obligations, $2.86 billion of money market instruments, and $1.22 billion of mortgage and other asset-backed loans and securities. As of November 2007, we held approximately $10.58 billion of financial instruments in our bank and insurance subsidiaries, primarily consisting of $4.70 billion of mortgage and other asset-backed loans and securities, $2.93 billion of corporate debt securities and other debt obligations and $2.77 billion of U.S. government, federal agency and sovereign obligations. In addition, as of November 2008 and November 2007, we held commitments and loans under the William Street credit extension program. See “— Contractual Obligations and Commitments — Commitments” above for information on our William Street program.


111


Table of Contents

 
Credit Risk
 
Credit risk represents the loss that we would incur if a counterparty or an issuer of securities or other instruments we hold fails to perform under its contractual obligations to us, or upon a deterioration in the credit quality of third parties whose securities or other instruments, including OTC derivatives, we hold. Our exposure to credit risk principally arises through our trading, investing and financing activities. To reduce our credit exposures, we seek to enter into netting agreements with counterparties that permit us to offset receivables and payables with such counterparties. In addition, we attempt to further reduce credit risk with certain counterparties by (i) entering into agreements that enable us to obtain collateral from a counterparty on an upfront or contingent basis, (ii) seeking third-party guarantees of the counterparty’s obligations, and/or (iii) transferring our credit risk to third parties using credit derivatives and/or other structures and techniques.
 
To measure and manage our credit exposures, we use a variety of tools, including credit limits referenced to both current exposure and potential exposure. Potential exposure is an estimate of exposure, within a specified confidence level, that could be outstanding over the life of a transaction based on market movements. In addition, as part of our market risk management process, for positions measured by changes in credit spreads, we use VaR and other sensitivity measures. To supplement our primary credit exposure measures, we also use scenario analyses, such as credit spread widening scenarios, stress tests and other quantitative tools.
 
Our global credit management systems monitor credit exposure to individual counterparties and on an aggregate basis to counterparties and their affiliates. These systems also provide management, including the Firmwide Risk and Credit Policy Committees, with information regarding credit risk by product, industry sector, country and region.
 
While our activities expose us to many different industries and counterparties, we routinely execute a high volume of transactions with counterparties in the financial services industry, including brokers and dealers, commercial banks and investment funds, resulting in significant credit concentration with respect to this industry. In the ordinary course of business, we may also be subject to a concentration of credit risk to a particular counterparty, borrower or issuer.
 
As of November 2008 and November 2007, we held $53.98 billion (6% of total assets) and $45.75 billion (4% of total assets), respectively, of U.S. government and federal agency obligations included in “Trading assets, at fair value” and “Cash and securities segregated for regulatory and other purposes” in the consolidated statements of financial condition. As of November 2008 and November 2007, we held $21.13 billion (2% of total assets) and $31.65 billion (3% of total assets), respectively, of other sovereign obligations, principally consisting of securities issued by the governments of Japan and the United Kingdom. In addition, as of November 2008 and November 2007, $126.27 billion and $144.92 billion of our securities purchased under agreements to resell and securities borrowed (including those in “Cash and securities segregated for regulatory and other purposes”), respectively, were collateralized by U.S. government and federal agency obligations. As of November 2008 and November 2007, $65.37 billion and $41.26 billion of our securities purchased under agreements to resell and securities borrowed, respectively, were collateralized by other sovereign obligations. As of November 2008 and November 2007, we did not have credit exposure to any other counterparty that exceeded 2% of our total assets. However, over the past several years, the amount and duration of our credit exposures with respect to OTC derivatives has been increasing, due to, among other factors, the growth of our OTC derivative activities and market evolution toward longer-dated transactions. A further discussion of our derivative activities follows below.


112


Table of Contents

 
Derivatives
 
Derivative contracts are instruments, such as futures, forwards, swaps or option contracts, that derive their value from underlying assets, indices, reference rates or a combination of these factors. Derivative instruments may be privately negotiated contracts, which are often referred to as OTC derivatives, or they may be listed and traded on an exchange.
 
Substantially all of our derivative transactions are entered into to facilitate client transactions, to take proprietary positions or as a means of risk management. In addition to derivative transactions entered into for trading purposes, we enter into derivative contracts to manage currency exposure on our net investment in non-U.S. operations and to manage the interest rate and currency exposure on our long-term borrowings and certain short-term borrowings.
 
Derivatives are used in many of our businesses, and we believe that the associated market risk can only be understood relative to all of the underlying assets or risks being hedged, or as part of a broader trading strategy. Accordingly, the market risk of derivative positions is managed together with our nonderivative positions.
 
The fair value of our derivative contracts is reflected net of cash paid or received pursuant to credit support agreements and is reported on a net-by-counterparty basis in our consolidated statements of financial condition when we believe a legal right of setoff exists under an enforceable netting agreement. For an OTC derivative, our credit exposure is directly with our counterparty and continues until the maturity or termination of such contract.


113


Table of Contents

The following tables set forth the fair values of our OTC derivative assets and liabilities by product and by remaining contractual maturity:
 
OTC Derivatives
(in millions)
 
                                         
Assets   As of November 2008
    0-12
  1 - 5
  5 - 10
  10 Years
   
Contract Type
 
Months
 
Years
 
Years
 
or Greater
 
Total
 
Interest rates
  $ 16,220     $ 43,864     $ 35,050     $ 40,649     $ 135,783  
Credit derivatives
    10,364       45,596       20,110       13,788       89,858  
Currencies
    28,056       12,191       5,980       4,137       50,364  
Commodities
    13,660       12,717       1,175       1,681       29,233  
Equities
    17,830       4,742       3,927       1,061       27,560  
Netting across contract types (1)
    (6,238 )     (9,160 )     (3,515 )     (3,802 )     (22,715 )
                                         
Subtotal
  $ 79,892  (4)   $ 109,950     $ 62,727     $ 57,514     $ 310,083  
                                         
Cross maturity netting (2)
                                    (48,750 )
Cash collateral netting (3)
                                    (137,160 )
                                         
Total
                                  $ 124,173  
                                         
                                         
                                         
Liabilities                    
    0-12
  1 - 5
  5 - 10
  10 Years
   
Contract Type
 
Months
 
Years
 
Years
 
or Greater
 
Total
 
Interest rates
  $ 8,004     $ 16,152     $ 17,456     $ 26,399     $ 68,011  
Credit derivatives
    6,591       20,958       10,301       13,610       51,460  
Currencies
    29,130       13,755       4,109       2,051       49,045  
Commodities
    12,685       10,391       1,575       827       25,478  
Equities
    14,016       4,741       1,751       320       20,828  
Netting across contract types (1)
    (6,238 )     (9,160 )     (3,515 )     (3,802 )     (22,715 )
                                         
Subtotal
  $ 64,188  (4)   $ 56,837     $ 31,677     $ 39,405     $ 192,107  
                                         
Cross maturity netting (2)
                                    (48,750 )
Cash collateral netting (3)
                                    (34,009 )
                                         
Total
                                  $ 109,348  
                                         
 
 
(1) Represents the netting of receivable balances with payable balances for the same counterparty across contract types within a maturity category, pursuant to credit support agreements.
 
(2) Represents the netting of receivable balances with payable balances for the same counterparty across maturity categories, pursuant to credit support agreements.
 
(3) Represents the netting of cash collateral received and posted on a counterparty basis pursuant to credit support agreements.
 
(4) Includes fair values of OTC derivative assets and liabilities, maturing within six months, of $56.72 billion and $51.26 billion, respectively.


114


Table of Contents

OTC Derivatives
(in millions)
 
                                         
Assets   As of November 2007
    0-12
  1 - 5
  5 - 10
  10 Years
   
Contract Type
 
Months
 
Years
 
Years
 
or Greater
 
Total
 
Interest rates
  $ 8,703     $ 10,965     $ 17,176     $ 28,388     $ 65,232  
Credit derivatives
    11,168       13,006       6,501       20,163       50,838  
Currencies
    20,586       9,275       5,106       2,127       37,094  
Commodities
    6,264       12,064       1,766       899       20,993  
Equities
    13,845       5,312       4,273       1,603       25,033  
Netting across contract types (1)
    (3,355 )     (5,665 )     (3,132 )     (2,066 )     (14,218 )
                                         
Subtotal
  $ 57,211  (4)   $ 44,957     $ 31,690     $ 51,114     $ 184,972  
                                         
Cross maturity netting (2)
                                    (33,849 )
Cash collateral netting (3)
                                    (59,050 )
                                         
Total
                                  $ 92,073  
                                         
                                         
                                         
Liabilities                    
    0-12
  1 - 5
  5 - 10
  10 Years
   
Contract Type
 
Months
 
Years
 
Years
 
or Greater
 
Total
 
Interest rates
  $ 10,234     $ 10,802     $ 9,816     $ 10,287     $ 41,139  
Credit derivatives
    7,085       11,842       5,084       16,077       40,088  
Currencies
    16,560       9,815       1,446       1,772       29,593  
Commodities
    8,752       9,690       2,757       506       21,705  
Equities
    17,460       7,723       3,833       1,382       30,398  
Netting across contract types (1)
    (3,355 )     (5,665 )     (3,132 )     (2,066 )     (14,218 )
                                         
Subtotal
  $ 56,736  (4)   $ 44,207     $ 19,804     $ 27,958     $ 148,705  
                                         
Cross maturity netting (2)
                                    (33,849 )
Cash collateral netting (3)
                                    (27,758 )
                                         
Total
                                  $ 87,098  
                                         
 
 
(1) Represents the netting of receivable balances with payable balances for the same counterparty across contract types within a maturity category, pursuant to credit support agreements.
 
(2) Represents the netting of receivable balances with payable balances for the same counterparty across maturity categories, pursuant to credit support agreements.
 
(3) Represents the netting of cash collateral received and posted on a counterparty basis pursuant to credit support agreements.
 
(4) Includes fair values of OTC derivative assets and liabilities, maturing within six months, of $41.80 billion and $41.12 billion, respectively.
 
 
In the tables above, for option contracts that require settlement by delivery of an underlying derivative instrument, the remaining contractual maturity is generally classified based upon the maturity date of the underlying derivative instrument. In those instances where the underlying instrument does not have a maturity date or either counterparty has the right to settle in cash, the remaining contractual maturity is generally based upon the option expiration date.


115


Table of Contents

The following tables set forth the distribution, by credit rating, of our exposure with respect to OTC derivatives by remaining contractual maturity, both before and after consideration of the effect of collateral and netting agreements. The categories shown reflect our internally determined public rating agency equivalents:
 
OTC Derivative Credit Exposure
(in millions)
 
                                                                 
    As of November 2008
                                Exposure
Credit Rating
  0-12
  1 - 5
  5 - 10
  10 Years
              Net of
Equivalent
 
Months
 
Years
 
Years
 
or Greater
 
Total
 
Netting (2)
 
Exposure
 
Collateral
 
AAA/Aaa
  $ 5,700     $ 7,000     $ 4,755     $ 2,726     $ 20,181     $ (6,765 )   $ 13,416     $ 12,328  
AA/Aa2
    26,040       37,378       30,293       18,084       111,795       (78,085 )     33,710       29,438  
A/A2
    22,374       34,796       15,317       20,498       92,985       (58,744 )     34,241       28,643  
BBB/Baa2
    11,844       19,200       7,635       13,302       51,981       (29,791 )     22,190       16,155  
BB/Ba2 or lower
    13,161       10,403       4,035       2,711       30,310       (12,515 )     17,795       11,212  
Unrated
    773       1,173       692       193       2,831       (10 )     2,821       1,550  
                                                                 
Total
  $ 79,892  (1)   $ 109,950     $ 62,727     $ 57,514     $ 310,083     $ (185,910 )   $ 124,173     $ 99,326  
                                                                 
                                                                 
                                                                 
    As of November 2007
                                Exposure
Credit Rating
  0-12
  1 - 5
  5 - 10
  10 Years
              Net of
Equivalent
 
Months
 
Years
 
Years
 
or Greater
 
Total
 
Netting (2)
 
Exposure
 
Collateral
 
AAA/Aaa
  $ 6,018     $ 3,354     $ 2,893     $ 7,875     $ 20,140     $ (3,600 )   $ 16,540     $ 14,453  
AA/Aa2
    19,331       14,339       13,184       22,708       69,562       (40,661 )     28,901       24,758  
A/A2
    14,491       13,380       10,012       15,133       53,016       (32,453 )     20,563       16,010  
BBB/Baa2
    4,059       5,774       1,707       2,777       14,317       (4,437 )     9,880       6,542  
BB/Ba2 or lower
    6,854       5,676       3,347       2,541       18,418       (4,834 )     13,584       7,366  
Unrated
    6,458       2,434       547       80       9,519       (6,914 )     2,605       1,280  
                                                                 
Total
  $ 57,211  (1)   $ 44,957     $ 31,690     $ 51,114     $ 184,972     $ (92,899 )   $ 92,073     $ 70,409  
                                                                 
 
 
(1)  Includes fair values of OTC derivative assets, maturing within six months, of $56.72 billion and $41.80 billion as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively.
 
(2)  Represents the netting of receivable balances with payable balances for the same counterparty across maturity categories and the netting of cash collateral received, pursuant to credit support agreements. Receivable and payable balances with the same counterparty in the same maturity category are netted within such maturity category, where appropriate.
 
 
Derivative transactions may also involve legal risks including the risk that they are not authorized or appropriate for a counterparty, that documentation has not been properly executed or that executed agreements may not be enforceable against the counterparty. We attempt to minimize these risks by obtaining advice of counsel on the enforceability of agreements as well as on the authority of a counterparty to effect the derivative transaction. In addition, certain derivative transactions (e.g., credit derivative contracts) involve the risk that we may have difficulty obtaining, or be unable to obtain, the underlying security or obligation in order to satisfy any physical settlement requirement.


116


Table of Contents

 
Liquidity and Funding Risk
 
Liquidity is of critical importance to companies in the financial services sector. Most failures of financial institutions have occurred in large part due to insufficient liquidity resulting from adverse circumstances. Accordingly, Goldman Sachs has in place a comprehensive set of liquidity and funding policies that are intended to maintain significant flexibility to address both Goldman Sachs-specific and broader industry or market liquidity events. Our principal objective is to be able to fund Goldman Sachs and to enable our core businesses to continue to generate revenues, even under adverse circumstances.
 
We have implemented a number of policies according to the following liquidity risk management framework:
 
  •  Excess Liquidity — We maintain substantial excess liquidity to meet a broad range of potential cash outflows in a stressed environment, including financing obligations.
 
  •  Asset-Liability Management — We seek to maintain secured and unsecured funding sources that are sufficiently long-term in order to withstand a prolonged or severe liquidity-stressed environment without having to rely on asset sales.
 
  •  Conservative Liability Structure — We seek to access funding across a diverse range of markets, products and counterparties, emphasize less credit-sensitive sources of funding and conservatively manage the distribution of funding across our entity structure.
 
  •  Crisis Planning — We base our liquidity and funding management on stress-scenario planning and maintain a crisis plan detailing our response to a liquidity-threatening event.
 
Excess Liquidity
 
Our most important liquidity policy is to pre-fund what we estimate will be our likely cash needs during a liquidity crisis and hold such excess liquidity in the form of unencumbered, highly liquid securities that may be sold or pledged to provide same-day liquidity. This “Global Core Excess” is intended to allow us to meet immediate obligations without needing to sell other assets or depend on additional funding from credit-sensitive markets. We believe that this pool of excess liquidity provides us with a resilient source of funds and gives us significant flexibility in managing through a difficult funding environment. Our Global Core Excess reflects the following principles:
 
  •  The first days or weeks of a liquidity crisis are the most critical to a company’s survival.
 
  •  Focus must be maintained on all potential cash and collateral outflows, not just disruptions to financing flows. Goldman Sachs’ businesses are diverse, and its cash needs are driven by many factors, including market movements, collateral requirements and client commitments, all of which can change dramatically in a difficult funding environment.
 
  •  During a liquidity crisis, credit-sensitive funding, including unsecured debt and some types of secured financing agreements, may be unavailable, and the terms or availability of other types of secured financing may change.
 
  •  As a result of our policy to pre-fund liquidity that we estimate may be needed in a crisis, we hold more unencumbered securities and have larger unsecured debt balances than our businesses would otherwise require. We believe that our liquidity is stronger with greater balances of highly liquid unencumbered securities, even though it increases our unsecured liabilities and our funding costs.


117


Table of Contents

 
The size of our Global Core Excess is based on an internal liquidity model together with a qualitative assessment of the condition of the financial markets and of Goldman Sachs. Our liquidity model identifies and estimates cash and collateral outflows over a short-term horizon in a liquidity crisis, including, but not limited to:
 
  •  upcoming maturities of unsecured debt and letters of credit;
 
  •  potential buybacks of a portion of our outstanding negotiable unsecured debt and potential withdrawals of client deposits;
 
  •  adverse changes in the terms or availability of secured funding;
 
  •  derivatives and other margin and collateral outflows, including those due to market moves;
 
  •  potential cash outflows associated with our prime brokerage business;
 
  •  additional collateral that could be called in the event of a two-notch downgrade in our credit ratings;
 
  •  draws on our unfunded commitments not supported by William Street Funding Corporation (1); and
 
  •  upcoming cash outflows, such as tax and other large payments.
 
The following table sets forth the average loan value (the estimated amount of cash that would be advanced by counterparties against these securities), as well as overnight cash deposits, of our Global Core Excess:
 
                 
    Year Ended November
    2008   2007 
    (in millions)
U.S. dollar-denominated
  $ 78,048     $ 52,115  
Non-U.S. dollar-denominated
    18,677       11,928  
                 
Total Global Core Excess (2)
  $ 96,725     $ 64,043  
                 
 
 
The U.S. dollar-denominated excess is comprised of only unencumbered U.S. government securities, U.S. agency securities and highly liquid U.S. agency mortgage-backed securities, all of which are eligible as collateral in Federal Reserve open market operations, as well as overnight cash deposits. Our non-U.S. dollar-denominated excess is comprised of only unencumbered French, German, United Kingdom and Japanese government bonds and overnight cash deposits in highly liquid currencies. We strictly limit our Global Core Excess to this narrowly defined list of securities and cash because we believe they are highly liquid, even in a difficult funding environment. We do not believe other potential sources of excess liquidity, such as lower-quality unencumbered securities or committed credit facilities, are as reliable in a liquidity crisis.
 
We maintain our Global Core Excess to enable us to meet current and potential liquidity requirements of our parent company, Group Inc., and all of its subsidiaries. The amount of our Global Core Excess is driven by our assessment of potential cash and collateral outflows, regulatory obligations and the currency and timing requirements of our global business model. In addition, we recognize that our Global Core Excess held in a regulated entity may not be available to our parent company or other subsidiaries and therefore may only be available to meet the potential liquidity requirements of that entity.
 
 
(1) The Global Core Excess excludes liquid assets of $4.40 billion held separately by William Street Funding Corporation. See “— Contractual Obligations and Commitments” above for a further discussion of the William Street credit extension program.
(2) Beginning in 2008, our Global Core Excess as presented includes the Global Core Excess of GS Bank USA and GS Bank Europe. The 2007 amounts include $3.48 billion of Global Core Excess at GS Bank USA.


118


Table of Contents

In addition to our Global Core Excess, we have a significant amount of other unencumbered securities as a result of our business activities. These assets, which are located in the U. S., Europe and Asia, include other government bonds, high-grade money market securities, corporate bonds and marginable equities. We do not include these securities in our Global Core Excess.
 
We maintain our Global Core Excess and other unencumbered assets in an amount that, if pledged or sold, would provide the funds necessary to replace at least 110% of our unsecured obligations that are scheduled to mature (or where holders have the option to redeem) within the next 12 months. We assume conservative loan values that are based on stress-scenario borrowing capacity and we regularly review these assumptions asset class by asset class. The estimated aggregate loan value of our Global Core Excess, as well as overnight cash deposits, and our other unencumbered assets averaged $163.41 billion and $156.74 billion for the fiscal years ended November 2008 and November 2007, respectively.
 
Asset-Liability Management
 
We seek to maintain a highly liquid balance sheet and substantially all of our inventory is marked-to-market daily. We utilize aged inventory limits for certain financial instruments as a disincentive to our businesses to hold inventory over longer periods of time. We believe that these limits provide a complementary mechanism for ensuring appropriate balance sheet liquidity in addition to our standard position limits. Although our balance sheet fluctuates due to client activity, market conventions and periodic market opportunities in certain of our businesses, our total assets and adjusted assets at financial statement dates are typically not materially different from those occurring within our reporting periods.
 
We seek to manage the maturity profile of our secured and unsecured funding base such that we should be able to liquidate our assets prior to our liabilities coming due, even in times of prolonged or severe liquidity stress. We do not rely on immediate sales of assets (other than our Global Core Excess) to maintain liquidity in a distressed environment, although we recognize orderly asset sales may be prudent or necessary in a severe or persistent liquidity crisis.
 
In order to avoid reliance on asset sales, our goal is to ensure that we have sufficient total capital (unsecured long-term borrowings plus total shareholders’ equity) to fund our balance sheet for at least one year. The target amount of our total capital is based on an internal liquidity model, which incorporates, among other things, the following long-term financing requirements:
 
  •  the portion of trading assets that we believe could not be funded on a secured basis in periods of market stress, assuming conservative loan values;
 
  •  goodwill and identifiable intangible assets, property, leasehold improvements and equipment, and other illiquid assets;
 
  •  derivative and other margin and collateral requirements;
 
  •  anticipated draws on our unfunded loan commitments; and
 
  •  capital or other forms of financing in our regulated subsidiaries that are in excess of their long-term financing requirements. See “— Conservative Liability Structure” below for a further discussion of how we fund our subsidiaries.


119


Table of Contents

 
Certain financial instruments may be more difficult to fund on a secured basis during times of market stress. Accordingly, we generally hold higher levels of total capital for these assets than more liquid types of financial instruments. The following table sets forth our aggregate holdings in these categories of financial instruments:
 
                 
    As of November
    2008   2007
    (in millions)
Mortgage and other asset-backed loans and securities
  $ 22,393     $ 46,436  (6)
Bank loans and bridge loans (1)
    21,839       49,154  
Emerging market debt securities
    2,827       3,343  
High-yield and other debt obligations
    9,998       12,807  
Private equity and real estate fund investments (2)
    18,171       16,244  
Emerging market equity securities
    2,665       8,014  
ICBC ordinary shares (3)
    5,496       6,807  
SMFG convertible preferred stock (4)
    1,135       4,060  
Other restricted public equity securities
    568       3,455  
Other investments in funds (5)
    2,714       3,437  
 
 
(1) Includes funded commitments and inventory held in connection with our origination and secondary trading activities.
 
(2) Includes interests in our merchant banking funds. Such amounts exclude assets related to consolidated investment funds of $1.16 billion and $8.13 billion as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively, for which Goldman Sachs does not bear economic exposure.
 
(3) Includes interests of $3.48 billion and $4.30 billion as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively, held by investment funds managed by Goldman Sachs.
 
(4) During our second quarter of 2008, we converted one-third of our SMFG preferred stock investment into SMFG common stock, and delivered the common stock to close out one-third of our hedge position.
 
 
(5) Includes interests in other investment funds that we manage.
 
(6) Excludes $7.64 billion as of November 2007 of mortgage whole loans that were transferred to securitization vehicles where such transfers were accounted for as secured financings rather than sales under SFAS No. 140. We distributed to investors the securities that were issued by the securitization vehicles and therefore did not bear economic exposure to the underlying mortgage whole loans.
 
 
A large portion of these assets are funded through secured funding markets or nonrecourse financing. We focus on funding these assets on a secured basis with long contractual maturities to reduce refinancing risk in periods of market stress.
 
See Note 3 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for further information regarding the financial instruments we hold.
 
Conservative Liability Structure
 
We seek to structure our liabilities conservatively to reduce refinancing risk and the risk that we may be required to redeem or repurchase certain of our borrowings prior to their contractual maturity.
 
We fund a substantial portion of our inventory on a secured basis, which we believe provides Goldman Sachs with a more stable source of liquidity than unsecured financing, as it is less sensitive to changes in our credit due to the underlying collateral. However, we recognize that the terms or availability of secured funding, particularly overnight funding, can deteriorate rapidly in a difficult environment. To help mitigate this risk, we raise the majority of our funding for durations longer than overnight. We seek longer terms for secured funding collateralized by lower-quality assets, as we believe these funding transactions may pose greater refinancing risk. The weighted average life of our secured funding, excluding funding collateralized by highly liquid securities, such as U.S., French, German, United Kingdom and Japanese government bonds, and U.S. agency securities, exceeded 100 days as of November 2008.


120


Table of Contents

Our liquidity also depends to an important degree on the stability of our short-term unsecured financing base. Accordingly, we prefer the use of promissory notes (in which Goldman Sachs does not make a market) over commercial paper, which we may repurchase prior to maturity through the ordinary course of business as a market maker. As of November 2008 and November 2007, our unsecured short-term borrowings, including the current portion of unsecured long-term borrowings, were $52.66 billion and $71.56 billion, respectively. See Note 6 to the consolidated financial statements in Part II, Item 8 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for further information regarding our unsecured short-term borrowings.
 
We issue long-term borrowings as a source of total capital in order to meet our long-term financing requirements. The following table sets forth our quarterly unsecured long-term borrowings maturity profile through 2014:
 
Unsecured Long-Term Borrowings Maturity Profile
($ in millions)
 
 
 
The weighted average maturity of our unsecured long-term borrowings as of November 2008 was approximately eight years. To mitigate refinancing risk, we seek to limit the principal amount of debt maturing on any one day or during any week or year. We swap a substantial portion of our long-term borrowings into U.S. dollar obligations with short-term floating interest rates in order to minimize our exposure to interest rates and foreign exchange movements.
 
We issue substantially all of our unsecured debt without provisions that would, based solely upon an adverse change in our credit ratings, financial ratios, earnings, cash flows or stock price, trigger a requirement for an early payment, collateral support, change in terms, acceleration of maturity or the creation of an additional financial obligation.
 
As of November 2008, our bank depository institution subsidiaries had $27.64 billion in customer deposits, including $19.15 billion of deposits from our bank sweep programs and $8.49 billion of brokered certificates of deposit with a weighted average maturity of three years. In addition, we are pursuing a number of strategies to raise additional deposits as a source of funding for the firm. As of


121


Table of Contents

September 2008, GS Bank USA has access to funding through the Federal Reserve Bank discount window. While we do not rely on funding through the Federal Reserve Bank discount window in our liquidity modeling and stress testing, we maintain policies and procedures necessary to access this funding.
 
We seek to maintain broad and diversified funding sources globally for both secured and unsecured funding. We make extensive use of the repurchase agreement and securities lending markets, as well as other secured funding markets. In addition, we issue debt through syndicated U.S. registered offerings, U.S. registered and 144A medium-term note programs, offshore medium-term note offerings and other bond offerings, U.S. and non-U.S. commercial paper and promissory note issuances and other methods. We also arrange for letters of credit to be issued on our behalf.
 
We seek to distribute our funding products through our own sales force to a large, diverse global creditor base and we believe that our relationships with our creditors are critical to our liquidity. Our creditors include banks, governments, securities lenders, pension funds, insurance companies, mutual funds and individuals. We access funding in a variety of markets in the Americas, Europe and Asia. We have imposed various internal guidelines on creditor concentration, including the amount of our commercial paper and promissory notes that can be owned and letters of credit that can be issued by any single creditor or group of creditors.
 
In the latter half of 2008, we were unable to raise significant amounts of long-term unsecured debt in the public markets, other than as a result of the issuance of securities guaranteed by the FDIC under the TLGP. It is unclear when we will regain access to the public long-term unsecured debt markets on customary terms or whether any similar program will be available after the TLGP’s scheduled June 2009 expiration. However, we continue to have access to short-term funding and to a number of sources of secured funding, both in the private markets and through various government and central bank sponsored initiatives.
 
Over the past year, a number of U.S. regulatory agencies have taken steps to enhance the liquidity support available to financial services companies such as Group Inc., GS&Co., GSI and GS Bank USA. Some of these steps include:
 
  •  The Federal Reserve Bank of New York established the Primary Dealer Credit Facility in March 2008 to provide overnight funding to primary dealers in exchange for a specified range of collateral. In September 2008, the eligible collateral was expanded to include all collateral eligible in tri-party repurchase arrangements with the major clearing banks, and the facility was made available to GSI. This facility is scheduled to expire on April 30, 2009.
 
  •  The Federal Reserve Board introduced a new Term Securities Lending Facility (TSLF) in March 2008, which extended the term for which the Federal Reserve Board will lend Treasury securities to primary dealers from overnight to 28 days and, in September 2008, expanded the types of assets that can be used as collateral under the TSLF to include all investment-grade debt securities (rather than just Treasury, agency and certain AAA-rated asset-backed securities). This facility is scheduled to expire on April 30, 2009.
 
  •  In October 2008, the Federal Reserve Board established the Commercial Paper Funding Facility (CPFF) to serve as a funding backstop to facilitate the issuance of term commercial paper by eligible issuers. Through the CPFF, the Federal Reserve Bank of New York will finance the purchase of unsecured and asset-backed highly rated, U.S. dollar-denominated, three-month commercial paper from eligible issuers through its primary dealers. The facility is scheduled to expire on April 30, 2009. Our available funding under the CPFF is approximately $11 billion, of which a de minimis amount was utilized as of January 22, 2009.


122


Table of Contents

 
  •  The FDIC’s TLGP, which was established in October 2008, provides a guarantee of certain newly issued senior unsecured debt issued by eligible entities, including Group Inc. and GS Bank USA, as well as funds over $250,000 in non-interest-bearing transaction deposit accounts held by FDIC-insured banks (such as GS Bank USA). The debt guarantee is available, subject to limitations, for debt issued through June 30, 2009 and the deposit coverage lasts through December 31, 2009. We are able to have outstanding approximately $35 billion of debt under the TLGP that is issued prior to June 30, 2009. As of November 2008 and January 22, 2009, we had outstanding $4.18 billion of senior unsecured short-term borrowings and $25.54 billion of senior unsecured debt (comprised of $11.57 billion of short-term and $13.97 billion of long-term), respectively, under the TLGP.
 
See “— Certain Risk Factors That May Affect Our Businesses” above, and “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for a discussion of factors that could impair our ability to access the capital markets.
 
Subsidiary Funding Policies.  Substantially all of our unsecured funding is raised by our parent company, Group Inc. The parent company then lends the necessary funds to its subsidiaries, some of which are regulated, to meet their asset financing and capital requirements. In addition, the parent company provides its regulated subsidiaries with the necessary capital to meet their regulatory requirements. The benefits of this approach to subsidiary funding include enhanced control and greater flexibility to meet the funding requirements of our subsidiaries. Funding is also raised at the subsidiary level through secured funding and deposits.
 
Our intercompany funding policies are predicated on an assumption that, unless legally provided for, funds or securities are not freely available from a subsidiary to its parent company or other subsidiaries. In particular, many of our subsidiaries are subject to laws that authorize regulatory bodies to block or limit the flow of funds from those subsidiaries to Group Inc. Regulatory action of that kind could impede access to funds that Group Inc. needs to make payments on obligations, including debt obligations. As such, we assume that capital or other financing provided to our regulated subsidiaries is not available to our parent company or other subsidiaries until the maturity of such financing. In addition, we recognize that the Global Core Excess held in our regulated entities may not be available to our parent company or other subsidiaries and therefore may only be available to meet the potential liquidity requirements of those entities.
 
We also manage our liquidity risk by requiring senior and subordinated intercompany loans to have maturities equal to or shorter than the maturities of the aggregate borrowings of the parent company. This policy ensures that the subsidiaries’ obligations to the parent company will generally mature in advance of the parent company’s third-party borrowings. In addition, many of our subsidiaries and affiliates maintain unencumbered assets to cover their unsecured intercompany borrowings (other than subordinated debt) in order to mitigate parent company liquidity risk.
 
Group Inc. has provided substantial amounts of equity and subordinated indebtedness, directly or indirectly, to its regulated subsidiaries; for example, as of November 2008, Group Inc. had $26.01 billion of such equity and subordinated indebtedness invested in GS&Co., its principal U.S. registered broker-dealer; $22.06 billion invested in GSI, a regulated U.K. broker-dealer; $2.48 billion invested in Goldman Sachs Execution & Clearing, L.P., a U.S. registered broker-dealer; $3.79 billion invested in Goldman Sachs Japan Co., Ltd., a regulated Japanese broker-dealer; and $17.32 billion invested in GS Bank USA, a regulated New York State-chartered bank. Group Inc. also had $62.81 billion of unsubordinated loans to these entities as of November 2008, as well as significant amounts of capital invested in and loans to its other regulated subsidiaries.


123


Table of Contents

Crisis Planning
 
In order to be prepared for a liquidity event, or a period of market stress, we base our liquidity risk management framework and our resulting funding and liquidity policies on conservative stress-scenario assumptions. Our planning incorporates several market-based and operational stress scenarios. We also periodically conduct liquidity crisis drills to test our lines of communication and backup funding procedures.
 
In addition, we maintain a liquidity crisis plan that specifies an approach for analyzing and responding to a liquidity-threatening event. The plan provides the framework to estimate the likely impact of a liquidity event on Goldman Sachs based on some of the risks identified above and outlines which and to what extent liquidity maintenance activities should be implemented based on the severity of the event.
 
Credit Ratings
 
We rely upon the short-term and long-term debt capital markets to fund a significant portion of our day-to-day operations. The cost and availability of debt financing is influenced by our credit ratings. Credit ratings are important when we are competing in certain markets and when we seek to engage in longer-term transactions, including OTC derivatives. We believe our credit ratings are primarily based on the credit rating agencies’ assessment of our liquidity, market, credit and operational risk management practices, the level and variability of our earnings, our capital base, our franchise, reputation and management, our corporate governance and the external operating environment. See “— Certain Risk Factors That May Affect Our Businesses” above, and “Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A of our Annual Report on Form 10-K for a discussion of the risks associated with a reduction in our credit ratings.
 
On December 16, 2008, Moody’s Investors Service affirmed Group Inc.’s Short-Term Debt rating and lowered Group Inc.’s ratings on Long-Term Debt (from Aa3 to A1), Subordinated Debt (from A1 to A2) and Preferred Stock (from A2 to A3), and retained its outlook of “negative.” Also on December 16, 2008, Dominion Bond Rating Service Limited affirmed Group Inc.’s credit ratings but revised its outlook from “negative” to “under review with negative implications.” On December 17, 2008, Rating and Investment Information, Inc. affirmed Group Inc.’s Short-Term Debt rating at a-1+, lowered Group Inc.’s Long-Term Debt ratings from AA to AA- and retained its outlook of “negative.” On December 19, 2008, Standard & Poor’s Ratings Services lowered Group Inc.’s ratings on Short-Term Debt (from A-1+ to A-1), Long-Term Debt (from AA- to A), Subordinated Debt (from A+ to A-) and Preferred Stock (from A to BBB) and retained its outlook of “negative.” On January 23, 2009, Dominion Bond Rating Service Limited lowered Group Inc.’s ratings on Long-Term Debt (from AA (low) to A (high)), Subordinated Debt (from A (high) to A) and Preferred Stock (from A to A (low)).
 
The following table sets forth our unsecured credit ratings as of January 23, 2009:
 
                 
    Short-Term Debt   Long-Term Debt   Subordinated Debt   Preferred Stock
Dominion Bond Rating Service Limited
  R-1 (middle)   A (high)   A   A (low)
Fitch, Inc. 
  F1+   AA-   A+   A+
Moodys Investors Service
  P-1   A1   A2   A3
Standard & Poors Ratings Services
  A-1   A   A-   BBB
Rating and Investment Information, Inc. 
  a-1+   AA-   Not Applicable   Not Applicable


124


Table of Contents

Based on our credit ratings as of November 2008, additional collateral or termination payments pursuant to bilateral agreements with certain counterparties of approximately $1.11 billion and $1.51 billion would have been required in the event of a one-notch and two-notch reduction, respectively, in our long-term credit ratings. Based on our credit ratings reflected in the above table, additional collateral or termination payments pursuant to bilateral agreements with certain counterparties of approximately $897 million and $2.14 billion would have been required in the event of a one-notch and two-notch reduction, respectively, in our long-term credit ratings as of December 26, 2008. In evaluating our liquidity requirements, we consider additional collateral or termination payments that would be required in the event of a two-notch reduction in our long-term credit ratings, as well as collateral that has not been called by counterparties, but is available to them.
 
Cash Flows
 
As a global financial institution, our cash flows are complex and interrelated and bear little relation to our net earnings and net assets and, consequently, we believe that traditional cash flow analysis is less meaningful in evaluating our liquidity position than the excess liquidity and asset-liability management policies described above. Cash flow analysis may, however, be helpful in highlighting certain macro trends and strategic initiatives in our business.
 
Year Ended November 2008.  Our cash and cash equivalents increased by $5.46 billion to $15.74 billion at the end of 2008. We raised $9.80 billion in net cash from operating and financing activities, primarily from common and preferred stock issuances and deposits, partially offset by repayments of short-term borrowings. We used net cash of $4.34 billion in our investing activities.
 
Year Ended November 2007.  Our cash and cash equivalents increased by $4.34 billion to $10.28 billion at the end of 2007. We raised $73.79 billion in net cash from financing and investing activities, primarily through the issuance of unsecured borrowings, partially offset by common stock repurchases. We used net cash of $69.45 billion in our operating activities, primarily to capitalize on trading and investing opportunities for our clients and ourselves.
 
Operational Risk
 
Operational risk relates to the risk of loss arising from shortcomings or failures in internal processes, people or systems, or from external events. Operational risk can arise from many factors ranging from routine processing errors to potentially costly incidents related to, for example, major systems failures. Operational risk may also cause reputational harm. Thus, efforts to identify, manage and mitigate operational risk must be equally sensitive to the risk of reputational damage as well as the risk of financial loss.
 
We manage operational risk through the application of long-standing, but continuously evolving, firmwide control standards which are supported by the training, supervision and development of our people; the active participation and commitment of senior management in a continuous process of identifying and mitigating key operational risks across Goldman Sachs; and a framework of strong and independent control departments that monitor operational risk on a daily basis. Together, these elements form a strong firmwide control culture that serves as the foundation of our efforts to minimize operational risk exposure.
 
Operational Risk Management & Analysis, a risk management function independent of our revenue-producing units, is responsible for developing and implementing a formalized framework to identify, measure, monitor, and report operational risks to support active risk management across Goldman Sachs. This framework, which evolves with the changing needs of our businesses and regulatory guidance, incorporates analysis of internal and external operational risk events, business environment and internal control factors, and scenario analysis. The framework also provides regular reporting of our operational risk exposures to our Board, risk committees and senior management. For a further discussion of operational risk see “— Certain Risk Factors That May Affect Our Businesses” above, and “— Risk Factors” in Part I, Item 1A of our Annual Report on Form 10-K.


125


Table of Contents

 
Recent Accounting Developments
 
EITF Issue No. 06-11.  In June 2007, the Emerging Issues Task Force (EITF) reached consensus on Issue No. 06-11, “Accounting for Income Tax Benefits of Dividends on Share-Based Payment Awards.” EITF Issue No. 06-11 requires that the tax benefit related to dividend equivalents paid on restricted stock units, which are expected to vest, be recorded as an increase to additional paid-in capital. We currently account for this tax benefit as a reduction to income tax expense. EITF Issue No. 06-11 is to be applied prospectively for tax benefits on dividends declared in fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2007. We do not expect the adoption of EITF Issue No. 06-11 to have a material effect on our financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.
 
FASB Staff Position No. FAS 140-3.  In February 2008, the FASB issued FASB Staff Position (FSP) No. FAS 140-3, “Accounting for Transfers of Financial Assets and Repurchase Financing Transactions.” FSP No. FAS 140-3 requires an initial transfer of a financial asset and a repurchase financing that was entered into contemporaneously or in contemplation of the initial transfer to be evaluated as a linked transaction under SFAS No. 140 unless certain criteria are met, including that the transferred asset must be readily obtainable in the marketplace. FSP No. FAS 140-3 is effective for fiscal years beginning after November 15, 2008, and is applicable to new transactions entered into after the date of adoption. Early adoption is prohibited. We do not expect adoption of FSP No. FAS 140-3 to have a material effect on our financial condition and cash flows. Adoption of FSP No. FAS 140-3 will have no effect on our results of operations.
 
SFAS No. 161.  In March 2008, the FASB issued SFAS No. 161, “Disclosures about Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities — an amendment of FASB Statement No. 133.” SFAS No. 161 requires enhanced disclosures about an entity’s derivative and hedging activities, and is effective for financial statements issued for reporting periods beginning after November 15, 2008, with early application encouraged. Since SFAS No. 161 requires only additional disclosures concerning derivatives and hedging activities, adoption of SFAS No. 161 will not affect our financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.
 
FASB Staff Position No. EITF 03-6-1.  In June 2008, the FASB issued FSP No. EITF 03-6-1, “Determining Whether Instruments Granted in Share-Based Payment Transactions Are Participating Securities.” The FSP addresses whether instruments granted in share-based payment transactions are participating securities prior to vesting and therefore need to be included in the earnings allocation in calculating earnings per share under the two-class method described in SFAS No. 128, “Earnings per Share.” The FSP requires companies to treat unvested share-based payment awards that have non-forfeitable rights to dividend or dividend equivalents as a separate class of securities in calculating earnings per share. The FSP is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2008; earlier application is not permitted. We do not expect adoption of FSP No. EITF 03-6-1 to have a material effect on our results of operations or earnings per share.
 
FASB Staff Position No. FAS 133-1 and FIN 45-4.  In September 2008, the FASB issued FSP No. FAS 133-1 and FIN 45-4, “Disclosures about Credit Derivatives and Certain Guarantees: An Amendment of FASB Statement No. 133 and FASB Interpretation No. 45; and Clarification of the Effective Date of FASB Statement No. 161.” FSP No. FAS 133-1 and FIN 45-4 requires enhanced disclosures about credit derivatives and guarantees and amends FIN 45, “Guarantor’s Accounting and Disclosure Requirements for Guarantees, Including Indirect Guarantees of Indebtedness of Others” to exclude credit derivative instruments accounted for at fair value under SFAS No. 133. The FSP is effective for financial statements issued for reporting periods ending after November 15, 2008. Since FSP No. FAS 133-1 and FIN 45-4 only requires additional disclosures concerning credit derivatives and guarantees, adoption of FSP No. FAS 133-1 and FIN 45-4 did not have an effect on our financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.


126


Table of Contents

FASB Staff Position No. FAS 157-3.  In October 2008, the FASB issued FSP No. FAS 157-3, “Determining the Fair Value of a Financial Asset When the Market for That Asset Is Not Active.” FSP No. FAS 157-3 clarifies the application of SFAS No. 157 in an inactive market, without changing its existing principles. The FSP was effective immediately upon issuance. The adoption of FSP No. FAS 157-3 did not have an effect on our financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.
 
SFAS No. 141(R).  In December 2007, the FASB issued a revision to SFAS No. 141, “Business Combinations.” SFAS No. 141(R) requires changes to the accounting for transaction costs, certain contingent assets and liabilities, and other balances in a business combination. In addition, in partial acquisitions, when control is obtained, the acquiring company must measure and record all of the target’s assets and liabilities, including goodwill, at fair value as if the entire target company had been acquired. We will apply the provisions of SFAS No. 141(R) to business combinations occurring after December 26, 2008. Adoption of SFAS No. 141(R) will not affect our financial condition, results of operations or cash flows, but may have an effect on accounting for future business combinations.
 
SFAS No. 160.  In December 2007, the FASB issued SFAS No. 160, “Noncontrolling Interests in Consolidated Financial Statements — an amendment of ARB No. 51.” SFAS No. 160 requires that ownership interests in consolidated subsidiaries held by parties other than the parent (noncontrolling interests) be accounted for and presented as equity, rather than as a liability or mezzanine equity. SFAS No. 160 is effective for fiscal years beginning on or after December 15, 2008, but the presentation and disclosure requirements are to be applied retrospectively. We do not expect adoption of the statement to have a material effect on our financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.
 
FASB Staff Position No. FAS 140-4 and FIN 46(R)-8.  In December 2008, the FASB issued FSP No. FAS 140-4 and FIN 46(R)-8, “Disclosures by Public Entities (Enterprises) about Transfers of Financial Assets and Interests in Variable Interest Entities.” FSP No. FAS 140-4 and FIN 46(R)-8 requires enhanced disclosures about transfers of financial assets and interests in variable interest entities. The FSP is effective for interim and annual periods ending after December 15, 2008. Since the FSP requires only additional disclosures concerning transfers of financial assets and interests in variable interest entities, adoption of the FSP will not affect our financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.
 
EITF Issue No. 07-5.  In June 2008, the EITF reached consensus on Issue No. 07-5, “Determining Whether an Instrument (or Embedded Feature) Is Indexed to an Entity’s Own Stock.” EITF Issue No. 07-5 provides guidance about whether an instrument (such as our outstanding common stock warrants) should be classified as equity and not marked to market for accounting purposes. EITF Issue No. 07-5 is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2008. Adoption of EITF Issue No. 07-5 will not affect our financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.
 
Item 7A. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk
 
Quantitative and qualitative disclosure about market risk is set forth under “Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations — Risk Management” in Part II, Item 7 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K.


127


Table of Contents

Item 8.   Financial Statements and Supplementary Data
 
INDEX
 
         
    Page
    No.
    129  
       
    130  
       
Consolidated Financial Statements
       
    131  
    132  
    133  
    134  
    135  
       
       
    136  
    136  
    149  
    163  
    168  
    169  
    170  
    173  
    179  
    182  
    183  
    185  
    187  
    192  
    195  
    196  
    199  
    202  
    206  
    207  
    208  
       
       
    209  
    210  
    211  
    212  


128


Table of Contents

 
Management’s Report on Internal Control over
Financial Reporting
 
Management of The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc., together with its consolidated subsidiaries (the firm), is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting. The firm’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed under the supervision of the firm’s principal executive and principal financial officers to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of the firm’s financial statements for external reporting purposes in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles.
 
As of the end of the firm’s 2008 fiscal year, management conducted an assessment of the effectiveness of the firm’s internal control over financial reporting based on the framework established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). Based on this assessment, management has determined that the firm’s internal control over financial reporting as of November 28, 2008 was effective.
 
Our internal control over financial reporting includes policies and procedures that pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect transactions and dispositions of assets; provide reasonable assurances that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with U.S. generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and the directors of the firm; and provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use or disposition of the firm’s assets that could have a material effect on our financial statements.
 
The firm’s internal control over financial reporting as of November 28, 2008 has been audited by PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm, as stated in their report appearing on page 130, which expresses an unqualified opinion on the effectiveness of the firm’s internal control over financial reporting as of November 28, 2008.


129


Table of Contents

 
Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm
 
To the Board of Directors and the Shareholders of
The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc.:
 
In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements listed in the accompanying index present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. and its subsidiaries (the Company) at November 28, 2008 and November 30, 2007, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the three fiscal years in the period ended November 28, 2008 in conformity with accounting principles generally accepted in the United States of America. Also in our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting as of November 28, 2008, based on criteria established in Internal Control — Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO). The Company’s management is responsible for these financial statements, for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting appearing on page 129. Our responsibility is to express opinions on these financial statements and on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting based on our integrated audits. We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audits to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement and whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audits of the financial statements included examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. Our audit of internal control over financial reporting included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, and testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk. Our audits also included performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinions.
 
As discussed in Note 2 to the consolidated financial statements, as of the beginning of 2007 the Company adopted SFAS No. 157, “Fair Value Measurements” and SFAS No. 159, “The Fair Value Option for Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities.”
 
A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (i) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (ii) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (iii) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorized acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.
 
Because of its inherent limitations, internal control over financial reporting may not prevent or detect misstatements. Also, projections of any evaluation of effectiveness to future periods are subject to the risk that controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.
 
/s/ PricewaterhouseCoopers LLP
 
New York, New York
January 22, 2009


130


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
 
                         
    Year Ended November
    2008   2007   2006
    (in millions, except per
    share amounts)
 
Revenues
                       
Investment banking
  $ 5,179     $ 7,555     $ 5,613  
Trading and principal investments
    8,095       29,714       24,027  
Asset management and securities services
    4,672       4,731       4,527  
Interest income
    35,633       45,968       35,186  
                         
Total revenues
    53,579       87,968       69,353  
                         
Interest expense
    31,357       41,981       31,688  
                         
Revenues, net of interest expense
    22,222       45,987       37,665  
                         
Operating expenses
                       
Compensation and benefits
    10,934       20,190       16,457  
                         
Brokerage, clearing, exchange and distribution fees
    2,998       2,758       1,985  
Market development
    485       601       492  
Communications and technology
    759       665       544  
Depreciation and amortization
    1,022       624       521  
Amortization of identifiable intangible assets
    240       195       173  
Occupancy
    960       975       850  
Professional fees
    779       714       545  
Other expenses
    1,709       1,661       1,538  
                         
Total non-compensation expenses
    8,952       8,193       6,648  
                         
Total operating expenses
    19,886       28,383       23,105  
                         
                         
Pre-tax earnings
    2,336       17,604       14,560  
Provision for taxes
    14       6,005       5,023  
                         
Net earnings
    2,322       11,599       9,537  
Preferred stock dividends
    281       192       139  
                         
Net earnings applicable to common shareholders
  $ 2,041     $ 11,407     $ 9,398  
                         
Earnings per common share
                       
Basic
  $ 4.67     $ 26.34     $ 20.93  
Diluted
    4.47       24.73       19.69  
                         
Average common shares outstanding
                       
Basic
    437.0       433.0       449.0  
Diluted
    456.2       461.2       477.4  
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.


131


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
 
                 
    As of November
    2008   2007
    (in millions, except share
    and per share amounts)
 
Assets
               
Cash and cash equivalents
  $ 15,740     $ 10,282  
Cash and securities segregated for regulatory and other purposes (includes $78,830 and $94,018 at fair value as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively)
    106,664       119,939  
Collateralized agreements:
               
Securities purchased under agreements to resell, at fair value, and federal funds sold (includes $116,671 and $85,717 at fair value as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively)
    122,021       87,317  
Securities borrowed (includes $59,810 and $83,277 at fair value as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively)
    180,795       277,413  
Receivables from brokers, dealers and clearing organizations
    25,899       19,078  
Receivables from customers and counterparties (includes $1,598 and $1,950 at fair value as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively)
    64,665       129,105  
Trading assets, at fair value (includes $26,313 and $46,138 pledged as collateral as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively)
    338,325       452,595  
Other assets
    30,438       24,067  
                 
Total assets
  $ 884,547     $ 1,119,796  
                 
                 
Liabilities and shareholders’ equity
               
Deposits (includes $4,224 and $463 at fair value as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively)
  $ 27,643     $ 15,370  
Collateralized financings:
               
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase, at fair value
    62,883       159,178  
Securities loaned (includes $7,872 and $5,449 at fair value as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively)
    17,060       28,624  
Other secured financings (includes $20,249 and $33,581 at fair value as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively)
    38,683       65,710  
Payables to brokers, dealers and clearing organizations
    8,585       8,335  
Payables to customers and counterparties
    245,258       310,118  
Trading liabilities, at fair value
    175,972       215,023  
Unsecured short-term borrowings, including the current portion of unsecured long-term borrowings (includes $23,075 and $48,331 at fair value as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively)
    52,658       71,557  
Unsecured long-term borrowings (includes $17,446 and $15,928 at fair value as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively)
    168,220       164,174  
Other liabilities and accrued expenses (includes $978 at fair value as of November 2008)
    23,216       38,907  
                 
Total liabilities
    820,178       1,076,996  
                 
Commitments, contingencies and guarantees
               
                 
Shareholders’ equity
               
Preferred stock, par value $0.01 per share; aggregate liquidation preference of $18,100 and $3,100 as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively
    16,471       3,100  
Common stock, par value $0.01 per share; 4,000,000,000 shares authorized, 680,953,836 and 618,707,032 shares issued as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively, and 442,537,317 and 390,682,013 shares outstanding as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively
    7       6  
Restricted stock units and employee stock options
    9,284       9,302  
Nonvoting common stock, par value $0.01 per share; 200,000,000 shares authorized, no shares issued and outstanding
           
Additional paid-in capital
    31,071       22,027  
Retained earnings
    39,913       38,642  
Accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss)
    (202 )     (118 )
Common stock held in treasury, at cost, par value $0.01 per share; 238,416,519 and 228,025,019 shares as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively
    (32,175 )     (30,159 )
                 
Total shareholders’ equity
    64,369       42,800  
                 
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity
  $ 884,547     $ 1,119,796  
                 
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.


132


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
 
                         
    Year Ended November
    2008   2007   2006
    (in millions, except per share amounts)
 
Preferred stock
                       
Balance, beginning of year
  $ 3,100     $ 3,100     $ 1,750  
Issued
    13,367             1,350  
Preferred stock accretion
    4              
                         
Balance, end of year
    16,471       3,100       3,100  
Common stock, par value $0.01 per share
                       
Balance, beginning of year
    6       6       6  
Issued
    1              
                         
Balance, end of year
    7       6       6  
Restricted stock units and employee stock options
                       
Balance, beginning of year
    9,302       6,290       3,415  
Issuance and amortization of restricted stock units and employee stock options
    2,254       4,684       3,787  
Delivery of common stock underlying restricted stock units
    (1,995 )     (1,548 )     (781 )
Forfeiture of restricted stock units and employee stock options
    (274 )     (113 )     (129 )
Exercise of employee stock options
    (3 )     (11 )     (2 )
                         
Balance, end of year
    9,284       9,302       6,290  
Additional paid-in capital
                       
Balance, beginning of year
    22,027       19,731       17,159  
Issuance of common stock warrants
    1,633              
Issuance of common stock, including the delivery of common stock underlying restricted stock units and proceeds from the exercise of employee stock options
    8,081       2,338       2,432  
Cancellation of restricted stock units in satisfaction of withholding tax requirements
    (1,314 )     (929 )     (375 )
Stock purchase contract fee related to automatic preferred enhanced capital securities
          (20 )      
Preferred and common stock issuance costs
    (1 )           (1 )
Excess net tax benefit related to share-based compensation
    645       908       653  
Cash settlement of share-based compensation
          (1 )     (137 )
                         
Balance, end of year
    31,071       22,027       19,731  
Retained earnings
                       
Balance, beginning of year, as previously reported
    38,642       27,868       19,085  
Cumulative effect of adjustment from adoption of FIN 48
    (201 )            
Cumulative effect of adjustment from adoption of SFAS No. 157, net of tax
          51        
Cumulative effect of adjustment from adoption of SFAS No. 159, net of tax
          (45 )      
                         
Balance, beginning of year, after cumulative effect of adjustments
    38,441       27,874       19,085  
Net earnings
    2,322       11,599       9,537  
Dividends and dividend equivalents declared on common stock and restricted stock units
    (642 )     (639 )     (615 )
Dividends declared on preferred stock
    (204 )     (192 )     (139 )
Preferred stock accretion
    (4 )            
                         
Balance, end of year
    39,913       38,642       27,868  
Accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss)
                       
Balance, beginning of year
    (118 )     21        
Adjustment from adoption of SFAS No. 158, net of tax
          (194 )      
Currency translation adjustment, net of tax
    (98 )     39       45  
Pension and postretirement liability adjustment, net of tax
    69       38       (27 )
Net gains/(losses) on cash flow hedges, net of tax
          (2 )     (7 )
Net unrealized gains/(losses) on available-for-sale securities, net of tax
    (55 )     (12 )     10  
Reclassification to retained earnings from adoption of SFAS No. 159, net of tax
          (8 )      
                         
Balance, end of year
    (202 )     (118 )     21  
Common stock held in treasury, at cost
                       
Balance, beginning of year
    (30,159 )     (21,230 )     (13,413 )
Repurchased
    (2,037 )     (8,956 )     (7,817 )
Reissued
    21       27        
                         
Balance, end of year
    (32,175 )     (30,159 )     (21,230 )
                         
Total shareholders’ equity
  $ 64,369     $ 42,800     $ 35,786  
                         
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.


133


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
 
                         
    Year Ended November
    2008   2007   2006
    (in millions)
 
Cash flows from operating activities
                       
Net earnings
  $ 2,322     $ 11,599     $ 9,537  
Non-cash items included in net earnings
                       
Depreciation and amortization
    1,385       916       749  
Amortization of identifiable intangible assets
    240       251       246  
Deferred income taxes
    (1,763 )     129       (1,505 )
Share-based compensation
    1,611       4,465       3,654  
Changes in operating assets and liabilities
                       
Cash and securities segregated for regulatory and other purposes
    12,995       (39,079 )     (21,044 )
Net receivables from brokers, dealers and clearing organizations
    (6,587 )     (3,811 )     (1,794 )
Net payables to customers and counterparties
    (50 )     53,857       9,823  
Securities borrowed, net of securities loaned
    85,054       (51,655 )     (28,666 )
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase, net of securities purchased under agreements to resell and federal funds sold
    (130,999 )     6,845       5,825  
Trading assets, at fair value
    97,723       (118,864 )     (48,479 )
Trading liabilities, at fair value
    (39,051 )     57,938       6,384  
Other, net
    (20,986 )     7,962       12,823  
                         
Net cash provided by/(used for) operating activities
    1,894       (69,447 )     (52,447 )
Cash flows from investing activities
                       
Purchase of property, leasehold improvements and equipment
    (2,027 )     (2,130 )     (1,744 )
Proceeds from sales of property, leasehold improvements and equipment
    121       93       69  
Business acquisitions, net of cash acquired
    (2,613 )     (1,900 )     (1,661 )
Proceeds from sales of investments
    624       4,294       2,114  
Purchase of available-for-sale securities
    (3,851 )     (872 )     (12,922 )
Proceeds from sales of available-for-sale securities
    3,409       911       4,396  
                         
Net cash provided by/(used for) investing activities
    (4,337 )     396       (9,748 )
Cash flows from financing activities
                       
Unsecured short-term borrowings, net
    (19,295 )     12,262       (4,031 )
Other secured financings (short-term), net
    (8,727 )     2,780       16,856  
Proceeds from issuance of other secured financings (long-term)
    12,509       21,703       14,451  
Repayment of other secured financings (long-term), including the current portion
    (20,653 )     (7,355 )     (7,420 )
Proceeds from issuance of unsecured long-term borrowings
    37,758       57,516       48,839  
Repayment of unsecured long-term borrowings, including the current portion
    (25,579 )     (14,823 )     (13,510 )
Derivative contracts with a financing element, net
    781       4,814       3,494  
Deposits, net
    12,273       4,673       10,697  
Common stock repurchased
    (2,034 )     (8,956 )     (7,817 )
Dividends and dividend equivalents paid on common stock, preferred stock and restricted stock units
    (850 )     (831 )     (754 )
Proceeds from issuance of common stock
    6,105       791       1,613  
Proceeds from issuance of preferred stock, net of issuance costs
    13,366             1,349  
Proceeds from issuance of common stock warrants
    1,633              
Excess tax benefit related to share-based compensation
    614       817       464  
Cash settlement of share-based compensation
          (1 )     (137 )
                         
Net cash provided by financing activities
    7,901       73,390       64,094  
                         
Net increase in cash and cash equivalents
    5,458       4,339       1,899  
Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of year
    10,282       5,943       4,044  
                         
Cash and cash equivalents, end of year
  $ 15,740     $ 10,282     $ 5,943  
                         
 
SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURES:
 
Cash payments for interest, net of capitalized interest, were $32.37 billion, $40.74 billion and $30.98 billion for the years ended November 2008, November 2007 and November 2006, respectively.
 
Cash payments for income taxes, net of refunds, were $3.47 billion, $5.78 billion and $4.56 billion for the years ended November 2008, November 2007 and November 2006, respectively.
 
Non-cash activities:
The firm assumed $790 million, $409 million and $498 million of debt in connection with business acquisitions for the years ended November 2008, November 2007 and November 2006, respectively.
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.


134


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
 
                         
    Year Ended November
    2008   2007   2006
    (in millions)
 
Net earnings
  $ 2,322     $ 11,599     $ 9,537  
Currency translation adjustment, net of tax
    (98 )     39       45  
Pension and postretirement liability adjustment, net of tax
    69       38       (27 )
Net gains/(losses) on cash flow hedges, net of tax
          (2 )     (7 )
Net unrealized gains/(losses) on available-for-sale securities,
net of tax
    (55 )     (12 )     10  
                         
Comprehensive income
  $ 2,238     $ 11,662     $ 9,558  
                         
 
The accompanying notes are an integral part of these consolidated financial statements.


135


Table of Contents

THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
 
Note 1.   Description of Business
 
The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. (Group Inc.), a Delaware corporation, is a bank holding company and, together with its consolidated subsidiaries (collectively, the firm), a leading global investment banking, securities and investment management firm that provides a wide range of services worldwide to a substantial and diversified client base that includes corporations, financial institutions, governments and high-net-worth individuals.
 
The firm’s activities are divided into three segments:
 
  •  Investment Banking. The firm provides a broad range of investment banking services to a diverse group of corporations, financial institutions, investment funds, governments and individuals.
 
  •  Trading and Principal Investments. The firm facilitates client transactions with a diverse group of corporations, financial institutions, investment funds, governments and individuals and takes proprietary positions through market making in, trading of and investing in fixed income and equity products, currencies, commodities and derivatives on these products. In addition, the firm engages in market-making and specialist activities on equities and options exchanges, and the firm clears client transactions on major stock, options and futures exchanges worldwide. In connection with the firm’s merchant banking and other investing activities, the firm makes principal investments directly and through funds that the firm raises and manages.
 
  •  Asset Management and Securities Services. The firm provides investment advisory and financial planning services and offers investment products (primarily through separately managed accounts and commingled vehicles, such as mutual funds and private investment funds) across all major asset classes to a diverse group of institutions and individuals worldwide and provides prime brokerage services, financing services and securities lending services to institutional clients, including hedge funds, mutual funds, pension funds and foundations, and to high-net-worth individuals worldwide.
 
Note 2.   Significant Accounting Policies
 
Basis of Presentation
 
These consolidated financial statements include the accounts of Group Inc. and all other entities in which the firm has a controlling financial interest. All material intercompany transactions and balances have been eliminated.
 
The firm determines whether it has a controlling financial interest in an entity by first evaluating whether the entity is a voting interest entity, a variable interest entity (VIE) or a qualifying special-purpose entity (QSPE) under generally accepted accounting principles.
 
  •  Voting Interest Entities. Voting interest entities are entities in which (i) the total equity investment at risk is sufficient to enable the entity to finance its activities independently and (ii) the equity holders have the obligation to absorb losses, the right to receive residual returns and the right to make decisions about the entity’s activities. Voting interest entities are consolidated in accordance with Accounting Research Bulletin No. 51, “Consolidated Financial Statements,” as amended. The usual condition for a controlling financial interest in an entity is ownership of a majority voting interest. Accordingly, the firm consolidates voting interest entities in which it has a majority voting interest.
 
  •  Variable Interest Entities. VIEs are entities that lack one or more of the characteristics of a voting interest entity. A controlling financial interest in a VIE is present when an enterprise has a variable interest, or a combination of variable interests, that will absorb a majority of the VIE’s expected losses, receive a majority of the VIE’s expected residual returns, or both. The


136


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
  enterprise with a controlling financial interest, known as the primary beneficiary, consolidates the VIE. In accordance with Financial Accounting Standards Board (FASB) Interpretation (FIN) 46-R, “Consolidation of Variable Interest Entities,” the firm consolidates VIEs for which it is the primary beneficiary. The firm determines whether it is the primary beneficiary of a VIE by first performing a qualitative analysis of the VIE’s expected losses and expected residual returns. This analysis includes a review of, among other factors, the VIE’s capital structure, contractual terms, which interests create or absorb variability, related party relationships and the design of the VIE. Where qualitative analysis is not conclusive, the firm performs a quantitative analysis. For purposes of allocating a VIE’s expected losses and expected residual returns to its variable interest holders, the firm utilizes the “top down” method. Under that method, the firm calculates its share of the VIE’s expected losses and expected residual returns using the specific cash flows that would be allocated to it, based on contractual arrangements and/or the firm’s position in the capital structure of the VIE, under various probability-weighted scenarios. The firm reassesses its initial evaluation of an entity as a VIE and its initial determination of whether the firm is the primary beneficiary of a VIE upon the occurrence of certain reconsideration events as defined in FIN 46-R.
 
  •  QSPEs. QSPEs are passive entities that are commonly used in mortgage and other securitization transactions. Statement of Financial Accounting Standards (SFAS) No. 140, “Accounting for Transfers and Servicing of Financial Assets and Extinguishments of Liabilities,” sets forth the criteria an entity must satisfy to be a QSPE. These criteria include the types of assets a QSPE may hold, limits on asset sales, the use of derivatives and financial guarantees, and the level of discretion a servicer may exercise in attempting to collect receivables. These criteria may require management to make judgments about complex matters, such as whether a derivative is considered passive and the level of discretion a servicer may exercise, including, for example, determining when default is reasonably foreseeable. In accordance with SFAS No. 140 and FIN 46-R, the firm does not consolidate QSPEs.
 
  •  Equity-Method Investments. When the firm does not have a controlling financial interest in an entity but exerts significant influence over the entity’s operating and financial policies (generally defined as owning a voting interest of 20% to 50%) and has an investment in common stock or in-substance common stock, the firm accounts for its investment either in accordance with Accounting Principles Board Opinion (APB) No. 18, “The Equity Method of Accounting for Investments in Common Stock” or at fair value in accordance with SFAS No. 159, “The Fair Value Option for Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities.” In general, the firm accounts for investments acquired subsequent to the adoption of SFAS No. 159 at fair value. In certain cases, the firm may apply the equity method of accounting to new investments that are strategic in nature or closely related to the firm’s principal business activities, where the firm has a significant degree of involvement in the cash flows or operations of the investee, or where cost-benefit considerations are less significant. See “— Revenue Recognition — Other Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities at Fair Value” below for a discussion of the firm’s application of SFAS No. 159.
 
  •  Other. If the firm does not consolidate an entity or apply the equity method of accounting, the firm accounts for its investment at fair value. The firm also has formed numerous nonconsolidated investment funds with third-party investors that are typically organized as limited partnerships. The firm acts as general partner for these funds and generally does not hold a majority of the economic interests in these funds. The firm has generally provided the third-party investors with rights to terminate the funds or to remove the firm as the general partner. As a result, the firm does not consolidate these funds. These fund investments are included in “Trading assets, at fair value” in the consolidated statements of financial condition.


137


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
 
Unless otherwise stated herein, all references to 2008, 2007 and 2006 refer to the firm’s fiscal years ended, or the dates, as the context requires, November 28, 2008, November 30, 2007 and November 24, 2006, respectively. Certain reclassifications have been made to previously reported amounts to conform to the current presentation.
 
Use of Estimates
 
These consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles that require management to make certain estimates and assumptions. The most important of these estimates and assumptions relate to fair value measurements, the accounting for goodwill and identifiable intangible assets and the provision for potential losses that may arise from litigation and regulatory proceedings and tax audits. Although these and other estimates and assumptions are based on the best available information, actual results could be materially different from these estimates.
 
Revenue Recognition
 
Investment Banking. Underwriting revenues and fees from mergers and acquisitions and other financial advisory assignments are recognized in the consolidated statements of earnings when the services related to the underlying transaction are completed under the terms of the engagement. Expenses associated with such transactions are deferred until the related revenue is recognized or the engagement is otherwise concluded. Underwriting revenues are presented net of related expenses. Expenses associated with financial advisory transactions are recorded as non-compensation expenses, net of client reimbursements.
 
Trading Assets and Trading Liabilities. Substantially all trading assets and trading liabilities are reflected in the consolidated statements of financial condition at fair value, pursuant principally to:
 
  •  SFAS No. 115, “Accounting for Certain Investments in Debt and Equity Securities;”
 
  •  specialized industry accounting for broker-dealers and investment companies;
 
  •  SFAS No. 133, “Accounting for Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities;” or
 
  •  the fair value option under either SFAS No. 155, “Accounting for Certain Hybrid Financial Instruments — an amendment of FASB Statements No. 133 and 140,” or SFAS No. 159, “The Fair Value Option for Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities,” (i.e., the fair value option).
 
Related unrealized gains or losses are generally recognized in “Trading and principal investments” in the consolidated statements of earnings.
 
Upon becoming a bank holding company in September 2008, the firm could no longer apply specialized broker-dealer industry accounting to those subsidiaries not regulated as broker-dealers. Therefore, within the firm’s non-broker-dealer subsidiaries, the firm designated as held for trading those instruments within the scope of SFAS No. 115 (i.e., debt securities and marketable equity securities), and elected the fair value option for other cash instruments (specifically loans, loan commitments and certain private equity and restricted public equity securities) which the firm historically had carried at fair value. These fair value elections were in addition to previous elections made for certain corporate loans, loan commitments and certificates of deposit issued by Goldman Sachs Bank USA (GS Bank USA). There was no impact on earnings from these initial elections because all of these instruments were already recorded at fair value in “Trading assets, at fair value” or “Trading liabilities, at fair value” in the consolidated statements of financial condition prior to Group Inc. becoming a bank holding company.


138


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
 
Other Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities at Fair Value. In addition to “Trading assets, at fair value” and “Trading liabilities, at fair value,” the firm has elected to account for certain of its other financial assets and financial liabilities at fair value under the fair value option. The primary reasons for electing the fair value option are to reflect economic events in earnings on a timely basis, to mitigate volatility in earnings from using different measurement attributes and to address simplification and cost-benefit considerations.
 
Such financial assets and financial liabilities accounted for at fair value include:
 
  •  certain unsecured short-term borrowings, consisting of all promissory notes and commercial paper and certain hybrid financial instruments;
 
  •  certain other secured financings, primarily transfers accounted for as financings rather than sales under SFAS No. 140, debt raised through the firm’s William Street program and certain other nonrecourse financings;
 
  •  certain unsecured long-term borrowings, including prepaid physical commodity transactions;
 
  •  resale and repurchase agreements;
 
  •  securities borrowed and loaned within Trading and Principal Investments, consisting of the firm’s matched book and certain firm financing activities;
 
  •  certain corporate loans, loan commitments and certificates of deposit issued by GS Bank USA as well as securities held by GS Bank USA;
 
  •  receivables from customers and counterparties arising from transfers accounted for as secured loans rather than purchases under SFAS No. 140;
 
  •  certain insurance and reinsurance contracts; and
 
  •  in general, investments acquired after the adoption of SFAS No. 159 where the firm has significant influence over the investee and would otherwise apply the equity method of accounting.
 
Fair Value Measurements. The fair value of a financial instrument is the amount that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date (the exit price). Financial assets are marked to bid prices and financial liabilities are marked to offer prices. Fair value measurements do not include transaction costs.
 
The firm adopted SFAS No. 157, “Fair Value Measurements,” as of the beginning of 2007. SFAS No. 157 establishes a fair value hierarchy that prioritizes the inputs to valuation techniques used to measure fair value. The hierarchy gives the highest priority to unadjusted quoted prices in active markets for identical assets or liabilities (level 1 measurements) and the lowest priority to unobservable inputs (level 3 measurements). The three levels of the fair value hierarchy under SFAS No. 157 are described below:
 
Basis of Fair Value Measurement
 
  Level 1      Unadjusted quoted prices in active markets that are accessible at the measurement date for identical, unrestricted assets or liabilities;
 
  Level 2      Quoted prices in markets that are not considered to be active or financial instruments for which all significant inputs are observable, either directly or indirectly;
 
  Level 3      Prices or valuations that require inputs that are both significant to the fair value measurement and unobservable.


139


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
A financial instrument’s level within the fair value hierarchy is based on the lowest level of any input that is significant to the fair value measurement.
 
The firm defines active markets for equity instruments based on the average daily trading volume both in absolute terms and relative to the market capitalization for the instrument. The firm defines active markets for debt instruments based on both the average daily trading volume and the number of days with trading activity.
 
During the fourth quarter of 2008, both the FASB and the staff of the SEC re-emphasized the importance of sound fair value measurement in financial reporting. In October 2008, the FASB issued FASB Staff Position No. FAS 157-3, “Determining the Fair Value of a Financial Asset When the Market for That Asset is Not Active.” This statement clarifies that determining fair value in an inactive or dislocated market depends on facts and circumstances and requires significant management judgment. This statement specifies that it is acceptable to use inputs based on management estimates or assumptions, or for management to make adjustments to observable inputs to determine fair value when markets are not active and relevant observable inputs are not available. The firm’s fair value measurement policies are consistent with the guidance in FSP No. FAS 157-3.
 
Credit risk is an essential component of fair value. Cash products (e.g., bonds and loans) and derivative instruments (particularly those with significant future projected cash flows) trade in the market at levels which reflect credit considerations. The firm calculates the fair value of derivative assets by discounting future cash flows at a rate which incorporates counterparty credit spreads and the fair value of derivative liabilities by discounting future cash flows at a rate which incorporates the firm’s own credit spreads. In doing so, credit exposures are adjusted to reflect mitigants, namely collateral agreements which reduce exposures based on triggers and contractual posting requirements. The firm manages its exposure to credit risk as it does other market risks and will price, economically hedge, facilitate and intermediate trades which involve credit risk. The firm records liquidity valuation adjustments to reflect the cost of exiting concentrated risk positions, including exposure to the firm’s own credit spreads.
 
In determining fair value, the firm separates its “Trading assets, at fair value” and its “Trading liabilities, at fair value” into two categories: cash instruments and derivative contracts.
 
  •  Cash Instruments. The firm’s cash instruments are generally classified within level 1 or level 2 of the fair value hierarchy because they are valued using quoted market prices, broker or dealer quotations, or alternative pricing sources with reasonable levels of price transparency. The types of instruments valued based on quoted market prices in active markets include most U.S. government and sovereign obligations, active listed equities and certain money market securities. Such instruments are generally classified within level 1 of the fair value hierarchy. In accordance with SFAS No. 157, the firm does not adjust the quoted price for such instruments, even in situations where the firm holds a large position and a sale could reasonably impact the quoted price.
 
The types of instruments that trade in markets that are not considered to be active, but are valued based on quoted market prices, broker or dealer quotations, or alternative pricing sources with reasonable levels of price transparency include most government agency securities, investment-grade corporate bonds, certain mortgage products, certain bank loans and bridge loans, less liquid listed equities, state, municipal and provincial obligations and certain money market securities and loan commitments. Such instruments are generally classified within level 2 of the fair value hierarchy.
 
Certain cash instruments are classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy because they trade infrequently and therefore have little or no price transparency. Such instruments include private equity and real estate fund investments, certain bank loans and bridge loans (including


140


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
certain mezzanine financing, leveraged loans arising from capital market transactions and other corporate bank debt), less liquid corporate debt securities and other debt obligations (including less liquid high-yield corporate bonds, distressed debt instruments and collateralized debt obligations (CDOs) backed by corporate obligations), less liquid mortgage whole loans and securities (backed by either commercial or residential real estate), and acquired portfolios of distressed loans. The transaction price is initially used as the best estimate of fair value. Accordingly, when a pricing model is used to value such an instrument, the model is adjusted so that the model value at inception equals the transaction price. This valuation is adjusted only when changes to inputs and assumptions are corroborated by evidence such as transactions in similar instruments, completed or pending third-party transactions in the underlying investment or comparable entities, subsequent rounds of financing, recapitalizations and other transactions across the capital structure, offerings in the equity or debt capital markets, and changes in financial ratios or cash flows.
 
For positions that are not traded in active markets or are subject to transfer restrictions, valuations are adjusted to reflect illiquidity and/or non-transferability. Such adjustments are generally based on available market evidence. In the absence of such evidence, management’s best estimate is used.
 
Recent market conditions, particularly in the fourth quarter of 2008 (characterized by dislocations between asset classes, elevated levels of volatility, and reduced price transparency), have increased the level of management judgment required to value cash trading instruments classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy. In particular, management’s judgment is required to determine the appropriate risk-adjusted discount rate for cash trading instruments with little or no price transparency as a result of decreased volumes and lower levels of trading activity. In such situations, the firm’s valuation is adjusted to approximate rates which market participants would likely consider appropriate for relevant credit and liquidity risks.
 
  •  Derivative Contracts. Derivative contracts can be exchange-traded or over-the-counter (OTC). Exchange-traded derivatives typically fall within level 1 or level 2 of the fair value hierarchy depending on whether they are deemed to be actively traded or not. The firm generally values exchange-traded derivatives using models which calibrate to market-clearing levels and eliminate timing differences between the closing price of the exchange-traded derivatives and their underlying instruments. In such cases, exchange-traded derivatives are classified within level 2 of the fair value hierarchy.
 
OTC derivatives are valued using market transactions and other market evidence whenever possible, including market-based inputs to models, model calibration to market-clearing transactions, broker or dealer quotations, or alternative pricing sources with reasonable levels of price transparency. Where models are used, the selection of a particular model to value an OTC derivative depends upon the contractual terms of, and specific risks inherent in, the instrument as well as the availability of pricing information in the market. The firm generally uses similar models to value similar instruments. Valuation models require a variety of inputs, including contractual terms, market prices, yield curves, credit curves, measures of volatility, prepayment rates and correlations of such inputs. For OTC derivatives that trade in liquid markets, such as generic forwards, swaps and options, model inputs can generally be verified and model selection does not involve significant management judgment. OTC derivatives are classified within level 2 of the fair value hierarchy when all of the significant inputs can be corroborated to market evidence.
 
Certain OTC derivatives trade in less liquid markets with limited pricing information, and the determination of fair value for these derivatives is inherently more difficult. Such instruments


141


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
are classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy. Where the firm does not have corroborating market evidence to support significant model inputs and cannot verify the model to market transactions, the transaction price is initially used as the best estimate of fair value. Accordingly, when a pricing model is used to value such an instrument, the model is adjusted so that the model value at inception equals the transaction price. The valuations of these less liquid OTC derivatives are typically based on level 1 and/or level 2 inputs that can be observed in the market, as well as unobservable level 3 inputs. Subsequent to initial recognition, the firm updates the level 1 and level 2 inputs to reflect observable market changes, with resulting gains and losses reflected within level 3. Level 3 inputs are only changed when corroborated by evidence such as similar market transactions, third-party pricing services and/or broker or dealer quotations, or other empirical market data. In circumstances where the firm cannot verify the model value to market transactions, it is possible that a different valuation model could produce a materially different estimate of fair value.
 
When appropriate, valuations are adjusted for various factors such as liquidity, bid/offer spreads and credit considerations. Such adjustments are generally based on available market evidence. In the absence of such evidence, management’s best estimate is used.
 
Collateralized Agreements and Financings. Collateralized agreements consist of resale agreements and securities borrowed. Collateralized financings consist of repurchase agreements, securities loaned and other secured financings. Interest on collateralized agreements and collateralized financings is recognized in “Interest income” and “Interest expense,” respectively, over the life of the transaction.
 
  •  Resale and Repurchase Agreements. Securities purchased under agreements to resell and securities sold under agreements to repurchase, principally U.S. government, federal agency and investment-grade sovereign obligations, represent collateralized financing transactions. The firm receives securities purchased under agreements to resell, makes delivery of securities sold under agreements to repurchase, monitors the market value of these securities on a daily basis and delivers or obtains additional collateral as appropriate. As noted above, resale and repurchase agreements are carried in the consolidated statements of financial condition at fair value under SFAS No. 159. Resale and repurchase agreements are generally valued based on inputs with reasonable levels of price transparency and are classified within level 2 of the fair value hierarchy. Resale and repurchase agreements are presented on a net-by-counterparty basis when the requirements of FIN 41, “Offsetting of Amounts Related to Certain Repurchase and Reverse Repurchase Agreements,” or FIN 39, “Offsetting of Amounts Related to Certain Contracts,” are satisfied.
 
  •  Securities Borrowed and Loaned. Securities borrowed and loaned are generally collateralized by cash, securities or letters of credit. The firm receives securities borrowed, makes delivery of securities loaned, monitors the market value of securities borrowed and loaned, and delivers or obtains additional collateral as appropriate. Securities borrowed and loaned within Securities Services, relating to both customer activities and, to a lesser extent, certain firm financing activities, are recorded based on the amount of cash collateral advanced or received plus accrued interest. As these arrangements generally can be terminated on demand, they exhibit little, if any, sensitivity to changes in interest rates. As noted above, securities borrowed and loaned within Trading and Principal Investments, which are related to the firm’s matched book and certain firm financing activities, are recorded at fair value under SFAS No. 159. These securities borrowed and loaned transactions are generally valued based on inputs with reasonable levels of price transparency and are classified within level 2 of the fair value hierarchy.


142


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
 
  •  Other Secured Financings. In addition to repurchase agreements and securities loaned, the firm funds assets through the use of other secured financing arrangements and pledges financial instruments and other assets as collateral in these transactions. As noted above, the firm has elected to apply SFAS No. 159 to transfers accounted for as financings rather than sales under SFAS No. 140, debt raised through the firm’s William Street program and certain other nonrecourse financings, for which the use of fair value eliminates non-economic volatility in earnings that would arise from using different measurement attributes. These other secured financing transactions are generally valued based on inputs with reasonable levels of price transparency and are generally classified within level 2 of the fair value hierarchy. Other secured financings that are not recorded at fair value are recorded based on the amount of cash received plus accrued interest. See Note 3 for further information regarding other secured financings.
 
Hybrid Financial Instruments. Hybrid financial instruments are instruments that contain bifurcatable embedded derivatives under SFAS No. 133 and do not require settlement by physical delivery of non-financial assets (e.g., physical commodities). If the firm elects to bifurcate the embedded derivative, it is accounted for at fair value and the host contract is accounted for at amortized cost, adjusted for the effective portion of any fair value hedge accounting relationships. If the firm does not elect to bifurcate, the entire hybrid financial instrument is accounted for at fair value under SFAS No. 155. See Notes 3 and 6 for further information regarding hybrid financial instruments.
 
Transfers of Financial Assets. In general, transfers of financial assets are accounted for as sales under SFAS No. 140 when the firm has relinquished control over the transferred assets. For transfers accounted for as sales, any related gains or losses are recognized in net revenues. Transfers that are not accounted for as sales are accounted for as collateralized financings, with the related interest expense recognized in net revenues over the life of the transaction.
 
Commissions. Commission revenues from executing and clearing client transactions on stock, options and futures markets are recognized in “Trading and principal investments” in the consolidated statements of earnings on a trade-date basis.
 
Insurance Activities. Certain of the firm’s insurance and reinsurance contracts are accounted for at fair value under SFAS No. 159, with changes in fair value included in “Trading and principal investments” in the consolidated statements of earnings.
 
Revenues from variable annuity and life insurance and reinsurance contracts not accounted for at fair value under SFAS No. 159 generally consist of fees assessed on contract holder account balances for mortality charges, policy administration fees and surrender charges, and are recognized within “Trading and principal investments” in the consolidated statements of earnings in the period that services are provided.
 
Interest credited to variable annuity and life insurance and reinsurance contracts account balances and changes in reserves are recognized in “Other expenses” in the consolidated statements of earnings.
 
Premiums earned for underwriting property catastrophe reinsurance are recognized within “Trading and principal investments” in the consolidated statements of earnings over the coverage period, net of premiums ceded for the cost of reinsurance. Expenses for liabilities related to property catastrophe reinsurance claims, including estimates of losses that have been incurred but not reported, are recognized within “Other expenses” in the consolidated statements of earnings.
 
Merchant Banking Overrides. The firm is entitled to receive merchant banking overrides (i.e., an increased share of a fund’s income and gains) when the return on the funds’ investments


143


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
exceeds certain threshold returns. Overrides are based on investment performance over the life of each merchant banking fund, and future investment underperformance may require amounts of override previously distributed to the firm to be returned to the funds. Accordingly, overrides are recognized in the consolidated statements of earnings only when all material contingencies have been resolved. Overrides are included in “Trading and principal investments” in the consolidated statements of earnings.
 
Asset Management. Management fees are recognized over the period that the related service is provided based upon average net asset values. In certain circumstances, the firm is also entitled to receive incentive fees based on a percentage of a fund’s return or when the return on assets under management exceeds specified benchmark returns or other performance targets. Incentive fees are generally based on investment performance over a 12-month period and are subject to adjustment prior to the end of the measurement period. Accordingly, incentive fees are recognized in the consolidated statements of earnings when the measurement period ends. Asset management fees and incentive fees are included in “Asset management and securities services” in the consolidated statements of earnings.
 
Share-Based Compensation
 
The firm accounts for share-based compensation in accordance with SFAS No. 123-R, “Share-Based Payment.” The cost of employee services received in exchange for a share-based award is generally measured based on the grant-date fair value of the award. Share-based awards that do not require future service (i.e., vested awards, including awards granted to retirement-eligible employees) are expensed immediately. Share-based employee awards that require future service are amortized over the relevant service period. Expected forfeitures are included in determining share-based employee compensation expense. In the first quarter of 2006, the firm adopted SFAS No. 123-R under the modified prospective adoption method. Under that method of adoption, the provisions of SFAS No. 123-R are generally applied only to share-based awards granted subsequent to adoption. Share-based awards held by employees that were retirement-eligible on the date of adoption of SFAS No. 123-R must continue to be amortized over the stated service period of the award (and accelerated if the employee actually retires).
 
The firm pays cash dividend equivalents on outstanding restricted stock units. Dividend equivalents paid on restricted stock units are generally charged to retained earnings. Dividend equivalents paid on restricted stock units expected to be forfeited are included in compensation expense. The tax benefit related to dividend equivalents paid on restricted stock units is accounted for as a reduction of income tax expense. See “— Recent Accounting Developments” for a discussion of Emerging Issues Task Force (EITF) Issue No. 06-11, “Accounting for Income Tax Benefits of Dividends on Share-Based Payment Awards.”
 
In certain cases, primarily related to the death of an employee or conflicted employment (as outlined in the applicable award agreements), the firm may cash settle share-based compensation awards. For awards accounted for as equity instruments, “Additional paid-in capital” is adjusted to the extent of the difference between the current value of the award and the grant-date value of the award.
 
Goodwill
 
Goodwill is the cost of acquired companies in excess of the fair value of identifiable net assets at acquisition date. In accordance with SFAS No. 142, “Goodwill and Other Intangible Assets,” goodwill is tested at least annually for impairment. An impairment loss is recognized if the estimated fair value of an operating segment, which is a component one level below the firm’s three business segments, is


144


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
less than its estimated net book value. Such loss is calculated as the difference between the estimated fair value of goodwill and its carrying value.
 
Identifiable Intangible Assets
 
Identifiable intangible assets, which consist primarily of customer lists, Designated Market Maker (DMM) rights and the value of business acquired (VOBA) and deferred acquisition costs (DAC) in the firm’s insurance subsidiaries, are amortized over their estimated lives in accordance with SFAS No. 142 or, in the case of insurance contracts, in accordance with SFAS No. 60, “Accounting and Reporting by Insurance Enterprises,” and SFAS No. 97, “Accounting and Reporting by Insurance Enterprises for Certain Long-Duration Contracts and for Realized Gains and Losses from the Sale of Investments.” Identifiable intangible assets are tested for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances suggest that an asset’s or asset group’s carrying value may not be fully recoverable in accordance with SFAS No. 144, “Accounting for the Impairment or Disposal of Long-Lived Assets,” or SFAS No. 60 and SFAS No. 97. An impairment loss, generally calculated as the difference between the estimated fair value and the carrying value of an asset or asset group, is recognized if the sum of the estimated undiscounted cash flows relating to the asset or asset group is less than the corresponding carrying value.
 
Property, Leasehold Improvements and Equipment
 
Property, leasehold improvements and equipment, net of accumulated depreciation and amortization, are recorded at cost and included in “Other assets” in the consolidated statements of financial condition.
 
Substantially all property and equipment are depreciated on a straight-line basis over the useful life of the asset. Leasehold improvements are amortized on a straight-line basis over the useful life of the improvement or the term of the lease, whichever is shorter. Certain costs of software developed or obtained for internal use are capitalized and amortized on a straight-line basis over the useful life of the software.
 
Property, leasehold improvements and equipment are tested for impairment whenever events or changes in circumstances suggest that an asset’s or asset group’s carrying value may not be fully recoverable in accordance with SFAS No. 144. An impairment loss, calculated as the difference between the estimated fair value and the carrying value of an asset or asset group, is recognized if the sum of the expected undiscounted cash flows relating to the asset or asset group is less than the corresponding carrying value.
 
The firm’s operating leases include office space held in excess of current requirements. Rent expense relating to space held for growth is included in “Occupancy” in the consolidated statements of earnings. In accordance with SFAS No. 146, “Accounting for Costs Associated with Exit or Disposal Activities,” the firm records a liability, based on the fair value of the remaining lease rentals reduced by any potential or existing sublease rentals, for leases where the firm has ceased using the space and management has concluded that the firm will not derive any future economic benefits. Costs to terminate a lease before the end of its term are recognized and measured at fair value upon termination.
 
Foreign Currency Translation
 
Assets and liabilities denominated in non-U.S. currencies are translated at rates of exchange prevailing on the date of the consolidated statement of financial condition, and revenues and expenses are translated at average rates of exchange for the period. Gains or losses on translation of the financial statements of a non-U.S. operation, when the functional currency is other than the U.S. dollar, are included, net of hedges and taxes, in the consolidated statements of comprehensive


145


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
income. The firm seeks to reduce its net investment exposure to fluctuations in foreign exchange rates through the use of foreign currency forward contracts and foreign currency-denominated debt. For foreign currency forward contracts, hedge effectiveness is assessed based on changes in forward exchange rates; accordingly, forward points are reflected as a component of the currency translation adjustment in the consolidated statements of comprehensive income. For foreign currency-denominated debt, hedge effectiveness is assessed based on changes in spot rates. Foreign currency remeasurement gains or losses on transactions in nonfunctional currencies are included in the consolidated statements of earnings.
 
Income Taxes
 
Deferred tax assets and liabilities are recognized for temporary differences between the financial reporting and tax bases of the firm’s assets and liabilities. Valuation allowances are established to reduce deferred tax assets to the amount that more likely than not will be realized. The firm’s tax assets and liabilities are presented as a component of “Other assets” and “Other liabilities and accrued expenses,” respectively, in the consolidated statements of financial condition. Tax provisions are computed in accordance with SFAS No. 109, “Accounting for Income Taxes.”
 
The firm adopted the provisions of FIN 48, “Accounting for Uncertainty in Income Taxes — an Interpretation of FASB Statement No. 109,” as of December 1, 2007, and recorded a transition adjustment resulting in a reduction of $201 million to beginning retained earnings. See Note 16 for further information regarding the firm’s adoption of FIN 48. A tax position can be recognized in the financial statements only when it is more likely than not that the position will be sustained upon examination by the relevant taxing authority based on the technical merits of the position. A position that meets this standard is measured at the largest amount of benefit that will more likely than not be realized upon settlement. A liability is established for differences between positions taken in a tax return and amounts recognized in the financial statements. FIN 48 also provides guidance on derecognition, classification, interim period accounting and accounting for interest and penalties. Prior to the adoption of FIN 48, contingent liabilities related to income taxes were recorded when the criteria for loss recognition under SFAS No. 5, “Accounting for Contingencies,” as amended, had been met.
 
Earnings Per Common Share (EPS)
 
Basic EPS is calculated by dividing net earnings applicable to common shareholders by the weighted average number of common shares outstanding. Common shares outstanding includes common stock and restricted stock units for which no future service is required as a condition to the delivery of the underlying common stock. Diluted EPS includes the determinants of basic EPS and, in addition, reflects the dilutive effect of the common stock deliverable pursuant to stock warrants and options and to restricted stock units for which future service is required as a condition to the delivery of the underlying common stock.
 
Cash and Cash Equivalents
 
The firm defines cash equivalents as highly liquid overnight deposits held in the ordinary course of business. As of November 2008, “Cash and cash equivalents” on the consolidated statements of financial condition included $5.60 billion of cash and due from banks and $10.14 billion of interest-bearing deposits with banks. As of November 2007, “Cash and cash equivalents” on the consolidated statements of financial condition included $4.29 billion of cash and due from banks and $5.99 billion of interest-bearing deposits with banks.


146


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
Recent Accounting Developments
 
EITF Issue No. 06-11. In June 2007, the EITF reached consensus on Issue No. 06-11, “Accounting for Income Tax Benefits of Dividends on Share-Based Payment Awards.” EITF Issue No. 06-11 requires that the tax benefit related to dividend equivalents paid on restricted stock units, which are expected to vest, be recorded as an increase to additional paid-in capital. The firm currently accounts for this tax benefit as a reduction to income tax expense. EITF Issue No. 06-11 is to be applied prospectively for tax benefits on dividends declared in fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2007. The firm does not expect the adoption of EITF Issue No. 06-11 to have a material effect on its financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.
 
FASB Staff Position No. FAS 140-3. In February 2008, the FASB issued FASB Staff Position (FSP) No. FAS 140-3, “Accounting for Transfers of Financial Assets and Repurchase Financing Transactions.” FSP No. FAS 140-3 requires an initial transfer of a financial asset and a repurchase financing that was entered into contemporaneously or in contemplation of the initial transfer to be evaluated as a linked transaction under SFAS No. 140 unless certain criteria are met, including that the transferred asset must be readily obtainable in the marketplace. FSP No. FAS 140-3 is effective for fiscal years beginning after November 15, 2008, and is applicable to new transactions entered into after the date of adoption. Early adoption is prohibited. The firm does not expect adoption of FSP No. FAS 140-3 to have a material effect on its financial condition and cash flows. Adoption of FSP No. FAS 140-3 will have no effect on the firm’s results of operations.
 
SFAS No. 161. In March 2008, the FASB issued SFAS No. 161, “Disclosures about Derivative Instruments and Hedging Activities — an amendment of FASB Statement No. 133.” SFAS No. 161 requires enhanced disclosures about an entity’s derivative and hedging activities, and is effective for financial statements issued for reporting periods beginning after November 15, 2008, with early application encouraged. Since SFAS No. 161 requires only additional disclosures concerning derivatives and hedging activities, adoption of SFAS No. 161 will not affect the firm’s financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.
 
FASB Staff Position No. EITF 03-6-1. In June 2008, the FASB issued FSP No. EITF 03-6-1, “Determining Whether Instruments Granted in Share-Based Payment Transactions Are Participating Securities.” The FSP addresses whether instruments granted in share-based payment transactions are participating securities prior to vesting and therefore need to be included in the earnings allocation in calculating earnings per share under the two-class method described in SFAS No. 128, “Earnings per Share.” The FSP requires companies to treat unvested share-based payment awards that have non-forfeitable rights to dividend or dividend equivalents as a separate class of securities in calculating earnings per share. The FSP is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2008; earlier application is not permitted. The firm does not expect adoption of FSP No. EITF 03-6-1 to have a material effect on its results of operations or earnings per share.
 
FASB Staff Position No. FAS 133-1 and FIN 45-4. In September 2008, the FASB issued FSP No. FAS 133-1 and FIN 45-4, “Disclosures about Credit Derivatives and Certain Guarantees: An Amendment of FASB Statement No. 133 and FASB Interpretation No. 45; and Clarification of the Effective Date of FASB Statement No. 161.” FSP No. FAS 133-1 and FIN 45-4 requires enhanced disclosures about credit derivatives and guarantees and amends FIN 45, “Guarantor’s Accounting and Disclosure Requirements for Guarantees, Including Indirect Guarantees of Indebtedness of Others” to exclude credit derivative instruments accounted for at fair value under SFAS No. 133. The FSP is effective for financial statements issued for reporting periods ending after November 15, 2008. Since FSP No. FAS 133-1 and FIN 45-4 only requires additional disclosures concerning credit derivatives and guarantees, adoption of FSP No. FAS 133-1 and FIN 45-4 did not have an effect on the firm’s financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.


147


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
FASB Staff Position No. FAS 157-3. In October 2008, the FASB issued FSP No. FAS 157-3, “Determining the Fair Value of a Financial Asset When the Market for That Asset Is Not Active.” FSP No. FAS 157-3 clarifies the application of SFAS No. 157 in an inactive market, without changing its existing principles. The FSP was effective immediately upon issuance. The adoption of FSP No. FAS 157-3 did not have an effect on the firm’s financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.
 
SFAS No. 141(R). In December 2007, the FASB issued a revision to SFAS No. 141, “Business Combinations.” SFAS No. 141(R) requires changes to the accounting for transaction costs, certain contingent assets and liabilities, and other balances in a business combination. In addition, in partial acquisitions, when control is obtained, the acquiring company must measure and record all of the target’s assets and liabilities, including goodwill, at fair value as if the entire target company had been acquired. The firm will apply the provisions of SFAS No. 141(R) to business combinations occurring after December 26, 2008. Adoption of SFAS No. 141(R) will not affect the firm’s financial condition, results of operations or cash flows, but may have an effect on accounting for future business combinations.
 
SFAS No. 160. In December 2007, the FASB issued SFAS No. 160, “Noncontrolling Interests in Consolidated Financial Statements — an amendment of ARB No. 51.” SFAS No. 160 requires that ownership interests in consolidated subsidiaries held by parties other than the parent (noncontrolling interests) be accounted for and presented as equity, rather than as a liability or mezzanine equity. SFAS No. 160 is effective for fiscal years beginning on or after December 15, 2008, but the presentation and disclosure requirements are to be applied retrospectively. The firm does not expect adoption of the statement to have a material effect on its financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.
 
FASB Staff Position No. FAS 140-4 and FIN 46(R)-8. In December 2008, the FASB issued FSP No. FAS 140-4 and FIN 46(R)-8, “Disclosures by Public Entities (Enterprises) about Transfers of Financial Assets and Interests in Variable Interest Entities.” FSP No. FAS 140-4 and FIN 46(R)-8 requires enhanced disclosures about transfers of financial assets and interests in variable interest entities. The FSP is effective for interim and annual periods ending after December 15, 2008. Since the FSP requires only additional disclosures concerning transfers of financial assets and interests in variable interest entities, adoption of the FSP will not affect the firm’s financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.
 
EITF Issue No. 07-5. In June 2008, the EITF reached consensus on Issue No. 07-5, “Determining Whether an Instrument (or Embedded Feature) Is Indexed to an Entity’s Own Stock.” EITF Issue No. 07-5 provides guidance about whether an instrument (such as the firm’s outstanding common stock warrants) should be classified as equity and not marked to market for accounting purposes. EITF Issue No. 07-5 is effective for fiscal years beginning after December 15, 2008. Adoption of EITF Issue No. 07-5 will not affect the firm’s financial condition, results of operations or cash flows.


148


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
Note 3.   Financial Instruments
 
Fair Value of Financial Instruments
 
The following table sets forth the firm’s trading assets, at fair value, including those pledged as collateral, and trading liabilities, at fair value. At any point in time, the firm may use cash instruments as well as derivatives to manage a long or short risk position.
 
                                 
    As of November
    2008   2007
   
Assets
 
Liabilities
 
Assets
 
Liabilities
    (in millions)
Commercial paper, certificates of deposit,
time deposits and other money market instruments
  $ 8,662  (1)   $     $ 8,985  (1)   $  
U.S. government, federal agency and sovereign obligations
    69,653       37,000       70,774       58,637  
Mortgage and other asset-backed loans and securities
    22,393       340       54,073  (6)      
Bank loans and bridge loans
    21,839       3,108  (4)     49,154       3,563  (4)
Corporate debt securities and other debt obligations
    27,879       5,711       39,219       8,280  
Equities and convertible debentures
    57,049       12,116       122,205       45,130  
Physical commodities
    513       2       2,571       35  
Derivative contracts
    130,337  (2)     117,695  (5)     105,614  (2)     99,378  (5)
                                 
Total
  $ 338,325  (3)   $ 175,972     $ 452,595  (3)   $ 215,023  
                                 
 
 
     
(1)
  Includes $4.40 billion and $6.17 billion as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively, of money market instruments held by William Street Funding Corporation (Funding Corp.) to support the William Street credit extension program. See Note 8 for further information regarding the William Street program.
(2)
  Net of cash received pursuant to credit support agreements of $137.16 billion and $59.05 billion as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively.
(3)
  Includes $1.68 billion and $1.17 billion as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively, of securities held within the firm’s insurance subsidiaries which are accounted for as available-for-sale under SFAS No. 115.
(4)
  Includes the fair value of commitments to extend credit.
(5)
  Net of cash paid pursuant to credit support agreements of $34.01 billion and $27.76 billion as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively.
(6)
  Includes $7.64 billion as of November 2007 of mortgage whole loans that were transferred to securitization vehicles where such transfers were accounted for as secured financings rather than sales under SFAS No. 140. The firm distributed to investors the securities that were issued by the securitization vehicles and therefore did not bear economic exposure to the underlying mortgage whole loans.


149


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
Fair Value Hierarchy
 
The firm’s financial assets at fair value classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy are summarized below:
 
                 
    As of November
    2008   2007
    ($ in millions)
Total level 3 assets
  $ 66,190     $ 69,151  
Level 3 assets for which the firm bears economic exposure (1)
    59,574       54,714  
                 
Total assets
    884,547       1,119,796  
Total financial assets at fair value
    595,234       717,557  
                 
Total level 3 assets as a percentage of Total assets
    7.5 %     6.2 %
Level 3 assets for which the firm bears economic exposure as a percentage of Total assets
    6.7       4.9  
                 
Total level 3 assets as a percentage of Total financial assets at fair value
    11.1       9.6  
Level 3 assets for which the firm bears economic exposure as a percentage of Total financial assets at fair value
    10.0       7.6  
 
 
(1) Excludes assets which are financed by nonrecourse debt, attributable to minority investors or attributable to employee interests in certain consolidated funds.
 
The following tables set forth by level within the fair value hierarchy “Trading assets, at fair value,” “Trading liabilities, at fair value” and other financial assets and financial liabilities accounted for at fair value under SFAS No. 155 and SFAS No. 159 as of November 2008 and November 2007. See Note 2 for further information on the fair value hierarchy. As required by SFAS No. 157, assets and liabilities are classified in their entirety based on the lowest level of input that is significant to the fair value measurement.


150


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
                                         
    Financial Assets at Fair Value as of November 2008
                Netting and
   
   
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
 
Collateral
 
Total
    (in millions)
Commercial paper, certificates of deposit, time deposits and other money market instruments
  $ 5,205     $ 3,457     $     $     $ 8,662  
U.S. government, federal agency and sovereign obligations
    35,069       34,584                   69,653  
Mortgage and other asset-backed loans and securities
          6,886       15,507             22,393  
Bank loans and bridge loans
          9,882       11,957             21,839  
Corporate debt securities and other debt obligations
    14       20,269       7,596             27,879  
Equities and convertible debentures
    25,068       15,975       16,006   (6)           57,049  
Physical commodities
          513                   513  
                                         
Cash instruments
    65,356       91,566       51,066             207,988  
Derivative contracts
    24       256,412       15,124       (141,223 (7)     130,337  
                                         
Trading assets, at fair value
    65,380       347,978       66,190       (141,223 )     338,325  
Securities segregated for regulatory and other purposes
    20,030  (4)     58,800  (5)                 78,830  
Receivables from customers and counterparties (1)
          1,598                   1,598  
Securities borrowed (2)
          59,810                   59,810  
Securities purchased under agreements to resell, at fair value
          116,671                   116,671  
                                         
Total financial assets at fair value
  $ 85,410     $ 584,857     $ 66,190     $ (141,223 )   $ 595,234  
                                         
Level 3 assets for which the firm does not bear economic exposure (3)
                    (6,616 )                
                                         
Level 3 assets for which the firm bears economic exposure
                  $ 59,574                  
                                         
 
 
(1)  Principally consists of transfers accounted for as secured loans rather than purchases under SFAS No. 140 and prepaid variable share forwards.
 
(2)  Consists of securities borrowed within Trading and Principal Investments. Excludes securities borrowed within Securities Services, which are accounted for based on the amount of cash collateral advanced plus accrued interest.
 
(3)  Consists of level 3 assets which are financed by nonrecourse debt, attributable to minority investors or attributable to employee interests in certain consolidated funds.
 
(4)  Consists of U.S. Treasury securities and money market instruments as well as insurance separate account assets measured at fair value under AICPA SOP 03-1, “Accounting and Reporting by Insurance Enterprises for Certain Nontraditional Long-Duration Contracts and for Separate Accounts.”
 
(5)  Principally consists of securities borrowed and resale agreements. The underlying securities have been segregated to satisfy certain regulatory requirements.
 
(6)  Consists of private equity and real estate fund investments.
 
(7)  Represents cash collateral and the impact of netting across the levels of the fair value hierarchy. Netting among positions classified within the same level is included in that level.
 


151


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
                                         
    Financial Liabilities at Fair Value as of November 2008
                Netting and
   
   
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
 
Collateral
 
Total
    (in millions)
U.S. government, federal agency and sovereign obligations
  $ 36,385     $ 615     $     $     $ 37,000  
Mortgage and other asset-backed loans and securities
          320       20             340  
Bank loans and bridge loans
          2,278       830             3,108  
Corporate debt securities and other debt obligations
    11       5,185       515             5,711  
Equities and convertible debentures
    11,928       174       14             12,116  
Physical commodities
    2                         2  
                                         
Cash instruments
    48,326       8,572       1,379             58,277  
Derivative contracts
    21       145,777       9,968       (38,071 (8)     117,695  
                                         
Trading liabilities, at fair value
    48,347       154,349       11,347       (38,071 )     175,972  
Unsecured short-term borrowings (1)
          17,916       5,159             23,075  
Deposits (2)
          4,224                   4,224  
Securities loaned (3)
          7,872                   7,872  
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase, at fair value
          62,883                   62,883  
Other secured financings (4)
          16,429       3,820             20,249  
Other liabilities (5)
          978                   978  
Unsecured long-term borrowings (6)
          15,886       1,560             17,446  
                                         
Total financial liabilities at fair value
  $ 48,347     $ 280,537     $ 21,886  (7)   $ (38,071 )   $ 312,699  
                                         
 
 
(1)  Consists of promissory notes, commercial paper and hybrid financial instruments.
 
(2)  Consists of certain certificates of deposit issued by GS Bank USA.
 
(3)  Consists of securities loaned within Trading and Principal Investments. Excludes securities loaned within Securities Services, which are accounted for based on the amount of cash collateral received plus accrued interest.
 
(4)  Primarily includes transfers accounted for as financings rather than sales under SFAS No. 140, debt raised through the firm’s William Street program and certain other nonrecourse financings.
 
(5)  Consists of liabilities related to insurance contracts.
 
(6)  Primarily includes hybrid financial instruments and prepaid physical commodity transactions.
 
(7)  Level 3 liabilities were 7.0% of Total liabilities at fair value.
 
(8)  Represents cash collateral and the impact of netting across the levels of the fair value hierarchy. Netting among positions classified within the same level is included in that level.

152


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
                                         
    Financial Assets at Fair Value as of November 2007
                Netting and
   
   
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
 
Collateral
 
Total
    (in millions)
Commercial paper, certificates of deposit, time deposits and other money market instruments
  $ 6,237     $ 2,748     $     $     $ 8,985  
U.S. government, federal agency and sovereign obligations
    37,966       32,808                   70,774  
Mortgage and other asset-backed loans and securities
          38,073       16,000             54,073  
Bank loans and bridge loans
          35,820       13,334             49,154  
Corporate debt securities and other debt obligations
    915       32,193       6,111             39,219  
Equities and convertible debentures
    68,727       35,472       18,006   (6)           122,205  
Physical commodities
          2,571                   2,571  
                                         
Cash instruments
    113,845       179,685       53,451             346,981  
Derivative contracts
    286       153,065       15,700       (63,437 (7)     105,614  
                                         
Trading assets, at fair value
    114,131       332,750       69,151       (63,437 )     452,595  
Securities segregated for regulatory and other purposes
    24,078  (4)     69,940  (5)                 94,018  
Receivables from customers and counterparties (1)
          1,950                   1,950  
Securities borrowed (2)
          83,277                   83,277  
Securities purchased under agreements to resell, at fair value
          85,717                   85,717  
                                         
Total financial assets at fair value
  $ 138,209     $ 573,634     $ 69,151     $ (63,437 )   $ 717,557  
                                         
Level 3 assets for which the firm does not bear economic exposure (3)
                    (14,437 )                
                                         
Level 3 assets for which the firm bears economic exposure
                  $ 54,714                  
                                         
 
 
(1)  Consists of transfers accounted for as secured loans rather than purchases under SFAS No. 140 and prepaid variable share forwards.
 
(2)  Consists of securities borrowed within Trading and Principal Investments. Excludes securities borrowed within Securities Services, which are accounted for based on the amount of cash collateral advanced plus accrued interest.
 
(3)  Consists of level 3 assets which are financed by nonrecourse debt, attributable to minority investors or attributable to employee interests in certain consolidated funds.
 
(4)  Consists of U.S. Treasury securities and money market instruments as well as insurance separate account assets measured at fair value under AICPA SOP 03-1, “Accounting and Reporting by Insurance Enterprises for Certain Nontraditional Long-Duration Contracts and for Separate Accounts.”
 
(5)  Principally consists of securities borrowed and resale agreements. The underlying securities have been segregated to satisfy certain regulatory requirements.
 
(6)  Consists of private equity and real estate fund investments.
 
(7)  Represents cash collateral and the impact of netting across the levels of the fair value hierarchy. Netting among positions classified within the same level is included in that level.
 


153


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
                                         
    Financial Liabilities at Fair Value as of November 2007
                Netting and
   
   
Level 1
 
Level 2
 
Level 3
 
Collateral
 
Total
    (in millions)
U.S. government, federal agency and sovereign obligations
  $ 57,714     $ 923     $     $     $ 58,637  
Bank loans and bridge loans
          3,525       38             3,563  
Corporate debt securities and other debt obligations
          7,764       516             8,280  
Equities and convertible debentures
    44,076       1,054                   45,130  
Physical commodities
          35                   35  
                                         
Cash instruments
    101,790       13,301       554             115,645  
Derivative contracts
    212       117,794       13,644       (32,272 (7)     99,378  
                                         
Trading liabilities, at fair value
    102,002       131,095       14,198       (32,272 )     215,023  
Unsecured short-term borrowings (1)
          44,060       4,271             48,331  
Deposits (2)
          463                   463  
Securities loaned (3)
          5,449                   5,449  
Securities sold under agreements to repurchase, at fair value
          159,178                   159,178  
Other secured financings (4)
          33,581                   33,581  
Unsecured long-term borrowings (5)
          15,161       767             15,928  
                                         
Total financial liabilities at fair value
  $ 102,002     $ 388,987     $ 19,236  (6)   $ (32,272 )   $ 477,953  
                                         
 
 
(1)  Consists of promissory notes, commercial paper and hybrid financial instruments.
 
(2)  Consists of certain certificates of deposit issued by GS Bank USA.
 
(3)  Consists of securities loaned within Trading and Principal Investments. Excludes securities loaned within Securities Services, which are accounted for based on the amount of cash collateral received plus accrued interest.
 
(4)  Primarily includes transfers accounted for as financings rather than sales under SFAS No. 140, debt raised through the firm’s William Street program and certain other nonrecourse financings.
 
(5)  Primarily includes hybrid financial instruments and prepaid physical commodity transactions.
 
(6)  Level 3 liabilities were 4.0% of Total liabilities at fair value.
 
(7)  Represents cash collateral and the impact of netting across the levels of the fair value hierarchy. Netting among positions classified within the same level is included in that level.

154


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
Level 3 Unrealized Gains/(Losses)
 
The table below sets forth a summary of unrealized gains/(losses) on the firm’s level 3 financial assets and financial liabilities still held at the reporting date for the years ended November 2008 and November 2007.
 
                 
    Level 3 Unrealized
    Gains/(Losses)
    Year Ended November
    2008   2007
    (in millions)
Cash Instruments — Assets
  $ (11,485 )   $ (2,292 )
Cash Instruments — Liabilities
    (871 )     (294 )
                 
Net unrealized gains/(losses) on level 3 cash instruments
    (12,356 )     (2,586 )
Derivative Contracts — Net
    5,577       4,543  
Unsecured Short-Term Borrowings
    737       (666 )
Other Secured Financings
    838        
Unsecured Long-Term Borrowings
    657       22  
                 
Total level 3 unrealized gains/(losses)
  $ (4,547 )   $ 1,313  
                 
 
Cash Instruments
 
The net unrealized loss on level 3 cash instruments of $12.36 billion for the year ended November 2008 primarily consisted of unrealized losses on loans and securities backed by commercial real estate, certain bank loans and bridge loans, private equity and real estate fund investments. Losses during the year reflected the significant weakness in the global credit and equity markets.
 
Level 3 cash instruments are frequently economically hedged with instruments classified within level 1 and level 2, and accordingly, gains or losses that have been reported in level 3 can be offset by gains or losses attributable to instruments classified within level 1 or level 2 or by gains or losses on derivative contracts classified in level 3 of the fair value hierarchy.
 
Derivative Contracts
 
The net unrealized gain on level 3 derivative contracts of $5.58 billion for the year ended November 2008 was primarily attributable to changes in observable credit spreads (which are level 2 inputs) on the underlying instruments. Level 3 gains and losses on derivative contracts should be considered in the context of the following:
 
  •  A derivative contract with level 1 and/or level 2 inputs is classified as a level 3 financial instrument in its entirety if it has at least one significant level 3 input.
 
  •  If there is one significant level 3 input, the entire gain or loss from adjusting only observable inputs (i.e., level 1 and level 2) is still classified as level 3.
 
  •  Gains or losses that have been reported in level 3 resulting from changes in level 1 or level 2 inputs are frequently offset by gains or losses attributable to instruments classified within level 1 or level 2 or by cash instruments reported in level 3 of the fair value hierarchy.


155


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
The tables below set forth a summary of changes in the fair value of the firm’s level 3 financial assets and financial liabilities for the years ended November 2008 and November 2007. The tables reflect gains and losses, including gains and losses on financial assets and financial liabilities that were transferred to level 3 during the year, for all financial assets and financial liabilities categorized as level 3 as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively. The tables do not include gains or losses that were reported in level 3 in prior periods for instruments that were sold or transferred out of level 3 prior to the end of the period presented.
 
                                                 
    Level 3 Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities
    Year Ended November 2008
    Cash
  Cash
  Derivative
  Unsecured
  Other
  Unsecured
    Instruments
  Instruments
  Contracts
  Short-Term
  Secured
  Long-Term
   
- Assets
 
- Liabilities
 
- Net
 
Borrowings
 
Financings
 
Borrowings
    (in millions)
Balance, beginning of year
  $ 53,451     $ (554 )   $ 2,056     $ (4,271 )   $     $ (767 )
Realized gains/(losses)
    1,930   (1)     28   (3)     267   (3)     354   (3)     87   (3)     (20 (3)
Unrealized gains/(losses) relating to instruments still held at the reporting date
    (11,485 (1)     (871 (3)     5,577   (3)(4)     737   (3)     838   (3)     657   (3)
Purchases, issuances and settlements
    3,955       55       (1,813 )     (1,353 )     416       (1,314 )
Transfers in and/or out of level 3
    3,215   (2)     (37 )     (931 (5)     (626 )     (5,161 (6)     (116 )
                                                 
Balance, end of year
  $ 51,066     $ (1,379 )   $ 5,156     $ (5,159 )   $ (3,820 )   $ (1,560 )
                                                 
                                                 
                                                 
    Level 3 Financial Assets and Financial Liabilities
    Year Ended November 2007
    Cash
  Cash
  Derivative
  Unsecured
  Other
  Unsecured
    Instruments
  Instruments
  Contracts
  Short-Term
  Secured
  Long-Term
   
- Assets
 
- Liabilities
 
- Net
 
Borrowings
 
Financings
 
Borrowings
            (in millions)        
Balance, beginning of year
  $ 29,905     $ (223 )   $ 580     $ (3,253 )   $     $ (135 )
Realized gains/(losses)
    2,232   (1)     (9 (3)     1,713   (3)     167   (3)           (7 (3)
Unrealized gains/(losses) relating to instruments still held at the reporting date
    (2,292 (1)     (294 (3)     4,543   (3)(4)     (666 (3)           22   (3)
Purchases, issuances and settlements
    22,561       (30 )     (1,365 )     (1,559 )           (567 )
Transfers in and/or out of level 3
    1,045   (7)     2       (3,415 (8)     1,040             (80 )
                                                 
Balance, end of year
  $ 53,451     $ (554 )   $ 2,056     $ (4,271 )   $     $ (767 )
                                                 
 
 
(1)  The aggregate amounts include approximately $(11.54) billion and $1.98 billion reported in “Trading and principal investments” and “Interest income,” respectively, in the consolidated statements of earnings for the year ended November 2008. The aggregate amounts include approximately $(1.77) billion and $1.71 billion reported in “Trading and principal investments” and “Interest income,” respectively, in the consolidated statements of earnings for the year ended November 2007.
 
(2)  Principally reflects transfers from level 2 within the fair value hierarchy of loans and securities backed by commercial real estate, reflecting reduced price transparency for these financial instruments.
 
(3)  Substantially all is reported in “Trading and principal investments” in the consolidated statements of earnings.
 
(4)  Principally resulted from changes in level 2 inputs.
 
(5)  Principally reflects transfers to level 2 within the fair value hierarchy of mortgage-related derivative assets, as recent trading activity provided improved transparency of correlation inputs. This decrease was partially offset by transfers from level 2 within the fair value hierarchy of credit and equity-linked derivatives due to reduced price transparency.
 
(6)  Consists of transfers from level 2 within the fair value hierarchy.
 
(7)  Principally reflects transfers from level 2 within the fair value hierarchy of loans and securities backed by commercial and residential real estate and certain bank loans and bridge loans, reflecting reduced price transparency for these financial instruments.
 
(8)  Principally reflects transfers from level 2 within the fair value hierarchy of structured credit derivative liabilities, due to reduced transparency of correlation inputs.


156


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
 
Impact of Credit Spreads
 
On an ongoing basis, the firm realizes gains or losses relating to changes in credit risk on derivative contracts through changes in credit mitigants or the sale or unwind of the contracts. The net gain/(loss) attributable to the impact of changes in credit exposure and credit spreads on derivative contracts was $(137) million and $86 million for the years ended November 2008 and November 2007, respectively.
 
The following table sets forth the net gains attributable to the impact of changes in the firm’s own credit spreads on unsecured borrowings for which the fair value option was elected. The firm calculates the fair value of unsecured borrowings by discounting future cash flows at a rate which incorporates the firm’s observable credit spreads.
 
                 
    Year Ended November
    2008   2007
    (in millions)
Net gains including hedges
  $ 1,127     $ 203  
Net gains excluding hedges
    1,196       216  
 
The impact of changes in instrument-specific credit spreads on loans and loan commitments for which the fair value option was elected was a loss of $4.61 billion for the year ended November 2008 and not material for the year ended November 2007. The firm attributes changes in the fair value of floating rate loans and loan commitments to changes in instrument-specific credit spreads. For fixed rate loans and loan commitments, the firm allocates changes in fair value between interest rate-related changes and credit spread-related changes based on changes in interest rates. See below for additional details regarding the fair value option.
 
The Fair Value Option
 
Gains/Losses
 
The following table sets forth the gains/(losses) included in earnings for the years ended November 2008 and November 2007 as a result of the firm electing to apply the fair value option to certain financial assets and financial liabilities, as described in Note 2. The table excludes gains and losses related to trading assets and trading liabilities, as well as gains and losses that would have been recognized under other generally accepted accounting principles if the firm had not elected the fair value option or that are economically hedged with instruments accounted for at fair value under other generally accepted accounting principles.
 
                 
    Year Ended November
    2008   2007
    (in millions)
Unsecured long-term borrowings (1)
  $ 915     $ 202  
Other secured financings (2)
    894       (293 )
Unsecured short-term borrowings (3)
    266       6  
Other (4)
    (20 )     18  
                 
Total (5)
  $ 2,055     $ (67 )
                 
 
 
(1) Excludes gains of $2.42 billion and losses of $2.18 billion for the years ended November 2008 and November 2007, respectively, related to the derivative component of hybrid financial instruments. Such gains and losses would have been recognized pursuant to SFAS No. 133 if the firm had not elected to account for the entire hybrid instrument at fair value under the fair value option.


157


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
(2) Excludes gains of $1.29 billion and $2.19 billion for the years ended November 2008 and November 2007, respectively, related to financings recorded as a result of securitization-related transactions that were accounted for as secured financings rather than sales under SFAS No. 140. Changes in the fair value of these secured financings are offset by changes in the fair value of the related financial instruments included within the firm’s “Trading assets, at fair value” in the consolidated statements of financial condition.
 
(3) Excludes gains of $6.37 billion and losses of $1.07 billion for the years ended November 2008 and November 2007, respectively, related to the derivative component of hybrid financial instruments. Such gains and losses would have been recognized pursuant to SFAS No. 133 if the firm had not elected to account for the entire hybrid instrument at fair value under the fair value option.
 
(4) Primarily consists of certain insurance and reinsurance contracts, resale and repurchase agreements and securities borrowed and loaned within Trading and Principal Investments.
 
(5) Reported within “Trading and principal investments” within the consolidated statements of earnings. The amounts exclude contractual interest, which is included in “Interest income” and “Interest expense,” for all instruments other than hybrid financial instruments.
 
All trading assets and trading liabilities are accounted for at fair value either under the fair value option or as required by other accounting pronouncements. Excluding equities commissions of $5.00 billion and $4.58 billion for the years ended November 2008 and November 2007, respectively, and the gains and losses on the instruments accounted for under the fair value option described above, the firm’s “Trading and principal investments” revenues in the consolidated statements of earnings primarily represent gains and losses on “Trading assets, at fair value” and “Trading liabilities, at fair value” in the consolidated statements of financial condition.
 
Loans and Loan Commitments
 
As of November 2008, the aggregate contractual principal amount of loans and long-term receivables for which the fair value option was elected exceeded the related fair value by $50.21 billion, including a difference of $37.46 billion related to loans with an aggregate fair value of $3.77 billion that were on nonaccrual status (including loans more than 90 days past due). The aggregate contractual principal exceeds the related fair value primarily because the firm regularly purchases loans, such as distressed loans, at values significantly below contractual principal amounts.
 
As of November 2008, the fair value of unfunded lending commitments for which the fair value option was elected was a liability of $3.52 billion and the related total contractual amount of these lending commitments was $39.49 billion.
 
As of November 2007, substantially all of the firm’s loans and unfunded lending commitments were recorded at fair value in accordance with specialized industry accounting for broker-dealers, and not pursuant to the fair value option. As a result, the difference between the aggregate fair value and related contractual principal amounts of loans and long-term receivables accounted for under the fair value option was not material as of November 2007. See Note 2 for further information related to fair value option elections made by the firm upon becoming a bank holding company in September 2008.
 
Long-term Debt Instruments
 
The aggregate contractual principal amount of long-term debt instruments (principal and non-principal protected) for which the fair value option was elected exceeded the related fair value by $2.42 billion as of November 2008, while the difference between the fair value and the aggregate contractual principal amount was not material to the carrying value as of November 2007.


158


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
Credit Concentrations
 
Credit concentrations may arise from trading, investing, underwriting and securities borrowing activities and may be impacted by changes in economic, industry or political factors. The firm seeks to mitigate credit risk by actively monitoring exposures and obtaining collateral as deemed appropriate. While the firm’s activities expose it to many different industries and counterparties, the firm routinely executes a high volume of transactions with counterparties in the financial services industry, including brokers and dealers, commercial banks, investment funds and other institutional clients, resulting in significant credit concentration with respect to this industry. In the ordinary course of business, the firm may also be subject to a concentration of credit risk to a particular counterparty, borrower or issuer.
 
As of November 2008 and November 2007, the firm held $53.98 billion (6% of total assets) and $45.75 billion (4% of total assets), respectively, of U.S. government and federal agency obligations included in “Trading assets, at fair value” and “Cash and securities segregated for regulatory and other purposes” in the consolidated statements of financial condition. As of November 2008 and November 2007, the firm held $21.13 billion (2% of total assets) and $31.65 billion (3% of total assets), respectively, of other sovereign obligations, principally consisting of securities issued by the governments of Japan and the United Kingdom. In addition, as of November 2008 and November 2007, $126.27 billion and $144.92 billion of the firm’s securities purchased under agreements to resell and securities borrowed (including those in “Cash and securities segregated for regulatory and other purposes”), respectively, were collateralized by U.S. government and federal agency obligations. As of November 2008 and November 2007, $65.37 billion and $41.26 billion of the firm’s securities purchased under agreements to resell and securities borrowed, respectively, were collateralized by other sovereign obligations. As of November 2008 and November 2007, the firm did not have credit exposure to any other counterparty that exceeded 2% of the firm’s total assets.
 
Derivative Activities
 
Derivative contracts are instruments, such as futures, forwards, swaps or option contracts, that derive their value from underlying assets, indices, reference rates or a combination of these factors. Derivative instruments may be privately negotiated contracts, which are often referred to as OTC derivatives, or they may be listed and traded on an exchange. Derivatives may involve future commitments to purchase or sell financial instruments or commodities, or to exchange currency or interest payment streams. The amounts exchanged are based on the specific terms of the contract with reference to specified rates, securities, commodities, currencies or indices.
 
Certain cash instruments, such as mortgage-backed securities, interest-only and principal-only obligations, and indexed debt instruments, are not considered derivatives even though their values or contractually required cash flows are derived from the price of some other security or index. However, certain commodity-related contracts are included in the firm’s derivatives disclosure, as these contracts may be settled in cash or the assets to be delivered under the contract are readily convertible into cash.
 
The firm enters into derivative transactions to facilitate client transactions, to take proprietary positions and as a means of risk management. Risk exposures are managed through diversification, by controlling position sizes and by entering into offsetting positions. For example, the firm may manage the risk related to a portfolio of common stock by entering into an offsetting position in a related equity-index futures contract.
 
The firm applies hedge accounting under SFAS No. 133 to certain derivative contracts. The firm uses these derivatives to manage certain interest rate and currency exposures, including the firm’s net investment in non-U.S. operations. The firm designates certain interest rate swap contracts as fair value hedges. These interest rate swap contracts hedge changes in the relevant benchmark interest


159


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
rate (e.g., London Interbank Offered Rate (LIBOR)), effectively converting a substantial portion of the firm’s unsecured long-term and certain unsecured short-term borrowings into floating rate obligations. See Note 2 for information regarding the firm’s accounting policy for foreign currency forward contracts used to hedge its net investment in non-U.S. operations.
 
The firm applies a long-haul method to all of its hedge accounting relationships to perform an ongoing assessment of the effectiveness of these relationships in achieving offsetting changes in fair value or offsetting cash flows attributable to the risk being hedged. The firm utilizes a dollar-offset method, which compares the change in the fair value of the hedging instrument to the change in the fair value of the hedged item, excluding the effect of the passage of time, to prospectively and retrospectively assess hedge effectiveness. The firm’s prospective dollar-offset assessment utilizes scenario analyses to test hedge effectiveness via simulations of numerous parallel and slope shifts of the relevant yield curve. Parallel shifts change the interest rate of all maturities by identical amounts. Slope shifts change the curvature of the yield curve. For both the prospective assessment, in response to each of the simulated yield curve shifts, and the retrospective assessment, a hedging relationship is deemed to be effective if the fair value of the hedging instrument and the hedged item change inversely within a range of 80% to 125%.
 
For fair value hedges, gains or losses on derivative transactions are recognized in “Interest expense” in the consolidated statements of earnings. The change in fair value of the hedged item attributable to the risk being hedged is reported as an adjustment to its carrying value and is subsequently amortized into interest expense over its remaining life. Gains or losses related to hedge ineffectiveness for all hedges are generally included in “Interest expense.” These gains or losses and the component of gains or losses on derivative transactions excluded from the assessment of hedge effectiveness (e.g., the effect of the passage of time on fair value hedges of the firm’s borrowings) were not material to the firm’s results of operations for the years ended November 2008, November 2007 and November 2006. Gains and losses on derivatives used for trading purposes are included in “Trading and principal investments” in the consolidated statements of earnings.
 
The fair value of the firm’s derivative contracts is reflected net of cash paid or received pursuant to credit support agreements and is reported on a net-by-counterparty basis in the firm’s consolidated statements of financial condition when management believes a legal right of setoff exists under an enforceable netting agreement. The fair value of derivative financial instruments, presented in accordance with the firm’s netting policy, is set forth below:
 
                                 
    As of November
    2008   2007
   
Assets
 
Liabilities
 
Assets
 
Liabilities
    (in millions)
Contract Type
                               
Forward settlement contracts
  $ 35,997     $ 35,778     $ 22,561     $ 27,138  
Swap agreements
    175,153       82,189       104,793       62,697  
Option contracts
    81,077       58,467       53,056       53,047  
                                 
Subtotal
    292,227       176,434       180,410       142,882  
Netting across contract types (1)
    (24,730 )     (24,730 )     (15,746 )     (15,746 )
Cash collateral netting (2)
    (137,160 )     (34,009 )     (59,050 )     (27,758 )
                                 
Total
  $ 130,337     $ 117,695     $ 105,614     $ 99,378  
                                 
 
 
(1) Represents the netting of receivable balances with payable balances for the same counterparty across contract types pursuant to legally enforceable netting agreements.
 
(2) Represents the netting of cash collateral received and posted on a counterparty basis pursuant to credit support agreements.


160


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
The fair value of derivatives accounted for as qualifying hedges under SFAS No. 133 consisted of $20.40 billion and $5.15 billion in assets as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively, and $128 million and $355 million in liabilities as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively.
 
The firm also has embedded derivatives that have been bifurcated from related borrowings under SFAS No. 133. Such derivatives, which are classified in unsecured short-term and unsecured long-term borrowings, had a carrying value of $(774) million and $463 million (excluding the debt host contract) as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively. See Notes 6 and 7 for further information regarding the firm’s unsecured borrowings.
 
The firm enters into various derivative transactions that are considered credit derivatives under FSP No. FAS 133-1 and FIN 45-4. The firm’s written and purchased credit derivatives include credit default swaps, credit spread options, credit index products and total return swaps. As of November 2008, the firm’s written and purchased credit derivatives had total gross notional amounts of $3.78 trillion and $4.03 trillion, respectively, for total net purchased protection of $255.24 billion in notional value.
 
The following table sets forth certain information related to the firm’s credit derivatives. Fair values in the table below exclude the effects of both netting under enforceable netting agreements and netting of cash paid pursuant to credit support agreements, and therefore are not representative of the firm’s net exposure.
 
                                                         
    As of November 2008
    Maximum Payout/Notional Amount by Period of Expiration   Maximum Payout/Notional Amount    
                    Offsetting
  Other
  Written
                Written
  Purchased
  Purchased
  Credit
            10 Years
  Credit
  Credit
  Credit
  Derivatives at
   
0 - 5 Years
 
5 - 10 Years
 
or Greater
 
Derivatives
 
Derivatives (1)
 
Derivatives (2)
 
Fair Value
    ($ in millions)
Credit spread on underlying (basis points) (3)                                                        
0-250
  $ 1,194,228     $ 609,056     $ 22,866     $ 1,826,150     $ 1,632,681     $ 347,573     $ 77,836  
251-500
    591,813       184,763       12,494       789,070       784,149       26,316       94,278  
501-1,000
    430,801       140,782       15,886       587,469       538,251       67,958       75,079  
Greater than 1,000
    383,626       120,866       71,690       576,182       533,816       103,362       222,346  
                                                         
Total
  $ 2,600,468  (4)   $ 1,055,467     $ 122,936     $ 3,778,871     $ 3,488,897  (4)   $ 545,209     $ 469,539  (5)
                                                         
 
 
(1)  Offsetting purchased credit derivatives represent the notional amount of purchased credit derivatives to the extent they hedge written credit derivatives with identical underlyings.
 
(2)  Comprised of purchased protection in excess of the amount of written protection on identical underlyings and purchased protection on other underlyings on which the firm has not written protection.
 
(3)  Credit spread on the underlying, together with the period of expiration, are indicators of payment/performance risk. For example, the firm is least likely to pay or otherwise be required to perform where the credit spread on the underlying is “0-250” basis points and the period of expiration is “0-5 Years.” The likelihood of payment or performance is generally greater as the credit spread on the underlying and period of expiration increase.
 
(4)  Includes a maximum payout/notional amount for written credit derivatives of $208.44 billion expiring within one year as of November 2008.
 
(5)  This liability excludes the effects of both netting under enforceable netting agreements and netting of cash collateral paid pursuant to credit support agreements. Including the effects of netting receivable balances with payable balances for the same counterparty pursuant to enforceable netting agreements, the firm’s net liability related to credit derivatives in the firm’s statement of financial condition as of November 2008 was $33.76 billion. This net amount excludes the netting of cash collateral paid pursuant to credit support agreements.


161


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
 
Collateralized Transactions
 
The firm receives financial instruments as collateral, primarily in connection with resale agreements, securities borrowed, derivative transactions and customer margin loans. Such financial instruments may include obligations of the U.S. government, federal agencies, sovereigns and corporations, as well as equities and convertibles.
 
In many cases, the firm is permitted to deliver or repledge these financial instruments in connection with entering into repurchase agreements, securities lending agreements and other secured financings, collateralizing derivative transactions and meeting firm or customer settlement requirements. As of November 2008 and November 2007, the fair value of financial instruments received as collateral by the firm that it was permitted to deliver or repledge was $578.72 billion and $891.05 billion, respectively, of which the firm delivered or repledged $445.11 billion and $785.62 billion, respectively.
 
The firm also pledges assets that it owns to counterparties who may or may not have the right to deliver or repledge them. Trading assets pledged to counterparties that have the right to deliver or repledge are included in “Trading assets, at fair value” in the consolidated statements of financial condition and were $26.31 billion and $46.14 billion as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively. Trading assets, pledged in connection with repurchase agreements, securities lending agreements and other secured financings to counterparties that did not have the right to sell or repledge are included in “Trading assets, at fair value” in the consolidated statements of financial condition and were $80.85 billion and $156.92 billion as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively. Other assets (primarily real estate and cash) owned and pledged in connection with other secured financings to counterparties that did not have the right to sell or repledge were $9.24 billion and $5.86 billion as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively.
 
In addition to repurchase agreements and securities lending agreements, the firm obtains secured funding through the use of other arrangements. Other secured financings include arrangements that are nonrecourse, that is, only the subsidiary that executed the arrangement or a subsidiary guaranteeing the arrangement is obligated to repay the financing. Other secured financings consist of liabilities related to the firm’s William Street program, consolidated VIEs, collateralized central bank financings, transfers of financial assets that are accounted for as financings rather than sales under SFAS No. 140 (primarily pledged bank loans and mortgage whole loans) and other structured financing arrangements.


162


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
Other secured financings by maturity are set forth in the table below:
 
                 
    As of November
    2008   2007
    (in millions)
Other secured financings (short-term) (1)(2)
  $ 21,225     $ 32,410  
Other secured financings (long-term):
               
2009
          2,903  
2010
    2,157       2,301  
2011
    4,578       2,427  
2012
    3,040       4,973  
2013
    1,377       702  
2014-thereafter
    6,306       19,994  
                 
Total other secured financings (long-term) (3)(4)
    17,458       33,300  
                 
Total other secured financings (5)
  $ 38,683     $ 65,710  
                 
 
 
(1) As of November 2008, consists of U.S. dollar-denominated financings of $12.53 billion with a weighted average interest rate of 2.98% and non-U.S. dollar-denominated financings of $8.70 billion with a weighted average interest rate of 0.95%, after giving effect to hedging activities. As of November 2007, consists of U.S. dollar-denominated financings of $18.47 billion with a weighted average interest rate of 5.32% and non-U.S. dollar-denominated financings of $13.94 billion with a weighted average interest rate of 0.91%, after giving effect to hedging activities. The weighted average interest rates as of November 2008 and November 2007 excluded financial instruments accounted for at fair value under SFAS No. 159.
 
(2) Includes other secured financings maturing within one year of the financial statement date and other secured financings that are redeemable within one year of the financial statement date at the option of the holder.
 
(3) As of November 2008, consists of U.S. dollar-denominated financings of $9.55 billion with a weighted average interest rate of 4.62% and non-U.S. dollar-denominated financings of $7.91 billion with a weighted average interest rate of 4.39%, after giving effect to hedging activities. As of November 2007, consists of U.S. dollar-denominated financings of $22.13 billion with a weighted average interest rate of 5.73% and non-U.S. dollar-denominated financings of $11.17 billion with a weighted average interest rate of 4.28%, after giving effect to hedging activities. The weighted average interest rates as of November 2008 and November 2007 excluded financial instruments accounted for at fair value under SFAS No. 159.
 
(4) Secured long-term financings that are repayable prior to maturity at the option of the firm are reflected at their contractual maturity dates. Secured long-term financings that are redeemable prior to maturity at the option of the holder are reflected at the dates such options become exercisable.
 
(5) As of November 2008, $31.54 billion of these financings were collateralized by financial instruments and $7.14 billion by other assets (primarily real estate and cash). As of November 2007, $61.34 billion of these financings were collateralized by financial instruments and $4.37 billion by other assets (primarily real estate and cash). Other secured financings include $13.74 billion and $25.37 billion of nonrecourse obligations as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively.
 
Note 4.   Securitization Activities and Variable Interest Entities
 
Securitization Activities
 
The firm securitizes commercial and residential mortgages, home equity and auto loans, government and corporate bonds and other types of financial assets. The firm acts as underwriter of the beneficial interests that are sold to investors. The firm derecognizes financial assets transferred in securitizations, provided it has relinquished control over such assets. Transferred assets are accounted for at fair value prior to securitization. Net revenues related to these underwriting activities are recognized in connection with the sales of the underlying beneficial interests to investors.


163


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
The firm may retain interests in securitized financial assets, primarily in the form of senior or subordinated securities, including residual interests. Retained interests are accounted for at fair value and are included in “Trading assets, at fair value” in the consolidated statements of financial condition.
 
The following table sets forth the amount of financial assets the firm securitized, as well as cash flows received on retained interests:
 
                 
    Year Ended November
    2008   2007
    (in millions)
Residential mortgages
  $ 6,671     $ 24,954  
Commercial mortgages
    773       19,498  
Other financial assets
    7,014  (1)     36,948  (2)
                 
Total
  $ 14,458     $ 81,400  
                 
Cash flows received on retained interests
  $ 505     $ 705  
                 
 
 
(1) Primarily in connection with collateralized loan obligations (CLOs).
 
(2) Primarily in connection with CDOs and CLOs.
 
As of November 2008 and November 2007, the firm held $1.78 billion and $4.57 billion of retained interests, respectively, from securitization activities, including $1.53 billion and $2.72 billion, respectively, held in QSPEs.
 
The following table sets forth the weighted average key economic assumptions used in measuring the fair value of the firm’s retained interests and the sensitivity of this fair value to immediate adverse changes of 10% and 20% in those assumptions:
 
                                 
    As of November 2008   As of November 2007
    Type of Retained Interests   Type of Retained Interests
    Mortgage-
  CDOs and
  Mortgage-
  CDOs and
   
Backed
 
CLOs (4)
 
Backed
 
CLOs (4)
        ($ in millions)    
Fair value of retained interests
  $ 1,415     $ 367     $ 3,378     $ 1,188  
                                 
Weighted average life (years)
    6.0       5.1       6.6       2.7  
                                 
Constant prepayment rate (1)
    15.5 %     4.5 %     15.1 %     11.9 %
Impact of 10% adverse change (1)
  $ (14 )   $ (6 )   $ (50 )   $ (43 )
Impact of 20% adverse change (1)
    (27 )     (12 )     (91 )     (98 )
                                 
Anticipated credit losses (2)
    2.0 %     N/A       4.3 %     N/A  
Impact of 10% adverse change (3)
  $ (1 )   $     $ (45 )   $  
Impact of 20% adverse change (3)
    (2 )           (72 )      
                                 
Discount rate
    21.1 %     29.2 %     8.4 %     23.1 %
Impact of 10% adverse change
  $ (46 )   $ (25 )   $ (89 )   $ (46 )
Impact of 20% adverse change
    (89 )     (45 )     (170 )     (92 )
 
 
  (1)  Constant prepayment rate is included only for positions for which constant prepayment rate is a key assumption in the determination of fair value.
 
  (2)  Anticipated credit losses are computed only on positions for which expected credit loss is a key assumption in the determination of fair value or positions for which expected credit loss is not reflected within the discount rate.
 
  (3)  The impacts of adverse change take into account credit mitigants incorporated in the retained interests, including over-collateralization and subordination provisions.
 
  (4)  Includes $192 million and $905 million as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively, of retained interests related to transfers of securitized assets that were accounted for as secured financings rather than sales under SFAS No. 140.


164


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
 
The preceding table does not give effect to the offsetting benefit of other financial instruments that are held to mitigate risks inherent in these retained interests. Changes in fair value based on an adverse variation in assumptions generally cannot be extrapolated because the relationship of the change in assumptions to the change in fair value is not usually linear. In addition, the impact of a change in a particular assumption is calculated independently of changes in any other assumption. In practice, simultaneous changes in assumptions might magnify or counteract the sensitivities disclosed above.
 
In addition to the retained interests described above, the firm also held interests in residential mortgage QSPEs purchased in connection with secondary market-making activities. These purchased interests were approximately $4 billion and $6 billion as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively.
 
As of November 2008 and November 2007, the firm held mortgage servicing rights with a fair value of $147 million and $93 million, respectively. These servicing assets represent the firm’s right to receive a future stream of cash flows, such as servicing fees, in excess of the firm’s obligation to service residential mortgages. The fair value of mortgage servicing rights will fluctuate in response to changes in certain economic variables, such as discount rates and loan prepayment rates. The firm estimates the fair value of mortgage servicing rights by using valuation models that incorporate these variables in quantifying anticipated cash flows related to servicing activities. Mortgage servicing rights are included in “Trading assets, at fair value” in the consolidated statements of financial condition and are classified within level 3 of the fair value hierarchy. The following table sets forth changes in the firm’s mortgage servicing rights, as well as servicing fees earned:
 
         
    Year Ended
   
November 2008
    (in millions)
Balance, beginning of year
  $ 93  
Purchases (1)
    272  
Servicing assets that resulted from transfers of financial assets
    3  
Changes in fair value due to changes in valuation inputs and assumptions
    (221 )
         
Balance, end of year (2)
  $ 147  
         
         
Contractually specified servicing fees
  $ 315  
         
 
 
(1) Primarily related to the acquisition of Litton Loan Servicing LP.
 
(2) As of November 2008, the fair value was estimated using a weighted average discount rate of approximately 16% and a weighted average prepayment rate of approximately 27%.


165


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
Variable Interest Entities (VIEs)
 
The firm, in the ordinary course of business, retains interests in VIEs in connection with its securitization activities. The firm also purchases and sells variable interests in VIEs, which primarily issue mortgage-backed and other asset-backed securities, CDOs and CLOs, in connection with its market-making activities and makes investments in and loans to VIEs that hold performing and nonperforming debt, equity, real estate, power-related and other assets. In addition, the firm utilizes VIEs to provide investors with principal-protected notes, credit-linked notes and asset-repackaged notes designed to meet their objectives.
 
VIEs generally purchase assets by issuing debt and equity instruments. In certain instances, the firm provides guarantees to VIEs or holders of variable interests in VIEs. In such cases, the maximum exposure to loss included in the tables set forth below is the notional amount of such guarantees. Such amounts do not represent anticipated losses in connection with these guarantees.
 
The firm’s variable interests in VIEs include senior and subordinated debt; loan commitments; limited and general partnership interests; preferred and common stock; interest rate, foreign currency, equity, commodity and credit derivatives; guarantees; and residual interests in mortgage-backed and asset-backed securitization vehicles, CDOs and CLOs. The firm’s exposure to the obligations of VIEs is generally limited to its interests in these entities.


166


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
The following tables set forth total assets in nonconsolidated VIEs in which the firm holds significant variable interests and the firm’s maximum exposure to loss excluding the benefit of offsetting financial instruments that are held to mitigate the risks associated with these variable interests. The firm has aggregated nonconsolidated VIEs based on principal business activity, as reflected in the first column. The nature of the firm’s variable interests can take different forms, as described in the columns under maximum exposure to loss.
 
                                                   
    As of November 2008
          Maximum Exposure to Loss in Nonconsolidated VIEs (1)
          Purchased
  Commitments
           
          and Retained
  and
      Loans and
   
   
VIE Assets
   
Interests
 
Guarantees
 
Derivatives
 
Investments
 
Total
          (in millions)    
Mortgage CDOs
  $ 13,061       $ 242     $     $ 5,616  (4)   $     $ 5,858  
Corporate CDOs and CLOs
    8,584         161             918  (5)           1,079  
Real estate, credit-related and other investing (2)
    26,898               143             3,223       3,366  
Municipal bond securitizations
    111               111                   111  
Other asset-backed
    4,355                     1,084             1,084  
Power-related
    844               37             213       250  
Principal-protected notes (3)
    4,516                     4,353             4,353  
                                                   
Total
  $ 58,369       $ 403     $ 291     $ 11,971     $ 3,436     $ 16,101  
                                                   
                                                   
                                                   
    As of November 2007
          Maximum Exposure to Loss in Nonconsolidated VIEs (1)
          Purchased
  Commitments
           
          and Retained
  and
      Loans and
   
   
VIE Assets
   
Interests
 
Guarantees
 
Derivatives
 
Investments
 
Total
          (in millions)    
Mortgage CDOs
  $ 18,914       $ 1,011     $     $ 10,089  (4)   $     $ 11,100  
Corporate CDOs and CLOs
    10,750         411             2,218  (5)           2,629  
Real estate, credit-related and other investing (2)
    17,272               107       12       3,141       3,260  
Municipal bond securitizations
    1,413               1,413                   1,413  
Other mortgage-backed
    3,881         719                         719  
Other asset-backed
    3,771                     1,579             1,579  
Power-related
    438         2       37             16       55  
Principal-protected notes (3)
    5,698                     5,186             5,186  
                                                   
Total
  $ 62,137       $ 2,143     $ 1,557     $ 19,084     $ 3,157     $ 25,941  
                                                   
 
 
(1)  Such amounts do not represent the anticipated losses in connection with these transactions as they exclude the effect of offsetting financial instruments that are held to mitigate these risks.
 
(2)  The firm obtains interests in these VIEs in connection with making investments in real estate, distressed loans and other types of debt, mezzanine instruments and equities.
 
(3)  Consists of out-of-the-money written put options that provide principal protection to clients invested in various fund products, with risk to the firm mitigated through portfolio rebalancing.
 
(4)  Primarily consists of written protection on investment-grade, short-term collateral held by VIEs that have issued CDOs.
 
(5)  Primarily consists of total return swaps on CDOs and CLOs. The firm has generally transferred the risks related to the underlying securities through derivatives with non-VIEs.


167


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
 
The following table sets forth the firm’s total assets and maximum exposure to loss excluding the benefit of offsetting financial instruments that are held to mitigate the risks associated with its significant variable interests in consolidated VIEs where the firm does not hold a majority voting interest. The firm has aggregated consolidated VIEs based on principal business activity, as reflected in the first column.
 
                                 
    As of November 2008   As of November 2007
        Maximum
      Maximum
        Exposure
      Exposure
   
VIE Assets (1)
 
to Loss (2)
 
VIE Assets (1)
 
to Loss (2)
        (in millions)    
Real estate, credit-related and other investing
  $ 1,560     $ 469     $ 2,118     $ 525  
Municipal bond securitizations
    985       985       1,959       1,959  
CDOs, mortgage-backed and other asset-backed
    32             604       109  
Foreign exchange and commodities
    652       740       300       329  
Principal-protected notes
    215       233       1,119       1,118  
                                 
Total
  $ 3,444     $ 2,427     $ 6,100     $ 4,040  
                                 
 
 
(1) Consolidated VIE assets include assets financed on a nonrecourse basis.
 
(2) Such amounts do not represent the anticipated losses in connection with these transactions as they exclude the effect of offsetting financial instruments that are held to mitigate these risks.
 
The firm did not have off-balance-sheet commitments to purchase or finance any CDOs held by structured investment vehicles as of November 2008 or November 2007.
 
Note 5.   Deposits
 
The following table sets forth deposits as of November 2008 and November 2007:
 
                 
    As of November
    2008   2007
    (in millions)
U.S. offices (1)
  $ 23,018     $ 15,272  
Non-U.S. offices (2)
    4,625       98  
                 
Total (includes $4,224 and $463 at fair value as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively)
  $ 27,643     $ 15,370  
                 
 
 
(1) Substantially all U.S. deposits were interest-bearing and were held at GS Bank USA.
 
(2) All non-U.S. deposits were interest-bearing and were primarily held at Goldman Sachs Bank (Europe) PLC (GS Bank Europe).


168


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
 
Included in the above table are time deposits of $8.49 billion and $463 million, as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively. The following table sets forth the maturities of time deposits as of November 2008:
 
                         
    As of November 2008
   
U.S.
 
Non-U.S.
 
Total
    (in millions)
2009
  $ 3,583     $     $ 3,583  
2010
    937       30       967  
2011
    661             661  
2012
    286             286  
2013
    1,431       25       1,456  
2014-thereafter
    1,532             1,532  
                         
Total
  $ 8,430     $ 55     $ 8,485  
                         
 
Note 6.   Short-Term Borrowings
 
As of November 2008, short-term borrowings were $73.89 billion, comprised of $21.23 billion included in “Other secured financings” in the consolidated statement of financial condition and $52.66 billion of unsecured short-term borrowings. As of November 2007, short-term borrowings were $103.97 billion, comprised of $32.41 billion included in “Other secured financings” in the consolidated statement of financial condition and $71.56 billion of unsecured short-term borrowings. See Note 3 for information on other secured financings.
 
Unsecured short-term borrowings include the portion of unsecured long-term borrowings maturing within one year of the financial statement date and unsecured long-term borrowings that are redeemable within one year of the financial statement date at the option of the holder. The firm accounts for promissory notes, commercial paper and certain hybrid financial instruments at fair value under SFAS No. 155 or SFAS No. 159. Short-term borrowings that are not recorded at fair value are recorded based on the amount of cash received plus accrued interest, and such amounts approximate fair value due to the short-term nature of the obligations.
 
Unsecured short-term borrowings are set forth below:
 
                 
    As of November
    2008   2007
    (in millions)
Current portion of unsecured long-term borrowings (1)
  $ 26,281     $ 22,740  
Hybrid financial instruments
    12,086       22,318  
Promissory notes (2)
    6,944       13,251  
Commercial paper (3)
    1,125       4,343  
Other short-term borrowings
    6,222       8,905  
                 
Total (4)
  $ 52,658     $ 71,557  
                 
 
 
(1) Includes $25.12 billion and $21.24 billion as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively, issued by
Group Inc.
 
(2) Includes $3.42 billion as of November 2008 guaranteed by the Federal Deposit Insurance Corporation (FDIC) under the Temporary Liquidity Guarantee Program (TLGP).
 
(3) Includes $751 million as of November 2008 guaranteed by the FDIC under the TLGP.
 
(4) The weighted average interest rates for these borrowings, after giving effect to hedging activities, were 3.37% and 4.77% as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively. The weighted average interest rates as of November 2008 and November 2007 excluded financial instruments accounted for at fair value under SFAS No. 155 or SFAS No. 159.


169


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
Note 7.   Long-Term Borrowings
 
As of November 2008, long-term borrowings were $185.68 billion, comprised of $17.46 billion included in “Other secured financings” in the consolidated statements of financial condition and $168.22 billion of unsecured long-term borrowings. As of November 2007, long-term borrowings were $197.47 billion, comprised of $33.30 billion included in “Other secured financings” in the consolidated statements of financial condition and $164.17 billion of unsecured long-term borrowings. See Note 3 for information on other secured financings.
 
The firm’s unsecured long-term borrowings extend through 2043 and consist principally of senior borrowings.
 
Unsecured long-term borrowings issued by Group Inc. and its subsidiaries are set forth below:
 
                 
    As of November
    2008   2007
    (in millions)
Fixed rate obligations (1)
               
Group Inc. 
  $ 101,454     $ 82,276  
Subsidiaries
    2,371       2,144  
Floating rate obligations (2)
               
Group Inc. 
    57,018       73,075  
Subsidiaries
    7,377       6,679  
                 
Total (3)
  $ 168,220     $ 164,174  
                 
 
 
(1) As of November 2008 and November 2007, $70.08 billion and $55.28 billion, respectively, of the firm’s fixed rate debt obligations were denominated in U.S. dollars and interest rates ranged from 3.87% to 10.04% and from 3.88% to 10.04%, respectively. As of November 2008 and November 2007, $33.75 billion and $29.14 billion, respectively, of the firm’s fixed rate debt obligations were denominated in non-U.S. dollars and interest rates ranged from 0.67% to 8.88% for both periods.
 
(2) As of November 2008 and November 2007, $32.41 billion and $47.31 billion, respectively, of the firm’s floating rate debt obligations were denominated in U.S. dollars. As of November 2008 and November 2007, $31.99 billion and $32.44 billion, respectively, of the firm’s floating rate debt obligations were denominated in non-U.S. dollars. Floating interest rates generally are based on LIBOR or the federal funds target rate. Equity-linked and indexed instruments are included in floating rate obligations.
 
(3) Includes $3.36 billion and $3.05 billion as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively, of foreign currency-denominated debt designated as hedges of net investments in non-U.S. subsidiaries under SFAS No. 133.


170


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
Unsecured long-term borrowings by maturity date are set forth below:
 
                                                 
    As of November
    2008 (1)(2)   2007 (1)(2)
   
Group Inc.
 
Subsidiaries
 
Total
 
Group Inc.
 
Subsidiaries
 
Total
    (in millions)
2009
  $     $     $     $ 22,695     $ 487     $ 23,182  
2010
    13,967       276       14,243       13,433       270       13,703  
2011
    10,377       502       10,879       10,572       115       10,687  
2012
    16,806       66       16,872       18,487       121       18,608  
2013
    21,627       251       21,878       15,501       315       15,816  
2014-thereafter
    95,695       8,653       104,348       74,663       7,515       82,178  
                                                 
Total
  $ 158,472     $ 9,748     $ 168,220     $ 155,351     $ 8,823     $ 164,174  
                                                 
 
 
(1) Unsecured long-term borrowings maturing within one year of the financial statement date and certain unsecured long-term borrowings that are redeemable within one year of the financial statement date at the option of the holder are included as unsecured short-term borrowings in the consolidated statements of financial condition.
 
(2) Unsecured long-term borrowings that are repayable prior to maturity at the option of the firm are reflected at their contractual maturity dates. Unsecured long-term borrowings that are redeemable prior to maturity at the option of the holder are reflected at the dates such options become exercisable.
 
The firm enters into derivative contracts to effectively convert a substantial portion of its unsecured long-term borrowings which are not accounted for at fair value into U.S. dollar-based floating rate obligations. Accordingly, excluding the cumulative impact of changes in the firm’s credit spreads, the carrying value of unsecured long-term borrowings approximated fair value as of November 2008 and November 2007. For unsecured long-term borrowings for which the firm did not elect the fair value option, the cumulative impact due to the widening of the firm’s own credit spreads was a reduction in the fair value of total unsecured long-term borrowings of approximately 9% and 1% as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively.
 
The effective weighted average interest rates for unsecured long-term borrowings are set forth below:
 
                                 
    As of November
    2008   2007
   
Amount
 
Rate
 
Amount
 
Rate
    ($ in millions)
Fixed rate obligations
                               
Group Inc. 
  $ 1,863       5.71 %   $ 1,858       5.69 %
Subsidiaries
    2,152       4.32       1,929       4.88  
Floating rate obligations (1)(2)
                               
Group Inc. 
    156,609       2.66       153,493       5.20  
Subsidiaries
    7,596       4.23       6,894       4.43  
                                 
Total (2)
  $ 168,220       2.73 %   $ 164,174       5.19 %
                                 
 
 
(1) Includes fixed rate obligations that have been converted into floating rate obligations through derivative contracts.
 
(2) The weighted average interest rates as of November 2008 and November 2007 excluded financial instruments accounted for at fair value under SFAS No. 155 or SFAS No. 159.


171


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
Subordinated Borrowings
 
As of November 2008, unsecured long-term borrowings were comprised of subordinated borrowings with outstanding principal amounts of $19.26 billion as set forth below, of which $18.79 billion has been issued by Group Inc. As of November 2007, unsecured long-term borrowings were comprised of subordinated borrowings with outstanding principal amounts of $16.32 billion as set forth below, of which $16.00 billion has been issued by Group Inc.
 
Junior Subordinated Debt Issued to Trusts in Connection with Fixed-to-Floating and Floating Rate Normal Automatic Preferred Enhanced Capital Securities.  In 2007, Group Inc. issued a total of $2.25 billion of remarketable junior subordinated debt to Goldman Sachs Capital II and Goldman Sachs Capital III (APEX Trusts), Delaware statutory trusts that, in turn, issued $2.25 billion of guaranteed perpetual Automatic Preferred Enhanced Capital Securities (APEX) to third parties and a de minimis amount of common securities to Group Inc. Group Inc. also entered into contracts with the APEX Trusts to sell $2.25 billion of perpetual non-cumulative preferred stock to be issued by Group Inc. (the stock purchase contracts). The APEX Trusts are wholly owned finance subsidiaries of the firm for regulatory and legal purposes but are not consolidated for accounting purposes.
 
The firm pays interest semi-annually on $1.75 billion of junior subordinated debt issued to Goldman Sachs Capital II at a fixed annual rate of 5.59% and the debt matures on June 1, 2043. The firm pays interest quarterly on $500 million of junior subordinated debt issued to Goldman Sachs Capital III at a rate per annum equal to three-month LIBOR plus 0.57% and the debt matures on September 1, 2043. In addition, the firm makes contract payments at a rate of 0.20% per annum on the stock purchase contracts held by the APEX Trusts. The firm has the right to defer payments on the junior subordinated debt and the stock purchase contracts, subject to limitations, and therefore cause payment on the APEX to be deferred. During any such extension period, the firm will not be permitted to, among other things, pay dividends on or make certain repurchases of its common or preferred stock. The junior subordinated debt is junior in right of payment to all of Group Inc.’s senior indebtedness and all of Group Inc.’s other subordinated borrowings.
 
In connection with the APEX issuance, the firm covenanted in favor of certain of its debtholders, who are initially the holders of Group Inc.’s 6.345% Junior Subordinated Debentures due February 15, 2034, that, subject to certain exceptions, the firm would not redeem or purchase (i) Group Inc.’s junior subordinated debt issued to the APEX Trusts prior to the applicable stock purchase date or (ii) APEX or shares of Group Inc.’s Series E or Series F Preferred Stock prior to the date that is ten years after the applicable stock purchase date, unless the applicable redemption or purchase price does not exceed a maximum amount determined by reference to the aggregate amount of net cash proceeds that the firm has received from the sale of qualifying equity securities during the 180-day period preceding the redemption or purchase.
 
The firm has accounted for the stock purchase contracts as equity instruments under EITF Issue No. 00-19, “Accounting for Derivative Financial Instruments Indexed to, and Potentially Settled in, a Company’s Own Stock,” and, accordingly, recorded the cost of the stock purchase contracts as a reduction to additional paid-in capital. See Note 9 for information on the preferred stock that Group Inc. will issue in connection with the stock purchase contracts.
 
Junior Subordinated Debt Issued to a Trust in Connection with Trust Preferred Securities.  Group Inc. issued $2.84 billion of junior subordinated debentures in 2004 to Goldman Sachs Capital I (Trust), a Delaware statutory trust that, in turn, issued $2.75 billion of guaranteed preferred beneficial interests to third parties and $85 million of common beneficial interests to Group Inc. and invested the proceeds from the sale in junior subordinated debentures issued by Group Inc. The Trust is a wholly


172


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
owned finance subsidiary of the firm for regulatory and legal purposes but is not consolidated for accounting purposes.
 
The firm pays interest semi-annually on these debentures at an annual rate of 6.345% and the debentures mature on February 15, 2034. The coupon rate and the payment dates applicable to the beneficial interests are the same as the interest rate and payment dates applicable to the debentures. The firm has the right, from time to time, to defer payment of interest on the debentures, and, therefore, cause payment on the Trust’s preferred beneficial interests to be deferred, in each case up to ten consecutive semi-annual periods. During any such extension period, the firm will not be permitted to, among other things, pay dividends on or make certain repurchases of its common stock. The Trust is not permitted to pay any distributions on the common beneficial interests held by Group Inc. unless all dividends payable on the preferred beneficial interests have been paid in full. These debentures are junior in right of payment to all of Group Inc.’s senior indebtedness and all of Group Inc.’s subordinated borrowings, other than the junior subordinated debt issued in connection with the Normal Automatic Preferred Enhanced Capital Securities.
 
Subordinated Debt.  As of November 2008, the firm had $14.17 billion of other subordinated debt outstanding, of which $13.70 billion has been issued by Group Inc., with maturities ranging from fiscal 2009 to 2038. The effective weighted average interest rate on this debt was 1.99%, after giving effect to derivative contracts used to convert fixed rate obligations into floating rate obligations. As of November 2007, the firm had $11.23 billion of other subordinated debt outstanding, of which $10.91 billion has been issued by Group Inc., with maturities ranging from fiscal 2009 to 2037. The effective weighted average interest rate on this debt was 5.75%, after giving effect to derivative contracts used to convert fixed rate obligations into floating rate obligations. This debt is junior in right of payment to all of the firm’s senior indebtedness.
 
Note 8.   Commitments, Contingencies and Guarantees
 
Commitments
 
Forward Starting Collateralized Agreements and Financings.  The firm had forward starting resale agreements and securities borrowing agreements of $61.46 billion and $28.14 billion as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively. The firm had forward starting repurchase agreements and securities lending agreements of $6.95 billion and $15.39 billion as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively.
 
Commitments to Extend Credit.  In connection with its lending activities, the firm had outstanding commitments to extend credit of $41.04 billion and $82.75 billion as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively. The firm’s commitments to extend credit are agreements to lend to counterparties that have fixed termination dates and are contingent on the satisfaction of all conditions to borrowing set forth in the contract. Since these commitments may expire unused or be reduced or cancelled at the counterparty’s request, the total commitment amount does not necessarily reflect the actual future cash flow requirements. The firm accounts for these commitments at fair value. To the extent that the firm recognizes losses on these commitments, such losses are recorded within the firm’s Trading and Principal Investments segment net of any related underwriting fees.


173


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
The following table summarizes the firm’s commitments to extend credit, net of amounts syndicated to third parties, as of November 2008 and November 2007:
 
                 
    Year Ended November
    2008   2007
    (in millions)
Commercial lending commitments
               
Investment-grade
  $ 8,007     $ 11,719  
Non-investment-grade
    9,318       41,930  
William Street program
    22,610       24,488  
Warehouse financing
    1,101       4,610  
                 
Total commitments to extend credit
  $ 41,036     $ 82,747  
                 
 
  •  Commercial lending commitments.  The firm’s commercial lending commitments are generally extended in connection with contingent acquisition financing and other types of corporate lending as well as commercial real estate financing. The total commitment amount does not necessarily reflect the actual future cash flow requirements, as the firm may syndicate all or substantial portions of these commitments in the future, the commitments may expire unused, or the commitments may be cancelled or reduced at the request of the counterparty. In addition, commitments that are extended for contingent acquisition financing are often intended to be short-term in nature, as borrowers often seek to replace them with other funding sources.
 
Included within non-investment-grade commitments as of November 2008 was $2.07 billion of exposure to leveraged lending capital market transactions, $164 million related to commercial real estate transactions and $7.09 billion arising from other unfunded credit facilities. Included within the non-investment-grade amount as of November 2007 was $26.09 billion of exposure to leveraged lending capital market transactions, $3.50 billion related to commercial real estate transactions and $12.34 billion arising from other unfunded credit facilities. Including funded loans, the firm’s total exposure to leveraged lending capital market transactions was $7.97 billion and $43.06 billion as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively.
 
  •  William Street program.  Substantially all of the commitments provided under the William Street credit extension program are to investment-grade corporate borrowers. Commitments under the program are principally extended by William Street Commitment Corporation (Commitment Corp.), a consolidated wholly owned subsidiary of GS Bank USA, and also by William Street Credit Corporation, GS Bank USA or Goldman Sachs Credit Partners L.P. The commitments extended by Commitment Corp. are supported, in part, by funding raised by William Street Funding Corporation (Funding Corp.), another consolidated wholly owned subsidiary of GS Bank USA. The assets and liabilities of Commitment Corp. and Funding Corp. are legally separated from other assets and liabilities of the firm. The assets of Commitment Corp. and of Funding Corp. will not be available to their respective shareholders until the claims of their respective creditors have been paid. In addition, no affiliate of either Commitment Corp. or Funding Corp., except in limited cases as expressly agreed in writing, is responsible for any obligation of either entity. With respect to most of the William Street commitments, Sumitomo Mitsui Financial Group, Inc. (SMFG) provides the firm with credit loss protection that is generally limited to 95% of the first loss the firm realizes on approved loan commitments, up to a maximum of $1.00 billion. In addition, subject to the satisfaction of certain conditions, upon the firm’s request, SMFG will provide protection for 70% of additional losses on such commitments, up to a maximum of $1.13 billion, of which $375 million of protection has been provided as of November 2008. The firm also uses other financial instruments to mitigate credit risks related to certain William Street commitments not covered by SMFG.


174


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
 
  •  Warehouse financing.  The firm provides financing for the warehousing of financial assets. These arrangements are secured by the warehoused assets, primarily consisting of commercial mortgages as of November 2008 and corporate bank loans and commercial mortgages as of November 2007.
 
Letters of Credit.  The firm provides letters of credit issued by various banks to counterparties in lieu of securities or cash to satisfy various collateral and margin deposit requirements. Letters of credit outstanding were $7.25 billion and $8.75 billion as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively.
 
Investment Commitments.  In connection with its merchant banking and other investing activities, the firm invests in private equity, real estate and other assets directly and through funds that it raises and manages. In connection with these activities, the firm had commitments to invest up to $14.27 billion and $17.76 billion as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively, including $12.25 billion and $12.32 billion, respectively, of commitments to invest in funds managed by the firm.
 
Construction-Related Commitments.  As of November 2008 and November 2007, the firm had construction-related commitments of $483 million and $769 million, respectively, including commitments of $388 million and $642 million as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively, related to the firm’s new headquarters in New York City, which is expected to cost between $2.1 billion and $2.3 billion. The firm has partially financed this construction project with $1.65 billion of tax-exempt Liberty Bonds.
 
Underwriting Commitments.  As of November 2008 and November 2007, the firm had commitments to purchase $241 million and $88 million, respectively, of securities in connection with its underwriting activities.
 
Other.  The firm had other purchase commitments of $260 million as of November 2008 and $1.76 billion (including a $1.34 billion commitment for the acquisition of Litton Loan Servicing LP) as of November 2007.
 
Leases.  The firm has contractual obligations under long-term noncancelable lease agreements, principally for office space, expiring on various dates through 2069. Certain agreements are subject to periodic escalation provisions for increases in real estate taxes and other charges. Future minimum rental payments, net of minimum sublease rentals are set forth below (in millions):
 
         
Minimum rental payments
       
2009
  $ 494  
2010
    458  
2011
    342  
2012
    276  
2013
    259  
2014-thereafter
    1,664  
         
Total
  $ 3,493  
         
 
Rent charged to operating expense is set forth below (in millions):
 
         
Net rent expense
       
2006
  $ 404  
2007
    412  
2008
    438  


175


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
Contingencies
 
The firm is involved in a number of judicial, regulatory and arbitration proceedings concerning matters arising in connection with the conduct of its businesses. Management believes, based on currently available information, that the results of such proceedings, in the aggregate, will not have a material adverse effect on the firm’s financial condition, but may be material to the firm’s operating results for any particular period, depending, in part, upon the operating results for such period. Given the inherent difficulty of predicting the outcome of the firm’s litigation and regulatory matters, particularly in cases or proceedings in which substantial or indeterminate damages or fines are sought, the firm cannot estimate losses or ranges of losses for cases or proceedings where there is only a reasonable possibility that a loss may be incurred.
 
In connection with its insurance business, the firm is contingently liable to provide guaranteed minimum death and income benefits to certain contract holders and has established a reserve related to $6.13 billion and $10.84 billion of contract holder account balances as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively, for such benefits. The weighted average attained age of these contract holders was 68 years and 67 years as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively. The net amount at risk, representing guaranteed minimum death and income benefits in excess of contract holder account balances, was $2.96 billion and $1.04 billion as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively. See Note 12 for more information on the firm’s insurance liabilities.
 
Guarantees
 
The firm enters into various derivative contracts that meet the definition of a guarantee under FIN 45, “Guarantor’s Accounting and Disclosure Requirements for Guarantees, Including Indirect Guarantees of Indebtedness of Others,” as amended by FSP No. FAS 133-1 and FIN 45-4.
 
FIN 45 does not require disclosures about derivative contracts if such contracts may be cash settled and the firm has no basis to conclude it is probable that the counterparties held, at inception, the underlying instruments related to the derivative contracts. The firm has concluded that these conditions have been met for certain large, internationally active commercial and investment bank counterparties and certain other counterparties. Accordingly, the firm has not included such contracts in the tables below.
 
The firm, in its capacity as an agency lender, indemnifies most of its securities lending customers against losses incurred in the event that borrowers do not return securities and the collateral held is insufficient to cover the market value of the securities borrowed.
 
In the ordinary course of business, the firm provides other financial guarantees of the obligations of third parties (e.g., performance bonds, standby letters of credit and other guarantees to enable clients to complete transactions and merchant banking fund-related guarantees). These guarantees represent obligations to make payments to beneficiaries if the guaranteed party fails to fulfill its obligation under a contractual arrangement with that beneficiary.


176


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
As of November 2008 and November 2007, derivative contracts that meet the definition of a guarantee include written equity and commodity put options, written currency contracts and interest rate caps, floors and swaptions. As of November 2007, prior to the adoption of FSP No. FAS 133-1 and FIN 45-4, derivative contracts that met the definition of a guarantee also included credit derivatives, such as credit default swaps, credit spread options, credit index products and total return swaps. See “— Recent Accounting Developments” for further information on FSP No. FAS 133-1 and FIN 45-4 and Note 3 for additional information on the firm’s credit derivatives as of November 2008. The following tables set forth certain information about the firm’s derivative contracts that meet the definition of a guarantee and certain other guarantees as of November 2008 and November 2007:
 
                                                 
    As of November 2008
        Maximum Payout/Notional Amount by Period of Expiration (1)
    Carrying
      2010-
  2012-
  2014-
   
   
Value
 
2009
 
2011
 
2013
 
Thereafter
 
Total
    (in millions)
 
Derivatives (2)
    $17,462       $114,863       $73,224       $30,312       $90,643       $309,042  
Securities lending indemnifications (3)
          19,306                         19,306  
Other financial guarantees
    235       203       477       458       238       1,376  
                                                 
    As of November 2007
        Maximum Payout/Notional Amount by Period of Expiration (1)
    Carrying
      2009-
  2011-
  2013-
   
   
Value
 
2008
 
2010
 
2012
 
Thereafter
 
Total
    (in millions)
 
Derivatives (2)(4)
    $33,098       $580,769       $492,563       $457,511       $514,498       $2,045,341  
Securities lending indemnifications (3)
          26,673                         26,673  
Performance bond (5)
          2,046                         2,046  
Other financial guarantees
    43       381       121       258       46       806  
 
 
(1) Such amounts do not represent the anticipated losses in connection with these contracts.
 
(2) Because derivative contracts are accounted for at fair value, carrying value is considered the best indication of payment/performance risk for individual contracts. However, the carrying value excludes the effect of a legal right of setoff that may exist under an enforceable netting agreement and the effect of netting of cash paid pursuant to credit support agreements. These derivative contracts are risk managed together with derivative contracts that are not considered guarantees under FIN 45 and, therefore, these amounts do not reflect the firm’s overall risk related to its derivative activities.
 
(3) Collateral held by the lenders in connection with securities lending indemnifications was $19.95 billion and $27.49 billion as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively. Because the contractual nature of these arrangements requires the firm to obtain collateral with a market value that exceeds the value of the securities on loan from the borrower, there is minimal performance risk associated with these guarantees.
 
(4) Includes credit derivatives that meet the definition of a guarantee as of November 2007.
 
(5) Excludes cash collateral of $2.05 billion related to this obligation.
 
The firm has established trusts, including Goldman Sachs Capital I, II and III, and other entities for the limited purpose of issuing securities to third parties, lending the proceeds to the firm and entering into contractual arrangements with the firm and third parties related to this purpose. See Note 7 for information regarding the transactions involving Goldman Sachs Capital I, II and III. The firm effectively provides for the full and unconditional guarantee of the securities issued by these entities, which are not consolidated for accounting purposes. Timely payment by the firm of amounts due to these entities under the borrowing, preferred stock and related contractual arrangements will be sufficient to cover payments due on the securities issued by these entities. Management believes that it is unlikely that any circumstances will occur, such as nonperformance on the part of paying agents or other service providers, that would make it necessary for the firm to make payments related


177


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
to these entities other than those required under the terms of the borrowing, preferred stock and related contractual arrangements and in connection with certain expenses incurred by these entities.
 
In the ordinary course of business, the firm indemnifies and guarantees certain service providers, such as clearing and custody agents, trustees and administrators, against specified potential losses in connection with their acting as an agent of, or providing services to, the firm or its affiliates. The firm also indemnifies some clients against potential losses incurred in the event specified third-party service providers, including sub-custodians and third-party brokers, improperly execute transactions. In addition, the firm is a member of payment, clearing and settlement networks as well as securities exchanges around the world that may require the firm to meet the obligations of such networks and exchanges in the event of member defaults. In connection with its prime brokerage and clearing businesses, the firm agrees to clear and settle on behalf of its clients the transactions entered into by them with other brokerage firms. The firm’s obligations in respect of such transactions are secured by the assets in the client’s account as well as any proceeds received from the transactions cleared and settled by the firm on behalf of the client. In connection with joint venture investments, the firm may issue loan guarantees under which it may be liable in the event of fraud, misappropriation, environmental liabilities and certain other matters involving the borrower. The firm is unable to develop an estimate of the maximum payout under these guarantees and indemnifications. However, management believes that it is unlikely the firm will have to make any material payments under these arrangements, and no liabilities related to these guarantees and indemnifications have been recognized in the consolidated statements of financial condition as of November 2008 and November 2007.
 
The firm provides representations and warranties to counterparties in connection with a variety of commercial transactions and occasionally indemnifies them against potential losses caused by the breach of those representations and warranties. The firm may also provide indemnifications protecting against changes in or adverse application of certain U.S. tax laws in connection with ordinary-course transactions such as securities issuances, borrowings or derivatives. In addition, the firm may provide indemnifications to some counterparties to protect them in the event additional taxes are owed or payments are withheld, due either to a change in or an adverse application of certain non-U.S. tax laws. These indemnifications generally are standard contractual terms and are entered into in the ordinary course of business. Generally, there are no stated or notional amounts included in these indemnifications, and the contingencies triggering the obligation to indemnify are not expected to occur. The firm is unable to develop an estimate of the maximum payout under these guarantees and indemnifications. However, management believes that it is unlikely the firm will have to make any material payments under these arrangements, and no liabilities related to these arrangements have been recognized in the consolidated statements of financial condition as of November 2008 and November 2007.
 
Group Inc. has guaranteed the payment obligations of Goldman, Sachs & Co. (GS&Co.), GS Bank USA and GS Bank Europe, subject to certain exceptions. In November 2008, the firm contributed subsidiaries with an aggregate of $117.16 billion of assets into GS Bank USA (which brought total assets in GS Bank USA to $145.06 billion as of November 2008) and Group Inc. agreed to guarantee certain losses, including credit-related losses, relating to assets held by the contributed entities. In connection with this guarantee, Group Inc. also agreed to pledge to GS Bank USA certain collateral, including interests in subsidiaries and other illiquid assets. In addition, Group Inc. guarantees many of the obligations of its other consolidated subsidiaries on a transaction-by-transaction basis, as negotiated with counterparties. Group Inc. is unable to develop an estimate of the maximum payout under its subsidiary guarantees; however, because these guaranteed obligations are also obligations of consolidated subsidiaries included in the tables above, Group Inc.’s liabilities as guarantor are not separately disclosed.


178


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
Note 9.   Shareholders’ Equity
 
Common and Preferred Equity
 
In September 2008, Group Inc. completed a public offering of 46.7 million shares of common stock at $123.00 per share for proceeds of $5.75 billion.
 
In October 2008, Group Inc. issued to Berkshire Hathaway Inc. and certain affiliates 50,000 shares of 10% Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series G (Series G Preferred Stock), and a five-year warrant to purchase up to 43.5 million shares of common stock at an exercise price of $115.00 per share, for aggregate proceeds of $5.00 billion. The allocated carrying values of the warrant and the Series G Preferred Stock on the date of issuance (based on their relative fair values) were $1.14 billion and $3.86 billion, respectively. The warrant is exercisable at any time until October 1, 2013 and the number of shares of common stock underlying the warrant and the exercise price are subject to adjustment for certain dilutive events.
 
In October 2008, under the U.S. Department of the Treasury’s (U.S. Treasury) TARP Capital Purchase Program, Group Inc. issued to the U.S. Treasury 10.0 million shares of Fixed Rate Cumulative Perpetual Preferred Stock, Series H (Series H Preferred Stock), and a 10-year warrant to purchase up to 12.2 million shares of common stock at an exercise price of $122.90 per share, for aggregate proceeds of $10.00 billion. The allocated carrying values of the warrant and the Series H Preferred Stock on the date of issuance (based on their relative fair values) were $490 million and $9.51 billion, respectively. Cumulative dividends on the Series H Preferred Stock are payable at 5% per annum through November 14, 2013 and at a rate of 9% per annum thereafter. The Series H Preferred Stock will be accreted to the redemption price of $10.00 billion over five years. The warrant is exercisable at any time until October 28, 2018 and the number of shares of common stock underlying the warrant and the exercise price are subject to adjustment for certain dilutive events. If, on or prior to December 31, 2009, the firm receives aggregate gross cash proceeds of at least $10 billion from sales of Tier 1 qualifying perpetual preferred stock or common stock, the number of shares of common stock issuable upon exercise of the warrant will be reduced by one-half of the original number of shares of common stock.
 
Dividends declared per common share were $1.40 in 2008, $1.40 in 2007, and $1.30 in 2006. On December 15, 2008, the Board of Directors of Group Inc. (Board) declared a dividend of $0.4666666 per common share to be paid on March 26, 2009 to common shareholders of record on February 24, 2009. The dividend of $0.4666666 per common share is reflective of a four-month period (December 2008 through March 2009), due to the change in the firm’s fiscal year-end. See Note 21 for further information regarding the change in the firm’s fiscal year-end. See below for information regarding restrictions on the firm’s ability to raise its common stock dividend.
 
During 2008 and 2007, the firm repurchased 10.5 million and 41.2 million shares of its common stock at an average cost per share of $193.18 and $217.29, for a total cost of $2.04 billion and $8.96 billion, respectively. In addition, to satisfy minimum statutory employee tax withholding requirements related to the delivery of common stock underlying restricted stock units, the firm cancelled 6.7 million and 4.7 million of restricted stock units with a total value of $1.31 billion and $929 million in 2008 and 2007, respectively.
 
The firm’s share repurchase program is intended to help maintain the appropriate level of common equity and to substantially offset increases in share count over time resulting from employee share-based compensation. The repurchase program is effected primarily through regular open-market purchases, the amounts and timing of which are determined primarily by the firm’s current and projected capital positions (i.e., comparisons of the firm’s desired level of capital to its actual level of capital) but which may also be influenced by general market conditions and the


179


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
prevailing price and trading volumes of the firm’s common stock, in each case subject to the limit imposed under the U.S. Treasury’s TARP Capital Purchase Program. See below for information regarding current restrictions on the firm’s ability to repurchase common stock.
 
As of November 2008, the firm had 10.2 million shares of perpetual preferred stock issued and outstanding as set forth in the following table:
 
                                     
    Dividend
  Shares
  Shares
      Earliest
  Redemption Value
Series
 
Preference
 
Issued
 
Authorized
 
Dividend Rate
 
Redemption Date
 
(in millions)
A
  Non-cumulative     30,000       50,000     3 month LIBOR + 0.75%,
with floor of 3.75% per annum
  April 25, 2010   $ 750  
                                     
B
  Non-cumulative     32,000       50,000     6.20% per annum   October 31, 2010     800  
                                     
C
  Non-cumulative     8,000       25,000     3 month LIBOR + 0.75%,
with floor of 4.00% per annum
  October 31, 2010     200  
                                     
D
  Non-cumulative     54,000       60,000     3 month LIBOR + 0.67%,
with floor of 4.00% per annum
  May 24, 2011     1,350  
                                     
G
  Cumulative     50,000       50,000     10.00% per annum   Date of issuance     5,500  
                                     
H
  Cumulative     10,000,000       10,000,000     5.00% per annum through
November 14, 2013 and
9.00% per annum thereafter
  Date of issuance     10,000  
                                     
          10,174,000       10,235,000             $ 18,600  
                                     
 
Each share of non-cumulative preferred stock issued and outstanding has a par value of $0.01, has a liquidation preference of $25,000, is represented by 1,000 depositary shares and is redeemable at the firm’s option, subject to the approval of the Board of Governors of the Federal Reserve System (Federal Reserve Board), at a redemption price equal to $25,000 plus declared and unpaid dividends.
 
Each share of Series G Preferred Stock issued and outstanding has a par value of $0.01, has a liquidation preference of $100,000 and is redeemable at the firm’s option, subject to the approval of the Federal Reserve Board, at a redemption price equal to $110,000 plus accrued and unpaid dividends.
 
Each share of Series H Preferred Stock issued and outstanding has a par value of $0.01, has a liquidation preference of $1,000 and is redeemable at the firm’s option, subject to the approval of the Federal Reserve Board, at a redemption price equal to $1,000 plus accrued and unpaid dividends, provided that through November 14, 2011 the Series H Preferred Stock is redeemable only in an amount up to the aggregate net cash proceeds received from sales of Tier 1 qualifying perpetual preferred stock or common stock, and only once such sales have resulted in aggregate gross proceeds of at least $2.5 billion.
 
All series of preferred stock are pari passu and have a preference over the firm’s common stock upon liquidation. Dividends on each series of preferred stock, if declared, are payable quarterly in arrears. The firm’s ability to declare or pay dividends on, or purchase, redeem or otherwise acquire, its common stock is subject to certain restrictions in the event that the firm fails to pay or set aside full dividends on the preferred stock for the latest completed dividend period. In addition, pursuant to the U.S. Treasury’s TARP Capital Purchase Program, until the earliest of October 28, 2011, the redemption of all of the Series H Preferred Stock or transfer by the U.S. Treasury of all of the Series H Preferred Stock to third parties, the firm must obtain the consent of the U.S. Treasury to raise the firm’s common stock dividend or to repurchase any shares of common stock or other preferred stock, with certain exceptions (including repurchases of shares of common stock under the firm’s share repurchase program to offset dilution from equity-based compensation). For as long as the Series H Preferred Stock remains outstanding, due to the limitations pursuant to the U.S. Treasury’s TARP Capital Purchase Program, the firm will repurchase shares of common stock through its share


180


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
repurchase program only for the purpose of offsetting dilution from equity-based compensation, to the extent permitted.
 
In 2007, the Board authorized 17,500.1 shares of perpetual Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series E, and 5,000.1 shares of perpetual Non-Cumulative Preferred Stock, Series F, in connection with the APEX issuance. See Note 7 for further information on the APEX issuance. Under the stock purchase contracts, Group Inc. will issue on the relevant stock purchase dates (on or before June 1, 2013 and September 1, 2013 for Series E and Series F preferred stock, respectively) one share of Series E and Series F preferred stock to Goldman Sachs Capital II and III, respectively, for each $100,000 principal amount of subordinated debt held by these trusts. When issued, each share of Series E and Series F preferred stock will have a par value of $0.01 and a liquidation preference of $100,000 per share. Dividends on Series E preferred stock, if declared, will be payable semi-annually at a fixed annual rate of 5.79% if the stock is issued prior to June 1, 2012 and quarterly thereafter, at a rate per annum equal to the greater of (i) three-month LIBOR plus 0.77% and (ii) 4.00%. Dividends on Series F preferred stock, if declared, will be payable quarterly at a rate per annum equal to three-month LIBOR plus 0.77% if the stock is issued prior to September 1, 2012 and quarterly thereafter, at a rate per annum equal to the greater of (i) three-month LIBOR plus 0.77% and (ii) 4.00%. The preferred stock may be redeemed at the option of the firm on the stock purchase dates or any day thereafter, subject to regulatory approval and certain covenant restrictions governing the firm’s ability to redeem or purchase the preferred stock without issuing common stock or other instruments with equity-like characteristics.
 
Preferred dividends declared are set forth below:
 
                                 
    Year Ended November
    2008   2007
    (per share)   (in millions)   (per share)   (in millions)
 
Series A
  $ 1,068.86     $ 32     $ 1,563.51     $ 47  
Series B
    1,550.00       50       1,550.00       50  
Series C
    1,110.18       9       1,563.51       12  
Series D
    1,105.18       59       1,543.06       83  
Series G
    1,083.33       54              
                                 
Total
          $ 204             $ 192  
                                 
 
On December 15, 2008, the Board declared a dividend per preferred share of $239.58, $387.50, $255.56, $255.56 and $2,500 for Series A, Series B, Series C, Series D and Series G preferred stock, respectively, to be paid on February 10, 2009 to preferred shareholders of record on January 26, 2009. Also on December 15, 2008, the Board declared a dividend of $14.8611111 per share of Series H preferred stock to be paid on February 17, 2009 to preferred shareholders of record on January 31, 2009. The total amount of preferred stock dividends declared on December 15, 2008 was $309 million.


181


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
Other Comprehensive Income
 
The following table sets forth the firm’s accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss) by type:
 
                 
    As of
    November
    2008   2007
    (in millions)
Adjustment from adoption of SFAS No. 158, net of tax
  $ (194 )   $ (194 )
Currency translation adjustment, net of tax
    (30 )     68  
Pension and postretirement liability adjustment, net of tax
    69        
Net unrealized gains/(losses) on available-for-sale securities, net of tax (1)
    (47 )     8  
                 
Total accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss), net of tax
  $ (202 )   $ (118 )
                 
 
 
  (1)  Consists of net unrealized losses of $55 million on available-for-sale securities held by the firm’s insurance subsidiaries and net unrealized gains of $8 million on available-for-sale securities held by investees accounted for under the equity method as of November 2008. Consists of net unrealized gains of $9 million on available-for-sale securities held by investees accounted for under the equity method and net unrealized losses of $1 million on available-for-sale securities held by the firm’s insurance subsidiaries as of November 2007.
 
Note 10.   Earnings Per Common Share
 
The computations of basic and diluted earnings per common share are set forth below:
 
                         
    Year Ended November
    2008   2007   2006
    (in millions, except per share amounts)
Numerator for basic and diluted EPS — net earnings applicable to common shareholders
  $ 2,041     $ 11,407     $ 9,398  
                         
Denominator for basic EPS — weighted average number of common shares
    437.0       433.0       449.0  
Effect of dilutive securities (1)
                       
Restricted stock units
    10.2       13.6       13.6  
Stock options
    9.0       14.6       14.8  
                         
Dilutive potential common shares
    19.2       28.2       28.4  
                         
Denominator for diluted EPS — weighted average number of common shares and dilutive potential common shares
    456.2       461.2       477.4  
                         
Basic EPS
  $ 4.67     $ 26.34     $ 20.93  
Diluted EPS
    4.47       24.73       19.69  
 
 
(1) The diluted EPS computations do not include the antidilutive effect of restricted stock units (RSUs), stock options and warrants as follows:
 
                         
    As of November
    2008   2007   2006
    (in millions)
 
Number of antidilutive RSUs and common shares underlying antidilutive stock options and warrants
    60.5              
                         


182


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
Note 11.   Goodwill and Identifiable Intangible Assets
 
Goodwill
 
The following table sets forth the carrying value of the firm’s goodwill by operating segment, which is included in “Other assets” in the consolidated statements of financial condition:
 
                 
    As of November
    2008   2007
    (in millions)
Investment Banking
               
Underwriting
  $ 125     $ 125  
Trading and Principal Investments
               
FICC
    247       123  
Equities (1)
    2,389       2,381  
Principal Investments
    80       11  
Asset Management and Securities Services
               
Asset Management (2)
    565       564  
Securities Services
    117       117  
                 
Total
  $ 3,523     $ 3,321  
                 
 
 
(1) Primarily related to SLK LLC (SLK).
 
(2) Primarily related to The Ayco Company, L.P. (Ayco).


183


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
Identifiable Intangible Assets
 
The following table sets forth the gross carrying amount, accumulated amortization and net carrying amount of the firm’s identifiable intangible assets:
 
                     
        As of November
        2008   2007
        (in millions)
 
Customer lists (1)
  Gross carrying amount   $ 1,160     $ 1,086  
    Accumulated amortization     (436 )     (354 )
                     
    Net carrying amount   $ 724     $ 732  
                     
New York Stock
  Gross carrying amount   $ 714     $ 714  
Exchange (NYSE)
  Accumulated amortization     (252 )     (212 )
                     
DMM rights
  Net carrying amount   $ 462     $ 502  
                     
Insurance-related
  Gross carrying amount   $ 448     $ 461  
assets (2)
  Accumulated amortization     (145 )     (89 )
                     
    Net carrying amount   $ 303     $ 372  
                     
Exchange-traded
  Gross carrying amount   $ 138     $ 138  
fund (ETF) lead
  Accumulated amortization     (43 )     (38 )
                     
market maker rights
  Net carrying amount   $ 95     $ 100  
                     
Other (3)
  Gross carrying amount   $ 178     $ 360  
    Accumulated amortization     (85 )     (295 )
                     
    Net carrying amount   $ 93     $ 65  
                     
Total
  Gross carrying amount   $ 2,638     $ 2,759  
    Accumulated amortization     (961 )     (988 )
                     
    Net carrying amount   $ 1,677     $ 1,771  
                     
 
 
(1) Primarily includes the firm’s clearance and execution and NASDAQ customer lists related to SLK and financial counseling customer lists related to Ayco.
 
(2) Consists of VOBA and DAC. VOBA represents the present value of estimated future gross profits of acquired variable annuity and life insurance businesses. DAC results from commissions paid by the firm to the primary insurer (ceding company) on life and annuity reinsurance agreements as compensation to place the business with the firm and to cover the ceding company’s acquisition expenses. VOBA and DAC are amortized over the estimated life of the underlying contracts based on estimated gross profits, and amortization is adjusted based on actual experience. The weighted average remaining amortization period for VOBA and DAC is seven years as of November 2008.
 
(3) Primarily includes marketing-related assets and power contracts.


184


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
Substantially all of the firm’s identifiable intangible assets are considered to have finite lives and are amortized over their estimated lives. The weighted average remaining life of the firm’s identifiable intangibles is approximately 11 years.
 
The estimated future amortization for existing identifiable intangible assets through 2013 is set forth below (in millions):
 
         
2009
  $ 172  
2010
    155  
2011
    150  
2012
    142  
2013
    129  
 
Note 12.   Other Assets and Other Liabilities
 
Other Assets
 
Other assets are generally less liquid, nonfinancial assets. The following table sets forth the firm’s other assets by type:
 
                 
    As of November
    2008   2007
    (in millions)
Property, leasehold improvements and equipment (1)
  $ 10,793     $ 8,975  
Goodwill and identifiable intangible assets (2)
    5,200       5,092  
Income tax-related assets
    8,359       4,177  
Equity-method investments (3)
    1,454       2,014  
Miscellaneous receivables and other
    4,632       3,809  
                 
Total
  $ 30,438     $ 24,067  
                 
 
 
(1) Net of accumulated depreciation and amortization of $6.55 billion and $5.88 billion as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively.
 
(2) See Note 11 for further information regarding the firm’s goodwill and identifiable intangible assets.
 
(3) Excludes investments of $3.45 billion and $2.25 billion accounted for at fair value under SFAS No. 159 as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively, which are included in “Trading assets, at fair value” in the consolidated statements of financial condition.


185


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
Other Liabilities
 
The following table sets forth the firm’s other liabilities and accrued expenses by type:
 
                 
    As of November
    2008   2007
    (in millions)
Compensation and benefits
  $ 4,646     $ 11,816  
Insurance-related liabilities (1)
    9,673       10,344  
Minority interest (2)
    1,643       7,265  
Income tax-related liabilities
    2,865       2,546  
Employee interests in consolidated funds
    517       2,187  
Accrued expenses and other payables
    3,872       4,749  
                 
Total
  $ 23,216     $ 38,907  
                 
 
 
(1) Insurance-related liabilities are set forth in the table below:
 
                 
    As of November
    2008   2007
    (in millions)
 
Separate account liabilities
  $ 3,628     $ 7,039  
Liabilities for future benefits and unpaid claims
    4,778       2,142  
Contract holder account balances
    899       937  
Reserves for guaranteed minimum death and income benefits
    368       226  
                 
Total insurance-related liabilities
  $ 9,673     $ 10,344  
                 
 
Separate account liabilities are supported by separate account assets, representing segregated contract holder funds under variable annuity and life insurance contracts. Separate account assets are included in “Cash and securities segregated for regulatory and other purposes” in the consolidated statements of financial condition.
 
Liabilities for future benefits and unpaid claims include liabilities arising from reinsurance provided by the firm to other insurers. The firm had a receivable for $1.30 billion as of both November 2008 and November 2007, related to such reinsurance contracts, which is reported in “Receivables from customers and counterparties” in the consolidated statements of financial condition. In addition, the firm has ceded risks to reinsurers related to certain of its liabilities for future benefits and unpaid claims and had a receivable of $1.20 billion and $785 million as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively, related to such reinsurance contracts, which is reported in “Receivables from customers and counterparties” in the consolidated statements of financial condition. Contracts to cede risks to reinsurers do not relieve the firm from its obligations to contract holders. Liabilities for future benefits and unpaid claims include $978 million carried at fair value under SFAS No. 159.
 
Reserves for guaranteed minimum death and income benefits represent a liability for the expected value of guaranteed benefits in excess of projected annuity account balances. These reserves are computed in accordance with AICPA SOP 03-1 and are based on total payments expected to be made less total fees expected to be assessed over the life of the contract.
 
(2) Includes $784 million and $5.95 billion related to consolidated investment funds as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively.


186


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
Note 13.   Employee Benefit Plans
 
The firm sponsors various pension plans and certain other postretirement benefit plans, primarily healthcare and life insurance. The firm also provides certain benefits to former or inactive employees prior to retirement.
 
Defined Benefit Pension Plans and Postretirement Plans
 
Employees of certain non-U.S. subsidiaries participate in various defined benefit pension plans. These plans generally provide benefits based on years of credited service and a percentage of the employee’s eligible compensation. The firm maintains a defined benefit pension plan for most U.K. employees. As of April 2008, the U.K. defined benefit plan was closed to new participants, but will continue to accrue benefits for existing participants.
 
The firm also maintains a defined benefit pension plan for substantially all U.S. employees hired prior to November 1, 2003. As of November 2004, this plan was closed to new participants and frozen such that existing participants would not accrue any additional benefits. In addition, the firm maintains unfunded postretirement benefit plans that provide medical and life insurance for eligible retirees and their dependents covered under these programs.
 
On November 30, 2007, the firm adopted SFAS No. 158 which requires an entity to recognize in its statement of financial condition the funded status of its defined benefit pension and postretirement plans, measured as the difference between the fair value of the plan assets and the benefit obligation. Upon adoption, SFAS No. 158 requires an entity to recognize previously unrecognized actuarial gains and losses, prior service costs, and transition obligations and assets within “Accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss)” in the consolidated statements of changes in shareholders’ equity. Additional minimum pension liabilities are derecognized upon adoption of the new standard.
 
As a result of adopting SFAS No. 158, the firm recorded increases of $59 million and $253 million to “Other assets” and “Other liabilities and accrued expenses,” respectively, and a $194 million loss, net of taxes, within “Accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss).”


187


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
The following table provides a summary of the changes in the plans’ benefit obligations and the fair value of assets for November 2008 and November 2007 and a statement of the funded status of the plans as of November 2008 and November 2007:
 
                                                 
    As of or for the Year Ended November
    2008   2007
    U.S.
  Non-U.S.
  Post-
  U.S.
  Non-U.S.
  Post-
   
Pension
 
Pension
 
retirement
 
Pension
 
Pension
 
retirement
    (in millions)
Benefit obligation
                                               
Balance, beginning of year
  $ 399     $ 748     $ 445     $ 395     $ 673     $ 372  
Service cost
          84       26             78       21  
Interest cost
    24       41       31       22       34       23  
Plan amendments
                (61 )           (1 )      
Actuarial loss/(gain)
    (50 )     (261 )     10       (11 )     (79 )     36  
Benefits paid
    (8 )     (2 )     (10 )     (7 )     (1 )     (7 )
Effect of foreign exchange rates
          (154 )                 44        
                                                 
Balance, end of year
  $ 365     $ 456     $ 441     $ 399     $ 748     $ 445  
                                                 
Fair value of plan assets
                                               
Balance, beginning of year
  $ 450     $ 614     $     $ 423     $ 506     $  
Actual return on plan assets
    (151 )     (77 )           34       36        
Firm contributions
          184       9             38       7  
Employee contributions
          1                   1        
Benefits paid
    (8 )     (1 )     (9 )     (7 )     (1 )     (7 )
Effect of foreign exchange rates
          (170 )                 34        
                                                 
Balance, end of year
  $ 291     $ 551     $     $ 450     $ 614     $  
                                                 
Funded status of plans
  $ (74 )   $ 95     $ (441 )   $ 51     $ (134 )   $ (445 )
                                                 
Amounts recognized in the Consolidated Statements of Financial Condition consist of:
                                               
Other assets
  $     $ 129     $     $ 51     $     $  
Other liabilities and accrued expenses
    (74 )     (34 )     (441 )           (134 )     (445 )
                                                 
Net amount recognized
  $ (74 )   $ 95     $ (441 )   $ 51     $ (134 )   $ (445 )
                                                 
Amounts recognized in
Accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss) consist of:
                                               
Actuarial loss/(gain)
  $ 195     $ (59 )   $ 129     $ 60     $ 79     $ 130  
Prior service cost/(credit)
          3       (39 )           3       34  
Transition obligation/(asset)
    (11 )     3             (14 )     4       1  
                                                 
Total amount recognized — Pre-tax
  $ 184     $ (53 )   $ 90     $ 46     $ 86     $ 165  
                                                 
 
The accumulated benefit obligation for all defined benefit pension plans was $769 million and $1.05 billion as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively.
 
For plans in which the accumulated benefit obligation exceeded plan assets, the aggregate projected benefit obligation and accumulated benefit obligation was $426 million and $413 million, respectively, as of November 2008, and $722 million and $636 million, respectively, as of


188


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
November 2007. The fair value of plan assets for each of these plans was $317 million and $590 million as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively.
 
The components of pension expense/(income) and postretirement expense are set forth below:
 
                         
    Year Ended November
   
2008
 
2007
 
2006
    (in millions)
U.S. pension
                       
Interest cost
  $ 24     $ 22     $ 21  
Expected return on plan assets
    (33 )     (32 )     (26 )
Net amortization
    (1 )     1       7  
                         
Total
  $ (10 )   $ (9 )   $ 2  
                         
Non-U.S. pension
                       
Service cost
  $ 84     $ 78     $ 58  
Interest cost
    41       34       25  
Expected return on plan assets
    (41 )     (36 )     (29 )
Net amortization
    2       10       11  
                         
Total
  $ 86     $ 86     $ 65  
                         
Postretirement
                       
Service cost
  $ 26     $ 21     $ 19  
Interest cost
    31       23       19  
Net amortization
    23       19       18  
                         
Total
  $ 80     $ 63     $ 56  
                         
Estimated 2009 amortization from Accumulated other comprehensive income:
                       
Actuarial loss/(gain)
  $ 26                  
Prior service cost/(credit)
    8                  
Transition obligation/(asset)
    (2 )                
                         
Total
  $ 32                  
                         


189


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
The weighted average assumptions used to develop the actuarial present value of the projected benefit obligation and net periodic pension cost are set forth below. These assumptions represent a weighted average of the assumptions used for the U.S. and non-U.S. plans and are based on the economic environment of each applicable country.
 
                         
    Year Ended November
    2008   2007   2006
Defined benefit pension plans
                       
U.S. pension — projected benefit obligation
                       
Discount rate
    6.75 %     6.00 %     5.50 %
Rate of increase in future compensation levels
    N/A       N/A       N/A  
U.S. pension — net periodic benefit cost
                       
Discount rate
    6.00       5.50       5.25  
Rate of increase in future compensation levels
    N/A       N/A       N/A  
Expected long-term rate of return on plan assets
    7.50       7.50       7.50  
Non-U.S. pension — projected benefit obligation
                       
Discount rate
    6.79       5.91       4.85  
Rate of increase in future compensation levels
    3.85       5.38       4.98  
Non-U.S. pension — net periodic benefit cost
                       
Discount rate
    5.91       4.85       4.81  
Rate of increase in future compensation levels
    5.38       4.98       4.75  
Expected long-term rate of return on plan assets
    5.89       6.84       6.93  
Postretirement plans — benefit obligation
                       
Discount rate
    6.75 %     6.00 %     5.50 %
Rate of increase in future compensation levels
    5.00       5.00       5.00  
Postretirement plans — net periodic benefit cost
                       
Discount rate
    6.00       5.50       5.25  
Rate of increase in future compensation levels
    5.00       5.00       5.00  
 
Generally, the firm determined the discount rates for its defined benefit plans by referencing indices for long-term, high-quality bonds and ensuring that the discount rate does not exceed the yield reported for those indices after adjustment for the duration of the plans’ liabilities.
 
The firm’s approach in determining the long-term rate of return for plan assets is based upon historical financial market relationships that have existed over time with the presumption that this trend will generally remain constant in the future.
 
For measurement purposes, an annual growth rate in the per capita cost of covered healthcare benefits of 9.30% was assumed for the year ending November 2009. The rate was assumed to decrease ratably to 5.00% for the year ending November 2015 and remain at that level thereafter.
 
The assumed cost of healthcare has an effect on the amounts reported for the firm’s postretirement plans. A 1% change in the assumed healthcare cost trend rate would have the following effects:
 
                                 
    1% Increase   1% Decrease
    2008   2007   2008   2007
    (in millions)
Service plus interest costs
  $ 11     $ 12     $ (9 )   $ (9 )
Obligation
    90       94       (70 )     (72 )


190


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
The following table sets forth the composition of plan assets for the U.S. and non-U.S. defined benefit pension plans by asset category:
 
                                 
    As of November
    2008   2007
    U.S.
  Non-U.S.
  U.S.
  Non-U.S.
   
Pension
 
Pension
 
Pension
 
Pension
Equity securities
    69 %     28 %     63 %     45 %
Debt securities
    29       7       23       8  
Other
    2       65       14       47  
                                 
Total
    100 %     100 %     100 %     100 %
                                 
 
The investment approach of the firm’s U.S. and major non-U.S. defined benefit pension plans involves employing a sufficient level of flexibility to capture investment opportunities as they occur, while maintaining reasonable parameters to ensure that prudence and care are exercised in the execution of the investment programs. The plans employ a total return on investment approach, whereby a mix, which is broadly similar to the actual asset allocation as of November 2008, of equity securities, debt securities and other assets, is targeted to maximize the long-term return on assets for a given level of risk. Investment risk is measured and monitored on an ongoing basis by the firm’s Retirement Committee through periodic portfolio reviews, meetings with investment managers and annual liability measurements.
 
The firm expects to contribute a minimum of $73 million to its pension plans and $13 million to its postretirement plans in 2009.
 
The following table sets forth benefits projected to be paid from the firm’s U.S. and non-U.S. defined benefit pension and postretirement plans (net of Medicare subsidy receipts) and reflects expected future service costs, where appropriate:
 
                         
    U.S.
  Non-U.S.
  Post-
   
Pension
 
Pension
 
retirement
    (in millions)
2009
  $ 9     $ 7     $ 13  
2010
    10       8       15  
2011
    10       8       17  
2012
    11       8       18  
2013
    13       8       19  
2014-2018
    81       47       108  
 
Defined Contribution Plans
 
The firm contributes to employer-sponsored U.S. and non-U.S. defined contribution plans. The firm’s contribution to these plans was $208 million, $258 million and $230 million for the years ended November 2008, November 2007 and November 2006, respectively.


191


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
Note 14.   Employee Incentive Plans
 
Stock Incentive Plan
 
The firm sponsors a stock incentive plan, The Goldman Sachs Amended and Restated Stock Incentive Plan (Amended SIP), which provides for grants of incentive stock options, nonqualified stock options, stock appreciation rights, dividend equivalent rights, restricted stock, restricted stock units, awards with performance conditions and other share-based awards. In the second quarter of 2003, the Amended SIP was approved by the firm’s shareholders, effective for grants after April 1, 2003.
 
The total number of shares of common stock that may be issued under the Amended SIP through 2008 may not exceed 250 million shares and, in each year thereafter, may not exceed 5% of the issued and outstanding shares of common stock, determined as of the last day of the immediately preceding year, increased by the number of shares available for awards in previous years but not covered by awards granted in such years. As of November 2008 and November 2007, 162.4 million and 160.6 million shares, respectively, were available for grant under the Amended SIP.
 
Other Compensation Arrangements
 
The firm has maintained deferred compensation plans for eligible employees. In general, under the plans, participants were able to defer payment of a portion of their cash year-end compensation. During the deferral period, participants were able to notionally invest their deferrals in certain alternatives available under the plans. Generally, under current tax law, participants are not subject to income tax on amounts deferred or on any notional investment earnings until the returns are distributed, and the firm is not entitled to a corresponding tax deduction until the amounts are distributed. Beginning with the 2008 year, these deferred compensation plans were frozen with respect to new contributions and the plans were terminated. Participants generally will receive distributions of their benefits in 2009 except that no payments will be accelerated for certain senior executives. The firm has recognized compensation expense for the amounts deferred under these plans. As of November 2008 and November 2007, $220 million and $281 million, respectively, related to these plans was included in “Other liabilities and accrued expenses” in the consolidated statements of financial condition.
 
The firm has a discount stock program through which Participating Managing Directors may be permitted to acquire restricted stock units at an effective 25% discount (for 2008 year-end compensation, the program was suspended, and no individual was permitted to acquire discounted restricted stock units thereunder). In prior years, the 25% discount was effected by an additional grant of restricted stock units equal to one-third of the number of restricted stock units purchased by qualifying participants. The purchased restricted stock units were 100% vested when granted, but the shares underlying them generally were subject to certain transfer restrictions (which were waived in December 2008 except for certain senior executives). The shares underlying the restricted stock units that were granted to effect the 25% discount generally vest in equal installments on the second and third anniversaries following the grant date and were not transferable before the third anniversary of the grant date (transfer restrictions on vested awards were waived in December 2008 except for certain senior executives). Compensation expense related to these restricted stock units is recognized over the vesting period. The total value of restricted stock units granted for 2007 in order to effect the 25% discount was $66 million.


192


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
Restricted Stock Units
 
The firm issues restricted stock units to employees under the Amended SIP, primarily in connection with year-end compensation and acquisitions. Restricted stock units are valued based on the closing price of the underlying shares at the date of grant. Year-end restricted stock units generally vest and deliver as outlined in the applicable restricted stock unit agreements. All employee restricted stock unit agreements provide that vesting is accelerated in certain circumstances, such as upon retirement, death and extended absence. Of the total restricted stock units outstanding as of November 2008 and November 2007, (i) 12.0 million units and 22.0 million units, respectively, required future service as a condition to the delivery of the underlying shares of common stock and (ii) 43.9 million units and 51.6 million units, respectively, did not require future service. In all cases, delivery of the underlying shares of common stock is conditioned on the grantees satisfying certain vesting and other requirements outlined in the award agreements. When delivering the underlying shares to employees, the firm generally issues new shares of common stock. The activity related to these restricted stock units is set forth below:
 
                                 
        Weighted Average Grant-Date
    Restricted Stock
  Fair Value of Restricted
    Units Outstanding   Stock Units Outstanding
    Future
  No Future
  Future
  No Future
    Service
  Service
  Service
  Service
   
Required
 
Required
 
Required
 
Required
Outstanding, November 2007 (1)
    22,025,347       51,565,557     $ 180.98     $ 164.94  
Granted (2)(3)
    1,787,746       103,474       154.32       154.13  
Forfeited
    (898,950 )     (649,694 )     184.67       171.40  
Delivered (4)
          (18,086,395 )           112.27  
Vested (3)
    (10,950,279 )     10,950,279       152.06       152.06  
                                 
Outstanding, November 2008
    11,963,864       43,883,221     $ 203.19     $ 183.31  
                                 
 
 
(1) Includes restricted stock units granted to employees in December 2007 as part of compensation for fiscal 2007.
 
(2) The weighted average grant-date fair value of restricted stock units granted during the years ended November 2008, November 2007 and November 2006 was $154.31, $224.13 and $196.99, respectively.
 
(3) The aggregate fair value of awards vested during the years ended November 2008, November 2007 and November 2006 was $1.03 billion, $5.63 billion and $4.40 billion, respectively.
 
(4) Includes restricted stock units that were cash settled.
 
Stock Options
 
Stock options granted to employees generally vest as outlined in the applicable stock option agreement and generally first become exercisable on or after the third anniversary of the grant date. Other than the options granted in December 2007 related to 2007 compensation, no options were granted during fiscal 2008. Year-end stock options for 2007 become exercisable in January 2011 and expire on November 24, 2017. Shares received on exercise prior to January 2013 for year-end 2007 options cannot be sold, transferred or otherwise disposed of until January 2013. All employee stock option agreements provide that vesting is accelerated in certain circumstances, such as upon retirement, death and extended absence. In general, all stock options expire on the tenth anniversary of the grant date, although they may be subject to earlier termination or cancellation under certain circumstances in accordance with the terms of the Amended SIP and the applicable stock option agreement. The dilutive effect of the firm’s outstanding stock options is included in “Average common shares outstanding — Diluted” on the consolidated statements of earnings.


193


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
The activity related to these stock options is set forth below:
 
                                 
                Weighted
        Weighted
  Aggregate
  Average
    Options
  Average
  Intrinsic Value
  Remaining
   
Outstanding
 
Exercise Price
 
(in millions)
 
Life (years)
Outstanding, November 2007 (1)
    39,229,629     $ 106.63                  
Granted
                           
Exercised
    (4,743,181 )     74.55                  
Forfeited
    (847,316 )     173.21                  
                                 
Outstanding, November 2008
    33,639,132     $ 109.47     $ 34       4.23  
                                 
Exercisable, November 2008
    24,866,508     $ 84.67     $ 34       2.87  
                                 
 
 
(1) Includes stock options granted to employees in December 2007 as part of compensation for fiscal 2007, for which no future service was required.
 
The total intrinsic value of options exercised during the years ended November 2008, November 2007 and November 2006 was $433 million, $1.32 billion and $1.52 billion, respectively.
 
The options outstanding as of November 2008 are set forth below:
 
                                         
            Weighted
        Weighted
  Average
    Options
  Average
  Remaining
Exercise Price
 
Outstanding
 
Exercise Price
 
Life (years)
$ 45.00 –     $ 59.99           1,285,788     $ 52.97       0.50  
  60.00 –       74.99                        
  75.00 –       89.99           11,898,382       81.03       2.93  
  90.00 –       104.99           11,682,338       91.86       3.07  
  105.00 –       119.99                        
  120.00 –       134.99           2,791,500       131.64       7.00  
  135.00 –       194.99                        
  195.00 –       209.99           5,981,124       202.27       8.56  
                                         
Outstanding, November 2008
    33,639,132                  
                         
 
The weighted average fair value of options granted for 2007 and 2006 was $51.04 and $49.96 per option, respectively. Fair value was estimated as of the grant date based on a Black-Scholes option-pricing model principally using the following weighted average assumptions:
 
                         
    Year Ended November
    2008 (1)   2007   2006
Risk-free interest rate
    N/A       4.0 %     4.6 %
Expected volatility
    N/A       35.0       27.5  
Dividend yield
    N/A       0.7       0.7  
Expected life
    N/A       7.5 years       7.5 years  
 
 
(1) There were no options granted during fiscal 2008 other than those related to 2007 compensation and included in the 2007 disclosures above.


194


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
The common stock underlying the options granted for 2007 and 2006 is subject to transfer restrictions for a period of 2 years and 1 year, respectively, from the date the options become exercisable. The value of the common stock underlying the options granted for 2007 and 2006 reflects a liquidity discount of 24.0% and 17.5%, respectively, as a result of these transfer restrictions. The liquidity discount was based on the firm’s pre-determined written liquidity discount policies. The 7.5 years expected life of the options reflects the estimated impact of these sales restrictions on the life of the awards.
 
The following table sets forth share-based compensation and the related tax benefit:
 
                         
    Year Ended November
    2008   2007   2006
    (in millions)
Share-based compensation
  $ 1,587     $ 4,549     $ 3,669  
Excess tax benefit related to options exercised
    144       469       542  
Excess tax benefit related to share-based compensation (1)
    645       908       653  
 
 
(1) Represents the tax benefit, recognized in additional paid-in capital, on stock options exercised and the delivery of common stock underlying restricted stock units.
 
As of November 2008, there was $1.25 billion of total unrecognized compensation cost related to nonvested share-based compensation arrangements. This cost is expected to be recognized over a weighted average period of 1.84 years.
 
On December 17, 2008 the firm granted 20.6 million restricted stock units and 36.0 million stock options to its employees. The restricted stock units and options require future service and are subject to additional vesting conditions as outlined in the award agreements. Generally shares underlying RSUs are delivered and stock options become exercisable shortly after vesting, but are subject to certain transfer restrictions. These grants are not included in the above tables.
 
Note 15.   Transactions with Affiliated Funds
 
The firm has formed numerous nonconsolidated investment funds with third-party investors. The firm generally acts as the investment manager for these funds and, as such, is entitled to receive management fees and, in certain cases, advisory fees, incentive fees or overrides from these funds. These fees amounted to $3.14 billion, $3.62 billion and $3.37 billion for the years ended November 2008, November 2007 and November 2006, respectively. As of November 2008 and November 2007, the fees receivable from these funds were $861 million and $596 million, respectively. Additionally, the firm may invest alongside the third-party investors in certain funds. The aggregate carrying value of the firm’s interests in these funds was $14.45 billion and $12.90 billion as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively. In the ordinary course of business, the firm may also engage in other activities with these funds, including, among others, securities lending, trade execution, trading, custody, and acquisition and bridge financing. See Note 8 for the firm’s commitments related to these funds.


195


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
Note 16.   Income Taxes
 
The components of the net tax expense reflected in the consolidated statements of earnings are set forth below:
 
                         
    Year Ended November
    2008   2007   2006
    (in millions)
Current taxes
                       
U.S. federal
  $ (278 )   $ 2,934     $ 3,736  
State and local
    91       388       627  
Non-U.S. 
    1,964       2,554       2,165  
                         
Total current tax expense
    1,777       5,876       6,528  
                         
Deferred taxes
                       
U.S. federal
    (880 )     118       (635 )
State and local
    (92 )     100       (262 )
Non-U.S. 
    (791 )     (89 )     (608 )
                         
Total deferred tax (benefit)/expense
    (1,763 )     129       (1,505 )
                         
Net tax expense
  $ 14     $ 6,005     $ 5,023  
                         
 
Deferred income taxes reflect the net tax effects of temporary differences between the financial reporting and tax bases of assets and liabilities. These temporary differences result in taxable or deductible amounts in future years and are measured using the tax rates and laws that will be in effect when such differences are expected to reverse.
 
Significant components of the firm’s deferred tax assets and liabilities are set forth below:
 
                 
    As of November
    2008   2007
    (in millions)
Deferred tax assets
               
Compensation and benefits
  $ 3,732     $ 3,869  
FIN 48 asset
    625        
Foreign tax credits
    334        
Unrealized losses
    94        
Other, net
    1,481       997  
                 
      6,266       4,866  
Valuation allowance (1)
    (93 )     (112 )
                 
Total deferred tax assets (2)
  $ 6,173     $ 4,754  
                 
Deferred tax liabilities
               
Depreciation and amortization
    1,558       1,208  
Unrealized gains
          1,279  
                 
Total deferred tax liabilities (2)
  $ 1,558     $ 2,487  
                 
 
 
(1) Relates primarily to the ability to utilize losses in various tax jurisdictions.
 
(2) Before netting within tax jurisdictions.
 
The firm permanently reinvests eligible earnings of certain foreign subsidiaries and, accordingly, does not accrue any U.S. income taxes that would arise if such earnings were repatriated. As of November 2008, this policy resulted in an unrecognized net deferred tax liability of $1.1 billion attributable to reinvested earnings of $11.6 billion.


196


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
During 2008, the valuation allowance was decreased by $19 million, primarily due to the utilization of net operating losses previously considered more likely than not to expire unused. Net operating loss carryforwards were $2.77 billion and $2.12 billion as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively.
 
The firm had federal net operating loss carryforwards, primarily resulting from acquisitions, of $172 million and $139 million as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively. The firm recorded a related net deferred income tax asset of $56 million and $44 million as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively. These carryforwards are subject to annual limitations on utilization and will begin to expire in 2016.
 
The firm had state and local net operating loss carryforwards, primarily resulting from acquisitions, of $2.59 billion and $1.62 billion as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively. The firm recorded a related net deferred income tax asset of $97 million and $21 million as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively. These carryforwards are subject to annual limitations on utilization and will begin to expire in 2012.
 
The firm had foreign net operating loss carryforwards of $5 million and $306 million as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively. The firm recorded a related net deferred income tax asset of $84 million as of November 2007. These carryforwards are subject to limitation on utilization and can be carried forward indefinitely.
 
The firm had foreign tax credit carryforwards of $334 million as of November 2008. These carryforwards are subject to limitation on utilization and will begin to expire in 2018.
 
The firm adopted the provisions of FIN 48 as of December 1, 2007 and recorded a transition adjustment resulting in a reduction of $201 million to beginning retained earnings.
 
The following table sets forth the changes in the firm’s unrecognized tax benefits from December 1, 2007 to November 28, 2008 (in millions):
 
         
Balance at December 1, 2007
  $ 1,042  
Increases based on tax positions related to the current year
    172  
Increases based on tax positions related to prior years
    264  
Decreases related to tax positions of prior years
    (67 )
Decreases related to settlements
    (38 )
         
Balance at November 2008
  $ 1,373  
         
 
As of November 2008, the firm’s liability for unrecognized tax benefits reported in “Other liabilities and accrued expenses” in the consolidated statement of financial condition was $1.4 billion. The firm reported a related deferred tax asset of $625 million in “Other assets” in the consolidated statement of financial condition. If recognized, the net tax benefit of $748 million would reduce the firm’s effective income tax rate. As of November 2008, the firm’s accrued liability for interest expense related to income tax matters and income tax penalties was $110.9 million. The firm reports interest expense related to income tax matters in “Provision for taxes” in the consolidated statements of earnings and income tax penalties in “Other expenses” in the consolidated statements of earnings. The firm recognized $36.7 million of interest and income tax penalties for the year ended November 2008. The firm does not expect unrecognized tax benefits to change significantly during the twelve months subsequent to November 28, 2008.


197


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
The firm is subject to examination by the U.S. Internal Revenue Service (IRS) and other taxing authorities in jurisdictions where the firm has significant business operations, such as the United Kingdom, Japan, Hong Kong, Korea and various states, such as New York. The tax years under examination vary by jurisdiction. The firm does not expect that potential additional assessments from these examinations will be material to its results of operations.
 
Below is a table of the earliest tax years that remain subject to examination by major jurisdiction:
 
         
    Earliest
    Tax Year
    Subject to
Jurisdiction
 
Examination
U.S. Federal
    2005  (1)
New York State and City
    2004  (2)
United Kingdom
    2005  
Japan
    2005  
Hong Kong
    2002  
Korea
    2003  
 
 
(1) IRS examination of fiscal 2005, 2006 and 2007 began during 2008.
 
(2) New York State and City examination of fiscal 2004, 2005 and 2006 began in 2008.
 
All years subsequent to the above years remain open to examination by the taxing authorities. The firm believes that the liability for unrecognized tax benefits it has established is adequate in relation to the potential for additional assessments. The resolution of tax matters is not expected to have a material effect on the firm’s financial condition but may be material to the firm’s operating results for a particular period, depending, in part, upon the operating results for that period.
 
A reconciliation of the U.S. federal statutory income tax rate to the firm’s effective income tax rate is set forth below:
 
                         
    Year Ended November
    2008   2007   2006
U.S. federal statutory income tax rate
    35.0 %     35.0 %     35.0 %
Increase related to state and local taxes, net of U.S. income tax effects
          1.8       1.6  
Tax credits
    (4.3 )     (0.5 )     (0.6 )
Foreign operations
    (29.8 )     (1.6 )     (1.3 )
Tax-exempt income, including dividends
    (5.9 )     (0.4 )     (0.4 )
Other
    5.6  (1)     (0.2 (2)     0.2  
                         
Effective income tax rate
    0.6 %     34.1 %     34.5 %
                         
 
 
(1) Primarily includes the effect of FIN 48 liability increase.
 
(2) Primarily includes the effect of audit settlements.
 
Tax benefits of approximately $645 million in November 2008, $908 million in November 2007 and $653 million in November 2006, related to the delivery of common stock underlying restricted stock units and the exercise of options, were credited directly to “Additional paid-in capital” in the consolidated statements of financial condition and changes in shareholders’ equity.


198


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
Note 17.   Regulation
 
On September 21, 2008, Group Inc. became a bank holding company under the U.S. Bank Holding Company Act of 1956. As of that date, the Federal Reserve Board became the primary U.S. regulator of Group Inc., as a consolidated entity. Prior to September 21, 2008, Group Inc. was subject to regulation by the SEC as a Consolidated Supervised Entity (CSE) and was subject to group-wide supervision and examination by the SEC and to minimum capital standards on a consolidated basis. On September 26, 2008, the SEC announced that it was ending the CSE program. The firm’s principal U.S. broker-dealer, GS&Co., remains subject to regulation by the SEC.
 
The firm is subject to regulatory capital requirements administered by the U.S. federal banking agencies. The firm’s bank depository institution subsidiaries, including GS Bank USA, are subject to similar capital guidelines. Under the Federal Reserve Board’s capital adequacy guidelines and the regulatory framework for prompt corrective action (PCA) that is applicable to GS Bank USA, the firm and its bank depository institution subsidiaries must meet specific capital guidelines that involve quantitative measures of assets, liabilities and certain off-balance-sheet items as calculated under regulatory reporting practices. The firm and its bank depository institution subsidiaries’ capital amounts, as well as GS Bank USA’s PCA classification, are also subject to qualitative judgments by the regulators about components, risk weightings and other factors. The firm anticipates reporting capital ratios as follows:
 
  •  Before Group Inc. became a bank holding company, it was subject to capital guidelines by the SEC as a CSE that were generally consistent with those set out in the Revised Framework for the International Convergence of Capital Measurement and Capital Standards issued by the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (Basel II). The firm currently computes and reports its firmwide capital ratios in accordance with the Basel II requirements as applicable to the firm when it was regulated as a CSE for the purpose of assessing the adequacy of its capital. Under the Basel II framework as it applied to the firm when it was regulated as a CSE, the firm evaluates its Tier 1 Capital and Total Allowable Capital as a percentage of Risk-Weighted Assets (RWAs). As of November 2008, the firm’s Total Capital Ratio (Total Allowable Capital as a percentage of RWAs) was 18.9% and the firm’s Tier 1 Ratio (Tier 1 Capital as a percentage of RWAs) was 15.6%, in each case calculated under the Basel II framework as it applied to the firm when it was regulated as a CSE. The firm expects to continue to report to investors for a period of time its Basel II capital ratios as applicable to it when it was regulated as a CSE.
 
  •  The regulatory capital guidelines currently applicable to bank holding companies are based on the Capital Accord of the Basel Committee on Banking Supervision (Basel I), with Basel II to be phased in over time. The firm is currently working with the Federal Reserve Board to put in place the appropriate reporting and compliance mechanisms and methodologies to allow reporting of the Basel I capital ratios as of the end of March 2009.
 
  •  In addition, the firm is currently working to implement the Basel II framework as applicable to it as a bank holding company (as opposed to as a CSE). U.S. banking regulators have incorporated the Basel II framework into the existing risk-based capital requirements by requiring that internationally active banking organizations, such as Group Inc., transition to Basel II over the next several years.


199


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
The Federal Reserve Board also has established minimum leverage ratio guidelines. The firm was not subject to these guidelines before becoming a bank holding company and, accordingly, is currently working with the Federal Reserve Board to finalize its methodology for calculating this ratio. The Tier 1 leverage ratio is defined as Tier 1 capital (as applicable to the firm as a bank holding company) divided by adjusted average total assets (which includes adjustments for disallowed goodwill and certain intangible assets). The minimum Tier 1 leverage ratio is 3% for bank holding companies that have received the highest supervisory rating under Federal Reserve Board guidelines or that have implemented the Federal Reserve Board’s risk-based capital measure for market risk. Other bank holding companies must have a minimum Tier 1 leverage ratio of 4%. Bank holding companies may be expected to maintain ratios well above the minimum levels, depending upon their particular condition, risk profile and growth plans. As of November 2008, the firm’s estimated Tier 1 leverage ratio was 6.1%. This ratio represents a preliminary estimate and may be revised in subsequent filings as the firm continues to work with the Federal Reserve Board to finalize the methodology for the calculation.
 
The firm’s U.S. regulated broker-dealer subsidiaries include GS&Co. and Goldman Sachs Execution & Clearing, L.P. (GSEC). GS&Co. and GSEC are registered U.S. broker-dealers and futures commission merchants subject to Rule 15c3-1 of the SEC and Rule 1.17 of the Commodity Futures Trading Commission, which specify uniform minimum net capital requirements, as defined, for their registrants, and also effectively require that a significant part of the registrants’ assets be kept in relatively liquid form. GS&Co. and GSEC have elected to compute their minimum capital requirements in accordance with the “Alternative Net Capital Requirement” as permitted by Rule 15c3-1. As of November 2008, GS&Co. had regulatory net capital, as defined by Rule 15c3-1, of $10.92 billion, which exceeded the amounts required by $8.87 billion. As of November 2008, GSEC had regulatory net capital, as defined by Rule 15c3-1, of $1.38 billion, which exceeded the amounts required by $1.29 billion. In addition to its alternative minimum net capital requirements, GS&Co. is also required to hold tentative net capital in excess of $1 billion and net capital in excess of $500 million in accordance with the market and credit risk standards of Appendix E of Rule 15c3-1. GS&Co. is also required to notify the SEC in the event that its tentative net capital is less than $5 billion. As of November 2008 and November 2007, GS&Co. had tentative net capital and net capital in excess of both the minimum and the notification requirements.
 
As of November 2008, GS Bank USA, a New York State-chartered bank and a member of the Federal Reserve System and the FDIC, is regulated by the Federal Reserve Board and the New York State Banking Department and is subject to minimum capital requirements that (subject to certain exceptions) are similar to those applicable to bank holding companies. GS Bank USA was formed in November 2008 through the merger of the firm’s existing Utah industrial bank (named GS Bank USA) into the firm’s New York limited purpose trust company, with the surviving company taking the name GS Bank USA. As of November 2007, GS Bank USA’s predecessor was a wholly owned industrial bank regulated by the Utah Department of Financial Institutions, was a member of the FDIC and was subject to minimum capital requirements. The firm computes the capital ratios for GS Bank USA in accordance with the Basel I framework for purposes of assessing the adequacy of its capital. In order to be considered a “well capitalized” depository institution under the Federal Reserve Board guidelines, GS Bank USA must maintain a Tier 1 capital ratio of at least 6%, a total capital ratio of at least 10% and a Tier 1 leverage ratio of at least 5%. In connection with the November 2008 asset transfer described below, GS Bank USA agreed with the Federal Reserve Board to minimum capital ratios in excess of these “well capitalized” levels. Accordingly, for a period of time, GS Bank USA is expected to maintain a Tier 1 capital ratio of at least 8%, a total capital ratio of at least 11% and a Tier 1 leverage ratio of at least 6%. In November 2008, the firm contributed subsidiaries with an aggregate of $117.16 billion in assets into GS Bank USA (which brought total assets in GS Bank USA


200


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
to $145.06 billion as of November 2008). As a result, the firm is currently working with the Federal Reserve Board to finalize its methodology for the Basel I calculations. As of November 2008, under Basel I, GS Bank USA’s estimated Tier 1 capital ratio was 8.9% and estimated total capital ratio was 11.6%. In addition, GS Bank USA’s estimated Tier 1 leverage ratio was 9.1%.
 
The deposits of GS Bank USA are insured by the FDIC to the extent provided by law. The Federal Reserve Board requires depository institutions to maintain cash reserves with a Federal Reserve Bank. The reserve balance deposited by the firm’s depository institution subsidiaries held at the Federal Reserve Bank was approximately $94 million and $32 million as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively. GS Bank Europe, a wholly owned credit institution, is regulated by the Irish Financial Services Regulatory Authority and is subject to minimum capital requirements. As of November 2008, GS Bank USA and GS Bank Europe were both in compliance with all regulatory capital requirements.
 
Transactions between GS Bank USA and Group Inc. and its subsidiaries and affiliates (other than, generally, subsidiaries of GS Bank USA) are regulated by the Federal Reserve Board. These regulations generally limit the types and amounts of transactions (including loans to and borrowings from GS Bank USA) that may take place and generally require those transactions to be on an arms-length basis.
 
The firm has U.S. insurance subsidiaries that are subject to state insurance regulation and oversight in the states in which they are domiciled and in the other states in which they are licensed. In addition, certain of the firm’s insurance subsidiaries outside of the U.S. are regulated by the Bermuda Monetary Authority and by Lloyd’s (which is, in turn, regulated by the U.K.’s Financial Services Authority (FSA)). The firm’s insurance subsidiaries were in compliance with all regulatory capital requirements as of November 2008 and November 2007.
 
The firm’s principal non-U.S. regulated subsidiaries include Goldman Sachs International (GSI) and Goldman Sachs Japan Co., Ltd. (GSJCL). GSI, the firm’s regulated U.K. broker-dealer, is subject to the capital requirements of the FSA. GSJCL, the firm’s regulated Japanese broker-dealer, is subject to the capital requirements imposed by Japan’s Financial Services Agency. As of November 2008 and November 2007, GSI and GSJCL were in compliance with their local capital adequacy requirements. Certain other non-U.S. subsidiaries of the firm are also subject to capital adequacy requirements promulgated by authorities of the countries in which they operate. As of November 2008 and November 2007, these subsidiaries were in compliance with their local capital adequacy requirements.
 
The regulatory requirements referred to above restrict Group Inc.’s ability to withdraw capital from its regulated subsidiaries. As of November 2008 and November 2007, approximately $26.92 billion and $18.10 billion, respectively, of net assets of regulated subsidiaries were restricted as to the payment of dividends to Group Inc. In addition to limitations on the payment of dividends imposed by federal and state laws, the Federal Reserve Board and the FDIC have authority to prohibit or to limit the payment of dividends by the banking organizations they supervise (including GS Bank USA) if, in the Federal Reserve Board’s opinion, payment of a dividend would constitute an unsafe or unsound practice in the light of the financial condition of the banking organization. As of November 2008, GS Bank USA was not able to declare dividends to Group Inc. without regulatory approval.


201


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
Note 18.   Business Segments
 
In reporting to management, the firm’s operating results are categorized into the following three business segments: Investment Banking, Trading and Principal Investments, and Asset Management and Securities Services.
 
Basis of Presentation
 
In reporting segments, certain of the firm’s business lines have been aggregated where they have similar economic characteristics and are similar in each of the following areas: (i) the nature of the services they provide, (ii) their methods of distribution, (iii) the types of clients they serve and (iv) the regulatory environments in which they operate.
 
The cost drivers of the firm taken as a whole — compensation, headcount and levels of business activity — are broadly similar in each of the firm’s business segments. Compensation and benefits expenses within the firm’s segments reflect, among other factors, the overall performance of the firm as well as the performance of individual business units. Consequently, pre-tax margins in one segment of the firm’s business may be significantly affected by the performance of the firm’s other business segments.
 
The firm allocates revenues and expenses among the three business segments. Due to the integrated nature of these segments, estimates and judgments have been made in allocating certain revenue and expense items. Transactions between segments are based on specific criteria or approximate third-party rates. Total operating expenses include corporate items that have not been allocated to individual business segments. The allocation process is based on the manner in which management views the business of the firm.
 
The segment information presented in the table below is prepared according to the following methodologies:
 
  •  Revenues and expenses directly associated with each segment are included in determining pre-tax earnings.
 
  •  Net revenues in the firm’s segments include allocations of interest income and interest expense to specific securities, commodities and other positions in relation to the cash generated by, or funding requirements of, such underlying positions. Net interest is included within segment net revenues as it is consistent with the way in which management assesses segment performance.
 
  •  Overhead expenses not directly allocable to specific segments are allocated ratably based on direct segment expenses.


202


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
Segment Operating Results
 
Management believes that the following information provides a reasonable representation of each segment’s contribution to consolidated pre-tax earnings and total assets:
 
                             
        As of or for the Year Ended November
        2008   2007   2006
        (in millions)
 
Investment
  Net revenues   $ 5,185     $ 7,555     $ 5,629  
Banking
  Operating expenses     3,143       4,985       4,062  
                             
    Pre-tax earnings   $ 2,042     $ 2,570     $ 1,567  
                             
    Segment assets   $ 1,948     $ 5,526     $ 4,967  
                             
Trading and
  Net revenues   $ 9,063     $ 31,226     $ 25,562  
Principal
  Operating expenses     11,808       17,998       14,962  
                             
Investments
  Pre-tax earnings/(loss)   $ (2,745 )   $ 13,228     $ 10,600  
                             
    Segment assets   $ 645,267     $ 744,647     $ 566,499  
                             
Asset Management
  Net revenues   $ 7,974     $ 7,206     $ 6,474  
and Securities
  Operating expenses     4,939       5,363       4,036  
                             
Services
  Pre-tax earnings   $ 3,035     $ 1,843     $ 2,438  
                             
    Segment assets   $ 237,332     $ 369,623     $ 266,735  
                             
Total
  Net revenues (1)(2)   $ 22,222     $ 45,987     $ 37,665  
    Operating expenses (3)     19,886       28,383       23,105  
                             
    Pre-tax earnings (4)   $ 2,336     $ 17,604     $ 14,560  
                             
    Total assets   $ 884,547     $ 1,119,796     $ 838,201  
                             
 
 
(1) Net revenues include net interest as set forth in the table below:
 
                         
    Year Ended November
    2008   2007   2006
    (in millions)
 
Investment Banking
  $ 6     $     $ 16  
Trading and Principal Investments
    968       1,512       1,535  
Asset Management and Securities Services
    3,302       2,475       1,947  
                         
Total net interest
  $  4,276     $ 3,987     $ 3,498  
                         
 
(2) Net revenues includes non-interest income as set forth in the table below:
 
                         
    Year Ended November
    2008   2007   2006
    (in millions)
 
Investment banking fees
  $ 5,179     $ 7,555     $ 5,613  
Equities commissions
    4,998       4,579       3,518  
Asset management and other fees
    4,672       4,731       4,527  
Trading and principal investments revenues
    3,097       25,135       20,509  
                         
Total non-interest income
  $ 17,946     $ 42,000     $ 34,167  
                         


203


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
Trading and principal investments revenues include $(61) million, $6 million and $(7) million for the years ended November 2008, November 2007 and November 2006, respectively, of realized gains/(losses) on securities held within the firm’s insurance subsidiaries which are accounted for as available-for-sale under SFAS No. 115.
 
(3) Operating expenses include net provisions for a number of litigation and regulatory proceedings of $(4) million, $37 million and $45 million for the years ended November 2008, November 2007 and November 2006, respectively, that have not been allocated to the firm’s segments.
 
(4) Pre-tax earnings include total depreciation and amortization as set forth in the table below:
 
                         
    Year Ended November
    2008   2007   2006
    (in millions)
 
Investment Banking
  $ 187     $ 137     $ 119  
Trading and Principal Investments
    1,161       845       725  
Asset Management and Securities Services
    277       185       151  
                         
Total depreciation and amortization
  $ 1,625     $ 1,167     $ 995  
                         
 
Geographic Information
 
Due to the highly integrated nature of international financial markets, the firm manages its businesses based on the profitability of the enterprise as a whole. Since a significant portion of the firm’s activities require cross-border coordination in order to facilitate the needs of the firm’s clients, the methodology for allocating the firm’s profitability to geographic regions is dependent on the judgment of management.
 
Geographic results are generally allocated as follows:
 
  •  Investment Banking: location of the client and investment banking team.
 
  •  Fixed Income, Currency and Commodities, and Equities: location of the trading desk.
 
  •  Principal Investments: location of the investment.
 
  •  Asset Management: location of the sales team.
 
  •  Securities Services: location of the primary market for the underlying security.


204


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
 
The following table sets forth the total net revenues, pre-tax earnings and net earnings of the firm and its consolidated subsidiaries by geographic region allocated on the methodology described above, as well as the percentage of total net revenues, pre-tax earnings and net earnings for each geographic region:
 
                                                 
    Year Ended November
    2008   2007   2006
    ($ in millions)
Net revenues
                                               
Americas (1)
  $ 15,485       70 %   $ 23,412       51 %   $ 20,361       54 %
EMEA (2)
    5,910       26       13,538       29       9,354       25  
Asia
    827       4       9,037       20       7,950       21  
                                                 
Total net revenues
  $ 22,222       100 %   $ 45,987       100 %   $ 37,665       100 %
                                                 
Pre-tax earnings
                                               
Americas (1)
  $ 4,879       N.M. %   $ 7,673       43 %   $ 7,515       52 %
EMEA (2)
    169       N.M.       5,458       31       3,075       21  
Asia
    (2,716 )     N.M.       4,510       26       4,015       27  
Corporate (3)
    4             (37 )           (45 )      
                                                 
Total pre-tax earnings
  $ 2,336       100 %   $ 17,604       100 %   $ 14,560       100 %
                                                 
Net earnings
                                               
Americas (1)
  $ 3,371       N.M. %   $ 4,981       43 %   $ 4,855       51 %
EMEA (2)
    694       N.M.       3,735       32       2,117       22  
Asia
    (1,746 )     N.M.       2,907       25       2,594       27  
Corporate (3)
    3             (24 )           (29 )      
                                                 
Total net earnings
  $ 2,322       100 %   $ 11,599       100 %   $ 9,537       100 %
                                                 
 
 
(1) Substantially all relates to the U.S.
 
(2) EMEA (Europe, Middle East and Africa).
 
(3) Consists of net provisions for a number of litigation and regulatory proceedings.


205


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
Note 19.   Interest Income and Interest Expense
 
The following table sets forth the details of the firm’s interest income and interest expense:
 
                         
    Year Ended November
    2008   2007   2006
    (in millions)
Interest income (1)
                       
Deposits with banks
  $ 188     $ 119     $ 159  
Securities borrowed, securities purchased under agreements to resell, at fair value, and federal funds sold
    11,746       18,013       9,850  
Trading assets
    13,150       13,120       10,717  
Other interest (2)
    10,549       14,716       14,460  
                         
Total interest income
  $ 35,633     $ 45,968     $ 35,186  
                         
Interest expense
                       
Deposits
  $ 756     $ 677     $ 146  
Securities loaned and securities sold under agreements to repurchase, at fair value
    7,414       12,612       9,525  
Trading liabilities
    2,789       3,866       3,125  
Short-term borrowings (3)
    1,864       3,398       2,905  
Long-term borrowings (4)
    13,687       14,147       9,777  
Other interest (5)
    4,847       7,281       6,210  
                         
Total interest expense
  $ 31,357     $ 41,981     $ 31,688  
                         
Net interest income
  $ 4,276     $ 3,987     $ 3,498  
                         
 
 
(1) Interest income is recorded on an accrual basis based on contractual interest rates.
 
(2) Primarily includes interest income on customer debit balances, securities borrowed and other interest-earning assets.
 
(3) Includes interest on unsecured short-term borrowings and short-term other secured financings.
 
(4) Includes interest on unsecured long-term borrowings and long-term other secured financings.
 
(5) Primarily includes interest expense on customer credit balances, securities loaned and other interest-bearing liabilities.


206


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
 
Note 20.   Parent Company
 
Group Inc. — Condensed Statements of Earnings
 
                         
Year ended November   2008   2007   2006
 
    (in millions)
 
Revenues
                       
Dividends from bank subsidiary (1)
  $ 2,922     $ 18     $ 285  
Dividends from nonbank subsidiaries
    3,716       4,273       5,076  
Undistributed earnings/(loss) of subsidiaries
    (3,971 )     6,708       4,516  
Principal investments (2)
    (2,886 )     2,062       1,951  
Interest income (2)
    7,167       9,049       7,231  
 
 
Total revenues
    6,948       22,110       19,059  
Interest expense (2)
    8,229       8,914       6,760  
 
 
Revenues, net of interest expense
    (1,281 )     13,196       12,299  
                         
Operating expenses
                       
Compensation and benefits
    122       780       407  
Other expenses (2)
    471       281       177  
 
 
Total operating expenses
    593       1,061       584  
 
 
                         
Pre-tax earnings/(loss)
    (1,874 )     12,135       11,715  
Provision/(benefit) for taxes
    (4,196 )     536       2,178  
 
 
Net earnings
    2,322       11,599       9,537  
Preferred stock dividends
    281       192       139  
 
 
Net earnings applicable to
common shareholders
  $ 2,041     $ 11,407     $ 9,398  
 
Group Inc. — Condensed Statements of Financial Condition
 
                 
As of November   2008   2007
 
    (in millions)
 
                 
Assets
               
Cash and cash equivalents
  $ 1,035     $ 62  
Loans to and receivables from subsidiaries (2)
               
Bank subsidiary (1)
    19,247       1,626  
Nonbank subsidiaries
    157,086       174,589  
Investments in subsidiaries and associates (2)
               
Bank subsidiary (1)
    13,322       4,028  
Nonbank subsidiaries
    38,375       36,333  
Trading assets, at fair value
    40,171       35,614  
Other assets (2)
    10,414       6,929  
 
 
Total assets
  $ 279,650     $ 259,181  
 
 
                 
Liabilities and shareholders’ equity
               
Unsecured short-term borrowings (3)
               
With third parties
  $ 37,941     $ 46,577  
With subsidiaries
    7,462       5,137  
Payables to subsidiaries
    754       392  
Trading liabilities, at fair value
    3,530       1,971  
Other liabilities
    5,247       5,038  
                 
Unsecured long-term borrowings (4)
               
With third parties (2)
    158,472       155,351  
With subsidiaries (2) (5)
    1,875       1,915  
 
 
Total liabilities
    215,281       216,381  
 
Commitments, contingencies and guarantees
                 
Shareholders’ equity
               
Preferred stock
    16,471       3,100  
Common stock
    7       6  
Restricted stock units and employee stock options
    9,284       9,302  
Additional paid-in capital
    31,071       22,027  
Retained earnings
    39,913       38,642  
Accumulated other comprehensive income/(loss)
    (202 )     (118 )
Common stock held in treasury, at cost
    (32,175 )     (30,159 )
 
 
Total shareholders’ equity
    64,369       42,800  
 
 
Total liabilities and shareholders’ equity
  $ 279,650     $ 259,181  
 
Group Inc. — Condensed Statements of Cash Flows
 
                         
Year ended November   2008   2007   2006
 
    (in millions)
 
Cash flows from operating activities
                       
Net earnings
  $ 2,322     $ 11,599     $ 9,537  
Non-cash items included in net earnings
                       
Undistributed (earnings)/loss of subsidiaries (2)
    3,971       (6,708 )     (4,516 )
Depreciation and amortization
    1       11       7  
Deferred income taxes
    (2,178 )     877       228  
Share-based compensation
    40       459       451  
Changes in operating assets and liabilities
                       
Trading assets, at fair value
    (4,661 )     (17,795 )     (7,763 )
Trading liabilities, at fair value
    1,559       86       (85 )
Net receivables from subsidiaries
    (12,177 )     2,396       1,883  
Other, net
    (6,588 )     5,448       4,187  
 
 
Net cash provided by/(used for) operating activities
    (17,711 )     (3,627 )     3,929  
                         
Cash flows from investing activities
                       
Purchase of property, leasehold improvements
and equipment
    (49 )     (29 )      
Proceeds from sales of property, leasehold
improvements and equipment
          11       30  
Issuance of short-term loans to subsidiaries,
net of repayments
    3,701       (22,668 )     (12,953 )
Issuance of term loans to subsidiaries
    (14,242 )     (48,299 )     (12,362 )
Repayments of term loans by subsidiaries
    24,925       41,143       3,967  
Dividends received (2)
    6,638       4,291       5,361  
Capital contributions to subsidiaries, net (2)
    (22,245 )     (4,517 )     (7,898 )
 
 
Net cash used for investing activities
    (1,272 )     (30,068 )     (23,855 )
                         
Cash flows from financing activities
                       
Unsecured short-term borrowings, net
    (10,564 )     3,255       (6,621 )
Other secured financing (short-term), net
          (380 )     380  
Proceeds from issuance of long-term borrowings
    35,645       53,041       44,043  
Repayment of long-term borrowings, including the current portion
    (23,959 )     (13,984 )     (12,590 )
Common stock repurchased
    (2,034 )     (8,956 )     (7,817 )
Dividends and dividend equivalents paid on common stock, preferred stock and restricted stock units
    (850 )     (831 )     (754 )
Proceeds from issuance of common stock
    6,105       791       1,613  
Proceeds from issuance of preferred stock,
net of issuance costs
    13,366             1,349  
Proceeds from issuance of common stock warrants
    1,633              
Excess tax benefit related to share-based compensation
    614       817       464  
Cash settlement of share-based compensation
          (1 )     (137 )
 
 
Net cash provided by financing activities
    19,956       33,752       19,930  
Net increase in cash and cash equivalents
    973       57       4  
Cash and cash equivalents, beginning of year
    62       5       1  
 
 
Cash and cash equivalents, end of year
  $ 1,035     $ 62     $ 5  
 
 
 
SUPPLEMENTAL DISCLOSURES:
 
Cash payments for third-party interest, net of capitalized interest, were $7.18 billion, $7.78 billion and $6.11 billion for the years ended November 2008, November 2007 and November 2006, respectively.
 
Cash payments for income taxes, net of refunds, were $99 million, $3.27 billion and $2.86 billion for the years ended November 2008, November 2007 and November 2006, respectively.
 
     
(1)
  GS Bank USA. For purposes of identifying bank subsidiaries, the reorganization described in Note 17 is given effect as of the earliest reporting period in this disclosure.
(2)
  Prior periods have been reclassified to conform to the current presentation.
(3)
  Includes $11.67 billion and $28.69 billion at fair value as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively.
(4)
  Includes $10.90 billion and $10.29 billion at fair value as of November 2008 and November 2007, respectively.
(5)
  As of November 2008, unsecured long-term borrowings with subsidiaries by maturity date are $506 million in 2009, $512 million in 2010, $184 million in 2011, $126 million in 2012, $142 million in 2013 and $405 million in 2014-thereafter.


207


Table of Contents

 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC. and SUBSIDIARIES
 
NOTES TO CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS (Continued)
 
 
Note 21.   Subsequent Events
 
On December 15, 2008, the Board approved a change in the firm’s fiscal year-end from the last Friday of November to the last Friday of December. The change is effective for the firm’s 2009 fiscal year. The firm’s 2009 fiscal year began December 27, 2008 and will end December 25, 2009, resulting in a one-month transition period that began November 29, 2008 and ended December 26, 2008.
 
In December 2008, there was continued deterioration in the credit of LyondellBasell Finance Company, to which the firm had provided bridge loan financing. On January 6, 2009, certain legal entities within the LyondellBasell Industries AF S.C.A. group filed for bankruptcy. As a result, the firm incurred a loss of approximately $850 million in December 2008 from marking the bridge and bank loan facilities held in LyondellBasell Finance Company to expected recovery levels.


208


Table of Contents

 
SUPPLEMENTAL FINANCIAL INFORMATION
 
Quarterly Results (unaudited)
 
The following represents the firm’s unaudited quarterly results for 2008 and 2007. These quarterly results were prepared in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles and reflect all adjustments that are, in the opinion of management, necessary for a fair statement of the results. These adjustments are of a normal recurring nature.
 
                                 
    2008 Quarter
   
First
 
Second
 
Third
 
Fourth
    (in millions, except per share data)
Total revenues
  $ 18,629     $ 17,643     $ 13,625     $ 3,682  
Interest expense
    10,294       8,221       7,582       5,260  
                                 
Revenues, net of interest expense
    8,335       9,422       6,043       (1,578 )
Operating expenses (1)
    6,192       6,590       5,083       2,021  
                                 
Pre-tax earnings/(loss)
    2,143       2,832       960       (3,599 )
Provision/(benefit) for taxes
    632       745       115       (1,478 )
                                 
Net earnings/(loss)
    1,511       2,087       845       (2,121 )
Preferred stock dividends
    44       36       35       166  
                                 
Net earnings/(loss) applicable to common shareholders
  $ 1,467     $ 2,051     $ 810     $ (2,287 )
                                 
Earnings/(loss) per common share
                               
Basic
  $ 3.39     $ 4.80     $ 1.89     $ (4.97 )
Diluted
    3.23       4.58       1.81       (4.97 )
Dividends declared and paid per common share
    0.35       0.35       0.35       0.35  
                                 
                                 
    2007 Quarter
   
First
 
Second
 
Third
 
Fourth
    (in millions, except per share data)
Total revenues
  $ 22,280     $ 20,351     $ 23,803     $ 21,534  
Interest expense
    9,550       10,169       11,469       10,793  
                                 
Revenues, net of interest expense
    12,730       10,182       12,334       10,741  
Operating expenses (1)
    7,871       6,751       8,075       5,686  
                                 
Pre-tax earnings
    4,859       3,431       4,259       5,055  
Provision for taxes
    1,662       1,098       1,405       1,840  
                                 
Net earnings
    3,197       2,333       2,854       3,215  
Preferred stock dividends
    49       46       48       49  
                                 
Net earnings applicable to common shareholders
  $ 3,148     $ 2,287     $ 2,806     $ 3,166  
                                 
Earnings per common share
                               
Basic
  $ 7.08     $ 5.25     $ 6.54     $ 7.49  
Diluted
    6.67       4.93       6.13       7.01  
Dividends declared and paid per common share
    0.35       0.35       0.35       0.35  
 
 
(1) The timing and magnitude of changes in the firm’s bonus accruals can have a significant effect on results in a given quarter.


209


Table of Contents

 
SUPPLEMENTAL FINANCIAL INFORMATION
 
 
Common Stock Price Range
 
The following table sets forth, for the quarters indicated, the high and low sales prices per share of the firm’s common stock.
 
                                                 
    Sales Price
    2008   2007   2006
   
High
 
Low
 
High
 
Low
 
High
 
Low
First quarter
  $ 229.35     $ 169.00     $ 222.75     $ 191.50     $ 146.35     $ 124.23  
Second quarter
    203.39       140.27       232.41       189.85       169.31       139.18  
Third quarter
    190.04       152.25       233.97       157.38       157.00       136.79  
Fourth quarter
    172.45       47.41       250.70       175.00       203.35       145.66  
 
As of January 16, 2009, there were 9,909 holders of record of the firm’s common stock.
 
On January 16, 2009, the last reported sales price for the firm’s common stock on the New York Stock Exchange was $73.05 per share.


210


Table of Contents

 
SUPPLEMENTAL FINANCIAL INFORMATION
 
 
Selected Financial Data
 
                                         
    As of or for the Year Ended November
    2008   2007   2006   2005   2004
Income statement data (in millions)
                                       
Total revenues
  $ 53,579     $ 87,968     $ 69,353     $ 43,391     $ 29,839  
Interest expense
    31,357       41,981       31,688       18,153       8,888  
                                         
Revenues, net of interest expense
    22,222       45,987       37,665       25,238       20,951  
Compensation and benefits
    10,934       20,190       16,457       11,758       9,681  
Other operating expenses
    8,952       8,193       6,648       5,207       4,594  
                                         
Pre-tax earnings
  $ 2,336     $ 17,604     $ 14,560     $ 8,273     $ 6,676  
 
 
Balance sheet data (in millions)
                                       
Total assets
  $ 884,547     $ 1,119,796     $ 838,201     $ 706,804     $ 531,379  
Other secured financings (long-term)
    17,458       33,300       26,134       15,669       12,087  
Unsecured long-term borrowings
    168,220       164,174       122,842       84,338       68,609  
Total liabilities
    820,178       1,076,996       802,415       678,802       506,300  
Total shareholders’ equity
    64,369       42,800       35,786       28,002       25,079  
 
 
Common share data (in millions, except per share amounts)
                                       
Earnings per common share
                                       
Basic
  $ 4.67     $ 26.34     $ 20.93     $ 11.73     $ 9.30  
Diluted
    4.47       24.73       19.69       11.21       8.92  
Dividends declared and paid per common share
    1.40       1.40       1.30       1.00       1.00  
Book value per common share (1)
    98.68       90.43       72.62       57.02       50.77  
Average common shares outstanding
                                       
Basic
    437.0       433.0       449.0       478.1       489.5  
Diluted
    456.2       461.2       477.4       500.2       510.5  
 
 
Selected data (unaudited)
                                       
Employees
                                       
Americas
    17,276       17,383       15,477       14,466       13,846  
Non-Americas 
    12,791       13,139       10,990       9,157       7,890  
                                         
Total employees (2)
    30,067       30,522       26,467       23,623       21,736  
 
 
Assets under management (in billions) (3)
                                       
Asset class
                                       
Alternative investments (4)
  $ 146     $ 151     $ 145     $ 110     $ 95  
Equity
    112       255       215       167       133  
Fixed income
    248       256       198       154       134  
                                         
Total non-money market assets
    506       662       558       431       362  
Money markets
    273       206       118       101       90  
                                         
Total assets under management
  $ 779     $ 868     $ 676     $ 532     $ 452  
 
 
 
(1)  Book value per common share is based on common shares outstanding, including restricted stock units granted to employees with no future service requirements, of 485.4 million, 439.0 million, 450.1 million, 460.4 million and 494.0 million as of November 2008, November 2007, November 2006, November 2005 and November 2004, respectively.
 
(2)  Excludes 4,671, 4,572, 3,868, 7,382 and 485 employees as of November 2008, November 2007, November 2006, November 2005 and November 2004, respectively, of consolidated entities held for investment purposes.
 
(3)  Substantially all assets under management are valued as of calendar month-end.
 
(4)  Primarily includes hedge funds, private equity, real estate, currencies, commodities and asset allocation strategies.


211


Table of Contents

 
SUPPLEMENTAL FINANCIAL INFORMATION
 
 
Statistical Disclosures
 
Distribution of Assets, Liabilities and Shareholders’ Equity
 
The following table sets forth a summary of consolidated average balances and interest rates for the years ended November 2008, November 2007 and November 2006.
 
                                                                         
    For the Year Ended November
    2008   2007   2006
    Average
      Average
  Average
      Average
  Average
      Average
   
balance
 
Interest
 
rate
 
balance
 
Interest
 
rate
 
balance
 
Interest
 
rate
    (in millions, except rates)
Assets
                                                                       
Deposits with banks
  $ 5,887     $ 188       3.19 %   $ 3,516     $ 119       3.38 %   $ 3,728     $ 159       4.27 %
U.S. 
    1,541       41       2.66       741       23       3.10       1,351       36       2.66  
Non-U.S. 
    4,346       147       3.38       2,775       96       3.46       2,377       123       5.17  
Securities borrowed, securities purchased under agreements to resell, at fair value, and federal funds sold
    421,157       11,746       2.79       348,691       18,013       5.17       308,509       9,850       3.19  
U.S. 
    331,043       8,791       2.66       279,456       15,449       5.53       240,263       8,061       3.36  
Non-U.S. 
    90,114       2,955       3.28       69,235       2,564       3.70       68,246       1,789       2.62  
Trading assets (1)(2)
    328,208       13,150       4.01       336,412       13,120       3.90       265,878       10,717       4.03  
U.S. 
    186,498       7,700       4.13       190,589       8,167       4.29       177,984       7,397       4.16  
Non-U.S. 
    141,710       5,450       3.85       145,823       4,953       3.40       87,894       3,320       3.78  
Other interest-earning assets (3)
    221,040       10,549       4.77       203,048       14,716       7.25       158,162       14,460       9.14  
U.S. 
    131,778       4,438       3.37       97,830       6,480       6.62       96,517       9,321       9.66  
Non-U.S. 
    89,262       6,111       6.85       105,218       8,236       7.83       61,645       5,139       8.34  
                                                                         
Total interest-earning assets
    976,292       35,633       3.65       891,667       45,968       5.16       736,277       35,186       4.78  
Cash and due from banks
    7,975                       3,926                       3,348                  
Other noninterest-earning assets (2)
    154,727                       102,312                       80,856                  
                                                                         
Total Assets
  $ 1,138,994                     $ 997,905                     $ 820,481                  
                                                                         
Liabilities
                                                                       
Interest-bearing deposits
  $ 26,455       756       2.86     $ 13,227       677       5.12     $ 2,853       146       5.12  
U.S. 
    21,598       617       2.86       13,128       674       5.13       2,778       143       5.15  
Non-U.S. 
    4,857       139       2.86       99       3       3.03       75       3       4.00  
Securities loaned and securities sold under agreements to repurchase, at fair value
    194,935       7,414       3.80       214,511       12,612       5.88       206,992       9,525       4.60  
U.S. 
    107,361       3,663       3.41       95,391       7,697       8.07       118,020       7,055       5.98  
Non-U.S. 
    87,574       3,751       4.28       119,120       4,915       4.13       88,972       2,470       2.78  
Trading liabilities (1)(2)
    95,377       2,789       2.92       109,736       3,866       3.52       99,967       3,125       3.13  
U.S. 
    49,152       1,202       2.45       61,510       2,334       3.79       61,005       1,814       2.97  
Non-U.S. 
    46,225       1,587       3.43       48,226       1,532       3.18       38,962       1,311       3.36  
Commercial paper
    4,097       145       3.54       5,605       269       4.80       7,485       361       4.82  
U.S. 
    3,147       121       3.84       4,871       242       4.97       6,859       331       4.83  
Non-U.S. 
    950       24       2.53       734       27       3.68       626       30       4.79  
Other borrowings (4)(5)
    99,351       1,719       1.73       89,924       3,129       3.48       58,277       2,544       4.37  
U.S. 
    52,126       1,046       2.01       44,789       1,779       3.97       43,534       1,521       3.49  
Non-U.S. 
    47,225       673       1.43       45,135       1,350       2.99       14,743       1,023       6.94  
Long-term borrowings (5)(6)
    203,360       13,687       6.73       167,997       14,147       8.42       121,935       9,777       8.02  
U.S. 
    181,775       12,306       6.77       158,694       13,317       8.39       110,186       9,396       8.53  
Non-U.S. 
    21,585       1,381       6.40       9,303       830       8.92       11,749       381       3.24  
Other interest-bearing liabilities (7)
    345,956       4,847       1.40       248,640       7,281       2.93       205,556       6,210       3.02  
U.S. 
    214,780       2,184       1.02       142,002       3,666       2.58       114,874       2,932       2.55  
Non-U.S. 
    131,176       2,663       2.03       106,638       3,615       3.39       90,682       3,278       3.61  
                                                                         
Total interest-bearing liabilities
    969,531       31,357       3.23       849,640       41,981       4.94       703,065       31,688       4.51  
Noninterest-bearing deposits
    4                                                              
Other noninterest-bearing liabilities (2)
    122,292                       110,306                       86,368                  
                                                                         
Total liabilities
    1,091,827                       959,946                       789,433                  
Shareholders’ equity
                                                                       
Preferred stock
    5,157                       3,100                       2,400                  
Common stock
    42,010                       34,859                       28,648                  
                                                                         
Total shareholders’ equity
    47,167                       37,959                       31,048                  
Total liabilities, preferred stock and
shareholders’ equity
  $ 1,138,994                     $ 997,905                     $ 820,481                  
                                                                         
Interest rate spread
                    0.42 %                     0.22 %                     0.27 %
Net interest income and net yield on
interest-earning assets
          $ 4,276       0.44             $ 3,987       0.45             $ 3,498       0.48  
U.S. 
            (169 )     (0.03 )             410       0.07               1,623       0.31  
Non-U.S. 
            4,445       1.37               3,577       1.11               1,875       0.85  
Percentage of interest-earning assets and interest-bearing liabilities attributable to non-U.S. operations (8)
                                                                       
Assets
                    33.33 %                     36.23 %                     29.90 %
Liabilities
                    35.03                       38.75                       34.96  


212


Table of Contents

 
SUPPLEMENTAL FINANCIAL INFORMATION
 
 
(1)  Consists of cash trading instruments, including equity securities and convertible debentures.
 
(2)  Derivative instruments are included in other noninterest-earning assets and other noninterest-bearing liabilities.
 
(3)  Primarily consists of cash and securities segregated for regulatory and other purposes and receivables from customers and counterparties.
 
(4)  Consists of short-term other secured financings and unsecured short-term borrowings, excluding commercial paper.
 
(5)  Interest rates include the effects of hedging in accordance with SFAS No. 133.
 
(6)  Consists of long-term other secured financings and unsecured long-term borrowings.
 
(7)  Primarily consists of payables to customers and counterparties.
 
(8)  Assets, liabilities and interest are attributed to U.S. and non-U.S. based on the principal place of operations of the legal entity in which the assets and liabilities are held.


213


Table of Contents

 
SUPPLEMENTAL FINANCIAL INFORMATION
 
 
Changes in Net Interest Income, Volume and Rate Analysis
 
The following table sets forth an analysis of the effect on net interest income of volume and rate changes for the periods 2008 versus 2007 and 2007 versus 2006. In this analysis, changes due to volume/rate variance have been allocated to volume.
 
                                                 
    For the Year Ended November
    2008 versus 2007   2007 versus 2006
    Increase (decrease)
      Increase (decrease)
   
    due to change in:       due to change in:    
            Net
          Net
   
Volume
 
Rate
 
change
 
Volume
 
Rate
 
change
    (in millions)
Interest-earning assets
                                               
Deposits with banks
  $ 74     $ (5 )   $ 69     $ (5 )   $ (35 )   $ (40 )
U.S. 
    21       (3 )     18       (19 )     6       (13 )
Non-U.S. 
    53       (2 )     51       14       (41 )     (27 )
Securities borrowed, securities purchased under agreements to resell, at fair value and federal funds sold
    2,055       (8,322 )     (6,267 )     2,203       5,960       8,163  
U.S. 
    1,370       (8,028 )     (6,658 )     2,167       5,221       7,388  
Non-U.S. 
    685       (294 )     391       36       739       775  
Trading assets
    (327 )     357       30       2,508       (105 )     2,403  
U.S. 
    (169 )     (298 )     (467 )     540       230       770  
Non-U.S. 
    (158 )     655       497       1,968       (335 )     1,633  
Other interest-earning assets
    51       (4,218 )     (4,167 )     3,498       (3,242 )     256  
U.S. 
    1,143       (3,185 )     (2,042 )     87       (2,928 )     (2,841 )
Non-U.S. 
    (1,092 )     (1,033 )     (2,125 )     3,411       (314 )     3,097  
                                                 
Change in interest income
    1,853       (12,188 )     (10,335 )     8,204       2,578       10,782  
                                                 
Interest-bearing liabilities
                                               
Interest-bearing deposits
    378       (299 )     79       532       (1 )     531  
U.S. 
    242       (299 )     (57 )     531             531  
Non-U.S. 
    136             136       1       (1 )      
Securities loaned and securities sold under agreements to repurchase, at fair value
    (943 )     (4,255 )     (5,198 )     (582 )     3,669       3,087  
U.S. 
    408       (4,442 )     (4,034 )     (1,826 )     2,468       642  
Non-U.S. 
    (1,351 )     187       (1,164 )     1,244       1,201       2,445  
Trading liabilities
    (371 )     (706 )     (1,077 )     313       428       741  
U.S. 
    (302 )     (830 )     (1,132 )     19       501       520  
Non-U.S. 
    (69 )     124       55       294       (73 )     221  
Commercial paper
    (61 )     (63 )     (124 )     (95 )     3       (92 )
U.S. 
    (66 )     (55 )     (121 )     (99 )     10       (89 )
Non-U.S. 
    5       (8 )     (3 )     4       (7 )     (3 )
Other borrowings
    177       (1,587 )     (1,410 )     959       (374 )     585  
U.S. 
    147       (880 )     (733 )     50       208       258  
Non-U.S. 
    30       (707 )     (677 )     909       (582 )     327  
Long-term debt
    2,349       (2,809 )     (460 )     3,852       518       4,370  
U.S. 
    1,563       (2,574 )     (1,011 )     4,070       (149 )     3,921  
Non-U.S. 
    786       (235 )     551       (218 )     667       449  
Other interest-bearing liabilities
    1,238       (3,672 )     (2,434 )     1,243       (172 )     1,071  
U.S. 
    740       (2,222 )     (1,482 )     701       33       734  
Non-U.S. 
    498       (1,450 )     (952 )     542       (205 )     337  
                                                 
Change in interest expense
    2,767       (13,391 )     (10,624 )     6,222       4,071       10,293  
                                                 
Change in net interest income
  $ (914 )   $ 1,203     $ 289     $ 1,982     $ (1,493 )   $ 489  
                                                 


214


Table of Contents

 
SUPPLEMENTAL FINANCIAL INFORMATION
 
Available-for-sale Securities Portfolio
 
The following table sets forth the amortized cost, gross unrealized gains and losses, and fair value of available-for-sale securities at November 2008 and November 2007:
 
                                 
        Gross
  Gross
   
    Amortized
  Unrealized
  Unrealized
  Fair
   
Cost
 
Gains
 
Losses
 
Value
        (in millions)    
Available-for-sale securities, November 2008
                               
Commercial paper, certificates of deposit, time deposits and other money market instruments
  $ 259     $     $     $ 259  
U.S. governments, federal agency and sovereign obligations
    574       23       (3 )     594  
Mortgage and other asset-backed loans and securities
    213             (49 )     164  
Corporate debt securities and other debt obligations
    750       5       (90 )     665  
                                 
Total available-for-sale securities
  $ 1,796     $ 28     $ (142 )   $ 1,682  
                                 
Available-for-sale securities, November 2007
                               
Commercial paper, certificates of deposit, time deposits and other money market instruments
  $ 29     $     $     $ 29  
U.S. governments, federal agency and sovereign obligations
    389       9             398  
Mortgage and other asset-backed loans and securities
    179       1       (2 )     178  
Corporate debt securities and other debt obligations
    575       3       (14 )     564  
                                 
Total available-for-sale securities
  $ 1,172     $ 13     $ (16 )   $ 1,169  
                                 


215


Table of Contents

 
SUPPLEMENTAL FINANCIAL INFORMATION
 
                                                                                 
    As of November 2008
            Due After
  Due After
               
            One Year
  Five Years
               
    Due in One Year
  Through
  Through
  Due After
       
    or Less   Five Years   Ten Years   Ten Years   Total
   
Amount
 
Yield (1)
 
Amount
 
Yield (1)
 
Amount
 
Yield (1)
 
Amount
 
Yield (1)
 
Amount
 
Yield (1)
                    ($ in millions)                
Fair value of available-for-sale securities
                                                                               
Commercial paper, certificates of deposit, time deposits and other money market instruments
  $ 259       1 %   $       %   $       %   $       %   $ 259       1 %
U.S. governments, federal agency and sovereign obligations
                144       2       133       4       317       5       594       4  
Mortgage and other asset-backed loans and securities
                                        164       21       164       21  
Corporate debt securities and other debt obligations
    48       16       227       7       94       8       296       9       665       9  
                                                                                 
Total available-for-sale securities
  $ 307             $ 371             $ 227             $ 777             $ 1,682          
                                                                                 
Amortized cost of available-for-sale securities
  $ 310             $ 377             $ 229             $ 880             $ 1,796          
 
 
(1)  Yields are calculated on a weighted average basis.


216


Table of Contents

 
SUPPLEMENTAL FINANCIAL INFORMATION
 
Deposits
 
The following table sets forth a summary of the average balances and average interest rates for the firm’s interest-bearing deposits for the years ended November 2008, November 2007 and November 2006:
 
                                                 
    Average Balances   Average Interest Rates
    2008   2007   2006   2008  
2007
 
2006
    ($ in millions)
U.S.:
                                               
Savings (1)
  $ 20,214     $ 13,096     $ 2,745       2.82 %     5.12 %     5.14 %
Time
    1,384       32       33       3.40       9.96       5.42  
                                                 
Total U.S. deposits
    21,598       13,128       2,778       2.86       5.13       5.15  
Non-U.S.:
                                               
Demand
    4,842       99       75       2.83       3.03       4.00  
Time
    15                   13.00              
                                                 
Total Non-U.S. deposits
    4,857       99       75       2.86       3.03       4.00  
                                                 
Total deposits
  $ 26,455     $ 13,227     $ 2,853       2.86 %     5.12 %     5.12 %
                                                 
 
 
(1) Amounts are available for withdrawal upon short notice, generally within seven days.
 
As of November 2008, the firm had $55 million of non-U.S. time deposits greater than $100,000.
 
Ratios
 
The following table sets forth selected financial ratios:
 
                         
    Year Ended November
    2008   2007   2006
Net income to average assets
    0.2 %     1.2 %     1.2 %
Return on common shareholders’ equity (1)
    4.9       32.7       32.8  
Return on total shareholders’ equity (2)
    4.9       30.6       30.7  
Total average equity to average assets
    4.1       3.8       3.8  
Dividend payout ratio (3)
    31.3       5.7       6.6  
 
 
(1) Based on net income less preferred stock dividends as a percentage of average common shareholders’ equity.
 
(2) Based on net income as a percentage of average total shareholders’ equity.
 
(3) Dividends declared per common share as a percentage of net income per diluted share.


217


Table of Contents

 
SUPPLEMENTAL FINANCIAL INFORMATION
 
Short-term and Other Borrowed Funds (1)
 
The following table sets forth a summary of the firm’s securities loaned and securities sold under agreements to repurchase and short-term borrowings as of or for the years ended November as indicated below:
 
                                                                         
    Securities Loaned and
       
    Securities Sold Under
       
    Agreements to Repurchase   Commercial Paper   Other Funds Borrowed (2)(3)
    2008   2007   2006   2008   2007   2006   2008   2007   2006
    ($ in millions)
Amounts outstanding at year-end
  $ 79,943     $ 187,802     $ 169,700     $ 1,125     $ 4,343     $ 1,489     $ 72,758     $ 99,624     $ 70,705  
Average outstanding during the year
    194,935       214,511       206,992       4,097       5,605       7,485       99,351       89,924       58,277  
Maximum month-end outstanding
    256,596       270,991       278,560       12,718       8,846       18,227       109,927       105,845       82,353  
Weighted average interest rate
                                                                       
During the year (3)
    3.80 %     5.88 %     4.60 %     3.54 %     4.80 %     4.82 %     1.73 %     3.48 %     4.37 %
At year-end
    3.27       5.15       5.52       2.79       4.81       4.99       2.06  (3)     3.11  (3)     3.93  (3)
 
 
(1) Includes borrowings maturing within one year of the financial statement date and borrowings that are redeemable at the option of the holder within one year of the financial statement date.
 
(2) Includes short-term secured financings of $21.23 billion as of November 2008, $32.41 billion as of November 2007 and $24.29 billion as of November 2006.
 
(3) As of November 2008, November 2007 and November 2006, weighted average interest rates include the effects of hedging in accordance with SFAS No. 133.
 
Cross-border Outstandings
 
Cross-border outstandings are based upon the Federal Financial Institutions Examination Council’s (FFIEC) regulatory guidelines for reporting cross-border risk. Claims include cash, receivables, securities purchased under agreements to resell, securities borrowed and cash trading instruments, but exclude derivative instruments and commitments. Securities purchased under agreements to resell and securities borrowed are presented based on the domicile of the counterparty, without reduction for related securities collateral held.
 
The following table sets forth cross-border outstandings for each country in which cross-border outstandings exceed 0.75% of consolidated assets as of November 2008 in accordance with the FFIEC guidelines:
 
                                 
   
Banks
 
Governments
 
Other
 
Total
    (in millions)
Country
               
United Kingdom
  $ 5,104     $ 4,600     $ 51,531     $ 61,235  
Cayman Islands
    50             20,904       20,954  
Germany
    3,973       2,518       7,825       14,316  
France
    2,264       1,320       9,791       13,375  
Japan
    4,003       100       3,354       7,457  


218


Table of Contents

 
Item 9.   Changes in and Disagreements with Accountants on Accounting and Financial Disclosure
 
There were no changes in or disagreements with accountants on accounting and financial disclosure during the last two fiscal years.
 
Item 9A.   Controls and Procedures
 
As of the end of the period covered by this report, an evaluation was carried out by Goldman Sachs’ management, with the participation of our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, of the effectiveness of our disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rule 13a-15(e) under the Exchange Act). Based upon that evaluation, our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer concluded that these disclosure controls and procedures were effective as of the end of the period covered by this report. In addition, no change in our internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Rule 13a-15(f) under the Exchange Act) occurred during the fourth quarter of our fiscal year ended November 28, 2008 that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting.
 
Management’s Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting and the Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm are set forth in Part II, Item 8 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K.
 
Item 9B.   Other Information
 
Not applicable.


219


Table of Contents

 
PART III
 
Item 10.   Directors, Executive Officers and Corporate Governance
 
Information relating to our executive officers is included on pages 51 to 52 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K. Information relating to our directors, including our audit committee and audit committee financial experts and the procedures by which shareholders can recommend director nominees, and our executive officers will be in our definitive Proxy Statement for our 2009 Annual Meeting of Shareholders to be held on May 8, 2009, which will be filed within 120 days of the end of our fiscal year ended November 28, 2008 (2009 Proxy Statement) and is incorporated herein by reference. Information relating to our Code of Business Conduct and Ethics that applies to our senior financial officers, as defined in the Code, is included in Part I, Item 1 of our Annual Report on Form 10-K.
 
Item 11.   Executive Compensation
 
Information relating to our executive officer and director compensation and the compensation committee of our board of directors will be in the 2009 Proxy Statement and is incorporated herein by reference.
 
Item 12.   Security Ownership of Certain Beneficial Owners and Management and Related Stockholder Matters
 
Information relating to security ownership of certain beneficial owners of our common stock and information relating to the security ownership of our management will be in the 2009 Proxy Statement and is incorporated herein by reference.


220


Table of Contents

The following table provides information generally as of November 28, 2008, the last day of fiscal 2008, regarding securities to be issued on exercise of stock options, and securities remaining available for issuance under our equity compensation plans that were in effect during fiscal 2008.
 
                                 
                Number of Securities
        Number of
      Remaining Available
        Securities to be
      for Future Issuance
        Issued Upon
  Weighted-Average
  Under Equity
        Exercise of
  Exercise Price of
  Compensation Plans
        Outstanding
  Outstanding
  (Excluding Securities
        Options, Warrants
  Options, Warrants
  Reflected in the
   
Plan Category
 
and Rights
 
and Rights
 
Second Column)
Equity compensation plans approved by security holders
    The Goldman
Sachs Amended
and Restated
Stock Incentive
Plan (1)
      33,639,132  (2)   $ 109.47  (2)     216,990,058  (3)
Equity compensation plans not approved by security holders
    None                    
                             
Total
            33,639,132  (2)             216,990,058  (3)(4)
                             
 
 
(1) The Goldman Sachs Amended and Restated Stock Incentive Plan (SIP) was approved by the shareholders of Goldman Sachs at our 2003 Annual Meeting of Shareholders and is a successor plan to The Goldman Sachs 1999 Stock Incentive Plan (1999 Plan), which was approved by our shareholders immediately prior to our initial public offering in May 1999 and under which no additional awards have been granted since approval of the SIP.
 
(2) Includes options that are subject to vesting and other conditions.
 
(3) Of these shares, 54,852,028 shares may be issued pursuant to outstanding restricted stock units, including 54,824,666 shares granted under the SIP and 27,362 shares granted under the 1999 Plan; 151,230 shares may be issued pursuant to outstanding performance-based units granted under the SIP.
 
(4) Represents shares remaining to be issued under the SIP (217,388,173 shares) and the 1999 Plan (27,362 shares). The total number of shares of common stock that may be delivered pursuant to awards granted under the SIP initially may not exceed 250,000,000 shares. Beginning November 29, 2008 and each fiscal year thereafter, the number of shares of common stock that may be delivered pursuant to awards granted after April 1, 2003 under the SIP may not exceed 5% of our issued and outstanding shares of common stock, determined as of the last day of the immediately preceding fiscal year, increased by the number of shares that were available for awards in previous fiscal years but were not, at the date of determination, covered by awards granted in previous years.
 
Item 13.   Certain Relationships and Related Transactions, and Director Independence
 
Information regarding certain relationships and related transactions and director independence will be in the 2009 Proxy Statement and is incorporated herein by reference.
 
Item 14.   Principal Accountant Fees and Services
 
Information regarding principal accountant fees and services will be in the 2009 Proxy Statement and is incorporated herein by reference.


221


Table of Contents

 
PART IV
 
Item 15.   Exhibits and Financial Statement Schedules
 
(a)   Documents filed as part of this Report:
 
  1.  Consolidated Financial Statements
 
 The consolidated financial statements required to be filed in our Annual Report on Form 10-K are included in Part II, Item 8 hereof.
 
  2.  Exhibits
 
         
 
2.1
    Plan of Incorporation (incorporated by reference to the corresponding exhibit to the Registrant’s registration statement on Form S-1 (No. 333-74449)).
 
3.1
    Restated Certificate of Incorporation of The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc.
 
3.2
    Amended and Restated By-Laws of The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 3.1 to the Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 8-K, filed December 12, 2006).
 
4.1
    Indenture, dated as of May 19, 1999, between The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. and The Bank of New York, as trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 6 to the Registrant’s registration statement on Form 8-A, filed June 29, 1999).
 
4.2
    Subordinated Debt Indenture, dated as of February 20, 2004, between The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. and The Bank of New York, as trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 28, 2003).
 
4.3
    Warrant Indenture, dated as of February 14, 2006, between The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. and The Bank of New York, as trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.34 to the Registrant’s Post-Effective Amendment No. 3 to Form S-3, filed on March 1, 2006).
 
4.4
    Senior Debt Indenture, dated as of December 4, 2007, among GS Finance Corp., as issuer, The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc., as guarantor, and The Bank of New York, as Trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.69 to the Registrant’s Post-Effective Amendment No. 10 to Form S-3, filed on December 4, 2007).
 
4.5
    Form of floating rate senior debt security (TLGP) issued under the Senior Debt Indenture, dated as of July 16, 2008, between The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. and The Bank of New York Mellon, as trustee.
 
4.6
    Form of fixed rate senior debt security (TLGP) issued under the Senior Debt Indenture, dated as of July 16, 2008, between The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. and The Bank of New York Mellon, as trustee.
 
4.7
    Form of floating rate Medium-Term Note, Series D (TLGP) issued under the Senior Debt Indenture, dated as of July 16, 2008, between The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. and The Bank of New York Mellon, as trustee.
 
4.8
    Form of fixed rate Medium-Term Note, Series D (TLGP) issued under the Senior Debt Indenture, dated as of July 16, 2008, between The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. and The Bank of New York Mellon, as trustee.
 
4.9
    Senior Debt Indenture, dated as of July 16, 2008, between The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. and The Bank of New York Mellon, as trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.82 to the Registrant’s Post-Effective Amendment No. 11 to Form S-3 (No. 333-130074), filed July 17, 2008).
 
4.10
    Senior Debt Indenture, dated as of October 10, 2008, among GS Finance Corp., as issuer, The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc., as guarantor, and The Bank of New York Mellon, as trustee (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.70 to the Registrant’s registration statement on Form S-3 (No. 333-154173), filed October 10, 2008).
       
        Certain instruments defining the rights of holders of long-term debt securities of the Registrant and its subsidiaries are omitted pursuant to Item 601(b)(4)(iii) of Regulation S-K. The Registrant hereby undertakes to furnish to the SEC, upon request, copies of any such instruments.


222


Table of Contents

         
 
10.1
    The Goldman Sachs Amended and Restated Stock Incentive Plan.†
 
10.2
    The Goldman Sachs Defined Contribution Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.16 to the Registrant’s registration statement on Form S-1 (No. 333-75213)).†
 
10.3
    The Goldman Sachs Amended and Restated Restricted Partner Compensation Plan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended February 24, 2006).†
 
10.4
    Form of Employment Agreement for pre-IPO Participating Managing Directors (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.19 to the Registrant’s registration statement on Form S-1 (No. 333-75213)).†
 
10.5
    Form of Agreement Relating to Noncompetition and Other Covenants (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.20 to the Registrant’s registration statement on Form S-1 (No. 333-75213)).†
 
10.6
    Form of Option Agreement (Discretionary Options) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.24 to the Registrant’s registration statement on Form S-1 (No. 333-75213)).†
 
10.7
    Tax Indemnification Agreement, dated as of May 7, 1999, by and among The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. and various parties (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.25 to the Registrant’s registration statement on Form S-1 (No. 333-75213)).
 
10.8
    Amended and Restated Shareholders’ Agreement, dated June 22, 2004, among The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. and various parties (incorporated by reference to Exhibit M to Amendment No. 54 to Schedule 13D, filed June 23, 2004, relating to the Registrant’s common stock (No. 005-56295)).
 
10.9
    Instrument of Indemnification (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.27 to the Registrant’s registration statement on Form S-1 (No. 333-75213)).
 
10.10
    Form of Indemnification Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.28 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 26, 1999).
 
10.11
    Registration Rights Instrument, dated as of December 10, 1999 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit G to Amendment No. 1 to Schedule 13D, filed December 17, 1999, relating to the Registrant’s common stock (No. 005-56295)).
 
10.12
    Supplemental Registration Rights Instrument, dated as of December 10, 1999 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit H to Amendment No. 1 to Schedule 13D, filed December 17, 1999, relating to the Registrant’s common stock (No. 005-56295)).
 
10.13
    Form of Indemnification Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.44 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 26, 1999).
 
10.14
    Form of Indemnification Agreement, dated as of July 5, 2000 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended August 25, 2000).
 
10.15
    Amendment No. 1, dated as of September 5, 2000, to the Tax Indemnification Agreement, dated as of May 7, 1999 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 to the Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended August 25, 2000).
 
10.16
    Supplemental Registration Rights Instrument, dated as of December 21, 2000 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit AA to Amendment No. 12 to Schedule 13D, filed January 23, 2001, relating to the Registrant’s common stock (No. 005-56295)).
 
10.17
    Supplemental Registration Rights Instrument, dated as of December 21, 2001 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.4 to the Registrant’s registration statement on Form S-3 (No. 333-74006)).

223


Table of Contents

         
 
10.18
    Supplemental Registration Rights Instrument, dated as of December 20, 2002 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.4 to the Registrant’s registration statement on Form S-3 (No. 333-101093)).
 
10.19
    Letter, dated February 6, 2001, from The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. to Dr. Ruth J. Simmons (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.63 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 24, 2000).†
 
10.20
    Letter, dated February 6, 2001, from The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. to Mr. John H. Bryan (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.64 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 24, 2000).†
 
10.21
    Letter, dated February 6, 2001, from The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. to Mr. James A. Johnson (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.65 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 24, 2000).†
 
10.22
    Letter, dated December 18, 2002, from The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. to Mr. William W. George (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.39 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 29, 2002).†
 
10.23
    Letter, dated June 20, 2003, from The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. to Mr. Claes Dahlbäck (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended May 30, 2003).†
 
10.24
    Supplemental Registration Rights Instrument, dated as of December 19, 2003 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.4 to the Registrant’s registration statement on Form S-3 (No. 333-110371)).
 
10.25
    Letter, dated March 31, 2004, from The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. to Ms. Lois D. Juliber (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended May 28, 2004).†
 
10.26
    Letter, dated April 6, 2005, from The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. to Mr. Stephen Friedman (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed April 8, 2005).†
 
10.27
    Form of Amendment, dated November 27, 2004, to Agreement Relating to Noncompetition and Other Covenants, dated May 7, 1999 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.32 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 26, 2004).†
 
10.28
    Form of RSU Award Agreement for PMD Discount Stock Program (subject to transfer restrictions) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.29 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2007).†
 
10.29
    Form of RSU Award Agreement for PMD Discount Stock Program (not subject to transfer restrictions) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.30 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2007).†
 
10.30
    Form of RSU Award Agreement for PMD Discount Stock Program (subject to transfer restrictions) (French alternative award) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.31 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2007).†
 
10.31
    Form of RSU Award Agreement for PMD Discount Stock Program (not subject to transfer restrictions) (French alternative award) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.32 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2007).†
 
10.32
    Form of RSU Award Agreement for PMD Discount Stock Program (U.K. employee benefit trusts) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.33 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2007).†
 
10.33
    Form of Year-End Restricted Stock Award (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.34 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2007).†

224


Table of Contents

         
 
10.34
    Form of Year-End Restricted Stock Award in Connection with Outstanding RSU Awards (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.35 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2007).†
 
10.35
    The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. Non-Qualified Deferred Compensation Plan for U.S. Participating Managing Directors (terminated as of December 15, 2008) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.36 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2007).†
 
10.36
    Form of Year-End Option Award Agreement.†
 
10.37
    Form of Year-End RSU Award Agreement (not fully vested upon grant).†
 
10.38
    Form of Year-End RSU Award Agreement (fully vested upon grant) (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.37 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2007).†
 
10.39
    Form of Year-End RSU Award Agreement (French alternative award).†
 
10.40
    Amendments to 2005 and 2006 Year-End RSU and Option Award Agreements (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.44 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 30, 2007).†
 
10.41
    Form of Non-Employee Director Option Award Agreement.†
 
10.42
    Form of Non-Employee Director RSU Award Agreement.†
 
10.43
    Description of Non-Employee Director Compensation.†
 
10.44
    Ground Lease, dated August 23, 2005, between Battery Park City Authority d/b/a/ Hugh L. Carey Battery Park City Authority, as Landlord, and Goldman Sachs Headquarters LLC, as Tenant (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed August 26, 2005).
 
10.45
    General Guarantee Agreement, dated January 30, 2006, made by The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.45 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 25, 2005).
 
10.46
    Letter, dated November 10, 2006, from The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. to Mr. Rajat K. Gupta (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed November 13, 2006).†
 
10.47
    Goldman, Sachs & Co. Executive Life Insurance Policy and Certificate with Metropolitan Life Insurance Company for Participating Managing Directors (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended August 25, 2006).†
 
10.48
    Form of Goldman, Sachs & Co. Executive Life Insurance Policy with Pacific Life & Annuity Company for Participating Managing Directors, including policy specifications and form of restriction on Policy Owner’s Rights (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended August 25, 2006).†
 
10.49
    Form of Signature Card for Equity Awards.†
 
10.50
    Form of Employment Agreement for post-IPO Participating Managing Directors (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.50 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 24, 2006).†
 
10.51
    Form of Second Amendment, dated November 25, 2006, to Agreement Relating to Noncompetition and Other Covenants, dated May 7, 1999, as amended effective November 27, 2004 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.51 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the fiscal year ended November 24, 2006).†
 
10.52
    Description of PMD Retiree Medical Program (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 to the Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended February 29, 2008).†

225


Table of Contents

         
 
10.53
    Letter, dated June 28, 2008, from The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. to Mr. Lakshmi N. Mittal (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 99.1 to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed June 30, 2008).†
 
10.54
    Securities Purchase Agreement, dated September 29, 2008, between The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. and Berkshire Hathaway Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Registrant’s Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the period ended August 29, 2008).
 
10.55
    General Guarantee Agreement, dated October 21, 2008, made by The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. relating to the obligations of Goldman Sachs Bank USA (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.85 to the Registrant’s Post-Effective Amendment No. 1 to Form S-3, filed October 22, 2008).
 
10.56
    Form of Letter Agreement between The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. and each of Lloyd C. Blankfein, Gary D. Cohn, Jon Winkelried and David A. Viniar (incorporated by reference to Exhibit O to Amendment No. 70 to Schedule 13D, filed October 1, 2008, relating to the Registrant’s common stock (No. 005-56295)).
 
10.57
    Letter Agreement, dated as of October 26, 2008, including Securities Purchase Agreement — Standard Terms incorporated by reference therein, between The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. and the United States Department of the Treasury (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Registrant’s Current Report on Form 8-K, filed October 28, 2008).
 
10.58
    Form of Letter Agreement, dated October 28, 2008, between The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. and its senior executive officers relating to executive compensation limitations under the U.S. Treasury Department’s Capital Purchase Program.†
 
10.59
    General Guarantee Agreement, dated November 24, 2008, made by The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. relating to the obligations of Goldman Sachs Bank (Europe) PLC.
 
10.60
    Guarantee Agreement, dated November 28, 2008, between The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc. and Goldman Sachs Bank USA.
 
10.61
    Collateral Agreement, dated November 28, 2008, between The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc., Goldman Sachs Bank USA and each other party that becomes a pledgor pursuant thereto.
 
10.62
    Form of Performance-Based One-Time RSU Award Agreement.†
 
10.63
    Form of Make-Whole One-Time RSU Award Agreement.†
 
10.64
    Form of Incentive One-Time RSU Award Agreement.†
 
10.65
    Form of Year-End Supplemental RSU Award Agreement (employees in France).†
 
10.66
    Form of Signature Card for Equity Awards (employees in Asia outside China).†
 
10.67
    Form of Signature Card for Equity Awards (employees in China).†
 
10.68
    Amendments to Certain Equity Award Agreements.†
 
10.69
    Amendments to Certain Non-Employee Director Equity Award Agreements.†
 
12.1
    Statement re: Computation of Ratios of Earnings to Fixed Charges and Ratios of Earnings to Combined Fixed Charges and Preferred Stock Dividends.
 
21.1
    List of significant subsidiaries of The Goldman Sachs Group, Inc.
 
23.1
    Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm.
 
24.1
    Powers of Attorney (included on signature page).
 
31.1
    Rule 13a-14(a) Certifications.
 
32.1
    Section 1350 Certifications.
 
99.1
    Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm on Selected Financial Data.
 
†  This exhibit is a management contract or a compensatory plan or arrangement.

226


Table of Contents

 
SIGNATURES
 
Pursuant to the requirements of Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, the Registrant has duly caused this report to be signed on its behalf by the undersigned, thereunto duly authorized.
 
THE GOLDMAN SACHS GROUP, INC.
 
  By: 
/s/  David A. Viniar
Name: David A. Viniar
Title: Chief Financial Officer
 
Date: January 26, 2009


II-1


Table of Contents

 
POWER OF ATTORNEY
 
KNOW ALL PERSONS BY THESE PRESENTS, that each person whose signature appears below constitutes and appoints Lloyd C. Blankfein, Gary D. Cohn, Jon Winkelried, David A. Viniar, Gregory K. Palm and Esta E. Stecher, and each of them severally, his or her true and lawful attorney-in-fact with power of substitution and resubstitution to sign in his or her name, place and stead, in any and all capacities, to do any and all things and execute any and all instruments that such attorney may deem necessary or advisable under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 and any rules, regulations and requirements of the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission in connection with our Annual Report on Form 10-K and any and all amendments hereto, as fully for all intents and purposes as he or she might or could do in person, and hereby ratifies and confirms all said attorneys-in-fact and agents, each acting alone, and his or her substitute or substitutes, may lawfully do or cause to be done by virtue hereof.
 
Pursuant to the requirements of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, this report has been signed below by the following persons on behalf of the Registrant and in the capacities and on the dates indicated.
 
             
Signature
 
Capacity
 
Date
 
/s/  Lloyd C. Blankfein

Lloyd C. Blankfein
  Director, Chairman and
Chief Executive Officer
(Principal Executive Officer)
  January 26, 2009
         
/s/  John H. Bryan

John H. Bryan
  Director   January 26, 2009
         
/s/  Gary D. Cohn

Gary D. Cohn
  Director   January 26, 2009
         
/s/  Claes Dahlbäck

Claes Dahlbäck
  Director   January 26, 2009
         
/s/  Stephen Friedman

Stephen Friedman
  Director   January 26, 2009
         
/s/  William W. George

William W. George
  Director   January 26, 2009
         
/s/  Rajat K. Gupta

Rajat K. Gupta
  Director   January 26, 2009
         
/s/  James A. Johnson

James A. Johnson
  Director   January 26, 2009
         
/s/  Lois D. Juliber

Lois D. Juliber
  Director   January 26, 2009
         
/s/  Lakshmi N. Mittal

Lakshmi N. Mittal
  Director   January 26, 2009
         
/s/  Ruth J. Simmons

Ruth J. Simmons
  Director   January 26, 2009


II-2


Table of Contents

             
Signature
 
Capacity
 
Date
 
/s/  Jon Winkelried

Jon Winkelried
  Director   January 26, 2009
         
/s/  David A. Viniar

David A. Viniar
  Chief Financial Officer
(Principal Financial Officer)
  January 26, 2009
         
/s/  Sarah E. Smith

Sarah E. Smith
  Principal Accounting Officer   January 26, 2009


II-3